]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - etc/NEWS
-nb changed to -nbi
[gnu-emacs] / etc / NEWS
1 GNU Emacs NEWS -- history of user-visible changes. 2003-05-21
2 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005
3 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 See the end for copying conditions.
5
6 Please send Emacs bug reports to bug-gnu-emacs@gnu.org.
7 For older news, see the file ONEWS
8 You can narrow news to the specific version by calling
9 `view-emacs-news' with a prefix argument or by typing C-u C-h C-n.
10
11 Temporary note:
12 +++ indicates that the appropriate manual has already been updated.
13 --- means no change in the manuals is called for.
14 When you add a new item, please add it without either +++ or ---
15 so we will look at it and add it to the manual.
16
17 \f
18 * Installation Changes in Emacs 22.1
19
20 ---
21 ** Emacs now supports new configure options `--program-prefix',
22 `--program-suffix' and `--program-transform-name' that affect the names of
23 installed programs.
24
25 ---
26 ** Emacs can now be built without sound support.
27
28 ---
29 ** You can build Emacs with Gtk+ widgets by specifying `--with-x-toolkit=gtk'
30 when you run configure. This requires Gtk+ 2.0 or newer. This port
31 provides a way to display multilingual text in menus (with some caveats).
32
33 ---
34 ** The `emacsserver' program has been removed, replaced with Lisp code.
35
36 ---
37 ** By default, Emacs now uses a setgid helper program to update game
38 scores. The directory ${localstatedir}/games/emacs is the normal
39 place for game scores to be stored. You can control this with the
40 configure option `--with-game-dir'. The specific user that Emacs uses
41 to own the game scores is controlled by `--with-game-user'. If access
42 to a game user is not available, then scores will be stored separately
43 in each user's home directory.
44
45 ---
46 ** Leim is now part of the Emacs distribution.
47 You no longer need to download a separate tarball in order to build
48 Emacs with Leim.
49
50 +++
51 ** The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual is now part of the distribution.
52
53 The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual in Info format is built as part of the
54 Emacs build procedure and installed together with the Emacs User
55 Manual. A menu item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy
56 accessible (Help->More Manuals->Emacs Lisp Reference).
57
58 ---
59 ** The Introduction to Programming in Emacs Lisp manual is now part of
60 the distribution.
61
62 This manual is now part of the standard distribution and is installed,
63 together with the Emacs User Manual, into the Info directory. A menu
64 item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy accessible
65 (Help->More Manuals->Introduction to Emacs Lisp).
66
67 ---
68 ** New translations of the Emacs Tutorial are available in the
69 following languages: Brasilian Portuguese, Bulgarian, Chinese (both
70 with simplified and traditional characters), French, and Italian.
71 Type `C-u C-h t' to choose one of them in case your language setup
72 doesn't automatically select the right one.
73
74 ---
75 ** A French translation of the `Emacs Survival Guide' is available.
76
77 ---
78 ** Emacs now includes support for loading image libraries on demand.
79 (Currently this feature is only used on MS Windows.) You can configure
80 the supported image types and their associated dynamic libraries by
81 setting the variable `image-library-alist'.
82
83 ---
84 ** Support for Cygwin was added.
85
86 ---
87 ** Support for FreeBSD/Alpha has been added.
88
89 ---
90 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on S390 machines was added.
91
92 ---
93 ** Support for MacOS X was added.
94 See the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
95
96 ---
97 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on X86-64 machines was added.
98
99 ---
100 ** Mac OS 9 port now uses the Carbon API by default. You can also
101 create non-Carbon build by specifying `NonCarbon' as a target. See
102 the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
103
104 ---
105 ** Building with -DENABLE_CHECKING does not automatically build with union
106 types any more. Add -DUSE_LISP_UNION_TYPE if you want union types.
107
108 ---
109 ** When pure storage overflows while dumping, Emacs now prints how
110 much pure storage it will approximately need.
111
112 ** The script etc/emacs-buffer.gdb can be used with gdb to retrieve the
113 contents of buffers from a core dump and save them to files easily, should
114 emacs crash.
115
116 \f
117 * Startup Changes in Emacs 22.1
118
119 +++
120 ** New command line option -Q or --quick.
121 This is like using -q --no-site-file, but in addition it also disables
122 the fancy startup screen.
123
124 +++
125 ** New command line option -D or --basic-display.
126 Disables the menu-bar, the tool-bar, the scroll-bars, tool tips, and
127 the blinking cursor.
128
129 +++
130 ** New command line option -nbc or --no-blinking-cursor disables
131 the blinking cursor on graphical terminals.
132
133 +++
134 ** The option --script FILE runs Emacs in batch mode and loads FILE.
135 It is useful for writing Emacs Lisp shell script files, because they
136 can start with this line:
137
138 #!/usr/bin/emacs --script
139
140 +++
141 ** The option --directory DIR now modifies `load-path' immediately.
142 Directories are added to the front of `load-path' in the order they
143 appear on the command line. For example, with this command line:
144
145 emacs -batch -L .. -L /tmp --eval "(require 'foo)"
146
147 Emacs looks for library `foo' in the parent directory, then in /tmp, then
148 in the other directories in `load-path'. (-L is short for --directory.)
149
150 +++
151 ** The command line option --no-windows has been changed to
152 --no-window-system. The old one still works, but is deprecated.
153
154 +++
155 ** The -f option, used from the command line to call a function,
156 now reads arguments for the function interactively if it is
157 an interactively callable function.
158
159 +++
160 ** When you specify a frame size with --geometry, the size applies to
161 all frames you create. A position specified with --geometry only
162 affects the initial frame.
163
164 +++
165 ** Emacs can now be invoked in full-screen mode on a windowed display.
166 When Emacs is invoked on a window system, the new command-line options
167 `--fullwidth', `--fullheight', and `--fullscreen' produce a frame
168 whose width, height, or both width and height take up the entire
169 screen size. (For now, this does not work with some window managers.)
170
171 +++
172 ** Emacs now displays a splash screen by default even if command-line
173 arguments were given. The new command-line option --no-splash
174 disables the splash screen; see also the variable
175 `inhibit-startup-message' (which is also aliased as
176 `inhibit-splash-screen').
177
178 +++
179 ** The default is now to use an bitmap as the icon, so the command-line options
180 --icon-type, -i has been replaced with options --no-bitmap-icon, -nbi to turn
181 the bitmap icon off.
182
183 +++
184 ** New user option `inhibit-startup-buffer-menu'.
185 When loading many files, for instance with `emacs *', Emacs normally
186 displays a buffer menu. This option turns the buffer menu off.
187
188 +++
189 ** Init file changes
190 You can now put the init files .emacs and .emacs_SHELL under
191 ~/.emacs.d or directly under ~. Emacs will find them in either place.
192
193 +++
194 ** Emacs now reads the standard abbrevs file ~/.abbrev_defs
195 automatically at startup, if it exists. When Emacs offers to save
196 modified buffers, it saves the abbrevs too if they have changed. It
197 can do this either silently or asking for confirmation first,
198 according to the value of `save-abbrevs'.
199 \f
200 * Incompatible Editing Changes in Emacs 22.1
201
202 +++
203 ** M-g is now a prefix key.
204 M-g g and M-g M-g run goto-line.
205 M-g n and M-g M-n run next-error (like C-x `).
206 M-g p and M-g M-p run previous-error.
207
208 +++
209 ** C-u M-g M-g switches to the most recent previous buffer,
210 and goes to the specified line in that buffer.
211
212 When goto-line starts to execute, if there's a number in the buffer at
213 point then it acts as the default argument for the minibuffer.
214
215 +++
216 ** The old bindings C-M-delete and C-M-backspace have been deleted,
217 since there are situations where one or the other will shut down
218 the operating system or your X server.
219
220 +++
221 ** line-move-ignore-invisible now defaults to t.
222
223 +++
224 ** When the undo information of the current command gets really large
225 (beyond the value of `undo-outer-limit'), Emacs discards it and warns
226 you about it.
227
228 +++
229 ** `apply-macro-to-region-lines' now operates on all lines that begin
230 in the region, rather than on all complete lines in the region.
231
232 +++
233 ** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
234 previous mark, i.e. C-u C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... cycles through the
235 mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC to set the mark immediately after a jump.
236
237 +++
238 ** The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
239 have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
240
241 +++
242 ** In incremental search, C-w is changed. M-%, C-M-w and C-M-y are special.
243
244 See below under "incremental search changes".
245
246 ---
247 ** C-x C-f RET, typing nothing in the minibuffer, is no longer a special case.
248
249 Since the default input is the current directory, this has the effect
250 of specifying the current directory. Normally that means to visit the
251 directory with Dired.
252
253 +++
254 ** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
255 to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
256 it remains unchanged.
257
258 +++
259 ** M-o now is the prefix key for setting text properties;
260 M-o M-o requests refontification.
261
262 +++
263 ** You can now follow links by clicking Mouse-1 on the link.
264
265 See below for more details.
266
267 +++
268 ** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
269 control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
270 by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
271 too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
272 doublequotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
273 special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
274 \f
275 * Editing Changes in Emacs 22.1
276
277 +++
278 ** The max size of buffers and integers has been doubled.
279 On 32bit machines, it is now 256M (i.e. 268435455).
280
281 +++
282 ** M-g is now a prefix key.
283 M-g g and M-g M-g run goto-line.
284 M-g n and M-g M-n run next-error (like C-x `).
285 M-g p and M-g M-p run previous-error.
286
287 +++
288 ** C-u M-g M-g switches to the most recent previous buffer,
289 and goes to the specified line in that buffer.
290
291 When goto-line starts to execute, if there's a number in the buffer at
292 point then it acts as the default argument for the minibuffer.
293
294 +++
295 ** The old bindings C-M-delete and C-M-backspace have been deleted,
296 since there are situations where one or the other will shut down
297 the operating system or your X server.
298
299 +++
300 ** line-move-ignore-invisible now defaults to t.
301
302 +++
303 ** When the undo information of the current command gets really large
304 (beyond the value of `undo-outer-limit'), Emacs discards it and warns
305 you about it.
306
307 +++
308 ** `apply-macro-to-region-lines' now operates on all lines that begin
309 in the region, rather than on all complete lines in the region.
310
311 +++
312 ** You can now switch buffers in a cyclic order with C-x C-left and
313 (prev-buffer) and C-x C-right (next-buffer). C-x left and C-x right
314 can be used as well.
315
316 +++
317 ** `undo-only' does an undo which does not redo any previous undo.
318
319 +++
320 ** M-SPC (just-one-space) when given a numeric argument N
321 converts whitespace around point to N spaces.
322
323 ---
324 ** New commands to operate on pairs of open and close characters:
325 `insert-pair', `delete-pair', `raise-sexp'.
326
327 ---
328 ** New command `kill-whole-line' kills an entire line at once.
329 By default, it is bound to C-S-<backspace>.
330
331 +++
332 ** Yanking text now discards certain text properties that can
333 be inconvenient when you did not expect them. The variable
334 `yank-excluded-properties' specifies which ones. Insertion
335 of register contents and rectangles also discards these properties.
336
337 +++
338 ** The default values of paragraph-start and indent-line-function have
339 been changed to reflect those used in Text mode rather than those used
340 in Indented-Text mode.
341
342 +++
343 ** M-x setenv now expands environment variable references.
344
345 Substrings of the form `$foo' and `${foo}' in the specified new value
346 now refer to the value of environment variable foo. To include a `$'
347 in the value, use `$$'.
348
349 +++
350 ** `special-display-buffer-names' and `special-display-regexps' now
351 understand two new boolean pseudo-frame-parameters `same-frame' and
352 `same-window'.
353
354 +++
355 ** The default for the paper size (variable ps-paper-type) is taken
356 from the locale.
357
358 ** The command `list-faces-display' now accepts a prefix arg.
359 When passed, the function prompts for a regular expression and lists
360 only faces matching this regexp.
361
362 ** Mark command changes:
363
364 +++
365 *** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
366 previous mark, i.e. C-u C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... cycles through the
367 mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC to set the mark immediately after a jump.
368
369 +++
370 *** Marking commands extend the region when invoked multiple times.
371
372 If you type C-M-SPC (mark-sexp), M-@ (mark-word), M-h
373 (mark-paragraph), or C-M-h (mark-defun) repeatedly, the marked region
374 extends each time, so you can mark the next two sexps with M-C-SPC
375 M-C-SPC, for example. This feature also works for
376 mark-end-of-sentence, if you bind that to a key. It also extends the
377 region when the mark is active in Transient Mark mode, regardless of
378 the last command. To start a new region with one of marking commands
379 in Transient Mark mode, you can deactivate the active region with C-g,
380 or set the new mark with C-SPC.
381
382 +++
383 *** M-h (mark-paragraph) now accepts a prefix arg.
384
385 With positive arg, M-h marks the current and the following paragraphs;
386 if the arg is negative, it marks the current and the preceding
387 paragraphs.
388
389 +++
390 *** Some commands do something special in Transient Mark mode when the
391 mark is active--for instance, they limit their operation to the
392 region. Even if you don't normally use Transient Mark mode, you might
393 want to get this behavior from a particular command. There are two
394 ways you can enable Transient Mark mode and activate the mark, for one
395 command only.
396
397 One method is to type C-SPC C-SPC; this enables Transient Mark mode
398 and sets the mark at point. The other method is to type C-u C-x C-x.
399 This enables Transient Mark mode temporarily but does not alter the
400 mark or the region.
401
402 After these commands, Transient Mark mode remains enabled until you
403 deactivate the mark. That typically happens when you type a command
404 that alters the buffer, but you can also deactivate the mark by typing
405 C-g.
406
407 +++
408 *** Movement commands `beginning-of-buffer', `end-of-buffer',
409 `beginning-of-defun', `end-of-defun' do not set the mark if the mark
410 is already active in Transient Mark mode.
411
412 ** Help command changes:
413
414 +++
415 *** Changes in C-h bindings:
416
417 C-h e displays the *Messages* buffer.
418
419 C-h followed by a control character is used for displaying files
420 that do not change:
421
422 C-h C-f displays the FAQ.
423 C-h C-e displays the PROBLEMS file.
424
425 The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
426 have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
427
428 C-h c, C-h k, C-h w, and C-h f now handle remapped interactive commands.
429
430 - C-h c and C-h k report the actual command (after possible remapping)
431 run by the key sequence.
432
433 - C-h w and C-h f on a command which has been remapped now report the
434 command it is remapped to, and the keys which can be used to run
435 that command.
436
437 For example, if C-k is bound to kill-line, and kill-line is remapped
438 to new-kill-line, these commands now report:
439
440 - C-h c and C-h k C-k reports:
441 C-k runs the command new-kill-line
442
443 - C-h w and C-h f kill-line reports:
444 kill-line is remapped to new-kill-line which is on C-k, <deleteline>
445
446 - C-h w and C-h f new-kill-line reports:
447 new-kill-line is on C-k
448
449 ---
450 *** Help commands `describe-function' and `describe-key' now show function
451 arguments in lowercase italics on displays that support it. To change the
452 default, customize face `help-argument-name' or redefine the function
453 `help-default-arg-highlight'.
454
455 +++
456 *** C-h v and C-h f commands now include a hyperlink to the C source for
457 variables and functions defined in C (if the C source is available).
458
459 +++
460 *** Help mode now only makes hyperlinks for faces when the face name is
461 preceded or followed by the word `face'. It no longer makes
462 hyperlinks for variables without variable documentation, unless
463 preceded by one of the words `variable' or `option'. It now makes
464 hyperlinks to Info anchors (or nodes) if the anchor (or node) name is
465 enclosed in single quotes and preceded by `info anchor' or `Info
466 anchor' (in addition to earlier `info node' and `Info node').
467
468 +++
469 *** The new command `describe-char' (C-u C-x =) pops up a buffer with
470 description various information about a character, including its
471 encodings and syntax, its text properties, how to input, overlays, and
472 widgets at point. You can get more information about some of them, by
473 clicking on mouse-sensitive areas or moving there and pressing RET.
474
475 +++
476 *** The command `list-text-properties-at' has been deleted because
477 C-u C-x = gives the same information and more.
478
479 +++
480 *** New command `display-local-help' displays any local help at point
481 in the echo area. It is bound to `C-h .'. It normally displays the
482 same string that would be displayed on mouse-over using the
483 `help-echo' property, but, in certain cases, it can display a more
484 keyboard oriented alternative.
485
486 +++
487 *** New user option `help-at-pt-display-when-idle' allows to
488 automatically show the help provided by `display-local-help' on
489 point-over, after suitable idle time. The amount of idle time is
490 determined by the user option `help-at-pt-timer-delay' and defaults
491 to one second. This feature is turned off by default.
492
493 +++
494 *** The apropos commands now accept a list of words to match.
495 When more than one word is specified, at least two of those words must
496 be present for an item to match. Regular expression matching is still
497 available.
498
499 +++
500 *** The new option `apropos-sort-by-scores' causes the matching items
501 to be sorted according to their score. The score for an item is a
502 number calculated to indicate how well the item matches the words or
503 regular expression that you entered to the apropos command. The best
504 match is listed first, and the calculated score is shown for each
505 matching item.
506
507 ** Incremental Search changes:
508
509 +++
510 *** Vertical scrolling is now possible within incremental search.
511 To enable this feature, customize the new user option
512 `isearch-allow-scroll'. User written commands which satisfy stringent
513 constraints can be marked as "scrolling commands". See the Emacs manual
514 for details.
515
516 +++
517 *** C-w in incremental search now grabs either a character or a word,
518 making the decision in a heuristic way. This new job is done by the
519 command `isearch-yank-word-or-char'. To restore the old behavior,
520 bind C-w to `isearch-yank-word' in `isearch-mode-map'.
521
522 +++
523 *** C-y in incremental search now grabs the next line if point is already
524 at the end of a line.
525
526 +++
527 *** C-M-w deletes and C-M-y grabs a character in isearch mode.
528 Another method to grab a character is to enter the minibuffer by `M-e'
529 and to type `C-f' at the end of the search string in the minibuffer.
530
531 +++
532 *** M-% typed in isearch mode invokes `query-replace' or
533 `query-replace-regexp' (depending on search mode) with the current
534 search string used as the string to replace.
535
536 +++
537 *** Isearch no longer adds `isearch-resume' commands to the command
538 history by default. To enable this feature, customize the new
539 user option `isearch-resume-in-command-history'.
540
541 ** Replace command changes:
542
543 ---
544 *** New user option `query-replace-skip-read-only': when non-nil,
545 `query-replace' and related functions simply ignore
546 a match if part of it has a read-only property.
547
548 +++
549 *** When used interactively, the commands `query-replace-regexp' and
550 `replace-regexp' allow \,expr to be used in a replacement string,
551 where expr is an arbitrary Lisp expression evaluated at replacement
552 time. In many cases, this will be more convenient than using
553 `query-replace-regexp-eval'. `\#' in a replacement string now refers
554 to the count of replacements already made by the replacement command.
555 All regular expression replacement commands now allow `\?' in the
556 replacement string to specify a position where the replacement string
557 can be edited for each replacement.
558
559 +++
560 *** query-replace uses isearch lazy highlighting when the new user option
561 `query-replace-lazy-highlight' is non-nil.
562
563 ---
564 *** The current match in query-replace is highlighted in new face
565 `query-replace' which by default inherits from isearch face.
566
567 ** File operation changes:
568
569 +++
570 *** Unquoted `$' in file names do not signal an error any more when
571 the corresponding environment variable does not exist.
572 Instead, the `$ENVVAR' text is left as is, so that `$$' quoting
573 is only rarely needed.
574
575 +++
576 *** In processing a local variables list, Emacs strips the prefix and
577 suffix are from every line before processing all the lines.
578
579 +++
580 *** find-file-read-only visits multiple files in read-only mode,
581 when the file name contains wildcard characters.
582
583 +++
584 *** find-alternate-file replaces the current file with multiple files,
585 when the file name contains wildcard characters.
586
587 +++
588 *** Auto Compression mode is now enabled by default.
589
590 ---
591 *** C-x C-f RET, typing nothing in the minibuffer, is no longer a special case.
592
593 Since the default input is the current directory, this has the effect
594 of specifying the current directory. Normally that means to visit the
595 directory with Dired.
596
597 +++
598 *** When you are root, and you visit a file whose modes specify
599 read-only, the Emacs buffer is now read-only too. Type C-x C-q if you
600 want to make the buffer writable. (As root, you can in fact alter the
601 file.)
602
603 +++
604 *** C-x s (save-some-buffers) now offers an option `d' to diff a buffer
605 against its file, so you can see what changes you would be saving.
606
607 +++
608 *** The commands copy-file, rename-file, make-symbolic-link and
609 add-name-to-file, when given a directory as the "new name" argument,
610 convert it to a file name by merging in the within-directory part of
611 the existing file's name. (This is the same convention that shell
612 commands cp, mv, and ln follow.) Thus, M-x copy-file RET ~/foo RET
613 /tmp RET copies ~/foo to /tmp/foo.
614
615 ---
616 *** When used interactively, `format-write-file' now asks for confirmation
617 before overwriting an existing file, unless a prefix argument is
618 supplied. This behavior is analogous to `write-file'.
619
620 ---
621 *** The variable `auto-save-file-name-transforms' now has a third element that
622 controls whether or not the function `make-auto-save-file-name' will
623 attempt to construct a unique auto-save name (e.g. for remote files).
624
625 +++
626 *** The new option `write-region-inhibit-fsync' disables calls to fsync
627 in `write-region'. This can be useful on laptops to avoid spinning up
628 the hard drive upon each file save. Enabling this variable may result
629 in data loss, use with care.
630
631 +++
632 *** If the user visits a file larger than `large-file-warning-threshold',
633 Emacs asks for confirmation.
634
635 +++
636 *** require-final-newline now has two new possible values:
637
638 `visit' means add a newline (as an undoable change) if it's needed
639 when visiting the file.
640
641 `visit-save' means add a newline (as an undoable change) if it's
642 needed when visiting the file, and also add a newline if it's needed
643 when saving the file.
644
645 +++
646 *** The new option mode-require-final-newline controls how certain
647 major modes enable require-final-newline. Any major mode that's
648 designed for a kind of file that should normally end in a newline
649 sets require-final-newline based on mode-require-final-newline.
650 So you can customize mode-require-final-newline to control what these
651 modes do.
652
653 ** Minibuffer changes:
654
655 +++
656 *** There's a new face `minibuffer-prompt'.
657 Emacs adds this face to the list of text properties stored in the
658 variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', which is used to display the
659 prompt string.
660
661 ---
662 *** Enhanced visual feedback in `*Completions*' buffer.
663
664 Completions lists use faces to highlight what all completions
665 have in common and where they begin to differ.
666
667 The common prefix shared by all possible completions uses the face
668 `completions-common-part', while the first character that isn't the
669 same uses the face `completions-first-difference'. By default,
670 `completions-common-part' inherits from `default', and
671 `completions-first-difference' inherits from `bold'. The idea of
672 `completions-common-part' is that you can use it to make the common
673 parts less visible than normal, so that the rest of the differing
674 parts is, by contrast, slightly highlighted.
675
676 +++
677 *** File-name completion can now ignore specified directories.
678 If an element of the list in `completion-ignored-extensions' ends in a
679 slash `/', it indicates a subdirectory that should be ignored when
680 completing file names. Elements of `completion-ignored-extensions'
681 which do not end in a slash are never considered when a completion
682 candidate is a directory.
683
684 +++
685 *** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
686 to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
687 it remains unchanged.
688
689 +++
690 *** New user option `history-delete-duplicates'.
691 If set to t when adding a new history element, all previous identical
692 elements are deleted.
693
694 ** Redisplay changes:
695
696 +++
697 *** The mode line position information now comes before the major mode.
698 When the file is maintained under version control, that information
699 appears between the position information and the major mode.
700
701 +++
702 *** New face `escape-glyph' highlights control characters and escape glyphs.
703
704 +++
705 *** Non-breaking space and hyphens are now displayed with a special
706 face, either nobreak-space or escape-glyph. You can turn this off or
707 specify a different mode by setting the variable `nobreak-char-display'.
708
709 +++
710 *** The parameters of automatic hscrolling can now be customized.
711 The variable `hscroll-margin' determines how many columns away from
712 the window edge point is allowed to get before automatic hscrolling
713 will horizontally scroll the window. The default value is 5.
714
715 The variable `hscroll-step' determines how many columns automatic
716 hscrolling scrolls the window when point gets too close to the
717 window edge. If its value is zero, the default, Emacs scrolls the
718 window so as to center point. If its value is an integer, it says how
719 many columns to scroll. If the value is a floating-point number, it
720 gives the fraction of the window's width to scroll the window.
721
722 The variable `automatic-hscrolling' was renamed to
723 `auto-hscroll-mode'. The old name is still available as an alias.
724
725 ---
726 *** Moving or scrolling through images (and other lines) taller that
727 the window now works sensibly, by automatically adjusting the window's
728 vscroll property.
729
730 +++
731 *** The new face `mode-line-inactive' is used to display the mode line
732 of non-selected windows. The `mode-line' face is now used to display
733 the mode line of the currently selected window.
734
735 The new variable `mode-line-in-non-selected-windows' controls whether
736 the `mode-line-inactive' face is used.
737
738 +++
739 *** You can now customize the use of window fringes. To control this
740 for all frames, use M-x fringe-mode or the Show/Hide submenu of the
741 top-level Options menu, or customize the `fringe-mode' variable. To
742 control this for a specific frame, use the command M-x
743 set-fringe-style.
744
745 +++
746 *** Angle icons in the fringes can indicate the buffer boundaries. In
747 addition, up and down arrow bitmaps in the fringe indicate which ways
748 the window can be scrolled.
749
750 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
751 `indicate-buffer-boundaries' to a non-nil value. The default value of
752 this variable is found in `default-indicate-buffer-boundaries'.
753
754 If value is `left' or `right', both angle and arrow bitmaps are
755 displayed in the left or right fringe, resp.
756
757 The value can also be an alist which specifies the presence and
758 position of each bitmap individually.
759
760 For example, ((top . left) (t . right)) places the top angle bitmap
761 in left fringe, the bottom angle bitmap in right fringe, and both
762 arrow bitmaps in right fringe. To show just the angle bitmaps in the
763 left fringe, but no arrow bitmaps, use ((top . left) (bottom . left)).
764
765 +++
766 *** On window systems, lines which are exactly as wide as the window
767 (not counting the final newline character) are no longer broken into
768 two lines on the display (with just the newline on the second line).
769 Instead, the newline now "overflows" into the right fringe, and the
770 cursor will be displayed in the fringe when positioned on that newline.
771
772 The new user option 'overflow-newline-into-fringe' can be set to nil to
773 revert to the old behavior of continuing such lines.
774
775 +++
776 *** When a window has display margin areas, the fringes are now
777 displayed between the margins and the buffer's text area, rather than
778 outside those margins.
779
780 +++
781 *** A window can now have individual fringe and scroll-bar settings,
782 in addition to the individual display margin settings.
783
784 Such individual settings are now preserved when windows are split
785 horizontally or vertically, a saved window configuration is restored,
786 or when the frame is resized.
787
788 ** Cursor display changes:
789
790 +++
791 *** On X, MS Windows, and Mac OS, the blinking cursor's "off" state is
792 now controlled by the variable `blink-cursor-alist'.
793
794 +++
795 *** The X resource cursorBlink can be used to turn off cursor blinking.
796
797 +++
798 *** Emacs can produce an underscore-like (horizontal bar) cursor.
799 The underscore cursor is set by putting `(cursor-type . hbar)' in
800 default-frame-alist. It supports variable heights, like the `bar'
801 cursor does.
802
803 +++
804 *** Display of hollow cursors now obeys the buffer-local value (if any)
805 of `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' in the buffer that the cursor
806 appears in.
807
808 +++
809 *** The variable `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' can now be set to any
810 of the recognized cursor types.
811
812 ** New faces:
813
814 +++
815 *** `mode-line-highlight' is the standard face indicating mouse sensitive
816 elements on mode-line (and header-line) like `highlight' face on text
817 areas.
818
819 +++
820 *** `shadow' face defines the appearance of the "shadowed" text, i.e.
821 the text which should be less noticeable than the surrounding text.
822 This can be achieved by using shades of grey in contrast with either
823 black or white default foreground color. This generic shadow face
824 allows customization of the appearance of shadowed text in one place,
825 so package-specific faces can inherit from it.
826
827 +++
828 *** `vertical-border' face is used for the vertical divider between windows.
829
830 ** Font-Lock changes:
831
832 +++
833 *** M-o now is the prefix key for setting text properties;
834 M-o M-o requests refontification.
835
836 +++
837 *** All modes now support using M-x font-lock-mode to toggle
838 fontification, even those such as Occur, Info, and comint-derived
839 modes that do their own fontification in a special way.
840
841 The variable `Info-fontify' is no longer applicable; to disable
842 fontification in Info, remove `turn-on-font-lock' from
843 `Info-mode-hook'.
844
845 +++
846 *** font-lock-lines-before specifies a number of lines before the
847 current line that should be refontified when you change the buffer.
848 The default value is 1.
849
850 +++
851 *** font-lock: in modes like C and Lisp where the fontification assumes that
852 an open-paren in column 0 is always outside of any string or comment,
853 font-lock now highlights any such open-paren-in-column-zero in bold-red
854 if it is inside a string or a comment, to indicate that it can cause
855 trouble with fontification and/or indentation.
856
857 +++
858 *** New standard font-lock face `font-lock-preprocessor-face'.
859
860 +++
861 *** New standard font-lock face `font-lock-comment-delimiter-face'.
862
863 +++
864 *** Easy to overlook single character negation can now be font-locked.
865 You can use the new variable `font-lock-negation-char-face' and the face of
866 the same name to customize this. Currently the cc-modes, sh-script-mode,
867 cperl-mode and make-mode support this.
868
869 ---
870 *** The default settings for JIT stealth lock parameters are changed.
871 The default value for the user option jit-lock-stealth-time is now 16
872 instead of 3, and the default value of jit-lock-stealth-nice is now
873 0.5 instead of 0.125. The new defaults should lower the CPU usage
874 when Emacs is fontifying in the background.
875
876 ---
877 *** jit-lock can now be delayed with `jit-lock-defer-time'.
878
879 If this variable is non-nil, its value should be the amount of Emacs
880 idle time in seconds to wait before starting fontification. For
881 example, if you set `jit-lock-defer-time' to 0.25, fontification will
882 only happen after 0.25s of idle time.
883
884 ---
885 *** contextual refontification is now separate from stealth fontification.
886
887 jit-lock-defer-contextually is renamed jit-lock-contextually and
888 jit-lock-context-time determines the delay after which contextual
889 refontification takes place.
890
891 ** Menu support:
892
893 ---
894 *** A menu item "Show/Hide" was added to the top-level menu "Options".
895 This menu allows you to turn various display features on and off (such
896 as the fringes, the tool bar, the speedbar, and the menu bar itself).
897 You can also move the vertical scroll bar to either side here or turn
898 it off completely. There is also a menu-item to toggle displaying of
899 current date and time, current line and column number in the mode-line.
900
901 ---
902 *** Speedbar has moved from the "Tools" top level menu to "Show/Hide".
903
904 ---
905 *** You can exit dialog windows and menus by typing C-g.
906
907 ---
908 *** The menu item "Open File..." has been split into two items, "New File..."
909 and "Open File...". "Open File..." now opens only existing files. This is
910 to support existing GUI file selection dialogs better.
911
912 +++
913 *** The file selection dialog for Gtk+, Mac, W32 and Motif/Lesstif can be
914 disabled by customizing the variable `use-file-dialog'.
915
916 ---
917 *** The pop up menus for Lucid now stay up if you do a fast click and can
918 be navigated with the arrow keys (like Gtk+, Mac and W32).
919
920 +++
921 *** The Lucid menus can display multilingual text in your locale. You have
922 to explicitly specify a fontSet resource for this to work, for example
923 `-xrm "Emacs*fontSet: -*-helvetica-medium-r-*--*-120-*-*-*-*-*-*,*"'.
924
925 ---
926 *** Dialogs for Lucid/Athena and Lesstif/Motif now pops down when pressing
927 ESC, like they do for Gtk+, Mac and W32.
928
929 +++
930 *** For Gtk+ version 2.4, you can make Emacs use the old file dialog
931 by setting the variable `x-use-old-gtk-file-dialog' to t. Default is to use
932 the new dialog.
933
934 ** Mouse changes:
935
936 +++
937 *** If you set the new variable `mouse-autoselect-window' to a non-nil
938 value, windows are automatically selected as you move the mouse from
939 one Emacs window to another, even within a frame. A minibuffer window
940 can be selected only when it is active.
941
942 +++
943 *** On X, when the window manager requires that you click on a frame to
944 select it (give it focus), the selected window and cursor position
945 normally changes according to the mouse click position. If you set
946 the variable x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position to t, the selected
947 window and cursor position do not change when you click on a frame
948 to give it focus.
949
950 +++
951 *** You can now follow links by clicking Mouse-1 on the link.
952
953 Traditionally, Emacs uses a Mouse-1 click to set point and a Mouse-2
954 click to follow a link, whereas most other applications use a Mouse-1
955 click for both purposes, depending on whether you click outside or
956 inside a link. Now the behavior of a Mouse-1 click has been changed
957 to match this context-sentitive dual behavior. (If you prefer the old
958 behavior, set the user option `mouse-1-click-follows-link' to nil.)
959
960 Depending on the current mode, a Mouse-2 click in Emacs can do much
961 more than just follow a link, so the new Mouse-1 behavior is only
962 activated for modes which explicitly mark a clickable text as a "link"
963 (see the new function `mouse-on-link-p' for details). The Lisp
964 packages that are included in release 22.1 have been adapted to do
965 this, but external packages may not yet support this. However, there
966 is no risk in using such packages, as the worst thing that could
967 happen is that you get the original Mouse-1 behavior when you click
968 on a link, which typically means that you set point where you click.
969
970 If you want to get the original Mouse-1 action also inside a link, you
971 just need to press the Mouse-1 button a little longer than a normal
972 click (i.e. press and hold the Mouse-1 button for half a second before
973 you release it).
974
975 Dragging the Mouse-1 inside a link still performs the original
976 drag-mouse-1 action, typically copy the text.
977
978 You can customize the new Mouse-1 behavior via the new user options
979 `mouse-1-click-follows-link' and `mouse-1-click-in-non-selected-windows'.
980
981 +++
982 *** Emacs normally highlights mouse sensitive text whenever the mouse
983 is over the text. By setting the new variable `mouse-highlight', you
984 can optionally enable mouse highlighting only after you move the
985 mouse, so that highlighting disappears when you press a key. You can
986 also disable mouse highlighting.
987
988 +++
989 *** You can now customize if selecting a region by dragging the mouse
990 shall not copy the selected text to the kill-ring by setting the new
991 variable mouse-drag-copy-region to nil.
992
993 ---
994 *** mouse-wheels can now scroll a specific fraction of the window
995 (rather than a fixed number of lines) and the scrolling is `progressive'.
996
997 ---
998 *** Emacs ignores mouse-2 clicks while the mouse wheel is being moved.
999
1000 People tend to push the mouse wheel (which counts as a mouse-2 click)
1001 unintentionally while turning the wheel, so these clicks are now
1002 ignored. You can customize this with the mouse-wheel-click-event and
1003 mouse-wheel-inhibit-click-time variables.
1004
1005 +++
1006 *** Under X, mouse-wheel-mode is turned on by default.
1007
1008 ** Multilingual Environment (Mule) changes:
1009
1010 ---
1011 *** Language environment and various default coding systems are setup
1012 more correctly according to the current locale name. If the locale
1013 name doesn't specify a charset, the default is what glibc defines.
1014 This change can result in using the different coding systems as
1015 default in some locale (e.g. vi_VN).
1016
1017 +++
1018 *** The keyboard-coding-system is now automatically set based on your
1019 current locale settings if you are not using a window system. This
1020 can mean that the META key doesn't work but generates non-ASCII
1021 characters instead, depending on how the terminal (or terminal
1022 emulator) works. Use `set-keyboard-coding-system' (or customize
1023 keyboard-coding-system) if you prefer META to work (the old default)
1024 or if the locale doesn't describe the character set actually generated
1025 by the keyboard. See Info node `Single-Byte Character Support'.
1026
1027 +++
1028 *** The new command `revert-buffer-with-coding-system' (C-x RET r)
1029 revisits the current file using a coding system that you specify.
1030
1031 +++
1032 *** New command `recode-region' decodes the region again by a specified
1033 coding system.
1034
1035 +++
1036 *** The new command `recode-file-name' changes the encoding of the name
1037 of a file.
1038
1039 ---
1040 *** New command `ucs-insert' inserts a character specified by its
1041 unicode.
1042
1043 +++
1044 *** The new command `set-file-name-coding-system' (C-x RET F) sets
1045 coding system for encoding and decoding file names. A new menu item
1046 (Options->Mule->Set Coding Systems->For File Name) invokes this
1047 command.
1048
1049 +++
1050 *** New command quail-show-key shows what key (or key sequence) to type
1051 in the current input method to input a character at point.
1052
1053 +++
1054 *** Limited support for character `unification' has been added.
1055 Emacs now knows how to translate between different representations of
1056 the same characters in various Emacs charsets according to standard
1057 Unicode mappings. This applies mainly to characters in the ISO 8859
1058 sets plus some other 8-bit sets, but can be extended. For instance,
1059 translation works amongst the Emacs ...-iso8859-... charsets and the
1060 mule-unicode-... ones.
1061
1062 By default this translation happens automatically on encoding.
1063 Self-inserting characters are translated to make the input conformant
1064 with the encoding of the buffer in which it's being used, where
1065 possible.
1066
1067 You can force a more complete unification with the user option
1068 unify-8859-on-decoding-mode. That maps all the Latin-N character sets
1069 into Unicode characters (from the latin-iso8859-1 and
1070 mule-unicode-0100-24ff charsets) on decoding. Note that this mode
1071 will often effectively clobber data with an iso-2022 encoding.
1072
1073 ---
1074 *** There is support for decoding Greek and Cyrillic characters into
1075 either Unicode (the mule-unicode charsets) or the iso-8859 charsets,
1076 when possible. The latter are more space-efficient. This is
1077 controlled by user option utf-fragment-on-decoding.
1078
1079 ---
1080 *** New language environments: French, Ukrainian, Tajik,
1081 Bulgarian, Belarusian, Ukrainian, UTF-8, Windows-1255, Welsh, Latin-6,
1082 Latin-7, Lithuanian, Latvian, Swedish, Slovenian, Croatian, Georgian,
1083 Italian, Russian, Malayalam, Tamil, Russian, Chinese-EUC-TW. (Set up
1084 automatically according to the locale.)
1085
1086 ---
1087 *** New input methods: latin-alt-postfix, latin-postfix, latin-prefix,
1088 ukrainian-computer, belarusian, bulgarian-bds, russian-computer,
1089 vietnamese-telex, lithuanian-numeric, lithuanian-keyboard,
1090 latvian-keyboard, welsh, georgian, rfc1345, ucs, sgml,
1091 bulgarian-phonetic, dutch, slovenian, croatian, malayalam-inscript,
1092 tamil-inscript.
1093
1094 ---
1095 *** New input method chinese-sisheng for inputting Chinese Pinyin
1096 characters.
1097
1098 ---
1099 *** Improved Thai support. A new minor mode `thai-word-mode' (which is
1100 automatically activated if you select Thai as a language
1101 environment) changes key bindings of most word-oriented commands to
1102 versions which recognize Thai words. Affected commands are
1103 M-f (forward-word)
1104 M-b (backward-word)
1105 M-d (kill-word)
1106 M-DEL (backward-kill-word)
1107 M-t (transpose-words)
1108 M-q (fill-paragraph)
1109
1110 ---
1111 *** Indian support has been updated.
1112 The in-is13194 coding system is now Unicode-based. CDAC fonts are
1113 assumed. There is a framework for supporting various
1114 Indian scripts, but currently only Devanagari, Malayalam and Tamil are
1115 supported.
1116
1117 ---
1118 *** A UTF-7 coding system is available in the library `utf-7'.
1119
1120 ---
1121 *** The utf-8/16 coding systems have been enhanced.
1122 By default, untranslatable utf-8 sequences are simply composed into
1123 single quasi-characters. User option `utf-translate-cjk-mode' (it is
1124 turned on by default) arranges to translate many utf-8 CJK character
1125 sequences into real Emacs characters in a similar way to the Mule-UCS
1126 system. As this loads a fairly big data on demand, people who are not
1127 interested in CJK characters may want to customize it to nil.
1128 You can augment/amend the CJK translation via hash tables
1129 `ucs-mule-cjk-to-unicode' and `ucs-unicode-to-mule-cjk'. The utf-8
1130 coding system now also encodes characters from most of Emacs's
1131 one-dimensional internal charsets, specifically the ISO-8859 ones.
1132 The utf-16 coding system is affected similarly.
1133
1134 ---
1135 *** A new coding system `euc-tw' has been added for traditional Chinese
1136 in CNS encoding; it accepts both Big 5 and CNS as input; on saving,
1137 Big 5 is then converted to CNS.
1138
1139 ---
1140 *** Many new coding systems are available in the `code-pages' library.
1141 These include complete versions of most of those in codepage.el, based
1142 on Unicode mappings. `codepage-setup' is now obsolete and is used
1143 only in the MS-DOS port of Emacs. All coding systems defined in
1144 `code-pages' are auto-loaded.
1145
1146 ---
1147 *** New variable `utf-translate-cjk-unicode-range' controls which
1148 Unicode characters to translate in `utf-translate-cjk-mode'.
1149
1150 ---
1151 *** iso-10646-1 (`Unicode') fonts can be used to display any range of
1152 characters encodable by the utf-8 coding system. Just specify the
1153 fontset appropriately.
1154
1155 ** Customize changes:
1156
1157 +++
1158 *** Custom themes are collections of customize options. Create a
1159 custom theme with M-x customize-create-theme. Use M-x load-theme to
1160 load and enable a theme, and M-x disable-theme to disable it. Use M-x
1161 enable-theme to renable a disabled theme.
1162
1163 +++
1164 *** The commands M-x customize-face and M-x customize-face-other-window
1165 now look at the character after point. If a face or faces are
1166 specified for that character, the commands by default customize those
1167 faces.
1168
1169 ---
1170 *** The face-customization widget has been reworked to be less confusing.
1171 In particular, when you enable a face attribute using the corresponding
1172 check-box, there's no longer a redundant `*' option in value selection
1173 for that attribute; the values you can choose are only those which make
1174 sense for the attribute. When an attribute is de-selected by unchecking
1175 its check-box, then the (now ignored, but still present temporarily in
1176 case you re-select the attribute) value is hidden.
1177
1178 +++
1179 *** When you set or reset a variable's value in a Customize buffer,
1180 the previous value becomes the "backup value" of the variable.
1181 You can go back to that backup value by selecting "Use Backup Value"
1182 under the "[State]" button.
1183
1184 ** Buffer Menu changes:
1185
1186 +++
1187 *** New command `Buffer-menu-toggle-files-only' toggles display of file
1188 buffers only in the Buffer Menu. It is bound to `T' in Buffer Menu
1189 mode.
1190
1191 +++
1192 *** `buffer-menu' and `list-buffers' now list buffers whose names begin
1193 with a space, when those buffers are visiting files. Normally buffers
1194 whose names begin with space are omitted.
1195
1196 ---
1197 *** The new options `buffers-menu-show-directories' and
1198 `buffers-menu-show-status' let you control how buffers are displayed
1199 in the menu dropped down when you click "Buffers" from the menu bar.
1200
1201 `buffers-menu-show-directories' controls whether the menu displays
1202 leading directories as part of the file name visited by the buffer.
1203 If its value is `unless-uniquify', the default, directories are
1204 shown unless uniquify-buffer-name-style' is non-nil. The value of nil
1205 and t turn the display of directories off and on, respectively.
1206
1207 `buffers-menu-show-status' controls whether the Buffers menu includes
1208 the modified and read-only status of the buffers. By default it is
1209 t, and the status is shown.
1210
1211 Setting these variables directly does not take effect until next time
1212 the Buffers menu is regenerated.
1213
1214 ** Dired mode:
1215
1216 ---
1217 *** New faces dired-header, dired-mark, dired-marked, dired-flagged,
1218 dired-ignored, dired-directory, dired-symlink, dired-warning
1219 introduced for Dired mode instead of font-lock faces.
1220
1221 +++
1222 *** New Dired command `dired-compare-directories' marks files
1223 with different file attributes in two dired buffers.
1224
1225 +++
1226 *** New Dired command `dired-do-touch' (bound to T) changes timestamps
1227 of marked files with the value entered in the minibuffer.
1228
1229 +++
1230 *** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
1231 control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
1232 by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
1233 too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
1234 doublequotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
1235 special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
1236
1237 +++
1238 *** In Dired, the w command now copies the current line's file name
1239 into the kill ring. With a zero prefix arg, copies absolute file names.
1240
1241 +++
1242 *** In Dired-x, Omitting files is now a minor mode, dired-omit-mode.
1243
1244 The mode toggling command is bound to M-o. A new command
1245 dired-mark-omitted, bound to * O, marks omitted files. The variable
1246 dired-omit-files-p is obsoleted, use the mode toggling function
1247 instead.
1248
1249 +++
1250 *** The variables dired-free-space-program and dired-free-space-args
1251 have been renamed to directory-free-space-program and
1252 directory-free-space-args, and they now apply whenever Emacs puts a
1253 directory listing into a buffer.
1254
1255 ** Comint changes:
1256
1257 ---
1258 *** The comint prompt can now be made read-only, using the new user
1259 option `comint-prompt-read-only'. This is not enabled by default,
1260 except in IELM buffers. The read-only status of IELM prompts can be
1261 controlled with the new user option `ielm-prompt-read-only', which
1262 overrides `comint-prompt-read-only'.
1263
1264 The new commands `comint-kill-whole-line' and `comint-kill-region'
1265 support editing comint buffers with read-only prompts.
1266
1267 `comint-kill-whole-line' is like `kill-whole-line', but ignores both
1268 read-only and field properties. Hence, it always kill entire
1269 lines, including any prompts.
1270
1271 `comint-kill-region' is like `kill-region', except that it ignores
1272 read-only properties, if it is safe to do so. This means that if any
1273 part of a prompt is deleted, then the entire prompt must be deleted
1274 and that all prompts must stay at the beginning of a line. If this is
1275 not the case, then `comint-kill-region' behaves just like
1276 `kill-region' if read-only are involved: it copies the text to the
1277 kill-ring, but does not delete it.
1278
1279 +++
1280 *** The new command `comint-insert-previous-argument' in comint-derived
1281 modes (shell-mode etc) inserts arguments from previous command lines,
1282 like bash's `ESC .' binding. It is bound by default to `C-c .', but
1283 otherwise behaves quite similarly to the bash version.
1284
1285 +++
1286 *** `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields' has been renamed
1287 `comint-use-prompt-regexp'. The old name has been kept as an alias,
1288 but declared obsolete.
1289
1290 ** M-x Compile changes:
1291
1292 ---
1293 *** M-x compile has become more robust and reliable
1294
1295 Quite a few more kinds of messages are recognized. Messages that are
1296 recognized as warnings or informational come in orange or green, instead of
1297 red. Informational messages are by default skipped with `next-error'
1298 (controlled by `compilation-skip-threshold').
1299
1300 Location data is collected on the fly as the *compilation* buffer changes.
1301 This means you could modify messages to make them point to different files.
1302 This also means you can not go to locations of messages you may have deleted.
1303
1304 The variable `compilation-error-regexp-alist' has now become customizable. If
1305 you had added your own regexps to this, you'll probably need to include a
1306 leading `^', otherwise they'll match anywhere on a line. There is now also a
1307 `compilation-mode-font-lock-keywords' and it nicely handles all the checks
1308 that configure outputs and -o options so you see at a glance where you are.
1309
1310 The new file etc/compilation.txt gives examples of each type of message.
1311
1312 +++
1313 *** New user option `compilation-environment'.
1314 This option allows you to specify environment variables for inferior
1315 compilation processes without affecting the environment that all
1316 subprocesses inherit.
1317
1318 +++
1319 *** New user option `compilation-disable-input'.
1320 If this is non-nil, send end-of-file as compilation process input.
1321
1322 +++
1323 *** New options `next-error-highlight' and `next-error-highlight-no-select'
1324 specify the method of highlighting of the corresponding source line
1325 in new face `next-error'.
1326
1327 +++
1328 *** A new minor mode `next-error-follow-minor-mode' can be used in
1329 compilation-mode, grep-mode, occur-mode, and diff-mode (i.e. all the
1330 modes that can use `next-error'). In this mode, cursor motion in the
1331 buffer causes automatic display in another window of the corresponding
1332 matches, compilation errors, etc. This minor mode can be toggled with
1333 C-c C-f.
1334
1335 +++
1336 *** When the left fringe is displayed, an arrow points to current message in
1337 the compilation buffer.
1338
1339 +++
1340 *** The new variable `compilation-context-lines' controls lines of leading
1341 context before the current message. If nil and the left fringe is displayed,
1342 it doesn't scroll the compilation output window. If there is no left fringe,
1343 no arrow is displayed and a value of nil means display the message at the top
1344 of the window.
1345
1346 ** Occur mode changes:
1347
1348 +++
1349 *** In the *Occur* buffer, `o' switches to it in another window, and
1350 C-o displays the current line's occurrence in another window without
1351 switching to it.
1352
1353 +++
1354 *** You can now use next-error (C-x `) and previous-error to advance to
1355 the next/previous matching line found by M-x occur.
1356
1357 +++
1358 *** The new command `multi-occur' is just like `occur', except it can
1359 search multiple buffers. There is also a new command
1360 `multi-occur-by-filename-regexp' which allows you to specify the
1361 buffers to search by their filename. Internally, Occur mode has been
1362 rewritten, and now uses font-lock, among other changes.
1363
1364 ** Grep changes:
1365
1366 +++
1367 *** Grep has been decoupled from compilation mode setup.
1368
1369 There's a new separate package grep.el, with its own submenu and
1370 customization group.
1371
1372 ---
1373 *** M-x grep provides highlighting support.
1374
1375 Hits are fontified in green, and hits in binary files in orange. Grep buffers
1376 can be saved and automatically revisited.
1377
1378 +++
1379 *** `grep-find' is now also available under the name `find-grep' where
1380 people knowing `find-grep-dired' would probably expect it.
1381
1382 ---
1383 *** The new variables `grep-window-height', `grep-auto-highlight', and
1384 `grep-scroll-output' override the corresponding compilation mode
1385 settings, for grep commands only.
1386
1387 +++
1388 *** New option `grep-highlight-matches' highlightes matches in *grep*
1389 buffer. It uses a special feature of some grep programs which accept
1390 --color option to output markers around matches. When going to the next
1391 match with `next-error' the exact match is highlighted in the source
1392 buffer. Otherwise, if `grep-highlight-matches' is nil, the whole
1393 source line is highlighted.
1394
1395 +++
1396 *** New key bindings in grep output window:
1397 SPC and DEL scrolls window up and down. C-n and C-p moves to next and
1398 previous match in the grep window. RET jumps to the source line of
1399 the current match. `n' and `p' shows next and previous match in
1400 other window, but does not switch buffer. `{' and `}' jumps to the
1401 previous or next file in the grep output. TAB also jumps to the next
1402 file.
1403
1404 +++
1405 *** M-x grep now tries to avoid appending `/dev/null' to the command line
1406 by using GNU grep `-H' option instead. M-x grep automatically
1407 detects whether this is possible or not the first time it is invoked.
1408 When `-H' is used, the grep command line supplied by the user is passed
1409 unchanged to the system to execute, which allows more complicated
1410 command lines to be used than was possible before.
1411
1412 ** X Windows Support:
1413
1414 +++
1415 *** Emacs now supports drag and drop for X. Dropping a file on a window
1416 opens it, dropping text inserts the text. Dropping a file on a dired
1417 buffer copies or moves the file to that directory.
1418
1419 +++
1420 *** Under X11, it is possible to swap Alt and Meta (and Super and Hyper).
1421 The new variables `x-alt-keysym', `x-hyper-keysym', `x-meta-keysym',
1422 and `x-super-keysym' can be used to choose which keysyms Emacs should
1423 use for the modifiers. For example, the following two lines swap
1424 Meta and Alt:
1425 (setq x-alt-keysym 'meta)
1426 (setq x-meta-keysym 'alt)
1427
1428 +++
1429 *** The X resource useXIM can be used to turn off use of XIM, which can
1430 speed up Emacs with slow networking to the X server.
1431
1432 If the configure option `--without-xim' was used to turn off use of
1433 XIM by default, the X resource useXIM can be used to turn it on.
1434
1435 ---
1436 *** The new variable `x-select-request-type' controls how Emacs
1437 requests X selection. The default value is nil, which means that
1438 Emacs requests X selection with types COMPOUND_TEXT and UTF8_STRING,
1439 and use the more appropriately result.
1440
1441 ---
1442 *** The scrollbar under LessTif or Motif has a smoother drag-scrolling.
1443 On the other hand, the size of the thumb does not represent the actual
1444 amount of text shown any more (only a crude approximation of it).
1445
1446 ** Xterm support:
1447
1448 ---
1449 *** Emacs now responds to mouse-clicks on the mode-line, header-line and
1450 display margin, when run in an xterm.
1451
1452 ---
1453 *** Improved key bindings support when running in an xterm.
1454 When emacs is running in an xterm more key bindings are available. The
1455 following should work:
1456 {C,S,C-S,A}-{right,left,up,down,prior,next,delete,insert,F1-12}.
1457 These key bindings work on xterm from X.org 6.8, they might not work on
1458 some older versions of xterm, or on some proprietary versions.
1459
1460 ** Character terminal color support changes:
1461
1462 +++
1463 *** The new command-line option --color=MODE lets you specify a standard
1464 mode for a tty color support. It is meant to be used on character
1465 terminals whose capabilities are not set correctly in the terminal
1466 database, or with terminal emulators which support colors, but don't
1467 set the TERM environment variable to a name of a color-capable
1468 terminal. "emacs --color" uses the same color commands as GNU `ls'
1469 when invoked with "ls --color", so if your terminal can support colors
1470 in "ls --color", it will support "emacs --color" as well. See the
1471 user manual for the possible values of the MODE parameter.
1472
1473 ---
1474 *** Emacs now supports several character terminals which provide more
1475 than 8 colors. For example, for `xterm', 16-color, 88-color, and
1476 256-color modes are supported. Emacs automatically notes at startup
1477 the extended number of colors, and defines the appropriate entries for
1478 all of these colors.
1479
1480 +++
1481 *** Emacs now uses the full range of available colors for the default
1482 faces when running on a color terminal, including 16-, 88-, and
1483 256-color xterms. This means that when you run "emacs -nw" on an
1484 88-color or 256-color xterm, you will see essentially the same face
1485 colors as on X.
1486
1487 ---
1488 *** There's a new support for colors on `rxvt' terminal emulator.
1489 \f
1490 * New Modes and Packages in Emacs 22.1
1491
1492 ---
1493 ** Newsticker is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1494
1495 Newsticker asynchronously retrieves headlines (RSS) from a list of news
1496 sites, prepares these headlines for reading, and allows for loading the
1497 corresponding articles in a web browser. Its documentation is in a
1498 separate manual.
1499
1500 +++
1501 ** Filesets are collections of files. You can define a fileset in
1502 various ways, such as based on a directory tree or based on
1503 program files that include other program files.
1504
1505 Once you have defined a fileset, you can perform various operations on
1506 all the files in it, such as visiting them or searching and replacing
1507 in them.
1508
1509 +++
1510 ** Calc is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1511
1512 Calc is an advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool written in
1513 Emacs Lisp. Its documentation is in a separate manual; within Emacs,
1514 type "C-h i m calc RET" to read that manual. A reference card is
1515 available in `etc/calccard.tex' and `etc/calccard.ps'.
1516
1517 ---
1518 ** The new package ibuffer provides a powerful, completely
1519 customizable replacement for buff-menu.el.
1520
1521 ---
1522 ** Ido mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1523
1524 The ido (interactively do) package is an extension of the iswitchb
1525 package to do interactive opening of files and directories in addition
1526 to interactive buffer switching. Ido is a superset of iswitchb (with
1527 a few exceptions), so don't enable both packages.
1528
1529 +++
1530 ** Image files are normally visited in Image mode, which lets you toggle
1531 between viewing the image and viewing the text using C-c C-c.
1532
1533 ---
1534 ** CUA mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1535
1536 The new cua package provides CUA-like keybindings using C-x for
1537 cut (kill), C-c for copy, C-v for paste (yank), and C-z for undo.
1538 With cua, the region can be set and extended using shifted movement
1539 keys (like pc-selection-mode) and typed text replaces the active
1540 region (like delete-selection-mode). Do not enable these modes with
1541 cua-mode. Customize the variable `cua-mode' to enable cua.
1542
1543 In addition, cua provides unified rectangle support with visible
1544 rectangle highlighting: Use C-return to start a rectangle, extend it
1545 using the movement commands (or mouse-3), and cut or copy it using C-x
1546 or C-c (using C-w and M-w also works).
1547
1548 Use M-o and M-c to `open' or `close' the rectangle, use M-b or M-f, to
1549 fill it with blanks or another character, use M-u or M-l to upcase or
1550 downcase the rectangle, use M-i to increment the numbers in the
1551 rectangle, use M-n to fill the rectangle with a numeric sequence (such
1552 as 10 20 30...), use M-r to replace a regexp in the rectangle, and use
1553 M-' or M-/ to restrict command on the rectangle to a subset of the
1554 rows. See the commentary in cua-base.el for more rectangle commands.
1555
1556 Cua also provides unified support for registers: Use a numeric
1557 prefix argument between 0 and 9, i.e. M-0 .. M-9, for C-x, C-c, and
1558 C-v to cut or copy into register 0-9, or paste from register 0-9.
1559
1560 The last text deleted (not killed) is automatically stored in
1561 register 0. This includes text deleted by typing text.
1562
1563 Finally, cua provides a global mark which is set using S-C-space.
1564 When the global mark is active, any text which is cut or copied is
1565 automatically inserted at the global mark position. See the
1566 commentary in cua-base.el for more global mark related commands.
1567
1568 The features of cua also works with the standard emacs bindings for
1569 kill, copy, yank, and undo. If you want to use cua mode, but don't
1570 want the C-x, C-c, C-v, and C-z bindings, you can customize the
1571 `cua-enable-cua-keys' variable.
1572
1573 Note: This version of cua mode is not backwards compatible with older
1574 versions of cua.el and cua-mode.el. To ensure proper operation, you
1575 must remove older versions of cua.el or cua-mode.el as well as the
1576 loading and customization of those packages from the .emacs file.
1577
1578 +++
1579 ** Org mode is now part of the Emacs distribution
1580
1581 Org mode is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining ToDo lists, and
1582 doing project planning with a fast and effective plain-text system.
1583 It also contains a plain-text table editor with spreadsheet-like
1584 capabilities.
1585
1586 The Org mode table editor can be integrated into any major mode by
1587 activating the minor Orgtbl-mode.
1588
1589 The documentation for org-mode is in a separate manual; within Emacs,
1590 type "C-h i m org RET" to read that manual. A reference card is
1591 available in `etc/orgcard.tex' and `etc/orgcard.ps'.
1592
1593 +++
1594 ** The new package dns-mode.el add syntax highlight of DNS master files.
1595 The key binding C-c C-s (`dns-mode-soa-increment-serial') can be used
1596 to increment the SOA serial.
1597
1598 ---
1599 ** The new global minor mode `file-name-shadow-mode' modifies the way
1600 filenames being entered by the user in the minibuffer are displayed, so
1601 that it's clear when part of the entered filename will be ignored due to
1602 emacs' filename parsing rules. The ignored portion can be made dim,
1603 invisible, or otherwise less visually noticable. The display method can
1604 be displayed by customizing the variable `file-name-shadow-properties'.
1605
1606 +++
1607 ** The new package flymake.el does on-the-fly syntax checking of program
1608 source files. See the Flymake's Info manual for more details.
1609
1610 +++
1611 ** The new keypad setup package provides several common bindings for
1612 the numeric keypad which is available on most keyboards. The numeric
1613 keypad typically has the digits 0 to 9, a decimal point, keys marked
1614 +, -, /, and *, an Enter key, and a NumLock toggle key. The keypad
1615 package only controls the use of the digit and decimal keys.
1616
1617 By customizing the variables `keypad-setup', `keypad-shifted-setup',
1618 `keypad-numlock-setup', and `keypad-numlock-shifted-setup', or by
1619 using the function `keypad-setup', you can rebind all digit keys and
1620 the decimal key of the keypad in one step for each of the four
1621 possible combinations of the Shift key state (not pressed/pressed) and
1622 the NumLock toggle state (off/on).
1623
1624 The choices for the keypad keys in each of the above states are:
1625 `Plain numeric keypad' where the keys generates plain digits,
1626 `Numeric keypad with decimal key' where the character produced by the
1627 decimal key can be customized individually (for internationalization),
1628 `Numeric Prefix Arg' where the keypad keys produce numeric prefix args
1629 for emacs editing commands, `Cursor keys' and `Shifted Cursor keys'
1630 where the keys work like (shifted) arrow keys, home/end, etc., and
1631 `Unspecified/User-defined' where the keypad keys (kp-0, kp-1, etc.)
1632 are left unspecified and can be bound individually through the global
1633 or local keymaps.
1634
1635 +++
1636 ** The new kmacro package provides a simpler user interface to
1637 emacs' keyboard macro facilities.
1638
1639 Basically, it uses two function keys (default F3 and F4) like this:
1640 F3 starts a macro, F4 ends the macro, and pressing F4 again executes
1641 the last macro. While defining the macro, F3 inserts a counter value
1642 which automatically increments every time the macro is executed.
1643
1644 There is now a keyboard macro ring which stores the most recently
1645 defined macros.
1646
1647 The C-x C-k sequence is now a prefix for the kmacro keymap which
1648 defines bindings for moving through the keyboard macro ring,
1649 C-x C-k C-p and C-x C-k C-n, editing the last macro C-x C-k C-e,
1650 manipulating the macro counter and format via C-x C-k C-c,
1651 C-x C-k C-a, and C-x C-k C-f. See the commentary in kmacro.el
1652 for more commands.
1653
1654 The normal macro bindings C-x (, C-x ), and C-x e now interfaces to
1655 the keyboard macro ring.
1656
1657 The C-x e command now automatically terminates the current macro
1658 before calling it, if used while defining a macro.
1659
1660 In addition, when ending or calling a macro with C-x e, the macro can
1661 be repeated immediately by typing just the `e'. You can customize
1662 this behavior via the variables kmacro-call-repeat-key and
1663 kmacro-call-repeat-with-arg.
1664
1665 Keyboard macros can now be debugged and edited interactively.
1666 C-x C-k SPC steps through the last keyboard macro one key sequence
1667 at a time, prompting for the actions to take.
1668
1669 ---
1670 ** New minor mode, Visible mode, toggles invisibility in the current buffer.
1671 When enabled, it makes all invisible text visible. When disabled, it
1672 restores the previous value of `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
1673
1674 +++
1675 ** The wdired.el package allows you to use normal editing commands on Dired
1676 buffers to change filenames, permissions, etc...
1677
1678 +++
1679 ** The new package longlines.el provides a minor mode for editing text
1680 files composed of long lines, based on the `use-hard-newlines'
1681 mechanism. The long lines are broken up by inserting soft newlines,
1682 which are automatically removed when saving the file to disk or
1683 copying into the kill ring, clipboard, etc. By default, Longlines
1684 mode inserts soft newlines automatically during editing, a behavior
1685 referred to as "soft word wrap" in other text editors. This is
1686 similar to Refill mode, but more reliable. To turn the word wrap
1687 feature off, set `longlines-auto-wrap' to nil.
1688
1689 +++
1690 ** The printing package is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1691
1692 If you enable the printing package by including (require 'printing) in
1693 the .emacs file, the normal Print item on the File menu is replaced
1694 with a Print sub-menu which allows you to preview output through
1695 ghostview, use ghostscript to print (if you don't have a PostScript
1696 printer) or send directly to printer a PostScript code generated by
1697 `ps-print' package. Use M-x pr-help for more information.
1698
1699 ---
1700 ** The minor mode Reveal mode makes text visible on the fly as you
1701 move your cursor into hidden regions of the buffer.
1702 It should work with any package that uses overlays to hide parts
1703 of a buffer, such as outline-minor-mode, hs-minor-mode, hide-ifdef-mode, ...
1704
1705 There is also Global Reveal mode which affects all buffers.
1706
1707 ---
1708 ** The ruler-mode.el library provides a minor mode for displaying an
1709 "active" ruler in the header line. You can use the mouse to visually
1710 change the `fill-column', `window-margins' and `tab-stop-list'
1711 settings.
1712
1713 +++
1714 ** SES mode (ses-mode) is a new major mode for creating and editing
1715 spreadsheet files. Besides the usual Emacs features (intuitive command
1716 letters, undo, cell formulas in Lisp, plaintext files, etc.) it also offers
1717 viral immunity and import/export of tab-separated values.
1718
1719 +++
1720 ** The new global minor mode `size-indication-mode' (off by default)
1721 shows the size of accessible part of the buffer on the mode line.
1722
1723 +++
1724 ** The new package table.el implements editable, WYSIWYG, embedded
1725 `text tables' in Emacs buffers. It simulates the effect of putting
1726 these tables in a special major mode. The package emulates WYSIWYG
1727 table editing available in modern word processors. The package also
1728 can generate a table source in typesetting and markup languages such
1729 as latex and html from the visually laid out text table.
1730
1731 +++
1732 ** The thumbs.el package allows you to preview image files as thumbnails
1733 and can be invoked from a Dired buffer.
1734
1735 +++
1736 ** Tramp is now part of the distribution.
1737
1738 This package is similar to Ange-FTP: it allows you to edit remote
1739 files. But whereas Ange-FTP uses FTP to access the remote host,
1740 Tramp uses a shell connection. The shell connection is always used
1741 for filename completion and directory listings and suchlike, but for
1742 the actual file transfer, you can choose between the so-called
1743 `inline' methods (which transfer the files through the shell
1744 connection using base64 or uu encoding) and the `out-of-band' methods
1745 (which invoke an external copying program such as `rcp' or `scp' or
1746 `rsync' to do the copying).
1747
1748 Shell connections can be acquired via `rsh', `ssh', `telnet' and also
1749 `su' and `sudo'. Ange-FTP is still supported via the `ftp' method.
1750
1751 If you want to disable Tramp you should set
1752
1753 (setq tramp-default-method "ftp")
1754
1755 ---
1756 ** The URL package (which had been part of W3) is now part of Emacs.
1757
1758 ---
1759 ** `cfengine-mode' is a major mode for editing GNU Cfengine
1760 configuration files.
1761
1762 +++
1763 ** The new package conf-mode.el handles thousands of configuration files, with
1764 varying syntaxes for comments (;, #, //, /* */ or !), assignment (var = value,
1765 var : value, var value or keyword var value) and sections ([section] or
1766 section { }). Many files under /etc/, or with suffixes like .cf through
1767 .config, .properties (Java), .desktop (KDE/Gnome), .ini and many others are
1768 recognized.
1769
1770 ---
1771 ** GDB-Script-mode is used for files like .gdbinit.
1772
1773 +++
1774 ** The new python.el package is used to edit Python and Jython programs.
1775
1776 ---
1777 ** The TCL package tcl-mode.el was replaced by tcl.el.
1778 This was actually done in Emacs-21.1, and was not documented.
1779
1780 ** The new package scroll-lock.el provides the Scroll Lock minor mode
1781 for pager-like scrolling. Keys which normally move point by line or
1782 paragraph will scroll the buffer by the respective amount of lines
1783 instead and point will be kept vertically fixed relative to window
1784 boundaries during scrolling.
1785 \f
1786 * Changes in Specialized Modes and Packages in Emacs 22.1:
1787
1788 ** The variable `woman-topic-at-point' was renamed
1789 to `woman-use-topic-at-point' and behaves differently: if this
1790 variable is non-nil, the `woman' command uses the word at point
1791 automatically, without asking for a confirmation. Otherwise, the word
1792 at point is suggested as default, but not inserted at the prompt.
1793
1794 ---
1795 ** Changes to cmuscheme
1796
1797 *** Emacs now offers to start Scheme if the user tries to
1798 evaluate a Scheme expression but no Scheme subprocess is running.
1799
1800 *** If a file `.emacs_NAME' (where NAME is the name of the Scheme interpreter)
1801 exists in the user's home directory or in ~/.emacs.d, its
1802 contents are sent to the Scheme subprocess upon startup.
1803
1804 *** There are new commands to instruct the Scheme interpreter to trace
1805 procedure calls (`scheme-trace-procedure') and to expand syntactic forms
1806 (`scheme-expand-current-form'). The commands actually sent to the Scheme
1807 subprocess are controlled by the user options `scheme-trace-command',
1808 `scheme-untrace-command' and `scheme-expand-current-form'.
1809
1810 ---
1811 ** Makefile mode has submodes for automake, gmake, makepp and BSD make.
1812
1813 The former two couldn't be differentiated before, and the latter two
1814 are new. Font-locking is robust now and offers new customizable
1815 faces.
1816
1817 +++
1818 ** In Outline mode, `hide-body' no longer hides lines at the top
1819 of the file that precede the first header line.
1820
1821 +++
1822 ** Telnet now prompts you for a port number with C-u M-x telnet.
1823
1824 ---
1825 ** The terminal emulation code in term.el has been improved; it can
1826 run most curses applications now.
1827
1828 +++
1829 ** M-x diff uses Diff mode instead of Compilation mode.
1830
1831 +++
1832 ** You can now customize `fill-nobreak-predicate' to control where
1833 filling can break lines. The value is now normally a list of
1834 functions, but it can also be a single function, for compatibility.
1835
1836 Emacs provide two predicates, `fill-single-word-nobreak-p' and
1837 `fill-french-nobreak-p', for use as the value of
1838 `fill-nobreak-predicate'.
1839
1840 ---
1841 ** M-x view-file and commands that use it now avoid interfering
1842 with special modes such as Tar mode.
1843
1844 ---
1845 ** Commands `winner-redo' and `winner-undo', from winner.el, are now
1846 bound to C-c <left> and C-c <right>, respectively. This is an
1847 incompatible change.
1848
1849 ---
1850 ** `global-whitespace-mode' is a new alias for `whitespace-global-mode'.
1851
1852 +++
1853 ** M-x compare-windows now can automatically skip non-matching text to
1854 resync points in both windows.
1855
1856 +++
1857 ** New user option `add-log-always-start-new-record'.
1858
1859 When this option is enabled, M-x add-change-log-entry always
1860 starts a new record regardless of when the last record is.
1861
1862 ---
1863 ** PO translation files are decoded according to their MIME headers
1864 when Emacs visits them.
1865
1866 ** Info mode changes:
1867
1868 +++
1869 *** A numeric prefix argument of `info' selects an Info buffer
1870 with the number appended to the `*info*' buffer name (e.g. "*info*<2>").
1871
1872 +++
1873 *** isearch in Info uses Info-search and searches through multiple nodes.
1874
1875 Before leaving the initial Info node isearch fails once with the error
1876 message [initial node], and with subsequent C-s/C-r continues through
1877 other nodes. When isearch fails for the rest of the manual, it wraps
1878 aroung the whole manual to the top/final node. The user option
1879 `Info-isearch-search' controls whether to use Info-search for isearch,
1880 or the default isearch search function that wraps around the current
1881 Info node.
1882
1883 ---
1884 *** New search commands: `Info-search-case-sensitively' (bound to S),
1885 `Info-search-backward', and `Info-search-next' which repeats the last
1886 search without prompting for a new search string.
1887
1888 +++
1889 *** New command `Info-history-forward' (bound to r and new toolbar icon)
1890 moves forward in history to the node you returned from after using
1891 `Info-history-back' (renamed from `Info-last').
1892
1893 ---
1894 *** New command `Info-history' (bound to L) displays a menu of visited nodes.
1895
1896 ---
1897 *** New command `Info-toc' (bound to T) creates a node with table of contents
1898 from the tree structure of menus of the current Info file.
1899
1900 +++
1901 *** New command `info-apropos' searches the indices of the known
1902 Info files on your system for a string, and builds a menu of the
1903 possible matches.
1904
1905 ---
1906 *** New command `Info-copy-current-node-name' (bound to w) copies
1907 the current Info node name into the kill ring. With a zero prefix
1908 arg, puts the node name inside the `info' function call.
1909
1910 +++
1911 *** New face `info-xref-visited' distinguishes visited nodes from unvisited
1912 and a new option `Info-fontify-visited-nodes' to control this.
1913
1914 ---
1915 *** http and ftp links in Info are now operational: they look like cross
1916 references and following them calls `browse-url'.
1917
1918 +++
1919 *** Info now hides node names in menus and cross references by default.
1920
1921 If you prefer the old behavior, you can set the new user option
1922 `Info-hide-note-references' to nil.
1923
1924 ---
1925 *** Images in Info pages are supported.
1926
1927 Info pages show embedded images, in Emacs frames with image support.
1928 Info documentation that includes images, processed with makeinfo
1929 version 4.7 or newer, compiles to Info pages with embedded images.
1930
1931 +++
1932 *** The default value for `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' is now nil.
1933
1934 ---
1935 *** `Info-index' offers completion.
1936
1937 ** Lisp mode changes:
1938
1939 ---
1940 *** Lisp mode now uses `font-lock-doc-face' for doc strings.
1941
1942 +++
1943 *** C-u C-M-q in Emacs Lisp mode pretty-prints the list after point.
1944
1945 *** New features in evaluation commands
1946
1947 +++
1948 **** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) called on defface reinitializes
1949 the face to the value specified in the defface expression.
1950
1951 +++
1952 **** Typing C-x C-e twice prints the value of the integer result
1953 in additional formats (octal, hexadecimal, character) specified
1954 by the new function `eval-expression-print-format'. The same
1955 function also defines the result format for `eval-expression' (M-:),
1956 `eval-print-last-sexp' (C-j) and some edebug evaluation functions.
1957
1958 +++
1959 ** CC mode changes.
1960
1961 *** Font lock support.
1962 CC Mode now provides font lock support for all its languages. This
1963 supersedes the font lock patterns that have been in the core font lock
1964 package for C, C++, Java and Objective-C. Like indentation, font
1965 locking is done in a uniform way across all languages (except the new
1966 AWK mode - see below). That means that the new font locking will be
1967 different from the old patterns in various details for most languages.
1968
1969 The main goal of the font locking in CC Mode is accuracy, to provide a
1970 dependable aid in recognizing the various constructs. Some, like
1971 strings and comments, are easy to recognize while others like
1972 declarations and types can be very tricky. CC Mode can go to great
1973 lengths to recognize declarations and casts correctly, especially when
1974 the types aren't recognized by standard patterns. This is a fairly
1975 demanding analysis which can be slow on older hardware, and it can
1976 therefore be disabled by choosing a lower decoration level with the
1977 variable font-lock-maximum-decoration.
1978
1979 Note that the most demanding font lock level has been tuned with lazy
1980 fontification in mind, i.e. there should be a support mode that waits
1981 with the fontification until the text is actually shown
1982 (e.g. Just-in-time Lock mode, which is the default, or Lazy Lock
1983 mode). Fontifying a file with several thousand lines in one go can
1984 take the better part of a minute.
1985
1986 **** The (c|c++|objc|java|idl|pike)-font-lock-extra-types variables
1987 are now used by CC Mode to recognize identifiers that are certain to
1988 be types. (They are also used in cases that aren't related to font
1989 locking.) At the maximum decoration level, types are often recognized
1990 properly anyway, so these variables should be fairly restrictive and
1991 not contain patterns for uncertain types.
1992
1993 **** Support for documentation comments.
1994 There is a "plugin" system to fontify documentation comments like
1995 Javadoc and the markup within them. It's independent of the host
1996 language, so it's possible to e.g. turn on Javadoc font locking in C
1997 buffers. See the variable c-doc-comment-style for details.
1998
1999 Currently two kinds of doc comment styles are recognized: Suns Javadoc
2000 and Autodoc which is used in Pike. This is by no means a complete
2001 list of the most common tools; if your doc comment extractor of choice
2002 is missing then please drop a note to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
2003
2004 **** Better handling of C++ templates.
2005 As a side effect of the more accurate font locking, C++ templates are
2006 now handled much better. The angle brackets that delimit them are
2007 given parenthesis syntax so that they can be navigated like other
2008 parens.
2009
2010 This also improves indentation of templates, although there still is
2011 work to be done in that area. E.g. it's required that multiline
2012 template clauses are written in full and then refontified to be
2013 recognized, and the indentation of nested templates is a bit odd and
2014 not as configurable as it ought to be.
2015
2016 **** Improved handling of Objective-C and CORBA IDL.
2017 Especially the support for Objective-C and IDL has gotten an overhaul.
2018 The special "@" declarations in Objective-C are handled correctly.
2019 All the keywords used in CORBA IDL, PSDL, and CIDL are recognized and
2020 handled correctly, also wrt indentation.
2021
2022 *** Support for the AWK language.
2023 Support for the AWK language has been introduced. The implementation is
2024 based around GNU AWK version 3.1, but it should work pretty well with
2025 any AWK. As yet, not all features of CC Mode have been adapted for AWK.
2026 Here is a summary:
2027
2028 **** Indentation Engine
2029 The CC Mode indentation engine fully supports AWK mode.
2030
2031 AWK mode handles code formatted in the conventional AWK fashion: `{'s
2032 which start actions, user-defined functions, or compound statements are
2033 placed on the same line as the associated construct; the matching `}'s
2034 are normally placed under the start of the respective pattern, function
2035 definition, or structured statement.
2036
2037 The predefined indentation functions haven't yet been adapted for AWK
2038 mode, though some of them may work serendipitously. There shouldn't be
2039 any problems writing custom indentation functions for AWK mode.
2040
2041 The command C-c C-q (c-indent-defun) hasn't yet been adapted for AWK,
2042 though in practice it works properly nearly all the time. Should it
2043 fail, explicitly set the region around the function (using C-u C-SPC:
2044 C-M-h probably won't work either) then do C-M-\ (indent-region).
2045
2046 **** Font Locking
2047 There is a single level of font locking in AWK mode, rather than the
2048 three distinct levels the other modes have. There are several
2049 idiosyncrasies in AWK mode's font-locking due to the peculiarities of
2050 the AWK language itself.
2051
2052 **** Comment Commands
2053 M-; (indent-for-comment) works fine. None of the other CC Mode
2054 comment formatting commands have yet been adapted for AWK mode.
2055
2056 **** Movement Commands
2057 Most of the movement commands work in AWK mode. The most important
2058 exceptions are M-a (c-beginning-of-statement) and M-e
2059 (c-end-of-statement) which haven't yet been adapted.
2060
2061 The notion of "defun" has been augmented to include AWK pattern-action
2062 pairs. C-M-a (c-awk-beginning-of-defun) and C-M-e (c-awk-end-of-defun)
2063 recognize these pattern-action pairs, as well as user defined
2064 functions.
2065
2066 **** Auto-newline Insertion and Clean-ups
2067 Auto-newline insertion hasn't yet been adapted for AWK. Some of
2068 the clean-ups can actually convert good AWK code into syntactically
2069 invalid code. These features are best disabled in AWK buffers.
2070
2071 *** New syntactic symbols in IDL mode.
2072 The top level constructs "module" and "composition" (from CIDL) are
2073 now handled like "namespace" in C++: They are given syntactic symbols
2074 module-open, module-close, inmodule, composition-open,
2075 composition-close, and incomposition.
2076
2077 *** New functions to do hungry delete without enabling hungry delete mode.
2078 The functions `c-hungry-backspace' and `c-hungry-delete-forward' can be
2079 bound to keys to get this feature without toggling a mode.
2080
2081 *** Better control over `require-final-newline'.
2082
2083 The variable `c-require-final-newline' specifies which of the modes
2084 implemented by CC mode should insert final newlines. Its value is a
2085 list of modes, and only those modes should do it. By default the list
2086 includes C, C++ and Objective-C modes.
2087
2088 Whichever modes are in this list will set `require-final-newline'
2089 based on `mode-require-final-newline'.
2090
2091 *** Format change for syntactic context elements.
2092
2093 The elements in the syntactic context returned by `c-guess-basic-syntax'
2094 and stored in `c-syntactic-context' has been changed somewhat to allow
2095 attaching more information. They are now lists instead of single cons
2096 cells. E.g. a line that previously had the syntactic analysis
2097
2098 ((inclass . 11) (topmost-intro . 13))
2099
2100 is now analyzed as
2101
2102 ((inclass 11) (topmost-intro 13))
2103
2104 In some cases there are more than one position given for a syntactic
2105 symbol.
2106
2107 This change might affect code that call `c-guess-basic-syntax' directly,
2108 and custom lineup functions if they use `c-syntactic-context'. However,
2109 the argument given to lineup functions is still a single cons cell
2110 with nil or an integer in the cdr.
2111
2112 *** API changes for derived modes.
2113
2114 There have been extensive changes "under the hood" which can affect
2115 derived mode writers. Some of these changes are likely to cause
2116 incompatibilities with existing derived modes, but on the other hand
2117 care has now been taken to make it possible to extend and modify CC
2118 Mode with less risk of such problems in the future.
2119
2120 **** New language variable system.
2121 See the comment blurb near the top of cc-langs.el.
2122
2123 **** New initialization functions.
2124 The initialization procedure has been split up into more functions to
2125 give better control: `c-basic-common-init', `c-font-lock-init', and
2126 `c-init-language-vars'.
2127
2128 *** Changes in analysis of nested syntactic constructs.
2129 The syntactic analysis engine has better handling of cases where
2130 several syntactic constructs appear nested on the same line. They are
2131 now handled as if each construct started on a line of its own.
2132
2133 This means that CC Mode now indents some cases differently, and
2134 although it's more consistent there might be cases where the old way
2135 gave results that's more to one's liking. So if you find a situation
2136 where you think that the indentation has become worse, please report
2137 it to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
2138
2139 **** New syntactic symbol substatement-label.
2140 This symbol is used when a label is inserted between a statement and
2141 its substatement. E.g:
2142
2143 if (x)
2144 x_is_true:
2145 do_stuff();
2146
2147 *** Better handling of multiline macros.
2148
2149 **** Syntactic indentation inside macros.
2150 The contents of multiline #define's are now analyzed and indented
2151 syntactically just like other code. This can be disabled by the new
2152 variable `c-syntactic-indentation-in-macros'. A new syntactic symbol
2153 `cpp-define-intro' has been added to control the initial indentation
2154 inside `#define's.
2155
2156 **** New lineup function `c-lineup-cpp-define'.
2157
2158 Now used by default to line up macro continuation lines. The behavior
2159 of this function closely mimics the indentation one gets if the macro
2160 is indented while the line continuation backslashes are temporarily
2161 removed. If syntactic indentation in macros is turned off, it works
2162 much line `c-lineup-dont-change', which was used earlier, but handles
2163 empty lines within the macro better.
2164
2165 **** Automatically inserted newlines continues the macro if used within one.
2166 This applies to the newlines inserted by the auto-newline mode, and to
2167 `c-context-line-break' and `c-context-open-line'.
2168
2169 **** Better alignment of line continuation backslashes.
2170 `c-backslash-region' tries to adapt to surrounding backslashes. New
2171 variable `c-backslash-max-column' which put a limit on how far out
2172 backslashes can be moved.
2173
2174 **** Automatic alignment of line continuation backslashes.
2175 This is controlled by the new variable `c-auto-align-backslashes'. It
2176 affects `c-context-line-break', `c-context-open-line' and newlines
2177 inserted in Auto-Newline mode.
2178 **** Line indentation works better inside macros.
2179
2180 Regardless whether syntactic indentation and syntactic indentation
2181 inside macros are enabled or not, line indentation now ignores the
2182 line continuation backslashes. This is most noticeable when syntactic
2183 indentation is turned off and there are empty lines (save for the
2184 backslash) in the macro.
2185
2186 *** indent-for-comment is more customizable.
2187 The behavior of M-; (indent-for-comment) is now configurable through
2188 the variable `c-indent-comment-alist'. The indentation behavior based
2189 on the preceding code on the line, e.g. to get two spaces after #else
2190 and #endif but indentation to `comment-column' in most other cases
2191 (something which was hardcoded earlier).
2192
2193 *** New function `c-context-open-line'.
2194 It's the open-line equivalent of `c-context-line-break'.
2195
2196 *** New lineup functions
2197
2198 **** `c-lineup-string-cont'
2199 This lineup function lines up a continued string under the one it
2200 continues. E.g:
2201
2202 result = prefix + "A message "
2203 "string."; <- c-lineup-string-cont
2204
2205 **** `c-lineup-cascaded-calls'
2206 Lines up series of calls separated by "->" or ".".
2207
2208 **** `c-lineup-knr-region-comment'
2209 Gives (what most people think is) better indentation of comments in
2210 the "K&R region" between the function header and its body.
2211
2212 **** `c-lineup-gcc-asm-reg'
2213 Provides better indentation inside asm blocks.
2214
2215 **** `c-lineup-argcont'
2216 Lines up continued function arguments after the preceding comma.
2217
2218 *** Better caching of the syntactic context.
2219 CC Mode caches the positions of the opening parentheses (of any kind)
2220 of the lists surrounding the point. Those positions are used in many
2221 places as anchor points for various searches. The cache is now
2222 improved so that it can be reused to a large extent when the point is
2223 moved. The less it moves, the less needs to be recalculated.
2224
2225 The effect is that CC Mode should be fast most of the time even when
2226 opening parens are hung (i.e. aren't in column zero). It's typically
2227 only the first time after the point is moved far down in a complex
2228 file that it'll take noticeable time to find out the syntactic
2229 context.
2230
2231 *** Statements are recognized in a more robust way.
2232 Statements are recognized most of the time even when they occur in an
2233 "invalid" context, e.g. in a function argument. In practice that can
2234 happen when macros are involved.
2235
2236 *** Improved the way `c-indent-exp' chooses the block to indent.
2237 It now indents the block for the closest sexp following the point
2238 whose closing paren ends on a different line. This means that the
2239 point doesn't have to be immediately before the block to indent.
2240 Also, only the block and the closing line is indented; the current
2241 line is left untouched.
2242
2243 *** Added toggle for syntactic indentation.
2244 The function `c-toggle-syntactic-indentation' can be used to toggle
2245 syntactic indentation.
2246
2247 ** In sh-script, a continuation line is only indented if the backslash was
2248 preceded by a SPC or a TAB.
2249
2250 ---
2251 ** Perl mode has a new variable `perl-indent-continued-arguments'.
2252
2253 ---
2254 ** The old Octave mode bindings C-c f and C-c i have been changed
2255 to C-c C-f and C-c C-i. The C-c C-i subcommands now have duplicate
2256 bindings on control characters--thus, C-c C-i C-b is the same as
2257 C-c C-i b, and so on.
2258
2259 ** Fortran mode changes:
2260
2261 ---
2262 *** Fortran mode does more font-locking by default. Use level 3
2263 highlighting for the old default.
2264
2265 +++
2266 *** Fortran mode has a new variable `fortran-directive-re'.
2267 Adapt this to match the format of any compiler directives you use.
2268 Lines that match are never indented, and are given distinctive font-locking.
2269
2270 +++
2271 *** F90 mode and Fortran mode have new navigation commands
2272 `f90-end-of-block', `f90-beginning-of-block', `f90-next-block',
2273 `f90-previous-block', `fortran-end-of-block',
2274 `fortran-beginning-of-block'.
2275
2276 ---
2277 *** F90 mode and Fortran mode have support for `hs-minor-mode' (hideshow).
2278 It cannot deal with every code format, but ought to handle a sizeable
2279 majority.
2280
2281 ---
2282 *** The new function `f90-backslash-not-special' can be used to change
2283 the syntax of backslashes in F90 buffers.
2284
2285 ---
2286 ** Reftex mode changes
2287 +++
2288 *** Changes to RefTeX's table of contents
2289
2290 The new command keys "<" and ">" in the TOC buffer promote/demote the
2291 section at point or all sections in the current region, with full
2292 support for multifile documents.
2293
2294 The new command `reftex-toc-recenter' (`C-c -') shows the current
2295 section in the TOC buffer without selecting the TOC window.
2296 Recentering can happen automatically in idle time when the option
2297 `reftex-auto-recenter-toc' is turned on. The highlight in the TOC
2298 buffer stays when the focus moves to a different window. A dedicated
2299 frame can show the TOC with the current section always automatically
2300 highlighted. The frame is created and deleted from the toc buffer
2301 with the `d' key.
2302
2303 The toc window can be split off horizontally instead of vertically.
2304 See new option `reftex-toc-split-windows-horizontally'.
2305
2306 Labels can be renamed globally from the table of contents using the
2307 key `M-%'.
2308
2309 The new command `reftex-goto-label' jumps directly to a label
2310 location.
2311
2312 +++
2313 *** Changes related to citations and BibTeX database files
2314
2315 Commands that insert a citation now prompt for optional arguments when
2316 called with a prefix argument. Related new options are
2317 `reftex-cite-prompt-optional-args' and `reftex-cite-cleanup-optional-args'.
2318
2319 The new command `reftex-create-bibtex-file' creates a BibTeX database
2320 with all entries referenced in the current document. The keys "e" and
2321 "E" allow to produce a BibTeX database file from entries marked in a
2322 citation selection buffer.
2323
2324 The command `reftex-citation' uses the word in the buffer before the
2325 cursor as a default search string.
2326
2327 The support for chapterbib has been improved. Different chapters can
2328 now use BibTeX or an explicit `thebibliography' environment.
2329
2330 The macros which specify the bibliography file (like \bibliography)
2331 can be configured with the new option `reftex-bibliography-commands'.
2332
2333 Support for jurabib has been added.
2334
2335 +++
2336 *** Global index matched may be verified with a user function
2337
2338 During global indexing, a user function can verify an index match.
2339 See new option `reftex-index-verify-function'.
2340
2341 +++
2342 *** Parsing documents with many labels can be sped up.
2343
2344 Operating in a document with thousands of labels can be sped up
2345 considerably by allowing RefTeX to derive the type of a label directly
2346 from the label prefix like `eq:' or `fig:'. The option
2347 `reftex-trust-label-prefix' needs to be configured in order to enable
2348 this feature. While the speed-up is significant, this may reduce the
2349 quality of the context offered by RefTeX to describe a label.
2350
2351 +++
2352 *** Miscellaneous changes
2353
2354 The macros which input a file in LaTeX (like \input, \include) can be
2355 configured in the new option `reftex-include-file-commands'.
2356
2357 RefTeX supports global incremental search.
2358
2359 +++
2360 ** Prolog mode has a new variable `prolog-font-lock-keywords'
2361 to support use of font-lock.
2362
2363 ** HTML/SGML changes:
2364
2365 ---
2366 *** Emacs now tries to set up buffer coding systems for HTML/XML files
2367 automatically.
2368
2369 +++
2370 *** SGML mode has indentation and supports XML syntax.
2371 The new variable `sgml-xml-mode' tells SGML mode to use XML syntax.
2372 When this option is enabled, SGML tags are inserted in XML style,
2373 i.e., there is always a closing tag.
2374 By default, its setting is inferred on a buffer-by-buffer basis
2375 from the file name or buffer contents.
2376
2377 +++
2378 *** `xml-mode' is now an alias for `sgml-mode', which has XML support.
2379
2380 ** TeX modes:
2381
2382 +++
2383 *** C-c C-c prompts for a command to run, and tries to offer a good default.
2384
2385 +++
2386 *** The user option `tex-start-options-string' has been replaced
2387 by two new user options: `tex-start-options', which should hold
2388 command-line options to feed to TeX, and `tex-start-commands' which should hold
2389 TeX commands to use at startup.
2390
2391 ---
2392 *** verbatim environments are now highlighted in courier by font-lock
2393 and super/sub-scripts are made into super/sub-scripts.
2394
2395 +++
2396 *** New major mode Doctex mode, for *.dtx files.
2397
2398 ** BibTeX mode:
2399
2400 *** The new command `bibtex-url' browses a URL for the BibTeX entry at
2401 point (bound to C-c C-l and mouse-2, RET on clickable fields).
2402
2403 *** The new command `bibtex-entry-update' (bound to C-c C-u) updates
2404 an existing BibTeX entry.
2405
2406 *** New `bibtex-entry-format' option `required-fields', enabled by default.
2407
2408 *** `bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries' can take values `plain',
2409 `crossref', and `entry-class' which control the sorting scheme used
2410 for BibTeX entries. `bibtex-sort-entry-class' controls the sorting
2411 scheme `entry-class'. TAB completion for reference keys and
2412 automatic detection of duplicates does not require anymore that
2413 `bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries' is non-nil.
2414
2415 *** If the new variable `bibtex-parse-keys-fast' is non-nil,
2416 use fast but simplified algorithm for parsing BibTeX keys.
2417
2418 *** If the new variable `bibtex-autoadd-commas' is non-nil,
2419 automatically add missing commas at end of BibTeX fields.
2420
2421 *** The new variable `bibtex-autofill-types' contains a list of entry
2422 types for which fields are filled automatically (if possible).
2423
2424 *** The new command `bibtex-complete' completes word fragment before
2425 point according to context (bound to M-tab).
2426
2427 *** The new commands `bibtex-find-entry' and `bibtex-find-crossref'
2428 locate entries and crossref'd entries (bound to C-c C-s and C-c C-x).
2429 Crossref fields are clickable (bound to mouse-2, RET).
2430
2431 *** In BibTeX mode the command `fill-paragraph' (M-q) fills
2432 individual fields of a BibTeX entry.
2433
2434 *** The new variables `bibtex-files' and `bibtex-file-path' define a set
2435 of BibTeX files that are searched for entry keys.
2436
2437 *** The new command `bibtex-validate-globally' checks for duplicate keys
2438 in multiple BibTeX files.
2439
2440 *** The new command `bibtex-copy-summary-as-kill' pushes summary
2441 of BibTeX entry to kill ring (bound to C-c C-t).
2442
2443 +++
2444 ** In Enriched mode, `set-left-margin' and `set-right-margin' are now
2445 by default bound to `C-c [' and `C-c ]' instead of the former `C-c C-l'
2446 and `C-c C-r'.
2447
2448 ** GUD changes:
2449
2450 +++
2451 *** In GUD mode, when talking to GDB, C-x C-a C-j "jumps" the program
2452 counter to the specified source line (the one where point is).
2453
2454 ---
2455 *** GUD mode has its own tool bar for controlling execution of the inferior
2456 and other common debugger commands.
2457
2458 +++
2459 *** The new package gdb-ui.el provides an enhanced graphical interface to
2460 GDB. You can interact with GDB through the GUD buffer in the usual way, but
2461 there are also further buffers which control the execution and describe the
2462 state of your program. It can separate the input/output of your program from
2463 that of GDB and watches expressions in the speedbar. It also uses features of
2464 Emacs 21/22 such as the toolbar, and bitmaps in the fringe to indicate
2465 breakpoints.
2466
2467 Use M-x gdb to start GDB-UI.
2468
2469 *** The variable tooltip-gud-tips-p has been removed. GUD tooltips can now be
2470 toggled independently of normal tooltips with the minor mode
2471 `gud-tooltip-mode'.
2472
2473 +++
2474 *** In graphical mode, with a C program, GUD Tooltips have been extended to
2475 display the #define directive associated with an identifier when program is
2476 not executing.
2477
2478 ---
2479 ** GUD mode improvements for jdb:
2480
2481 *** Search for source files using jdb classpath and class
2482 information. Fast startup since there is no need to scan all
2483 source files up front. There is also no need to create and maintain
2484 lists of source directories to scan. Look at `gud-jdb-use-classpath'
2485 and `gud-jdb-classpath' customization variables documentation.
2486
2487 *** Supports the standard breakpoint (gud-break, gud-clear)
2488 set/clear operations from java source files under the classpath, stack
2489 traversal (gud-up, gud-down), and run until current stack finish
2490 (gud-finish).
2491
2492 *** Supports new jdb (Java 1.2 and later) in addition to oldjdb
2493 (Java 1.1 jdb).
2494
2495 *** The previous method of searching for source files has been
2496 preserved in case someone still wants/needs to use it.
2497 Set `gud-jdb-use-classpath' to nil.
2498
2499 Added Customization Variables
2500
2501 *** `gud-jdb-command-name'. What command line to use to invoke jdb.
2502
2503 *** `gud-jdb-use-classpath'. Allows selection of java source file searching
2504 method: set to t for new method, nil to scan `gud-jdb-directories' for
2505 java sources (previous method).
2506
2507 *** `gud-jdb-directories'. List of directories to scan and search for java
2508 classes using the original gud-jdb method (if `gud-jdb-use-classpath'
2509 is nil).
2510
2511 Minor Improvements
2512
2513 *** The STARTTLS wrapper (starttls.el) can now use GNUTLS
2514 instead of the OpenSSL based `starttls' tool. For backwards
2515 compatibility, it prefers `starttls', but you can toggle
2516 `starttls-use-gnutls' to switch to GNUTLS (or simply remove the
2517 `starttls' tool).
2518
2519 *** Do not allow debugger output history variable to grow without bounds.
2520
2521 ** Auto-Revert changes:
2522
2523 +++
2524 *** You can now use Auto Revert mode to `tail' a file.
2525
2526 If point is at the end of a file buffer before reverting, Auto Revert
2527 mode keeps it at the end after reverting. Similarly if point is
2528 displayed at the end of a file buffer in any window, it stays at
2529 the end of the buffer in that window. This allows to tail a file:
2530 just put point at the end of the buffer and it stays there. This
2531 rule applies to file buffers. For non-file buffers, the behavior can
2532 be mode dependent.
2533
2534 If you are sure that the file will only change by growing at the end,
2535 then you can tail the file more efficiently by using the new minor
2536 mode Auto Revert Tail mode. The function `auto-revert-tail-mode'
2537 toggles this mode.
2538
2539 +++
2540 *** Auto Revert mode is now more careful to avoid excessive reverts and
2541 other potential problems when deciding which non-file buffers to
2542 revert. This matters especially if Global Auto Revert mode is enabled
2543 and `global-auto-revert-non-file-buffers' is non-nil. Auto Revert
2544 mode only reverts a non-file buffer if the buffer has a non-nil
2545 `revert-buffer-function' and a non-nil `buffer-stale-function', which
2546 decides whether the buffer should be reverted. Currently, this means
2547 that auto reverting works for Dired buffers (although this may not
2548 work properly on all operating systems) and for the Buffer Menu.
2549
2550 +++
2551 *** If the new user option `auto-revert-check-vc-info' is non-nil, Auto
2552 Revert mode reliably updates version control info (such as the version
2553 control number in the mode line), in all version controlled buffers in
2554 which it is active. If the option is nil, the default, then this info
2555 only gets updated whenever the buffer gets reverted.
2556
2557 ---
2558 ** recentf changes.
2559
2560 The recent file list is now automatically cleanup when recentf mode is
2561 enabled. The new option `recentf-auto-cleanup' controls when to do
2562 automatic cleanup.
2563
2564 The ten most recent files can be quickly opened by using the shortcut
2565 keys 1 to 9, and 0, when the recent list is displayed in a buffer via
2566 the `recentf-open-files', or `recentf-open-more-files' commands.
2567
2568 The `recentf-keep' option replaces `recentf-keep-non-readable-files-p'
2569 and provides a more general mechanism to customize which file names to
2570 keep in the recent list.
2571
2572 With the more advanced option `recentf-filename-handlers', you can
2573 specify functions that successively transform recent file names. For
2574 example, if set to `file-truename' plus `abbreviate-file-name', the
2575 same file will not be in the recent list with different symbolic
2576 links, and the file name will be abbreviated.
2577
2578 To follow naming convention, `recentf-menu-append-commands-flag'
2579 replaces the misnamed option `recentf-menu-append-commands-p'. The
2580 old name remains available as alias, but has been marked obsolete.
2581
2582 +++
2583 ** Desktop package
2584
2585 +++
2586 *** Desktop saving is now a minor mode, `desktop-save-mode'.
2587
2588 +++
2589 *** The variable `desktop-enable' is obsolete.
2590
2591 Customize `desktop-save-mode' to enable desktop saving.
2592
2593 ---
2594 *** Buffers are saved in the desktop file in the same order as that in the
2595 buffer list.
2596
2597 +++
2598 *** The desktop package can be customized to restore only some buffers
2599 immediately, remaining buffers are restored lazily (when Emacs is
2600 idle).
2601
2602 +++
2603 *** New commands:
2604 - desktop-revert reverts to the last loaded desktop.
2605 - desktop-change-dir kills current desktop and loads a new.
2606 - desktop-save-in-desktop-dir saves desktop in the directory from which
2607 it was loaded.
2608 - desktop-lazy-complete runs the desktop load to completion.
2609 - desktop-lazy-abort aborts lazy loading of the desktop.
2610
2611 ---
2612 *** New customizable variables:
2613 - desktop-save. Determins whether the desktop should be saved when it is
2614 killed.
2615 - desktop-file-name-format. Format in which desktop file names should be saved.
2616 - desktop-path. List of directories in which to lookup the desktop file.
2617 - desktop-locals-to-save. List of local variables to save.
2618 - desktop-globals-to-clear. List of global variables that `desktop-clear' will clear.
2619 - desktop-clear-preserve-buffers-regexp. Regexp identifying buffers that `desktop-clear'
2620 should not delete.
2621 - desktop-restore-eager. Number of buffers to restore immediately. Remaining buffers are
2622 restored lazily (when Emacs is idle).
2623 - desktop-lazy-verbose. Verbose reporting of lazily created buffers.
2624 - desktop-lazy-idle-delay. Idle delay before starting to create buffers.
2625
2626 +++
2627 *** New command line option --no-desktop
2628
2629 ---
2630 *** New hooks:
2631 - desktop-after-read-hook run after a desktop is loaded.
2632 - desktop-no-desktop-file-hook run when no desktop file is found.
2633
2634 ---
2635 ** The saveplace.el package now filters out unreadable files.
2636
2637 When you exit Emacs, the saved positions in visited files no longer
2638 include files that aren't readable, e.g. files that don't exist.
2639 Customize the new option `save-place-forget-unreadable-files' to nil
2640 to get the old behavior. The new options `save-place-save-skipped'
2641 and `save-place-skip-check-regexp' allow further fine-tuning of this
2642 feature.
2643
2644 ** EDiff changes.
2645
2646 +++
2647 *** When comparing directories.
2648 Typing D brings up a buffer that lists the differences between the contents of
2649 directories. Now it is possible to use this buffer to copy the missing files
2650 from one directory to another.
2651
2652 +++
2653 *** When comparing files or buffers.
2654 Typing the = key now offers to perform the word-by-word comparison of the
2655 currently highlighted regions in an inferior Ediff session. If you answer 'n'
2656 then it reverts to the old behavior and asks the user to select regions for
2657 comparison.
2658
2659 +++
2660 *** The new command `ediff-backup' compares a file with its most recent
2661 backup using `ediff'. If you specify the name of a backup file,
2662 `ediff-backup' compares it with the file of which it is a backup.
2663
2664 +++
2665 ** Etags changes.
2666
2667 *** New regular expressions features
2668
2669 **** New syntax for regular expressions, multi-line regular expressions.
2670
2671 The syntax --ignore-case-regexp=/regex/ is now undocumented and retained
2672 only for backward compatibility. The new equivalent syntax is
2673 --regex=/regex/i. More generally, it is --regex=/TAGREGEX/TAGNAME/MODS,
2674 where `/TAGNAME' is optional, as usual, and MODS is a string of 0 or
2675 more characters among `i' (ignore case), `m' (multi-line) and `s'
2676 (single-line). The `m' and `s' modifiers behave as in Perl regular
2677 expressions: `m' allows regexps to match more than one line, while `s'
2678 (which implies `m') means that `.' matches newlines. The ability to
2679 span newlines allows writing of much more powerful regular expressions
2680 and rapid prototyping for tagging new languages.
2681
2682 **** Regular expressions can use char escape sequences as in GCC.
2683
2684 The escaped character sequence \a, \b, \d, \e, \f, \n, \r, \t, \v,
2685 respectively, stand for the ASCII characters BEL, BS, DEL, ESC, FF, NL,
2686 CR, TAB, VT,
2687
2688 **** Regular expressions can be bound to a given language.
2689
2690 The syntax --regex={LANGUAGE}REGEX means that REGEX is used to make tags
2691 only for files of language LANGUAGE, and ignored otherwise. This is
2692 particularly useful when storing regexps in a file.
2693
2694 **** Regular expressions can be read from a file.
2695
2696 The --regex=@regexfile option means read the regexps from a file, one
2697 per line. Lines beginning with space or tab are ignored.
2698
2699 *** New language parsing features
2700
2701 **** The `::' qualifier triggers C++ parsing in C file.
2702
2703 Previously, only the `template' and `class' keywords had this effect.
2704
2705 **** The GCC __attribute__ keyword is now recognized and ignored.
2706
2707 **** New language HTML.
2708
2709 Tags are generated for `title' as well as `h1', `h2', and `h3'. Also,
2710 when `name=' is used inside an anchor and whenever `id=' is used.
2711
2712 **** In Makefiles, constants are tagged.
2713
2714 If you want the old behavior instead, thus avoiding to increase the
2715 size of the tags file, use the --no-globals option.
2716
2717 **** New language Lua.
2718
2719 All functions are tagged.
2720
2721 **** In Perl, packages are tags.
2722
2723 Subroutine tags are named from their package. You can jump to sub tags
2724 as you did before, by the sub name, or additionally by looking for
2725 package::sub.
2726
2727 **** In Prolog, etags creates tags for rules in addition to predicates.
2728
2729 **** New language PHP.
2730
2731 Functions, classes and defines are tags. If the --members option is
2732 specified to etags, variables are tags also.
2733
2734 **** New default keywords for TeX.
2735
2736 The new keywords are def, newcommand, renewcommand, newenvironment and
2737 renewenvironment.
2738
2739 *** Honour #line directives.
2740
2741 When Etags parses an input file that contains C preprocessor's #line
2742 directives, it creates tags using the file name and line number
2743 specified in those directives. This is useful when dealing with code
2744 created from Cweb source files. When Etags tags the generated file, it
2745 writes tags pointing to the source file.
2746
2747 *** New option --parse-stdin=FILE.
2748
2749 This option is mostly useful when calling etags from programs. It can
2750 be used (only once) in place of a file name on the command line. Etags
2751 reads from standard input and marks the produced tags as belonging to
2752 the file FILE.
2753
2754 ** VC Changes
2755
2756 +++
2757 *** The key C-x C-q only changes the read-only state of the buffer
2758 (toggle-read-only). It no longer checks files in or out.
2759
2760 We made this change because we held a poll and found that many users
2761 were unhappy with the previous behavior. If you do prefer this
2762 behavior, you can bind `vc-toggle-read-only' to C-x C-q in your
2763 `.emacs' file:
2764
2765 (global-set-key "\C-x\C-q" 'vc-toggle-read-only)
2766
2767 The function `vc-toggle-read-only' will continue to exist.
2768
2769 +++
2770 *** The new variable `vc-cvs-global-switches' specifies switches that
2771 are passed to any CVS command invoked by VC.
2772
2773 These switches are used as "global options" for CVS, which means they
2774 are inserted before the command name. For example, this allows you to
2775 specify a compression level using the `-z#' option for CVS.
2776
2777 +++
2778 *** New backends for Subversion and Meta-CVS.
2779
2780 +++
2781 *** VC-Annotate mode enhancements
2782
2783 In VC-Annotate mode, you can now use the following key bindings for
2784 enhanced functionality to browse the annotations of past revisions, or
2785 to view diffs or log entries directly from vc-annotate-mode:
2786
2787 P: annotates the previous revision
2788 N: annotates the next revision
2789 J: annotates the revision at line
2790 A: annotates the revision previous to line
2791 D: shows the diff of the revision at line with its previous revision
2792 L: shows the log of the revision at line
2793 W: annotates the workfile (most up to date) version
2794
2795 ** pcl-cvs changes:
2796
2797 +++
2798 *** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d y' command to view the diffs
2799 between the local version of the file and yesterday's head revision
2800 in the repository.
2801
2802 +++
2803 *** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d r' command to view the changes
2804 anyone has committed to the repository since you last executed
2805 `checkout', `update' or `commit'. That means using cvs diff options
2806 -rBASE -rHEAD.
2807
2808 +++
2809 ** The new variable `mail-default-directory' specifies
2810 `default-directory' for mail buffers. This directory is used for
2811 auto-save files of mail buffers. It defaults to "~/".
2812
2813 +++
2814 ** The mode line can indicate new mail in a directory or file.
2815
2816 See the documentation of the user option
2817 `display-time-mail-directory'.
2818
2819 ** Rmail changes:
2820
2821 ---
2822 *** Rmail now displays 5-digit message ids in its summary buffer.
2823
2824 *** The new commands rmail-end-of-message and rmail-summary end-of-message,
2825 by default bound to `/', go to the end of the current mail message in
2826 Rmail and Rmail summary buffers.
2827
2828 +++
2829 *** Support for `movemail' from GNU mailutils was added to Rmail.
2830
2831 This version of `movemail' allows to read mail from a wide range of
2832 mailbox formats, including remote POP3 and IMAP4 mailboxes with or
2833 without TLS encryption. If GNU mailutils is installed on the system
2834 and its version of `movemail' can be found in exec-path, it will be
2835 used instead of the native one.
2836
2837 ** Gnus package
2838
2839 ---
2840 *** Gnus now includes Sieve and PGG
2841
2842 Sieve is a library for managing Sieve scripts. PGG is a library to handle
2843 PGP/MIME.
2844
2845 ---
2846 *** There are many news features, bug fixes and improvements.
2847
2848 See the file GNUS-NEWS or the node "Oort Gnus" in the Gnus manual for details.
2849
2850 ---
2851 ** MH-E changes.
2852
2853 Upgraded to MH-E version 7.84. There have been major changes since
2854 version 5.0.2; see MH-E-NEWS for details.
2855
2856 ** Calendar changes:
2857
2858 +++
2859 *** You can now use < and >, instead of C-x < and C-x >, to scroll
2860 the calendar left or right. (The old key bindings still work too.)
2861
2862 +++
2863 *** There is a new calendar package, icalendar.el, that can be used to
2864 convert Emacs diary entries to/from the iCalendar format.
2865
2866 +++
2867 *** Diary sexp entries can have custom marking in the calendar.
2868 Diary sexp functions which only apply to certain days (such as
2869 `diary-block' or `diary-cyclic') now take an optional parameter MARK,
2870 which is the name of a face or a single-character string indicating
2871 how to highlight the day in the calendar display. Specifying a
2872 single-character string as @var{mark} places the character next to the
2873 day in the calendar. Specifying a face highlights the day with that
2874 face. This lets you have different colors or markings for vacations,
2875 appointments, paydays or anything else using a sexp.
2876
2877 +++
2878 *** The new function `calendar-goto-day-of-year' (g D) prompts for a
2879 year and day number, and moves to that date. Negative day numbers
2880 count backward from the end of the year.
2881
2882 +++
2883 *** The new Calendar function `calendar-goto-iso-week' (g w)
2884 prompts for a year and a week number, and moves to the first
2885 day of that ISO week.
2886
2887 ---
2888 *** The new variable `calendar-minimum-window-height' affects the
2889 window generated by the function `generate-calendar-window'.
2890
2891 ---
2892 *** The functions `holiday-easter-etc' and `holiday-advent' now take
2893 optional arguments, in order to only report on the specified holiday
2894 rather than all. This makes customization of variables such as
2895 `christian-holidays' simpler.
2896
2897 ---
2898 *** The function `simple-diary-display' now by default sets a header line.
2899 This can be controlled through the variables `diary-header-line-flag'
2900 and `diary-header-line-format'.
2901
2902 +++
2903 *** The procedure for activating appointment reminders has changed:
2904 use the new function `appt-activate'. The new variable
2905 `appt-display-format' controls how reminders are displayed, replacing
2906 `appt-issue-message', `appt-visible', and `appt-msg-window'.
2907
2908 +++
2909 *** The new functions `diary-from-outlook', `diary-from-outlook-gnus',
2910 and `diary-from-outlook-rmail' can be used to import diary entries
2911 from Outlook-format appointments in mail messages. The variable
2912 `diary-outlook-formats' can be customized to recognize additional
2913 formats.
2914
2915 +++
2916 ** Speedbar changes:
2917
2918 *** Speedbar items can now be selected by clicking mouse-1, based on
2919 the `mouse-1-click-follows-link' mechanism.
2920
2921 *** SPC and DEL are no longer bound to scroll up/down in the speedbar
2922 keymap.
2923
2924 *** The new command `speedbar-toggle-line-expansion', bound to SPC,
2925 contracts or expands the line under the cursor.
2926
2927 *** New command `speedbar-create-directory', bound to `M'.
2928
2929 *** The new commands `speedbar-expand-line-descendants' and
2930 `speedbar-contract-line-descendants', bound to `[' and `]'
2931 respectively, expand and contract the line under cursor with all of
2932 its descendents.
2933
2934 *** The new user option `speedbar-query-confirmation-method' controls
2935 how querying is performed for file operations. A value of 'always
2936 means to always query before file operations; 'none-but-delete means
2937 to not query before any file operations, except before a file
2938 deletion.
2939
2940 *** The new user option `speedbar-select-frame-method' specifies how
2941 to select a frame for displaying a file opened with the speedbar. A
2942 value of 'attached means to use the attached frame (the frame that
2943 speedbar was started from.) A number such as 1 or -1 means to pass
2944 that number to `other-frame'.
2945
2946 *** The new user option `speedbar-use-tool-tips-flag', if non-nil,
2947 means to display tool-tips for speedbar items.
2948
2949 *** The frame management code in speedbar.el has been split into a new
2950 `dframe' library. Emacs Lisp code that makes use of the speedbar
2951 should use `dframe-attached-frame' instead of
2952 `speedbar-attached-frame', `dframe-timer' instead of `speedbar-timer',
2953 `dframe-close-frame' instead of `speedbar-close-frame', and
2954 `dframe-activity-change-focus-flag' instead of
2955 `speedbar-activity-change-focus-flag'. The variables
2956 `speedbar-update-speed' and `speedbar-navigating-speed' are also
2957 obsolete; use `dframe-update-speed' instead.
2958
2959 ---
2960 ** sql changes.
2961
2962 *** The variable `sql-product' controls the highlightng of different
2963 SQL dialects. This variable can be set globally via Customize, on a
2964 buffer-specific basis via local variable settings, or for the current
2965 session using the new SQL->Product submenu. (This menu replaces the
2966 SQL->Highlighting submenu.)
2967
2968 The following values are supported:
2969
2970 ansi ANSI Standard (default)
2971 db2 DB2
2972 informix Informix
2973 ingres Ingres
2974 interbase Interbase
2975 linter Linter
2976 ms Microsoft
2977 mysql MySQL
2978 oracle Oracle
2979 postgres Postgres
2980 solid Solid
2981 sqlite SQLite
2982 sybase Sybase
2983
2984 The current product name will be shown on the mode line following the
2985 SQL mode indicator.
2986
2987 The technique of setting `sql-mode-font-lock-defaults' directly in
2988 your `.emacs' will no longer establish the default highlighting -- Use
2989 `sql-product' to accomplish this.
2990
2991 ANSI keywords are always highlighted.
2992
2993 *** The function `sql-add-product-keywords' can be used to add
2994 font-lock rules to the product specific rules. For example, to have
2995 all identifiers ending in `_t' under MS SQLServer treated as a type,
2996 you would use the following line in your .emacs file:
2997
2998 (sql-add-product-keywords 'ms
2999 '(("\\<\\w+_t\\>" . font-lock-type-face)))
3000
3001 *** Oracle support includes keyword highlighting for Oracle 9i.
3002
3003 Most SQL and PL/SQL keywords are implemented. SQL*Plus commands are
3004 highlighted in `font-lock-doc-face'.
3005
3006 *** Microsoft SQLServer support has been significantly improved.
3007
3008 Keyword highlighting for SqlServer 2000 is implemented.
3009 sql-interactive-mode defaults to use osql, rather than isql, because
3010 osql flushes its error stream more frequently. Thus error messages
3011 are displayed when they occur rather than when the session is
3012 terminated.
3013
3014 If the username and password are not provided to `sql-ms', osql is
3015 called with the `-E' command line argument to use the operating system
3016 credentials to authenticate the user.
3017
3018 *** Postgres support is enhanced.
3019 Keyword highlighting of Postgres 7.3 is implemented. Prompting for
3020 the username and the pgsql `-U' option is added.
3021
3022 *** MySQL support is enhanced.
3023 Keyword higlighting of MySql 4.0 is implemented.
3024
3025 *** Imenu support has been enhanced to locate tables, views, indexes,
3026 packages, procedures, functions, triggers, sequences, rules, and
3027 defaults.
3028
3029 *** Added SQL->Start SQLi Session menu entry which calls the
3030 appropriate `sql-interactive-mode' wrapper for the current setting of
3031 `sql-product'.
3032
3033 ---
3034 *** sql.el supports the SQLite interpreter--call 'sql-sqlite'.
3035
3036 ** FFAP changes:
3037
3038 +++
3039 *** New ffap commands and keybindings:
3040
3041 C-x C-r (`ffap-read-only'),
3042 C-x C-v (`ffap-alternate-file'), C-x C-d (`ffap-list-directory'),
3043 C-x 4 r (`ffap-read-only-other-window'), C-x 4 d (`ffap-dired-other-window'),
3044 C-x 5 r (`ffap-read-only-other-frame'), C-x 5 d (`ffap-dired-other-frame').
3045
3046 ---
3047 *** FFAP accepts wildcards in a file name by default.
3048
3049 C-x C-f passes the file name to `find-file' with non-nil WILDCARDS
3050 argument, which visits multiple files, and C-x d passes it to `dired'.
3051
3052 ---
3053 ** In skeleton.el, `-' marks the `skeleton-point' without interregion interaction.
3054
3055 `@' has reverted to only setting `skeleton-positions' and no longer
3056 sets `skeleton-point'. Skeletons which used @ to mark
3057 `skeleton-point' independent of `_' should now use `-' instead. The
3058 updated `skeleton-insert' docstring explains these new features along
3059 with other details of skeleton construction.
3060
3061 ---
3062 ** Hideshow mode changes
3063
3064 *** New variable `hs-set-up-overlay' allows customization of the overlay
3065 used to effect hiding for hideshow minor mode. Integration with isearch
3066 handles the overlay property `display' specially, preserving it during
3067 temporary overlay showing in the course of an isearch operation.
3068
3069 *** New variable `hs-allow-nesting' non-nil means that hiding a block does
3070 not discard the hidden state of any "internal" blocks; when the parent
3071 block is later shown, the internal blocks remain hidden. Default is nil.
3072
3073 +++
3074 ** `hide-ifdef-mode' now uses overlays rather than selective-display
3075 to hide its text. This should be mostly transparent but slightly
3076 changes the behavior of motion commands like C-e and C-p.
3077
3078 ---
3079 ** `partial-completion-mode' now handles partial completion on directory names.
3080
3081 ---
3082 ** The type-break package now allows `type-break-file-name' to be nil
3083 and if so, doesn't store any data across sessions. This is handy if
3084 you don't want the `.type-break' file in your home directory or are
3085 annoyed by the need for interaction when you kill Emacs.
3086
3087 ---
3088 ** `ps-print' can now print characters from the mule-unicode charsets.
3089
3090 Printing text with characters from the mule-unicode-* sets works with
3091 `ps-print', provided that you have installed the appropriate BDF
3092 fonts. See the file INSTALL for URLs where you can find these fonts.
3093
3094 ---
3095 ** New command `strokes-global-set-stroke-string'.
3096 This is like `strokes-global-set-stroke', but it allows you to bind
3097 the stroke directly to a string to insert. This is convenient for
3098 using strokes as an input method.
3099
3100 ** Emacs server changes:
3101
3102 +++
3103 *** You can have several Emacs servers on the same machine.
3104
3105 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "foo")' -f server-start &
3106 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "bar")' -f server-start &
3107 % emacsclient -s foo file1
3108 % emacsclient -s bar file2
3109
3110 +++
3111 *** The `emacsclient' command understands the options `--eval' and
3112 `--display' which tell Emacs respectively to evaluate the given Lisp
3113 expression and to use the given display when visiting files.
3114
3115 +++
3116 *** User option `server-mode' can be used to start a server process.
3117
3118 ---
3119 ** LDAP support now defaults to ldapsearch from OpenLDAP version 2.
3120
3121 +++
3122 ** You can now disable pc-selection-mode after enabling it.
3123
3124 M-x pc-selection-mode behaves like a proper minor mode, and with no
3125 argument it toggles the mode. Turning off PC-Selection mode restores
3126 the global key bindings that were replaced by turning on the mode.
3127
3128 ---
3129 ** `uniquify-strip-common-suffix' tells uniquify to prefer
3130 `file|dir1' and `file|dir2' to `file|dir1/subdir' and `file|dir2/subdir'.
3131
3132 ---
3133 ** Support for `magic cookie' standout modes has been removed.
3134
3135 Emacs still works on terminals that require magic cookies in order to
3136 use standout mode, but they can no longer display mode-lines in
3137 inverse-video.
3138
3139 ---
3140 ** The game `mpuz' is enhanced.
3141
3142 `mpuz' now allows the 2nd factor not to have two identical digits. By
3143 default, all trivial operations involving whole lines are performed
3144 automatically. The game uses faces for better visual feedback.
3145
3146 ** battery.el changes:
3147
3148 ---
3149 *** display-battery-mode replaces display-battery.
3150
3151 ---
3152 *** battery.el now works on recent versions of OS X.
3153
3154 ---
3155 ** calculator.el now has radix grouping mode.
3156
3157 To enable this, set `calculator-output-radix' non-nil. In this mode a
3158 separator character is used every few digits, making it easier to see
3159 byte boundries etc. For more info, see the documentation of the
3160 variable `calculator-radix-grouping-mode'.
3161
3162 ---
3163 ** fast-lock.el and lazy-lock.el are obsolete. Use jit-lock.el instead.
3164
3165 ---
3166 ** iso-acc.el is now obsolete. Use one of the latin input methods instead.
3167
3168 ---
3169 ** cplus-md.el has been deleted.
3170 \f
3171 * Changes in Emacs 22.1 on non-free operating systems
3172
3173 +++
3174 ** The HOME directory defaults to Application Data under the user profile.
3175
3176 If you used a previous version of Emacs without setting the HOME
3177 environment variable and a `.emacs' was saved, then Emacs will continue
3178 using C:/ as the default HOME. But if you are installing Emacs afresh,
3179 the default location will be the "Application Data" (or similar
3180 localized name) subdirectory of your user profile. A typical location
3181 of this directory is "C:\Documents and Settings\USERNAME\Application Data",
3182 where USERNAME is your user name.
3183
3184 This change means that users can now have their own `.emacs' files on
3185 shared computers, and the default HOME directory is less likely to be
3186 read-only on computers that are administered by someone else.
3187
3188 +++
3189 ** Passing resources on the command line now works on MS Windows.
3190
3191 You can use --xrm to pass resource settings to Emacs, overriding any
3192 existing values. For example:
3193
3194 emacs --xrm "Emacs.Background:red" --xrm "Emacs.Geometry:100x20"
3195
3196 will start up Emacs on an initial frame of 100x20 with red background,
3197 irrespective of geometry or background setting on the Windows registry.
3198
3199 ---
3200 ** On MS Windows, the "system caret" now follows the cursor.
3201
3202 This enables Emacs to work better with programs that need to track
3203 the cursor, for example screen magnifiers and text to speech programs.
3204
3205 ---
3206 ** Tooltips now work on MS Windows.
3207
3208 See the Emacs 21.1 NEWS entry for tooltips for details.
3209
3210 ---
3211 ** Images are now supported on MS Windows.
3212
3213 PBM and XBM images are supported out of the box. Other image formats
3214 depend on external libraries. All of these libraries have been ported
3215 to Windows, and can be found in both source and binary form at
3216 http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net/. Note that libpng also depends on
3217 zlib, and tiff depends on the version of jpeg that it was compiled
3218 against. For additional information, see nt/INSTALL.
3219
3220 ---
3221 ** Sound is now supported on MS Windows.
3222
3223 WAV format is supported on all versions of Windows, other formats such
3224 as AU, AIFF and MP3 may be supported in the more recent versions of
3225 Windows, or when other software provides hooks into the system level
3226 sound support for those formats.
3227
3228 ---
3229 ** Different shaped mouse pointers are supported on MS Windows.
3230
3231 The mouse pointer changes shape depending on what is under the pointer.
3232
3233 ---
3234 ** Pointing devices with more than 3 buttons are now supported on MS Windows.
3235
3236 The new variable `w32-pass-extra-mouse-buttons-to-system' controls
3237 whether Emacs should handle the extra buttons itself (the default), or
3238 pass them to Windows to be handled with system-wide functions.
3239
3240 ---
3241 ** Emacs takes note of colors defined in Control Panel on MS-Windows.
3242
3243 The Control Panel defines some default colors for applications in much
3244 the same way as wildcard X Resources do on X. Emacs now adds these
3245 colors to the colormap prefixed by System (eg SystemMenu for the
3246 default Menu background, SystemMenuText for the foreground), and uses
3247 some of them to initialize some of the default faces.
3248 `list-colors-display' shows the list of System color names, in case
3249 you wish to use them in other faces.
3250
3251 ---
3252 ** On MS Windows NT/W2K/XP, Emacs uses Unicode for clipboard operations.
3253
3254 Those systems use Unicode internally, so this allows Emacs to share
3255 multilingual text with other applications. On other versions of
3256 MS Windows, Emacs now uses the appropriate locale coding-system, so
3257 the clipboard should work correctly for your local language without
3258 any customizations.
3259
3260 ---
3261 ** Running in a console window in Windows now uses the console size.
3262
3263 Previous versions of Emacs erred on the side of having a usable Emacs
3264 through telnet, even though that was inconvenient if you use Emacs in
3265 a local console window with a scrollback buffer. The default value of
3266 w32-use-full-screen-buffer is now nil, which favours local console
3267 windows. Recent versions of Windows telnet also work well with this
3268 setting. If you are using an older telnet server then Emacs detects
3269 that the console window dimensions that are reported are not sane, and
3270 defaults to 80x25. If you use such a telnet server regularly at a size
3271 other than 80x25, you can still manually set
3272 w32-use-full-screen-buffer to t.
3273
3274 ---
3275 ** On Mac OS, `keyboard-coding-system' changes based on the keyboard script.
3276
3277 ---
3278 ** The variable `mac-keyboard-text-encoding' and the constants
3279 `kTextEncodingMacRoman', `kTextEncodingISOLatin1', and
3280 `kTextEncodingISOLatin2' are obsolete.
3281 \f
3282 * Incompatible Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1
3283
3284 ---
3285 ** The variables post-command-idle-hook and post-command-idle-delay have
3286 been removed. Use run-with-idle-timer instead.
3287
3288 +++
3289 ** `suppress-keymap' now works by remapping `self-insert-command' to
3290 the command `undefined'. (In earlier Emacs versions, it used
3291 `substitute-key-definition' to rebind self inserting characters to
3292 `undefined'.)
3293
3294 +++
3295 ** Mode line display ignores text properties as well as the
3296 :propertize and :eval forms in the value of a variable whose
3297 `risky-local-variable' property is nil.
3298
3299 ---
3300 ** Support for Mocklisp has been removed.
3301 \f
3302 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1
3303
3304 ** General Lisp changes:
3305
3306 *** The function `expt' handles negative exponents differently.
3307 The value for `(expt A B)', if both A and B are integers and B is
3308 negative, is now a float. For example: (expt 2 -2) => 0.25.
3309
3310 +++
3311 *** The function `eql' is now available without requiring the CL package.
3312
3313 +++
3314 *** `makehash' is now obsolete. Use `make-hash-table' instead.
3315
3316 +++
3317 *** `add-to-list' takes an optional third argument, APPEND.
3318
3319 If APPEND is non-nil, the new element gets added at the end of the
3320 list instead of at the beginning. This change actually occurred in
3321 Emacs 21.1, but was not documented then.
3322
3323 +++
3324 *** New function `add-to-ordered-list' is like `add-to-list' but
3325 associates a numeric ordering of each element added to the list.
3326
3327 +++
3328 *** New function `copy-tree' makes a copy of a tree.
3329
3330 It recursively copyies through both CARs and CDRs.
3331
3332 +++
3333 *** New function `delete-dups' deletes `equal' duplicate elements from a list.
3334
3335 It modifies the list destructively, like `delete'. Of several `equal'
3336 occurrences of an element in the list, the one that's kept is the
3337 first one.
3338
3339 +++
3340 *** New function `rassq-delete-all'.
3341
3342 (rassq-delete-all VALUE ALIST) deletes, from ALIST, each element whose
3343 CDR is `eq' to the specified value.
3344
3345 +++
3346 *** The function `number-sequence' makes a list of equally-separated numbers.
3347
3348 For instance, (number-sequence 4 9) returns (4 5 6 7 8 9). By
3349 default, the separation is 1, but you can specify a different
3350 separation as the third argument. (number-sequence 1.5 6 2) returns
3351 (1.5 3.5 5.5).
3352
3353 +++
3354 *** New variables `most-positive-fixnum' and `most-negative-fixnum'.
3355
3356 They hold the largest and smallest possible integer values.
3357
3358 +++
3359 *** Minor change in the function `format'.
3360
3361 Some flags that were accepted but not implemented (such as "*") are no
3362 longer accepted.
3363
3364 +++
3365 *** Functions `get' and `plist-get' no longer give errors for bad plists.
3366
3367 They return nil for a malformed property list or if the list is
3368 cyclic.
3369
3370 +++
3371 *** New functions `lax-plist-get' and `lax-plist-put'.
3372
3373 They are like `plist-get' and `plist-put', except that they compare
3374 the property name using `equal' rather than `eq'.
3375
3376 +++
3377 *** New variable `print-continuous-numbering'.
3378
3379 When this is non-nil, successive calls to print functions use a single
3380 numbering scheme for circular structure references. This is only
3381 relevant when `print-circle' is non-nil.
3382
3383 When you bind `print-continuous-numbering' to t, you should
3384 also bind `print-number-table' to nil.
3385
3386 +++
3387 *** New function `macroexpand-all' expands all macros in a form.
3388
3389 It is similar to the Common-Lisp function of the same name.
3390 One difference is that it guarantees to return the original argument
3391 if no expansion is done, which can be tested using `eq'.
3392
3393 +++
3394 *** The function `atan' now accepts an optional second argument.
3395
3396 When called with 2 arguments, as in `(atan Y X)', `atan' returns the
3397 angle in radians between the vector [X, Y] and the X axis. (This is
3398 equivalent to the standard C library function `atan2'.)
3399
3400 +++
3401 *** A function or macro's doc string can now specify the calling pattern.
3402
3403 You put this info in the doc string's last line. It should be
3404 formatted so as to match the regexp "\n\n(fn .*)\\'". If you don't
3405 specify this explicitly, Emacs determines it from the actual argument
3406 names. Usually that default is right, but not always.
3407
3408 +++
3409 *** New macro `with-local-quit' temporarily allows quitting.
3410
3411 A quit inside the body of `with-local-quit' is caught by the
3412 `with-local-quit' form itself, but another quit will happen later once
3413 the code that has inhibitted quitting exits.
3414
3415 This is for use around potentially blocking or long-running code
3416 inside timer functions and `post-command-hook' functions.
3417
3418 +++
3419 *** New macro `define-obsolete-function-alias'.
3420
3421 This combines `defalias' and `make-obsolete'.
3422
3423 +++
3424 *** New function `unsafep' determines whether a Lisp form is safe.
3425
3426 It returns nil if the given Lisp form can't possibly do anything
3427 dangerous; otherwise it returns a reason why the form might be unsafe
3428 (calls unknown function, alters global variable, etc).
3429
3430 *** `list-faces-display' takes an optional argument, REGEXP.
3431
3432 If it is non-nil, the function lists only faces matching this regexp.
3433
3434 ** Lisp code indentation features:
3435
3436 +++
3437 *** The `defmacro' form can contain indentation and edebug declarations.
3438
3439 These declarations specify how to indent the macro calls in Lisp mode
3440 and how to debug them with Edebug. You write them like this:
3441
3442 (defmacro NAME LAMBDA-LIST [DOC-STRING] [DECLARATION ...] ...)
3443
3444 DECLARATION is a list `(declare DECLARATION-SPECIFIER ...)'. The
3445 possible declaration specifiers are:
3446
3447 (indent INDENT)
3448 Set NAME's `lisp-indent-function' property to INDENT.
3449
3450 (edebug DEBUG)
3451 Set NAME's `edebug-form-spec' property to DEBUG. (This is
3452 equivalent to writing a `def-edebug-spec' for the macro,
3453 but this is cleaner.)
3454
3455 ---
3456 *** cl-indent now allows customization of Indentation of backquoted forms.
3457
3458 See the new user option `lisp-backquote-indentation'.
3459
3460 ---
3461 *** cl-indent now handles indentation of simple and extended `loop' forms.
3462
3463 The new user options `lisp-loop-keyword-indentation',
3464 `lisp-loop-forms-indentation', and `lisp-simple-loop-indentation' can
3465 be used to customize the indentation of keywords and forms in loop
3466 forms.
3467
3468 +++
3469 ** Variable aliases:
3470
3471 *** New function: defvaralias ALIAS-VAR BASE-VAR [DOCSTRING]
3472
3473 This function defines the symbol ALIAS-VAR as a variable alias for
3474 symbol BASE-VAR. This means that retrieving the value of ALIAS-VAR
3475 returns the value of BASE-VAR, and changing the value of ALIAS-VAR
3476 changes the value of BASE-VAR.
3477
3478 DOCSTRING, if present, is the documentation for ALIAS-VAR; else it has
3479 the same documentation as BASE-VAR.
3480
3481 *** New function: indirect-variable VARIABLE
3482
3483 This function returns the variable at the end of the chain of aliases
3484 of VARIABLE. If VARIABLE is not a symbol, or if VARIABLE is not
3485 defined as an alias, the function returns VARIABLE.
3486
3487 It might be noteworthy that variables aliases work for all kinds of
3488 variables, including buffer-local and frame-local variables.
3489
3490 +++
3491 *** The macro `define-obsolete-variable-alias' combines `defvaralias' and
3492 `make-obsolete-variable'.
3493
3494 ** defcustom changes:
3495
3496 +++
3497 *** The new customization type `float' requires a floating point number.
3498
3499 ** String changes:
3500
3501 +++
3502 *** The escape sequence \s is now interpreted as a SPACE character.
3503
3504 Exception: In a character constant, if it is followed by a `-' in a
3505 character constant (e.g. ?\s-A), it is still interpreted as the super
3506 modifier. In strings, \s is always interpreted as a space.
3507
3508 +++
3509 *** A hex escape in a string constant forces the string to be multibyte.
3510
3511 +++
3512 *** An octal escape in a string constant forces the string to be unibyte.
3513
3514 +++
3515 *** `split-string' now includes null substrings in the returned list if
3516 the optional argument SEPARATORS is non-nil and there are matches for
3517 SEPARATORS at the beginning or end of the string. If SEPARATORS is
3518 nil, or if the new optional third argument OMIT-NULLS is non-nil, all
3519 empty matches are omitted from the returned list.
3520
3521 +++
3522 *** New function `string-to-multibyte' converts a unibyte string to a
3523 multibyte string with the same individual character codes.
3524
3525 +++
3526 *** New function `substring-no-properties' returns a substring without
3527 text properties.
3528
3529 +++
3530 *** The new function `assoc-string' replaces `assoc-ignore-case' and
3531 `assoc-ignore-representation', which are still available, but have
3532 been declared obsolete.
3533
3534 +++
3535 ** Displaying warnings to the user.
3536
3537 See the functions `warn' and `display-warning', or the Lisp Manual.
3538 If you want to be sure the warning will not be overlooked, this
3539 facility is much better than using `message', since it displays
3540 warnings in a separate window.
3541
3542 +++
3543 ** Progress reporters.
3544
3545 These provide a simple and uniform way for commands to present
3546 progress messages for the user.
3547
3548 See the new functions `make-progress-reporter',
3549 `progress-reporter-update', `progress-reporter-force-update',
3550 `progress-reporter-done', and `dotimes-with-progress-reporter'.
3551
3552 ** Buffer positions:
3553
3554 +++
3555 *** Function `compute-motion' now calculates the usable window
3556 width if the WIDTH argument is nil. If the TOPOS argument is nil,
3557 the usable window height and width is used.
3558
3559 +++
3560 *** The `line-move', `scroll-up', and `scroll-down' functions will now
3561 modify the window vscroll to scroll through display rows that are
3562 taller that the height of the window, for example in the presence of
3563 large images. To disable this feature, bind the new variable
3564 `auto-window-vscroll' to nil.
3565
3566 +++
3567 *** The argument to `forward-word', `backward-word' is optional.
3568
3569 It defaults to 1.
3570
3571 +++
3572 *** Argument to `forward-to-indentation' and `backward-to-indentation' is optional.
3573
3574 It defaults to 1.
3575
3576 +++
3577 *** New function `mouse-on-link-p' test if a position is in a clickable link.
3578
3579 This is the function used by the new `mouse-1-click-follows-link'
3580 functionality.
3581
3582 +++
3583 *** New function `line-number-at-pos' returns the line number of a position.
3584
3585 It an optional buffer position argument that defaults to point.
3586
3587 +++
3588 *** `field-beginning' and `field-end' take new optional argument, LIMIT.
3589
3590 This argument tells them not to search beyond LIMIT. Instead they
3591 give up and return LIMIT.
3592
3593 +++
3594 *** Function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now returns the pixel coordinates
3595 and partial visiblity state of the corresponding row, if the PARTIALLY
3596 arg is non-nil.
3597
3598 +++
3599 *** New functions `posn-at-point' and `posn-at-x-y' return
3600 click-event-style position information for a given visible buffer
3601 position or for a given window pixel coordinate.
3602
3603 ** Text modification:
3604
3605 +++
3606 *** The new function `insert-for-yank' normally works like `insert', but
3607 removes the text properties in the `yank-excluded-properties' list
3608 and handles the `yank-handler' text property.
3609
3610 +++
3611 *** The new function `insert-buffer-substring-as-yank' is like
3612 `insert-for-yank' except that it gets the text from another buffer as
3613 in `insert-buffer-substring'.
3614
3615 +++
3616 *** The new function `insert-buffer-substring-no-properties' is like
3617 `insert-buffer-substring', but removes all text properties from the
3618 inserted substring.
3619
3620 +++
3621 *** The new function `filter-buffer-substring' extracts a buffer
3622 substring, passes it through a set of filter functions, and returns
3623 the filtered substring. Use it instead of `buffer-substring' or
3624 `delete-and-extract-region' when copying text into a user-accessible
3625 data structure, such as the kill-ring, X clipboard, or a register.
3626
3627 The list of filter function is specified by the new variable
3628 `buffer-substring-filters'. For example, Longlines mode adds to
3629 `buffer-substring-filters' to remove soft newlines from the copied
3630 text.
3631
3632 +++
3633 *** Function `translate-region' accepts also a char-table as TABLE
3634 argument.
3635
3636 +++
3637 *** The new translation table `translation-table-for-input'
3638 is used for customizing self-insertion. The character to
3639 be inserted is translated through it.
3640
3641 ---
3642 *** Text clones.
3643
3644 The new function `text-clone-create'. Text clones are chunks of text
3645 that are kept identical by transparently propagating changes from one
3646 clone to the other.
3647
3648 ---
3649 *** The function `insert-string' is now obsolete.
3650
3651 ** Filling changes.
3652
3653 +++
3654 *** In determining an adaptive fill prefix, Emacs now tries the function in
3655 `adaptive-fill-function' _before_ matching the buffer line against
3656 `adaptive-fill-regexp' rather than _after_ it.
3657
3658 +++
3659 ** Atomic change groups.
3660
3661 To perform some changes in the current buffer "atomically" so that
3662 they either all succeed or are all undone, use `atomic-change-group'
3663 around the code that makes changes. For instance:
3664
3665 (atomic-change-group
3666 (insert foo)
3667 (delete-region x y))
3668
3669 If an error (or other nonlocal exit) occurs inside the body of
3670 `atomic-change-group', it unmakes all the changes in that buffer that
3671 were during the execution of the body. The change group has no effect
3672 on any other buffers--any such changes remain.
3673
3674 If you need something more sophisticated, you can directly call the
3675 lower-level functions that `atomic-change-group' uses. Here is how.
3676
3677 To set up a change group for one buffer, call `prepare-change-group'.
3678 Specify the buffer as argument; it defaults to the current buffer.
3679 This function returns a "handle" for the change group. You must save
3680 the handle to activate the change group and then finish it.
3681
3682 Before you change the buffer again, you must activate the change
3683 group. Pass the handle to `activate-change-group' afterward to
3684 do this.
3685
3686 After you make the changes, you must finish the change group. You can
3687 either accept the changes or cancel them all. Call
3688 `accept-change-group' to accept the changes in the group as final;
3689 call `cancel-change-group' to undo them all.
3690
3691 You should use `unwind-protect' to make sure the group is always
3692 finished. The call to `activate-change-group' should be inside the
3693 `unwind-protect', in case the user types C-g just after it runs.
3694 (This is one reason why `prepare-change-group' and
3695 `activate-change-group' are separate functions.) Once you finish the
3696 group, don't use the handle again--don't try to finish the same group
3697 twice.
3698
3699 To make a multibuffer change group, call `prepare-change-group' once
3700 for each buffer you want to cover, then use `nconc' to combine the
3701 returned values, like this:
3702
3703 (nconc (prepare-change-group buffer-1)
3704 (prepare-change-group buffer-2))
3705
3706 You can then activate the multibuffer change group with a single call
3707 to `activate-change-group', and finish it with a single call to
3708 `accept-change-group' or `cancel-change-group'.
3709
3710 Nested use of several change groups for the same buffer works as you
3711 would expect. Non-nested use of change groups for the same buffer
3712 will lead to undesirable results, so don't let it happen; the first
3713 change group you start for any given buffer should be the last one
3714 finished.
3715
3716 ** Buffer-related changes:
3717
3718 ---
3719 *** `list-buffers-noselect' now takes an additional argument, BUFFER-LIST.
3720
3721 If it is non-nil, it specifies which buffers to list.
3722
3723 +++
3724 *** `kill-buffer-hook' is now a permanent local.
3725
3726 +++
3727 *** The new function `buffer-local-value' returns the buffer-local
3728 binding of VARIABLE (a symbol) in buffer BUFFER. If VARIABLE does not
3729 have a buffer-local binding in buffer BUFFER, it returns the default
3730 value of VARIABLE instead.
3731
3732 *** The function `frame-or-buffer-changed-p' now lets you maintain
3733 various status records in parallel.
3734
3735 It take a variable (a symbol) as argument. If the variable is non-nil,
3736 then its value should be a vector installed previously by
3737 `frame-or-buffer-changed-p'. If the frame names, buffer names, buffer
3738 order, or their read-only or modified flags have changed, since the
3739 time the vector's contents were recorded by a previous call to
3740 `frame-or-buffer-changed-p', then the function returns t. Otherwise
3741 it returns nil.
3742
3743 On the first call to `frame-or-buffer-changed-p', the variable's
3744 value should be nil. `frame-or-buffer-changed-p' stores a suitable
3745 vector into the variable and returns t.
3746
3747 If the variable is itself nil, then `frame-or-buffer-changed-p' uses,
3748 for compatibility, an internal variable which exists only for this
3749 purpose.
3750
3751 +++
3752 *** The function `read-buffer' follows the convention for reading from
3753 the minibuffer with a default value: if DEF is non-nil, the minibuffer
3754 prompt provided in PROMPT is edited to show the default value provided
3755 in DEF before the terminal colon and space.
3756
3757 ** Local variables lists:
3758
3759 +++
3760 *** Text properties in local variables.
3761
3762 A file local variables list cannot specify a string with text
3763 properties--any specified text properties are discarded.
3764
3765 +++
3766 *** The variable `safe-local-eval-forms' specifies a list of forms that
3767 are ok to evaluate when they appear in an `eval' local variables
3768 specification. Normally Emacs asks for confirmation before evaluating
3769 such a form, but if the form appears in this list, no confirmation is
3770 needed.
3771
3772 ---
3773 *** If a function has a non-nil `safe-local-eval-function' property,
3774 that means it is ok to evaluate some calls to that function when it
3775 appears in an `eval' local variables specification. If the property
3776 is t, then any form calling that function with constant arguments is
3777 ok. If the property is a function or list of functions, they are called
3778 with the form as argument, and if any returns t, the form is ok to call.
3779
3780 If the form is not "ok to call", that means Emacs asks for
3781 confirmation as before.
3782
3783 ** Searching and matching changes:
3784
3785 +++
3786 *** New function `looking-back' checks whether a regular expression matches
3787 the text before point. Specifying the LIMIT argument bounds how far
3788 back the match can start; this is a way to keep it from taking too long.
3789
3790 +++
3791 *** The new variable `search-spaces-regexp' controls how to search
3792 for spaces in a regular expression. If it is non-nil, it should be a
3793 regular expression, and any series of spaces stands for that regular
3794 expression. If it is nil, spaces stand for themselves.
3795
3796 Spaces inside of constructs such as `[..]' and inside loops such as
3797 `*', `+', and `?' are never replaced with `search-spaces-regexp'.
3798
3799 +++
3800 *** New regular expression operators, `\_<' and `\_>'.
3801
3802 These match the beginning and end of a symbol. A symbol is a
3803 non-empty sequence of either word or symbol constituent characters, as
3804 specified by the syntax table.
3805
3806 ---
3807 *** rx.el has new corresponding `symbol-end' and `symbol-start' elements.
3808
3809 +++
3810 *** `skip-chars-forward' and `skip-chars-backward' now handle
3811 character classes such as `[:alpha:]', along with individual
3812 characters and ranges.
3813
3814 ---
3815 *** In `replace-match', the replacement text no longer inherits
3816 properties from surrounding text.
3817
3818 +++
3819 *** The list returned by `(match-data t)' now has the buffer as a final
3820 element, if the last match was on a buffer. `set-match-data'
3821 accepts such a list for restoring the match state.
3822
3823 +++
3824 *** Functions `match-data' and `set-match-data' now have an optional
3825 argument `reseat'. When non-nil, all markers in the match data list
3826 passed to these function will be reseated to point to nowhere.
3827
3828 +++
3829 *** The default value of `sentence-end' is now defined using the new
3830 variable `sentence-end-without-space', which contains such characters
3831 that end a sentence without following spaces.
3832
3833 The function `sentence-end' should be used to obtain the value of the
3834 variable `sentence-end'. If the variable `sentence-end' is nil, then
3835 this function returns the regexp constructed from the variables
3836 `sentence-end-without-period', `sentence-end-double-space' and
3837 `sentence-end-without-space'.
3838
3839 ** Undo changes:
3840
3841 +++
3842 *** `buffer-undo-list' can allows programmable elements.
3843
3844 These elements have the form (apply FUNNAME . ARGS), where FUNNAME is
3845 a symbol other than t or nil. That stands for a high-level change
3846 that should be undone by evaluating (apply FUNNAME ARGS).
3847
3848 These entries can also have the form (apply DELTA BEG END FUNNAME . ARGS)
3849 which indicates that the change which took place was limited to the
3850 range BEG...END and increased the buffer size by DELTA.
3851
3852 +++
3853 *** If the buffer's undo list for the current command gets longer than
3854 `undo-outer-limit', garbage collection empties it. This is to prevent
3855 it from using up the available memory and choking Emacs.
3856
3857 +++
3858 ** New `yank-handler' text property can be used to control how
3859 previously killed text on the kill ring is reinserted.
3860
3861 The value of the `yank-handler' property must be a list with one to four
3862 elements with the following format:
3863 (FUNCTION PARAM NOEXCLUDE UNDO).
3864
3865 The `insert-for-yank' function looks for a yank-handler property on
3866 the first character on its string argument (typically the first
3867 element on the kill-ring). If a `yank-handler' property is found,
3868 the normal behavior of `insert-for-yank' is modified in various ways:
3869
3870 When FUNCTION is present and non-nil, it is called instead of `insert'
3871 to insert the string. FUNCTION takes one argument--the object to insert.
3872 If PARAM is present and non-nil, it replaces STRING as the object
3873 passed to FUNCTION (or `insert'); for example, if FUNCTION is
3874 `yank-rectangle', PARAM should be a list of strings to insert as a
3875 rectangle.
3876 If NOEXCLUDE is present and non-nil, the normal removal of the
3877 `yank-excluded-properties' is not performed; instead FUNCTION is
3878 responsible for removing those properties. This may be necessary
3879 if FUNCTION adjusts point before or after inserting the object.
3880 If UNDO is present and non-nil, it is a function that will be called
3881 by `yank-pop' to undo the insertion of the current object. It is
3882 called with two arguments, the start and end of the current region.
3883 FUNCTION can set `yank-undo-function' to override the UNDO value.
3884
3885 *** The functions `kill-new', `kill-append', and `kill-region' now have an
3886 optional argument to specify the `yank-handler' text property to put on
3887 the killed text.
3888
3889 *** The function `yank-pop' will now use a non-nil value of the variable
3890 `yank-undo-function' (instead of `delete-region') to undo the previous
3891 `yank' or `yank-pop' command (or a call to `insert-for-yank'). The function
3892 `insert-for-yank' automatically sets that variable according to the UNDO
3893 element of the string argument's `yank-handler' text property if present.
3894
3895 *** The function `insert-for-yank' now supports strings where the
3896 `yank-handler' property does not span the first character of the
3897 string. The old behavior is available if you call
3898 `insert-for-yank-1' instead.
3899
3900 ** Syntax table changes:
3901
3902 +++
3903 *** The macro `with-syntax-table' no longer copies the syntax table.
3904
3905 +++
3906 *** The new function `syntax-after' returns the syntax code
3907 of the character after a specified buffer position, taking account
3908 of text properties as well as the character code.
3909
3910 +++
3911 *** `syntax-class' extracts the class of a syntax code (as returned
3912 by `syntax-after').
3913
3914 +++
3915 *** The new function `syntax-ppss' rovides an efficient way to find the
3916 current syntactic context at point.
3917
3918 ** File operation changes:
3919
3920 +++
3921 *** New vars `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' used when
3922 searching for an executable or an Emacs Lisp file.
3923
3924 +++
3925 *** The new primitive `set-file-times' sets a file's access and
3926 modification times. Magic file name handlers can handle this
3927 operation.
3928
3929 +++
3930 *** The new function `file-remote-p' tests a file name and returns
3931 non-nil if it specifies a remote file (one that Emacs accesses using
3932 its own special methods and not directly through the file system).
3933 The value in that case is an identifier for the remote file system.
3934
3935 +++
3936 *** `buffer-auto-save-file-format' is the new name for what was
3937 formerly called `auto-save-file-format'. It is now a permanent local.
3938
3939 +++
3940 *** Functions `file-name-sans-extension' and `file-name-extension' now
3941 ignore the leading dots in file names, so that file names such as
3942 `.emacs' are treated as extensionless.
3943
3944 +++
3945 *** `copy-file' now takes an additional option arg MUSTBENEW.
3946
3947 This argument works like the MUSTBENEW argument of write-file.
3948
3949 +++
3950 *** `visited-file-modtime' and `calendar-time-from-absolute' now return
3951 a list of two integers, instead of a cons.
3952
3953 +++
3954 *** `file-chase-links' now takes an optional second argument LIMIT which
3955 specifies the maximum number of links to chase through. If after that
3956 many iterations the file name obtained is still a symbolic link,
3957 `file-chase-links' returns it anyway.
3958
3959 +++
3960 *** The new hook `before-save-hook' is invoked by `basic-save-buffer'
3961 before saving buffers. This allows packages to perform various final
3962 tasks, for example; it can be used by the copyright package to make
3963 sure saved files have the current year in any copyright headers.
3964
3965 +++
3966 *** If `buffer-save-without-query' is non-nil in some buffer,
3967 `save-some-buffers' will always save that buffer without asking (if
3968 it's modified).
3969
3970 +++
3971 *** New function `locate-file' searches for a file in a list of directories.
3972 `locate-file' accepts a name of a file to search (a string), and two
3973 lists: a list of directories to search in and a list of suffixes to
3974 try; typical usage might use `exec-path' and `load-path' for the list
3975 of directories, and `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' for the list
3976 of suffixes. The function also accepts a predicate argument to
3977 further filter candidate files.
3978
3979 One advantage of using this function is that the list of suffixes in
3980 `exec-suffixes' is OS-dependant, so this function will find
3981 executables without polluting Lisp code with OS dependancies.
3982
3983 ---
3984 *** The precedence of file name handlers has been changed.
3985
3986 Instead of choosing the first handler that matches,
3987 `find-file-name-handler' now gives precedence to a file name handler
3988 that matches nearest the end of the file name. More precisely, the
3989 handler whose (match-beginning 0) is the largest is chosen. In case
3990 of ties, the old "first matched" rule applies.
3991
3992 +++
3993 *** A file name handler can declare which operations it handles.
3994
3995 You do this by putting an `operation' property on the handler name
3996 symbol. The property value should be a list of the operations that
3997 the handler really handles. It won't be called for any other
3998 operations.
3999
4000 This is useful for autoloaded handlers, to prevent them from being
4001 autoloaded when not really necessary.
4002
4003 +++
4004 *** The function `make-auto-save-file-name' is now handled by file
4005 name handlers. This will be exploited for remote files mainly.
4006
4007 ** Input changes:
4008
4009 +++
4010 *** An interactive specification can now use the code letter 'U' to get
4011 the up-event that was discarded in case the last key sequence read for a
4012 previous `k' or `K' argument was a down-event; otherwise nil is used.
4013
4014 +++
4015 *** The new interactive-specification `G' reads a file name
4016 much like `F', but if the input is a directory name (even defaulted),
4017 it returns just the directory name.
4018
4019 ---
4020 *** Functions `y-or-n-p', `read-char', `read-key-sequence' and the like, that
4021 display a prompt but don't use the minibuffer, now display the prompt
4022 using the text properties (esp. the face) of the prompt string.
4023
4024 +++
4025 *** (while-no-input BODY...) runs BODY, but only so long as no input
4026 arrives. If the user types or clicks anything, BODY stops as if a
4027 quit had occurred. `while-no-input' returns the value of BODY, if BODY
4028 finishes. It returns nil if BODY was aborted by a quit, and t if
4029 BODY was aborted by arrival of input.
4030
4031 ** Minibuffer changes:
4032
4033 +++
4034 *** The new function `minibufferp' returns non-nil if its optional
4035 buffer argument is a minibuffer. If the argument is omitted, it
4036 defaults to the current buffer.
4037
4038 +++
4039 *** New function `minibuffer-selected-window' returns the window which
4040 was selected when entering the minibuffer.
4041
4042 +++
4043 *** `read-from-minibuffer' now accepts an additional argument KEEP-ALL
4044 saying to put all inputs in the history list, even empty ones.
4045
4046 +++
4047 *** The `read-file-name' function now takes an additional argument which
4048 specifies a predicate which the file name read must satify. The
4049 new variable `read-file-name-predicate' contains the predicate argument
4050 while reading the file name from the minibuffer; the predicate in this
4051 variable is used by read-file-name-internal to filter the completion list.
4052
4053 ---
4054 *** The new variable `read-file-name-function' can be used by Lisp code
4055 to override the built-in `read-file-name' function.
4056
4057 +++
4058 *** The new variable `read-file-name-completion-ignore-case' specifies
4059 whether completion ignores case when reading a file name with the
4060 `read-file-name' function.
4061
4062 +++
4063 *** The new function `read-directory-name' for reading a directory name.
4064
4065 It is like `read-file-name' except that the defaulting works better
4066 for directories, and completion inside it shows only directories.
4067
4068 ** Completion changes:
4069
4070 +++
4071 *** The functions `all-completions' and `try-completion' now accept lists
4072 of strings as well as hash-tables additionally to alists, obarrays
4073 and functions. Furthermore, the function `test-completion' is now
4074 exported to Lisp. The keys in alists and hash tables can be either
4075 strings or symbols, which are automatically converted with to strings.
4076
4077 +++
4078 *** The new macro `dynamic-completion-table' supports using functions
4079 as a dynamic completion table.
4080
4081 (dynamic-completion-table FUN)
4082
4083 FUN is called with one argument, the string for which completion is required,
4084 and it should return an alist containing all the intended possible
4085 completions. This alist can be a full list of possible completions so that FUN
4086 can ignore the value of its argument. If completion is performed in the
4087 minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer from which the minibuffer was
4088 entered. `dynamic-completion-table' then computes the completion.
4089
4090 +++
4091 *** The new macro `lazy-completion-table' initializes a variable
4092 as a lazy completion table.
4093
4094 (lazy-completion-table VAR FUN &rest ARGS)
4095
4096 If the completion table VAR is used for the first time (e.g., by passing VAR
4097 as an argument to `try-completion'), the function FUN is called with arguments
4098 ARGS. FUN must return the completion table that will be stored in VAR. If
4099 completion is requested in the minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer
4100 from which the minibuffer was entered. The return value of
4101 `lazy-completion-table' must be used to initialize the value of VAR.
4102
4103 +++
4104 ** Enhancements to keymaps.
4105
4106 *** Cleaner way to enter key sequences.
4107
4108 You can enter a constant key sequence in a more natural format, the
4109 same one used for saving keyboard macros, using the macro `kbd'. For
4110 example,
4111
4112 (kbd "C-x C-f") => "\^x\^f"
4113
4114 *** Interactive commands can be remapped through keymaps.
4115
4116 This is an alternative to using `defadvice' or `substitute-key-definition'
4117 to modify the behavior of a key binding using the normal keymap
4118 binding and lookup functionality.
4119
4120 When a key sequence is bound to a command, and that command is
4121 remapped to another command, that command is run instead of the
4122 original command.
4123
4124 Example:
4125 Suppose that minor mode `my-mode' has defined the commands
4126 `my-kill-line' and `my-kill-word', and it wants C-k (and any other key
4127 bound to `kill-line') to run the command `my-kill-line' instead of
4128 `kill-line', and likewise it wants to run `my-kill-word' instead of
4129 `kill-word'.
4130
4131 Instead of rebinding C-k and the other keys in the minor mode map,
4132 command remapping allows you to directly map `kill-line' into
4133 `my-kill-line' and `kill-word' into `my-kill-word' using `define-key':
4134
4135 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-line] 'my-kill-line)
4136 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-word] 'my-kill-word)
4137
4138 When `my-mode' is enabled, its minor mode keymap is enabled too. So
4139 when the user types C-k, that runs the command `my-kill-line'.
4140
4141 Only one level of remapping is supported. In the above example, this
4142 means that if `my-kill-line' is remapped to `other-kill', then C-k still
4143 runs `my-kill-line'.
4144
4145 The following changes have been made to provide command remapping:
4146
4147 - Command remappings are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
4148 `remap', i.e. `(define-key MAP [remap CMD] DEF)' remaps command CMD
4149 to definition DEF in keymap MAP. The definition is not limited to
4150 another command; it can be anything accepted for a normal binding.
4151
4152 - The new function `command-remapping' returns the binding for a
4153 remapped command in the current keymaps, or nil if not remapped.
4154
4155 - `key-binding' now remaps interactive commands unless the optional
4156 third argument NO-REMAP is non-nil.
4157
4158 - `where-is-internal' now returns nil for a remapped command (e.g.
4159 `kill-line', when `my-mode' is enabled), and the actual key binding for
4160 the command it is remapped to (e.g. C-k for my-kill-line).
4161 It also has a new optional fifth argument, NO-REMAP, which inhibits
4162 remapping if non-nil (e.g. it returns "C-k" for `kill-line', and
4163 "<kill-line>" for `my-kill-line').
4164
4165 - The new variable `this-original-command' contains the original
4166 command before remapping. It is equal to `this-command' when the
4167 command was not remapped.
4168
4169 *** If text has a `keymap' property, that keymap takes precedence
4170 over minor mode keymaps.
4171
4172 *** The `keymap' property now also works at the ends of overlays and
4173 text properties, according to their stickiness. This also means that it
4174 works with empty overlays. The same hold for the `local-map' property.
4175
4176 *** Dense keymaps now handle inheritance correctly.
4177
4178 Previously a dense keymap would hide all of the simple-char key
4179 bindings of the parent keymap.
4180
4181 *** `define-key-after' now accepts keys longer than 1.
4182
4183 *** New function `current-active-maps' returns a list of currently
4184 active keymaps.
4185
4186 *** New function `describe-buffer-bindings' inserts the list of all
4187 defined keys and their definitions.
4188
4189 *** New function `keymap-prompt' returns the prompt string of a keymap.
4190
4191 *** (map-keymap FUNCTION KEYMAP) applies the function to each binding
4192 in the keymap.
4193
4194 *** New variable `emulation-mode-map-alists'.
4195
4196 Lisp packages using many minor mode keymaps can now maintain their own
4197 keymap alist separate from `minor-mode-map-alist' by adding their
4198 keymap alist to this list.
4199
4200 ** Abbrev changes:
4201
4202 +++
4203 *** The new function `copy-abbrev-table' copies an abbrev table.
4204
4205 It returns a new abbrev table that is a copy of a given abbrev table.
4206
4207 +++
4208 *** `define-abbrev' now accepts an optional argument SYSTEM-FLAG.
4209
4210 If non-nil, this marks the abbrev as a "system" abbrev, which means
4211 that it won't be stored in the user's abbrevs file if he saves the
4212 abbrevs. Major modes that predefine some abbrevs should always
4213 specify this flag.
4214
4215 +++
4216 ** Enhancements to process support
4217
4218 *** Function `list-processes' now has an optional argument; if non-nil,
4219 it lists only the processes whose query-on-exit flag is set.
4220
4221 *** New fns `set-process-query-on-exit-flag' and `process-query-on-exit-flag'.
4222
4223 These replace the old function `process-kill-without-query'. That
4224 function is still supported, but new code should use the new
4225 functions.
4226
4227 *** Function `signal-process' now accepts a process object or process
4228 name in addition to a process id to identify the signaled process.
4229
4230 *** Processes now have an associated property list where programs can
4231 maintain process state and other per-process related information.
4232
4233 Use the new functions `process-get' and `process-put' to access, add,
4234 and modify elements on this property list. Use the new functions
4235 `process-plist' and `set-process-plist' to access and replace the
4236 entire property list of a process.
4237
4238 *** Function `accept-process-output' has a new optional fourth arg
4239 JUST-THIS-ONE. If non-nil, only output from the specified process
4240 is handled, suspending output from other processes. If value is an
4241 integer, also inhibit running timers. This feature is generally not
4242 recommended, but may be necessary for specific applications, such as
4243 speech synthesis.
4244
4245 *** Adaptive read buffering of subprocess output.
4246
4247 On some systems, when emacs reads the output from a subprocess, the
4248 output data is read in very small blocks, potentially resulting in
4249 very poor performance. This behavior can be remedied to some extent
4250 by setting the new variable `process-adaptive-read-buffering' to a
4251 non-nil value (the default), as it will automatically delay reading
4252 from such processes, to allowing them to produce more output before
4253 emacs tries to read it.
4254
4255 *** The new function `call-process-shell-command'.
4256
4257 This executes a shell command synchronously in a separate process.
4258
4259 *** The new function `process-file' is similar to `call-process', but
4260 obeys file handlers. The file handler is chosen based on
4261 `default-directory'.
4262
4263 *** A process filter function gets the output as multibyte string
4264 if the process specifies t for its filter's multibyteness.
4265
4266 That multibyteness is decided by the value of
4267 `default-enable-multibyte-characters' when the process is created, and
4268 you can change it later with `set-process-filter-multibyte'.
4269
4270 *** The new function `set-process-filter-multibyte' sets the
4271 multibyteness of the strings passed to the process's filter.
4272
4273 *** The new function `process-filter-multibyte-p' returns the
4274 multibyteness of the strings passed to the process's filter.
4275
4276 *** If a process's coding system is `raw-text' or `no-conversion' and its
4277 buffer is multibyte, the output of the process is at first converted
4278 to multibyte by `string-to-multibyte' then inserted in the buffer.
4279 Previously, it was converted to multibyte by `string-as-multibyte',
4280 which was not compatible with the behavior of file reading.
4281
4282 +++
4283 ** Enhanced networking support.
4284
4285 *** The new `make-network-process' function makes network connections.
4286 It allows opening of stream and datagram connections to a server, as well as
4287 create a stream or datagram server inside emacs.
4288
4289 - A server is started using :server t arg.
4290 - Datagram connection is selected using :type 'datagram arg.
4291 - A server can open on a random port using :service t arg.
4292 - Local sockets are supported using :family 'local arg.
4293 - Non-blocking connect is supported using :nowait t arg.
4294 - The process' property list can be initialized using :plist PLIST arg;
4295 a copy of the server process' property list is automatically inherited
4296 by new client processes created to handle incoming connections.
4297
4298 To test for the availability of a given feature, use featurep like this:
4299 (featurep 'make-network-process '(:type datagram))
4300
4301 *** The old `open-network-stream' now uses `make-network-process'.
4302
4303 *** New functions `process-datagram-address', `set-process-datagram-address'.
4304
4305 These functions are used with datagram-based network processes to get
4306 and set the current address of the remote partner.
4307
4308 *** New function `format-network-address'.
4309
4310 This function reformats the Lisp representation of a network address
4311 to a printable string. For example, an IP address A.B.C.D and port
4312 number P is represented as a five element vector [A B C D P], and the
4313 printable string returned for this vector is "A.B.C.D:P". See the doc
4314 string for other formatting options.
4315
4316 *** `process-contact' has an optional KEY argument.
4317
4318 Depending on this argument, you can get the complete list of network
4319 process properties or a specific property. Using :local or :remote as
4320 the KEY, you get the address of the local or remote end-point.
4321
4322 An Inet address is represented as a 5 element vector, where the first
4323 4 elements contain the IP address and the fifth is the port number.
4324
4325 *** New functions `stop-process' and `continue-process'.
4326
4327 These functions stop and restart communication through a network
4328 connection. For a server process, no connections are accepted in the
4329 stopped state. For a client process, no input is received in the
4330 stopped state.
4331
4332 *** New function `network-interface-list'.
4333
4334 This function returns a list of network interface names and their
4335 current network addresses.
4336
4337 *** New function `network-interface-info'.
4338
4339 This function returns the network address, hardware address, current
4340 status, and other information about a specific network interface.
4341
4342 *** Deleting a network process with `delete-process' calls the sentinel.
4343
4344 The status message passed to the sentinel for a deleted network
4345 process is "deleted". The message passed to the sentinel when the
4346 connection is closed by the remote peer has been changed to
4347 "connection broken by remote peer".
4348
4349 ** Using window objects:
4350
4351 +++
4352 *** New function `window-body-height'.
4353
4354 This is like `window-height' but does not count the mode line or the
4355 header line.
4356
4357 +++
4358 *** New function `window-body-height'.
4359
4360 This is like `window-height' but does not count the mode line
4361 or the header line.
4362
4363 +++
4364 *** You can now make a window as short as one line.
4365
4366 A window that is just one line tall does not display either a mode
4367 line or a header line, even if the variables `mode-line-format' and
4368 `header-line-format' call for them. A window that is two lines tall
4369 cannot display both a mode line and a header line at once; if the
4370 variables call for both, only the mode line actually appears.
4371
4372 +++
4373 *** The new function `window-inside-edges' returns the edges of the
4374 actual text portion of the window, not including the scroll bar or
4375 divider line, the fringes, the display margins, the header line and
4376 the mode line.
4377
4378 +++
4379 *** The new functions `window-pixel-edges' and `window-inside-pixel-edges'
4380 return window edges in units of pixels, rather than columns and lines.
4381
4382 +++
4383 *** The new macro `with-selected-window' temporarily switches the
4384 selected window without impacting the order of `buffer-list'.
4385 It saves and restores the current buffer, too.
4386
4387 +++
4388 *** `select-window' takes an optional second argument NORECORD.
4389
4390 This is like `switch-to-buffer'.
4391
4392 +++
4393 *** `save-selected-window' now saves and restores the selected window
4394 of every frame. This way, it restores everything that can be changed
4395 by calling `select-window'. It also saves and restores the current
4396 buffer.
4397
4398 +++
4399 *** `set-window-buffer' has an optional argument KEEP-MARGINS.
4400
4401 If non-nil, that says to preserve the window's current margin, fringe,
4402 and scroll-bar settings.
4403
4404 +++
4405 *** The new function `window-tree' returns a frame's window tree.
4406
4407 +++
4408 ** Customizable fringe bitmaps
4409
4410 *** New function `define-fringe-bitmap' can now be used to create new
4411 fringe bitmaps, as well as change the built-in fringe bitmaps.
4412
4413 To change a built-in bitmap, do (require 'fringe) and use the symbol
4414 identifing the bitmap such as `left-truncation or `continued-line'.
4415
4416 *** New function `destroy-fringe-bitmap' deletes a fringe bitmap
4417 or restores a built-in one to its default value.
4418
4419 *** New function `set-fringe-bitmap-face' specifies the face to be
4420 used for a specific fringe bitmap. The face is automatically merged
4421 with the `fringe' face, so normally, the face should only specify the
4422 foreground color of the bitmap.
4423
4424 *** There are new display properties, `left-fringe' and `right-fringe',
4425 that can be used to show a specific bitmap in the left or right fringe
4426 bitmap of the display line.
4427
4428 Format is `display (left-fringe BITMAP [FACE])', where BITMAP is a
4429 symbol identifying a fringe bitmap, either built-in or defined with
4430 `define-fringe-bitmap', and FACE is an optional face name to be used
4431 for displaying the bitmap instead of the default `fringe' face.
4432 When specified, FACE is automatically merged with the `fringe' face.
4433
4434 *** New function `fringe-bitmaps-at-pos' returns the current fringe
4435 bitmaps in the display line at a given buffer position.
4436
4437 ** Other window fringe features:
4438
4439 +++
4440 *** Controlling the default left and right fringe widths.
4441
4442 The default left and right fringe widths for all windows of a frame
4443 can now be controlled by setting the `left-fringe' and `right-fringe'
4444 frame parameters to an integer value specifying the width in pixels.
4445 Setting the width to 0 effectively removes the corresponding fringe.
4446
4447 The actual default fringe widths for the frame may deviate from the
4448 specified widths, since the combined fringe widths must match an
4449 integral number of columns. The extra width is distributed evenly
4450 between the left and right fringe. For force a specific fringe width,
4451 specify the width as a negative integer (if both widths are negative,
4452 only the left fringe gets the specified width).
4453
4454 Setting the width to nil (the default), restores the default fringe
4455 width which is the minimum number of pixels necessary to display any
4456 of the currently defined fringe bitmaps. The width of the built-in
4457 fringe bitmaps is 8 pixels.
4458
4459 +++
4460 *** Per-window fringe and scrollbar settings
4461
4462 **** Windows can now have their own individual fringe widths and
4463 position settings.
4464
4465 To control the fringe widths of a window, either set the buffer-local
4466 variables `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', or call
4467 `set-window-fringes'.
4468
4469 To control the fringe position in a window, that is, whether fringes
4470 are positioned between the display margins and the window's text area,
4471 or at the edges of the window, either set the buffer-local variable
4472 `fringes-outside-margins' or call `set-window-fringes'.
4473
4474 The function `window-fringes' can be used to obtain the current
4475 settings. To make `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', and
4476 `fringes-outside-margins' take effect, you must set them before
4477 displaying the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force
4478 an update of the display margins.
4479
4480 **** Windows can now have their own individual scroll-bar settings
4481 controlling the width and position of scroll-bars.
4482
4483 To control the scroll-bar of a window, either set the buffer-local
4484 variables `scroll-bar-mode' and `scroll-bar-width', or call
4485 `set-window-scroll-bars'. The function `window-scroll-bars' can be
4486 used to obtain the current settings. To make `scroll-bar-mode' and
4487 `scroll-bar-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
4488 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
4489 of the display margins.
4490
4491 ** Redisplay features:
4492
4493 +++
4494 *** `sit-for' can now be called with args (SECONDS &optional NODISP).
4495
4496 +++
4497 *** New function `force-window-update' can initiate a full redisplay of
4498 one or all windows. Normally, this is not needed as changes in window
4499 contents are detected automatically. However, certain implicit
4500 changes to mode lines, header lines, or display properties may require
4501 forcing an explicit window update.
4502
4503 +++
4504 *** (char-displayable-p CHAR) returns non-nil if Emacs ought to be able
4505 to display CHAR. More precisely, if the selected frame's fontset has
4506 a font to display the character set that CHAR belongs to.
4507
4508 Fontsets can specify a font on a per-character basis; when the fontset
4509 does that, this value cannot be accurate.
4510
4511 +++
4512 *** You can define multiple overlay arrows via the new
4513 variable `overlay-arrow-variable-list'.
4514
4515 It contains a list of varibles which contain overlay arrow position
4516 markers, including the original `overlay-arrow-position' variable.
4517
4518 Each variable on this list can have individual `overlay-arrow-string'
4519 and `overlay-arrow-bitmap' properties that specify an overlay arrow
4520 string (for non-window terminals) or fringe bitmap (for window
4521 systems) to display at the corresponding overlay arrow position.
4522 If either property is not set, the default `overlay-arrow-string' or
4523 'overlay-arrow-fringe-bitmap' will be used.
4524
4525 +++
4526 *** New `line-height' and `line-spacing' properties for newline characters
4527
4528 A newline can now have `line-height' and `line-spacing' text or overlay
4529 properties that control the height of the corresponding display row.
4530
4531 If the `line-height' property value is t, the newline does not
4532 contribute to the height of the display row; instead the height of the
4533 newline glyph is reduced. Also, a `line-spacing' property on this
4534 newline is ignored. This can be used to tile small images or image
4535 slices without adding blank areas between the images.
4536
4537 If the `line-height' property value is a positive integer, the value
4538 specifies the minimum line height in pixels. If necessary, the line
4539 height it increased by increasing the line's ascent.
4540
4541 If the `line-height' property value is a float, the minimum line
4542 height is calculated by multiplying the default frame line height by
4543 the given value.
4544
4545 If the `line-height' property value is a cons (FACE . RATIO), the
4546 minimum line height is calculated as RATIO * height of named FACE.
4547 RATIO is int or float. If FACE is t, it specifies the current face.
4548
4549 If the `line-height' property value is a cons (nil . RATIO), the line
4550 height is calculated as RATIO * actual height of the line's contents.
4551
4552 If the `line-height' value is a cons (HEIGHT . TOTAL), HEIGHT specifies
4553 the line height as described above, while TOTAL is any of the forms
4554 described above and specifies the total height of the line, causing a
4555 varying number of pixels to be inserted after the line to make it line
4556 exactly that many pixels high.
4557
4558 If the `line-spacing' property value is an positive integer, the value
4559 is used as additional pixels to insert after the display line; this
4560 overrides the default frame `line-spacing' and any buffer local value of
4561 the `line-spacing' variable.
4562
4563 If the `line-spacing' property is a float or cons, the line spacing
4564 is calculated as specified above for the `line-height' property.
4565
4566 +++
4567 *** The buffer local `line-spacing' variable can now have a float value,
4568 which is used as a height relative to the default frame line height.
4569
4570 +++
4571 *** Enhancements to stretch display properties
4572
4573 The display property stretch specification form `(space PROPS)', where
4574 PROPS is a property list now allows pixel based width and height
4575 specifications, as well as enhanced horizontal text alignment.
4576
4577 The value of these properties can now be a (primitive) expression
4578 which is evaluated during redisplay. The following expressions
4579 are supported:
4580
4581 EXPR ::= NUM | (NUM) | UNIT | ELEM | POS | IMAGE | FORM
4582 NUM ::= INTEGER | FLOAT | SYMBOL
4583 UNIT ::= in | mm | cm | width | height
4584 ELEM ::= left-fringe | right-fringe | left-margin | right-margin
4585 | scroll-bar | text
4586 POS ::= left | center | right
4587 FORM ::= (NUM . EXPR) | (OP EXPR ...)
4588 OP ::= + | -
4589
4590 The form `NUM' specifies a fractional width or height of the default
4591 frame font size. The form `(NUM)' specifies an absolute number of
4592 pixels. If a symbol is specified, its buffer-local variable binding
4593 is used. The `in', `mm', and `cm' units specifies the number of
4594 pixels per inch, milli-meter, and centi-meter, resp. The `width' and
4595 `height' units correspond to the width and height of the current face
4596 font. An image specification corresponds to the width or height of
4597 the image.
4598
4599 The `left-fringe', `right-fringe', `left-margin', `right-margin',
4600 `scroll-bar', and `text' elements specify to the width of the
4601 corresponding area of the window.
4602
4603 The `left', `center', and `right' positions can be used with :align-to
4604 to specify a position relative to the left edge, center, or right edge
4605 of the text area. One of the above window elements (except `text')
4606 can also be used with :align-to to specify that the position is
4607 relative to the left edge of the given area. Once the base offset for
4608 a relative position has been set (by the first occurrence of one of
4609 these symbols), further occurences of these symbols are interpreted as
4610 the width of the area.
4611
4612 For example, to align to the center of the left-margin, use
4613 :align-to (+ left-margin (0.5 . left-margin))
4614
4615 If no specific base offset is set for alignment, it is always relative
4616 to the left edge of the text area. For example, :align-to 0 in a
4617 header line aligns with the first text column in the text area.
4618
4619 The value of the form `(NUM . EXPR)' is the value of NUM multiplied by
4620 the value of the expression EXPR. For example, (2 . in) specifies a
4621 width of 2 inches, while (0.5 . IMAGE) specifies half the width (or
4622 height) of the specified image.
4623
4624 The form `(+ EXPR ...)' adds up the value of the expressions.
4625 The form `(- EXPR ...)' negates or subtracts the value of the expressions.
4626
4627 +++
4628 *** Normally, the cursor is displayed at the end of any overlay and
4629 text property string that may be present at the current window
4630 position. The cursor can now be placed on any character of such
4631 strings by giving that character a non-nil `cursor' text property.
4632
4633 +++
4634 *** The display space :width and :align-to text properties are now
4635 supported on text terminals.
4636
4637 +++
4638 *** Support for displaying image slices
4639
4640 **** New display property (slice X Y WIDTH HEIGHT) can be used with
4641 an image property to display only a specific slice of the image.
4642
4643 **** Function `insert-image' has new optional fourth arg to
4644 specify image slice (X Y WIDTH HEIGHT).
4645
4646 **** New function `insert-sliced-image' inserts a given image as a
4647 specified number of evenly sized slices (rows x columns).
4648
4649 +++
4650 *** Images can now have an associated image map via the :map property.
4651
4652 An image map is an alist where each element has the format (AREA ID PLIST).
4653 An AREA is specified as either a rectangle, a circle, or a polygon:
4654 A rectangle is a cons (rect . ((X0 . Y0) . (X1 . Y1))) specifying the
4655 pixel coordinates of the upper left and bottom right corners.
4656 A circle is a cons (circle . ((X0 . Y0) . R)) specifying the center
4657 and the radius of the circle; R can be a float or integer.
4658 A polygon is a cons (poly . [X0 Y0 X1 Y1 ...]) where each pair in the
4659 vector describes one corner in the polygon.
4660
4661 When the mouse pointer is above a hot-spot area of an image, the
4662 PLIST of that hot-spot is consulted; if it contains a `help-echo'
4663 property it defines a tool-tip for the hot-spot, and if it contains
4664 a `pointer' property, it defines the shape of the mouse cursor when
4665 it is over the hot-spot. See the variable `void-area-text-pointer'
4666 for possible pointer shapes.
4667
4668 When you click the mouse when the mouse pointer is over a hot-spot,
4669 an event is composed by combining the ID of the hot-spot with the
4670 mouse event, e.g. [area4 mouse-1] if the hot-spot's ID is `area4'.
4671
4672 +++
4673 *** The function `find-image' now searches in etc/images/ and etc/.
4674 The new variable `image-load-path' is a list of locations in which to
4675 search for image files. The default is to search in etc/images, then
4676 in etc/, and finally in the directories specified by `load-path'.
4677 Subdirectories of etc/ and etc/images are not recursively searched; if
4678 you put an image file in a subdirectory, you have to specify it
4679 explicitly; for example, if an image is put in etc/images/foo/bar.xpm:
4680
4681 (defimage foo-image '((:type xpm :file "foo/bar.xpm")))
4682
4683 ** Mouse pointer features:
4684
4685 +++ (lispref)
4686 ??? (man)
4687 *** The mouse pointer shape in void text areas (i.e. after the end of a
4688 line or below the last line in the buffer) of the text window is now
4689 controlled by the new variable `void-text-area-pointer'. The default
4690 is to use the `arrow' (non-text) pointer. Other choices are `text'
4691 (or nil), `hand', `vdrag', `hdrag', `modeline', and `hourglass'.
4692
4693 +++
4694 *** The mouse pointer shape over an image can now be controlled by the
4695 :pointer image property.
4696
4697 +++
4698 *** The mouse pointer shape over ordinary text or images can now be
4699 controlled/overriden via the `pointer' text property.
4700
4701 ** Mouse event enhancements:
4702
4703 +++
4704 *** Mouse events for clicks on window fringes now specify `left-fringe'
4705 or `right-fringe' as the area.
4706
4707 +++
4708 *** All mouse events now include a buffer position regardless of where
4709 you clicked. For mouse clicks in window margins and fringes, this is
4710 a sensible buffer position corresponding to the surrounding text.
4711
4712 +++
4713 *** `posn-point' now returns buffer position for non-text area events.
4714
4715 +++
4716 *** Function `mouse-set-point' now works for events outside text area.
4717
4718 +++
4719 *** New function `posn-area' returns window area clicked on (nil means
4720 text area).
4721
4722 +++
4723 *** Mouse events include actual glyph column and row for all event types
4724 and all areas.
4725
4726 +++
4727 *** New function `posn-actual-col-row' returns the actual glyph coordinates
4728 of the mouse event position.
4729
4730 +++
4731 *** Mouse events can now indicate an image object clicked on.
4732
4733 +++
4734 *** Mouse events include relative X and Y pixel coordinates relative to
4735 the top left corner of the object (image or character) clicked on.
4736
4737 +++
4738 *** Mouse events include the pixel width and height of the object
4739 (image or character) clicked on.
4740
4741 +++
4742 *** New functions 'posn-object', 'posn-object-x-y', 'posn-object-width-height'.
4743
4744 These return the image or string object of a mouse click, the X and Y
4745 pixel coordinates relative to the top left corner of that object, and
4746 the total width and height of that object.
4747
4748 ** Text property and overlay changes:
4749
4750 +++
4751 *** Arguments for `remove-overlays' are now optional, so that you can
4752 remove all overlays in the buffer with just (remove-overlays).
4753
4754 +++
4755 *** New variable `char-property-alias-alist'.
4756
4757 This variable allows you to create alternative names for text
4758 properties. It works at the same level as `default-text-properties',
4759 although it applies to overlays as well. This variable was introduced
4760 to implement the `font-lock-face' property.
4761
4762 +++
4763 *** New function `get-char-property-and-overlay' accepts the same
4764 arguments as `get-char-property' and returns a cons whose car is the
4765 return value of `get-char-property' called with those arguments and
4766 whose cdr is the overlay in which the property was found, or nil if
4767 it was found as a text property or not found at all.
4768
4769 +++
4770 *** The new function `remove-list-of-text-properties'.
4771
4772 It is like `remove-text-properties' except that it takes a list of
4773 property names as argument rather than a property list.
4774
4775 ** Face changes
4776
4777 +++
4778 *** The new face attribute condition `min-colors' can be used to tailor
4779 the face color to the number of colors supported by a display, and
4780 define the foreground and background colors accordingly so that they
4781 look best on a terminal that supports at least this many colors. This
4782 is now the preferred method for defining default faces in a way that
4783 makes a good use of the capabilities of the display.
4784
4785 +++
4786 *** New function `display-supports-face-attributes-p' can be used to test
4787 whether a given set of face attributes is actually displayable.
4788
4789 A new predicate `supports' has also been added to the `defface' face
4790 specification language, which can be used to do this test for faces
4791 defined with `defface'.
4792
4793 ---
4794 *** The special treatment of faces whose names are of the form `fg:COLOR'
4795 or `bg:COLOR' has been removed. Lisp programs should use the
4796 `defface' facility for defining faces with specific colors, or use
4797 the feature of specifying the face attributes :foreground and :background
4798 directly in the `face' property instead of using a named face.
4799
4800 +++
4801 *** The first face specification element in a defface can specify
4802 `default' instead of frame classification. Then its attributes act as
4803 defaults that apply to all the subsequent cases (and can be overridden
4804 by them).
4805
4806 +++
4807 *** The variable `face-font-rescale-alist' specifies how much larger
4808 (or smaller) font we should use. For instance, if the value is
4809 '((SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN . 1.3)) and a face requests a font of 10
4810 point, we actually use a font of 13 point if the font matches
4811 SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN.
4812
4813 ---
4814 *** The function `face-differs-from-default-p' now truly checks
4815 whether the given face displays differently from the default face or
4816 not (previously it did only a very cursory check).
4817
4818 +++
4819 *** `face-attribute', `face-foreground', `face-background', `face-stipple'.
4820
4821 These now accept a new optional argument, INHERIT, which controls how
4822 face inheritance is used when determining the value of a face
4823 attribute.
4824
4825 +++
4826 *** New functions `face-attribute-relative-p' and `merge-face-attribute'
4827 help with handling relative face attributes.
4828
4829 +++
4830 *** The priority of faces in an :inherit attribute face list is reversed.
4831
4832 If a face contains an :inherit attribute with a list of faces, earlier
4833 faces in the list override later faces in the list; in previous
4834 releases of Emacs, the order was the opposite. This change was made
4835 so that :inherit face lists operate identically to face lists in text
4836 `face' properties.
4837
4838 ---
4839 *** On terminals, faces with the :inverse-video attribute are displayed
4840 with swapped foreground and background colors even when one of them is
4841 not specified. In previous releases of Emacs, if either foreground
4842 or background color was unspecified, colors were not swapped. This
4843 was inconsistent with the face behavior under X.
4844
4845 ---
4846 *** `set-fontset-font', `fontset-info', `fontset-font' now operate on
4847 the default fontset if the argument NAME is nil..
4848
4849 ** Font-Lock changes:
4850
4851 +++
4852 *** New special text property `font-lock-face'.
4853
4854 This property acts like the `face' property, but it is controlled by
4855 M-x font-lock-mode. It is not, strictly speaking, a builtin text
4856 property. Instead, it is implemented inside font-core.el, using the
4857 new variable `char-property-alias-alist'.
4858
4859 +++
4860 *** font-lock can manage arbitrary text-properties beside `face'.
4861
4862 **** the FACENAME returned in `font-lock-keywords' can be a list of the
4863 form (face FACE PROP1 VAL1 PROP2 VAL2 ...) so you can set other
4864 properties than `face'.
4865
4866 **** `font-lock-extra-managed-props' can be set to make sure those
4867 extra properties are automatically cleaned up by font-lock.
4868
4869 ---
4870 *** jit-lock obeys a new text-property `jit-lock-defer-multiline'.
4871
4872 If a piece of text with that property gets contextually refontified
4873 (see `jit-lock-defer-contextually'), then all of that text will
4874 be refontified. This is useful when the syntax of a textual element
4875 depends on text several lines further down (and when `font-lock-multiline'
4876 is not appropriate to solve that problem). For example in Perl:
4877
4878 s{
4879 foo
4880 }{
4881 bar
4882 }e
4883
4884 Adding/removing the last `e' changes the `bar' from being a piece of
4885 text to being a piece of code, so you'd put a `jit-lock-defer-multiline'
4886 property over the second half of the command to force (deferred)
4887 refontification of `bar' whenever the `e' is added/removed.
4888
4889 ** Major mode mechanism changes:
4890
4891 +++
4892 *** `set-auto-mode' now gives the interpreter magic line (if present)
4893 precedence over the file name. Likewise an `<?xml' or `<!DOCTYPE'
4894 declaration will give the buffer XML or SGML mode, based on the new
4895 var `magic-mode-alist'.
4896
4897 +++
4898 *** Use the new function `run-mode-hooks' to run the major mode's mode hook.
4899
4900 +++
4901 *** All major mode functions should now run the new normal hook
4902 `after-change-major-mode-hook', at their very end, after the mode
4903 hooks. `run-mode-hooks' does this automatically.
4904
4905 ---
4906 *** If a major mode function has a non-nil `no-clone-indirect'
4907 property, `clone-indirect-buffer' signals an error if you use
4908 it in that buffer.
4909
4910 +++
4911 *** Major modes can define `eldoc-documentation-function'
4912 locally to provide Eldoc functionality by some method appropriate to
4913 the language.
4914
4915 +++
4916 *** `define-derived-mode' by default creates a new empty abbrev table.
4917 It does not copy abbrevs from the parent mode's abbrev table.
4918
4919 +++
4920 *** The new function `run-mode-hooks' and the new macro `delay-mode-hooks'
4921 are used by `define-derived-mode' to make sure the mode hook for the
4922 parent mode is run at the end of the child mode.
4923
4924 ** Minor mode changes:
4925
4926 +++
4927 *** `define-minor-mode' now accepts arbitrary additional keyword arguments
4928 and simply passes them to `defcustom', if applicable.
4929
4930 +++
4931 *** `minor-mode-list' now holds a list of minor mode commands.
4932
4933 +++
4934 *** `define-global-minor-mode'.
4935
4936 This is a new name for what was formerly called
4937 `easy-mmode-define-global-mode'. The old name remains as an alias.
4938
4939 ** Command loop changes:
4940
4941 +++
4942 *** The new function `called-interactively-p' does what many people
4943 have mistakenly believed `interactive-p' to do: it returns t if the
4944 calling function was called through `call-interactively'.
4945
4946 Only use this when you cannot solve the problem by adding a new
4947 INTERACTIVE argument to the command.
4948
4949 +++
4950 *** The function `commandp' takes an additional optional argument.
4951
4952 If it is non-nil, then `commandp' checks for a function that could be
4953 called with `call-interactively', and does not return t for keyboard
4954 macros.
4955
4956 +++
4957 *** When a command returns, the command loop moves point out from
4958 within invisible text, in the same way it moves out from within text
4959 covered by an image or composition property.
4960
4961 This makes it generally unnecessary to mark invisible text as intangible.
4962 This is particularly good because the intangible property often has
4963 unexpected side-effects since the property applies to everything
4964 (including `goto-char', ...) whereas this new code is only run after
4965 `post-command-hook' and thus does not care about intermediate states.
4966
4967 +++
4968 *** If a command sets `transient-mark-mode' to `only', that
4969 enables Transient Mark mode for the following command only.
4970 During that following command, the value of `transient-mark-mode'
4971 is `identity'. If it is still `identity' at the end of the command,
4972 the next return to the command loop changes to nil.
4973
4974 +++
4975 *** Both the variable and the function `disabled-command-hook' have
4976 been renamed to `disabled-command-function'. The variable
4977 `disabled-command-hook' has been kept as an obsolete alias.
4978
4979 +++
4980 *** `emacsserver' now runs `pre-command-hook' and `post-command-hook'
4981 when it receives a request from emacsclient.
4982
4983 ** Lisp file loading changes:
4984
4985 +++
4986 *** `load-history' can now have elements of the form (t . FUNNAME),
4987 which means FUNNAME was previously defined as an autoload (before the
4988 current file redefined it).
4989
4990 +++
4991 *** `load-history' now records (defun . FUNNAME) when a function is
4992 defined. For a variable, it records just the variable name.
4993
4994 +++
4995 *** The function `symbol-file' can now search specifically for function,
4996 variable or face definitions.
4997
4998 +++
4999 *** `provide' and `featurep' now accept an optional second argument
5000 to test/provide subfeatures. Also `provide' now checks `after-load-alist'
5001 and runs any code associated with the provided feature.
5002
5003 ---
5004 *** The variable `recursive-load-depth-limit' has been deleted.
5005 Emacs now signals an error if the same file is loaded with more
5006 than 3 levels of nesting.
5007
5008 +++
5009 ** Byte compiler changes:
5010
5011 *** The byte compiler now displays the actual line and character
5012 position of errors, where possible. Additionally, the form of its
5013 warning and error messages have been brought into line with GNU standards
5014 for these. As a result, you can use next-error and friends on the
5015 compilation output buffer.
5016
5017 *** The new macro `with-no-warnings' suppresses all compiler warnings
5018 inside its body. In terms of execution, it is equivalent to `progn'.
5019
5020 *** You can avoid warnings for possibly-undefined symbols with a
5021 simple convention that the compiler understands. (This is mostly
5022 useful in code meant to be portable to different Emacs versions.)
5023 Write forms like the following, or code that macroexpands into such
5024 forms:
5025
5026 (if (fboundp 'foo) <then> <else>)
5027 (if (boundp 'foo) <then> <else)
5028
5029 In the first case, using `foo' as a function inside the <then> form
5030 won't produce a warning if it's not defined as a function, and in the
5031 second case, using `foo' as a variable won't produce a warning if it's
5032 unbound. The test must be in exactly one of the above forms (after
5033 macro expansion), but such tests can be nested. Note that `when' and
5034 `unless' expand to `if', but `cond' doesn't.
5035
5036 *** `(featurep 'xemacs)' is treated by the compiler as nil. This
5037 helps to avoid noisy compiler warnings in code meant to run under both
5038 Emacs and XEmacs and can sometimes make the result significantly more
5039 efficient. Since byte code from recent versions of XEmacs won't
5040 generally run in Emacs and vice versa, this optimization doesn't lose
5041 you anything.
5042
5043 *** The local variable `no-byte-compile' in Lisp files is now obeyed.
5044
5045 ---
5046 *** When a Lisp file uses CL functions at run-time, compiling the file
5047 now issues warnings about these calls, unless the file performs
5048 (require 'cl) when loaded.
5049
5050 ** Frame operations:
5051
5052 +++
5053 *** New functions `frame-current-scroll-bars' and `window-current-scroll-bars'.
5054
5055 These functions return the current locations of the vertical and
5056 horizontal scroll bars in a frame or window.
5057
5058 +++
5059 *** The new function `modify-all-frames-parameters' modifies parameters
5060 for all (existing and future) frames.
5061
5062 +++
5063 *** The new frame parameter `tty-color-mode' specifies the mode to use
5064 for color support on character terminal frames. Its value can be a
5065 number of colors to support, or a symbol. See the Emacs Lisp
5066 Reference manual for more detailed documentation.
5067
5068 +++
5069 *** When using non-toolkit scroll bars with the default width,
5070 the `scroll-bar-width' frame parameter value is nil.
5071
5072 ** Mule changes:
5073
5074 +++
5075 *** Already true in Emacs 21.1, but not emphasized clearly enough:
5076
5077 Multibyte buffers can now faithfully record all 256 character codes
5078 from 0 to 255. As a result, most of the past reasons to use unibyte
5079 buffers no longer exist. We only know of three reasons to use them
5080 now:
5081
5082 1. If you prefer to use unibyte text all of the time.
5083
5084 2. For reading files into temporary buffers, when you want to avoid
5085 the time it takes to convert the format.
5086
5087 3. For binary files where format conversion would be pointless and
5088 wasteful.
5089
5090 ---
5091 *** `set-buffer-file-coding-system' now takes an additional argument,
5092 NOMODIFY. If it is non-nil, it means don't mark the buffer modified.
5093
5094 +++
5095 *** The new variable `auto-coding-functions' lets you specify functions
5096 to examine a file being visited and deduce the proper coding system
5097 for it. (If the coding system is detected incorrectly for a specific
5098 file, you can put a `coding:' tags to override it.)
5099
5100 ---
5101 *** The new function `merge-coding-systems' fills in unspecified aspects
5102 of one coding system from another coding system.
5103
5104 ---
5105 *** New coding system property `mime-text-unsuitable' indicates that
5106 the coding system's `mime-charset' is not suitable for MIME text
5107 parts, e.g. utf-16.
5108
5109 +++
5110 *** New function `decode-coding-inserted-region' decodes a region as if
5111 it is read from a file without decoding.
5112
5113 ---
5114 *** New CCL functions `lookup-character' and `lookup-integer' access
5115 hash tables defined by the Lisp function `define-translation-hash-table'.
5116
5117 ---
5118 *** New function `quail-find-key' returns a list of keys to type in the
5119 current input method to input a character.
5120
5121 ** Mode line changes:
5122
5123 +++
5124 *** New function `format-mode-line'.
5125
5126 This returns the mode line or header line of the selected (or a
5127 specified) window as a string with or without text properties.
5128
5129 +++
5130 *** The new mode-line construct `(:propertize ELT PROPS...)' can be
5131 used to add text properties to mode-line elements.
5132
5133 +++
5134 *** The new `%i' and `%I' constructs for `mode-line-format' can be used
5135 to display the size of the accessible part of the buffer on the mode
5136 line.
5137
5138 +++
5139 *** Mouse-face on mode-line (and header-line) is now supported.
5140
5141 ** Menu manipulation changes:
5142
5143 ---
5144 *** To manipulate the File menu using easy-menu, you must specify the
5145 proper name "file". In previous Emacs versions, you had to specify
5146 "files", even though the menu item itself was changed to say "File"
5147 several versions ago.
5148
5149 ---
5150 *** The dummy function keys made by easy-menu are now always lower case.
5151 If you specify the menu item name "Ada", for instance, it uses `ada'
5152 as the "key" bound by that key binding.
5153
5154 This is relevant only if Lisp code looks for the bindings that were
5155 made with easy-menu.
5156
5157 ---
5158 *** `easy-menu-define' now allows you to use nil for the symbol name
5159 if you don't need to give the menu a name. If you install the menu
5160 into other keymaps right away (MAPS is non-nil), it usually doesn't
5161 need to have a name.
5162
5163 ** Operating system access:
5164
5165 +++
5166 *** The new primitive `get-internal-run-time' returns the processor
5167 run time used by Emacs since start-up.
5168
5169 +++
5170 *** Functions `user-uid' and `user-real-uid' now return floats if the
5171 user UID doesn't fit in a Lisp integer. Function `user-full-name'
5172 accepts a float as UID parameter.
5173
5174 +++
5175 *** New function `locale-info' accesses locale information.
5176
5177 ---
5178 *** On MS Windows, locale-coding-system is used to interact with the OS.
5179 The Windows specific variable w32-system-coding-system, which was
5180 formerly used for that purpose is now an alias for locale-coding-system.
5181
5182 ---
5183 *** New function `redirect-debugging-output' can be used to redirect
5184 debugging output on the stderr file handle to a file.
5185
5186 ** Miscellaneous:
5187
5188 +++
5189 *** A number of hooks have been renamed to better follow the conventions:
5190
5191 `find-file-hooks' to `find-file-hook',
5192 `find-file-not-found-hooks' to `find-file-not-found-functions',
5193 `write-file-hooks' to `write-file-functions',
5194 `write-contents-hooks' to `write-contents-functions',
5195 `x-lost-selection-hooks' to `x-lost-selection-functions',
5196 `x-sent-selection-hooks' to `x-sent-selection-functions',
5197 `delete-frame-hook' to `delete-frame-functions'.
5198
5199 In each case the old name remains as an alias for the moment.
5200
5201 +++
5202 *** local-write-file-hooks is marked obsolete
5203
5204 Use the LOCAL arg of `add-hook'.
5205
5206 ---
5207 *** New function `x-send-client-message' sends a client message when
5208 running under X.
5209
5210 ** GC changes:
5211
5212 +++
5213 *** New variable `gc-cons-percentage' automatically grows the GC cons threshold
5214 as the heap size increases.
5215
5216 +++
5217 *** New variables `gc-elapsed' and `gcs-done' provide extra information
5218 on garbage collection.
5219
5220 +++
5221 *** The normal hook `post-gc-hook' is run at the end of garbage collection.
5222
5223 The hook is run with GC inhibited, so use it with care.
5224 \f
5225 * New Packages for Lisp Programming in Emacs 22.1
5226
5227 +++
5228 ** The new library button.el implements simple and fast `clickable
5229 buttons' in emacs buffers. Buttons are much lighter-weight than the
5230 `widgets' implemented by widget.el, and can be used by lisp code that
5231 doesn't require the full power of widgets. Emacs uses buttons for
5232 such things as help and apropos buffers.
5233
5234 ---
5235 ** The new library tree-widget.el provides a widget to display a set
5236 of hierarchical data as an outline. For example, the tree-widget is
5237 well suited to display a hierarchy of directories and files.
5238
5239 +++
5240 ** The new library bindat.el provides functions to unpack and pack
5241 binary data structures, such as network packets, to and from Lisp
5242 data structures.
5243
5244 ---
5245 ** master-mode.el implements a minor mode for scrolling a slave
5246 buffer without leaving your current buffer, the master buffer.
5247
5248 It can be used by sql.el, for example: the SQL buffer is the master
5249 and its SQLi buffer is the slave. This allows you to scroll the SQLi
5250 buffer containing the output from the SQL buffer containing the
5251 commands.
5252
5253 This is how to use sql.el and master.el together: the variable
5254 sql-buffer contains the slave buffer. It is a local variable in the
5255 SQL buffer.
5256
5257 (add-hook 'sql-mode-hook
5258 (function (lambda ()
5259 (master-mode t)
5260 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
5261 (add-hook 'sql-set-sqli-hook
5262 (function (lambda ()
5263 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
5264
5265 +++
5266 ** The new library benchmark.el does timing measurements on Lisp code.
5267
5268 This includes measuring garbage collection time.
5269
5270 +++
5271 ** The new library testcover.el does test coverage checking.
5272
5273 This is so you can tell whether you've tested all paths in your Lisp
5274 code. It works with edebug.
5275
5276 The function `testcover-start' instruments all functions in a given
5277 file. Then test your code. The function `testcover-mark-all' adds
5278 overlay "splotches" to the Lisp file's buffer to show where coverage
5279 is lacking. The command `testcover-next-mark' (bind it to a key!)
5280 will move point forward to the next spot that has a splotch.
5281
5282 Normally, a red splotch indicates the form was never completely
5283 evaluated; a brown splotch means it always evaluated to the same
5284 value. The red splotches are skipped for forms that can't possibly
5285 complete their evaluation, such as `error'. The brown splotches are
5286 skipped for forms that are expected to always evaluate to the same
5287 value, such as (setq x 14).
5288
5289 For difficult cases, you can add do-nothing macros to your code to
5290 help out the test coverage tool. The macro `noreturn' suppresses a
5291 red splotch. It is an error if the argument to `noreturn' does
5292 return. The macro `1value' suppresses a brown splotch for its argument.
5293 This macro is a no-op except during test-coverage -- then it signals
5294 an error if the argument actually returns differing values.
5295 \f
5296 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.3
5297
5298 ** Support for GNU/Linux on little-endian MIPS and on IBM S390 has
5299 been added.
5300
5301 \f
5302 * Changes in Emacs 21.3
5303
5304 ** The obsolete C mode (c-mode.el) has been removed to avoid problems
5305 with Custom.
5306
5307 ** UTF-16 coding systems are available, encoding the same characters
5308 as mule-utf-8.
5309
5310 ** There is a new language environment for UTF-8 (set up automatically
5311 in UTF-8 locales).
5312
5313 ** Translation tables are available between equivalent characters in
5314 different Emacs charsets -- for instance `e with acute' coming from the
5315 Latin-1 and Latin-2 charsets. User options `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode'
5316 and `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' respectively turn on translation
5317 between ISO 8859 character sets (`unification') on encoding
5318 (e.g. writing a file) and decoding (e.g. reading a file). Note that
5319 `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is useful and safe, but
5320 `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' can cause text to change when you read
5321 it and write it out again without edits, so it is not generally advisable.
5322 By default `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is turned on.
5323
5324 ** In Emacs running on the X window system, the default value of
5325 `selection-coding-system' is now `compound-text-with-extensions'.
5326
5327 If you want the old behavior, set selection-coding-system to
5328 compound-text, which may be significantly more efficient. Using
5329 compound-text-with-extensions seems to be necessary only for decoding
5330 text from applications under XFree86 4.2, whose behavior is actually
5331 contrary to the compound text specification.
5332
5333 \f
5334 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.2
5335
5336 ** Support for BSD/OS 5.0 has been added.
5337
5338 ** Support for AIX 5.1 was added.
5339
5340 \f
5341 * Changes in Emacs 21.2
5342
5343 ** Emacs now supports compound-text extended segments in X selections.
5344
5345 X applications can use `extended segments' to encode characters in
5346 compound text that belong to character sets which are not part of the
5347 list of approved standard encodings for X, e.g. Big5. To paste
5348 selections with such characters into Emacs, use the new coding system
5349 compound-text-with-extensions as the value of selection-coding-system.
5350
5351 ** The default values of `tooltip-delay' and `tooltip-hide-delay'
5352 were changed.
5353
5354 ** On terminals whose erase-char is ^H (Backspace), Emacs
5355 now uses normal-erase-is-backspace-mode.
5356
5357 ** When the *scratch* buffer is recreated, its mode is set from
5358 initial-major-mode, which normally is lisp-interaction-mode,
5359 instead of using default-major-mode.
5360
5361 ** The new option `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' causes Info to behave
5362 like the stand-alone Info reader (from the GNU Texinfo package) as far
5363 as motion between nodes and their subnodes is concerned. If it is t
5364 (the default), Emacs behaves as before when you type SPC in a menu: it
5365 visits the subnode pointed to by the first menu entry. If this option
5366 is nil, SPC scrolls to the end of the current node, and only then goes
5367 to the first menu item, like the stand-alone reader does.
5368
5369 This change was already in Emacs 21.1, but wasn't advertised in the
5370 NEWS.
5371
5372 \f
5373 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 21.2
5374
5375 ** The meanings of scroll-up-aggressively and scroll-down-aggressively
5376 have been interchanged, so that the former now controls scrolling up,
5377 and the latter now controls scrolling down.
5378
5379 ** The variable `compilation-parse-errors-filename-function' can
5380 be used to transform filenames found in compilation output.
5381
5382 \f
5383 * Installation Changes in Emacs 21.1
5384
5385 See the INSTALL file for information on installing extra libraries and
5386 fonts to take advantage of the new graphical features and extra
5387 charsets in this release.
5388
5389 ** Support for GNU/Linux on IA64 machines has been added.
5390
5391 ** Support for LynxOS has been added.
5392
5393 ** There are new configure options associated with the support for
5394 images and toolkit scrollbars. Use the --help option in `configure'
5395 to list them.
5396
5397 ** You can build a 64-bit Emacs for SPARC/Solaris systems which
5398 support 64-bit executables and also on Irix 6.5. This increases the
5399 maximum buffer size. See etc/MACHINES for instructions. Changes to
5400 build on other 64-bit systems should be straightforward modulo any
5401 necessary changes to unexec.
5402
5403 ** There is a new configure option `--disable-largefile' to omit
5404 Unix-98-style support for large files if that is available.
5405
5406 ** There is a new configure option `--without-xim' that instructs
5407 Emacs to not use X Input Methods (XIM), if these are available.
5408
5409 ** `movemail' defaults to supporting POP. You can turn this off using
5410 the --without-pop configure option, should that be necessary.
5411
5412 ** This version can be built for the Macintosh, but does not implement
5413 all of the new display features described below. The port currently
5414 lacks unexec, asynchronous processes, and networking support. See the
5415 "Emacs and the Mac OS" appendix in the Emacs manual, for the
5416 description of aspects specific to the Mac.
5417
5418 ** Note that the MS-Windows port does not yet implement various of the
5419 new display features described below.
5420
5421 \f
5422 * Changes in Emacs 21.1
5423
5424 ** Emacs has a new redisplay engine.
5425
5426 The new redisplay handles characters of variable width and height.
5427 Italic text can be used without redisplay problems. Fonts containing
5428 oversized characters, i.e. characters larger than the logical height
5429 of a font can be used. Images of various formats can be displayed in
5430 the text.
5431
5432 ** Emacs has a new face implementation.
5433
5434 The new faces no longer fundamentally use X font names to specify the
5435 font. Instead, each face has several independent attributes--family,
5436 height, width, weight and slant--that it may or may not specify.
5437 These attributes can be merged from various faces, and then together
5438 specify a font.
5439
5440 Faces are supported on terminals that can display color or fonts.
5441 These terminal capabilities are auto-detected. Details can be found
5442 under Lisp changes, below.
5443
5444 ** Emacs can display faces on TTY frames.
5445
5446 Emacs automatically detects terminals that are able to display colors.
5447 Faces with a weight greater than normal are displayed extra-bright, if
5448 the terminal supports it. Faces with a weight less than normal and
5449 italic faces are displayed dimmed, if the terminal supports it.
5450 Underlined faces are displayed underlined if possible. Other face
5451 attributes such as `overline', `strike-through', and `box' are ignored
5452 on terminals.
5453
5454 The command-line options `-fg COLOR', `-bg COLOR', and `-rv' are now
5455 supported on character terminals.
5456
5457 Emacs automatically remaps all X-style color specifications to one of
5458 the colors supported by the terminal. This means you could have the
5459 same color customizations that work both on a windowed display and on
5460 a TTY or when Emacs is invoked with the -nw option.
5461
5462 ** New default font is Courier 12pt under X.
5463
5464 ** Sound support
5465
5466 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and FreeBSD (Voxware
5467 driver and native BSD driver, a.k.a. Luigi's driver). Currently
5468 supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio (*.au).
5469 You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes' to enable
5470 sound support.
5471
5472 ** Emacs now resizes mini-windows if appropriate.
5473
5474 If a message is longer than one line, or minibuffer contents are
5475 longer than one line, Emacs can resize the minibuffer window unless it
5476 is on a frame of its own. You can control resizing and the maximum
5477 minibuffer window size by setting the following variables:
5478
5479 - User option: max-mini-window-height
5480
5481 Maximum height for resizing mini-windows. If a float, it specifies a
5482 fraction of the mini-window frame's height. If an integer, it
5483 specifies a number of lines.
5484
5485 Default is 0.25.
5486
5487 - User option: resize-mini-windows
5488
5489 How to resize mini-windows. If nil, don't resize. If t, always
5490 resize to fit the size of the text. If `grow-only', let mini-windows
5491 grow only, until they become empty, at which point they are shrunk
5492 again.
5493
5494 Default is `grow-only'.
5495
5496 ** LessTif support.
5497
5498 Emacs now runs with the LessTif toolkit (see
5499 <http://www.lesstif.org>). You will need version 0.92.26, or later.
5500
5501 ** LessTif/Motif file selection dialog.
5502
5503 When Emacs is configured to use LessTif or Motif, reading a file name
5504 from a menu will pop up a file selection dialog if `use-dialog-box' is
5505 non-nil.
5506
5507 ** File selection dialog on MS-Windows is supported.
5508
5509 When a file is visited by clicking File->Open, the MS-Windows version
5510 now pops up a standard file selection dialog where you can select a
5511 file to visit. File->Save As also pops up that dialog.
5512
5513 ** Toolkit scroll bars.
5514
5515 Emacs now uses toolkit scroll bars if available. When configured for
5516 LessTif/Motif, it will use that toolkit's scroll bar. Otherwise, when
5517 configured for Lucid and Athena widgets, it will use the Xaw3d scroll
5518 bar if Xaw3d is available. You can turn off the use of toolkit scroll
5519 bars by specifying `--with-toolkit-scroll-bars=no' when configuring
5520 Emacs.
5521
5522 When you encounter problems with the Xaw3d scroll bar, watch out how
5523 Xaw3d is compiled on your system. If the Makefile generated from
5524 Xaw3d's Imakefile contains a `-DNARROWPROTO' compiler option, and your
5525 Emacs system configuration file `s/your-system.h' does not contain a
5526 define for NARROWPROTO, you might consider adding it. Take
5527 `s/freebsd.h' as an example.
5528
5529 Alternatively, if you don't have access to the Xaw3d source code, take
5530 a look at your system's imake configuration file, for example in the
5531 directory `/usr/X11R6/lib/X11/config' (paths are different on
5532 different systems). You will find files `*.cf' there. If your
5533 system's cf-file contains a line like `#define NeedWidePrototypes NO',
5534 add a `#define NARROWPROTO' to your Emacs system configuration file.
5535
5536 The reason for this is that one Xaw3d function uses `double' or
5537 `float' function parameters depending on the setting of NARROWPROTO.
5538 This is not a problem when Imakefiles are used because each system's
5539 imake configuration file contains the necessary information. Since
5540 Emacs doesn't use imake, this has do be done manually.
5541
5542 ** Tool bar support.
5543
5544 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. For details
5545 of how to define a tool bar, see the page describing Lisp-level
5546 changes. Tool-bar global minor mode controls whether or not it is
5547 displayed and is on by default. The appearance of the bar is improved
5548 if Emacs has been built with XPM image support. Otherwise monochrome
5549 icons will be used.
5550
5551 To make the tool bar more useful, we need contributions of extra icons
5552 for specific modes (with copyright assignments).
5553
5554 ** Tooltips.
5555
5556 Tooltips are small X windows displaying a help string at the current
5557 mouse position. The Lisp package `tooltip' implements them. You can
5558 turn them off via the user option `tooltip-mode'.
5559
5560 Tooltips also provides support for GUD debugging. If activated,
5561 variable values can be displayed in tooltips by pointing at them with
5562 the mouse in source buffers. You can customize various aspects of the
5563 tooltip display in the group `tooltip'.
5564
5565 ** Automatic Hscrolling
5566
5567 Horizontal scrolling now happens automatically if
5568 `automatic-hscrolling' is set (the default). This setting can be
5569 customized.
5570
5571 If a window is scrolled horizontally with set-window-hscroll, or
5572 scroll-left/scroll-right (C-x <, C-x >), this serves as a lower bound
5573 for automatic horizontal scrolling. Automatic scrolling will scroll
5574 the text more to the left if necessary, but won't scroll the text more
5575 to the right than the column set with set-window-hscroll etc.
5576
5577 ** When using a windowing terminal, each Emacs window now has a cursor
5578 of its own. By default, when a window is selected, the cursor is
5579 solid; otherwise, it is hollow. The user-option
5580 `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' controls how to display the
5581 cursor in non-selected windows. If nil, no cursor is shown, if
5582 non-nil a hollow box cursor is shown.
5583
5584 ** Fringes to the left and right of windows are used to display
5585 truncation marks, continuation marks, overlay arrows and alike. The
5586 foreground, background, and stipple of these areas can be changed by
5587 customizing face `fringe'.
5588
5589 ** The mode line under X is now drawn with shadows by default.
5590 You can change its appearance by modifying the face `mode-line'.
5591 In particular, setting the `:box' attribute to nil turns off the 3D
5592 appearance of the mode line. (The 3D appearance makes the mode line
5593 occupy more space, and thus might cause the first or the last line of
5594 the window to be partially obscured.)
5595
5596 The variable `mode-line-inverse-video', which was used in older
5597 versions of emacs to make the mode-line stand out, is now deprecated.
5598 However, setting it to nil will cause the `mode-line' face to be
5599 ignored, and mode-lines to be drawn using the default text face.
5600
5601 ** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
5602
5603 Different parts of the mode line have been made mouse-sensitive on all
5604 systems which support the mouse. Moving the mouse to a
5605 mouse-sensitive part in the mode line changes the appearance of the
5606 mouse pointer to an arrow, and help about available mouse actions is
5607 displayed either in the echo area, or in the tooltip window if you
5608 have enabled one.
5609
5610 Currently, the following actions have been defined:
5611
5612 - Mouse-1 on the buffer name in the mode line goes to the next buffer.
5613
5614 - Mouse-3 on the buffer-name goes to the previous buffer.
5615
5616 - Mouse-2 on the read-only or modified status in the mode line (`%' or
5617 `*') toggles the status.
5618
5619 - Mouse-3 on the mode name displays a minor-mode menu.
5620
5621 ** Hourglass pointer
5622
5623 Emacs can optionally display an hourglass pointer under X. You can
5624 turn the display on or off by customizing group `cursor'.
5625
5626 ** Blinking cursor
5627
5628 M-x blink-cursor-mode toggles a blinking cursor under X and on
5629 terminals having terminal capabilities `vi', `vs', and `ve'. Blinking
5630 and related parameters like frequency and delay can be customized in
5631 the group `cursor'.
5632
5633 ** New font-lock support mode `jit-lock-mode'.
5634
5635 This support mode is roughly equivalent to `lazy-lock' but is
5636 generally faster. It supports stealth and deferred fontification.
5637 See the documentation of the function `jit-lock-mode' for more
5638 details.
5639
5640 Font-lock uses jit-lock-mode as default support mode, so you don't
5641 have to do anything to activate it.
5642
5643 ** The default binding of the Delete key has changed.
5644
5645 The new user-option `normal-erase-is-backspace' can be set to
5646 determine the effect of the Delete and Backspace function keys.
5647
5648 On window systems, the default value of this option is chosen
5649 according to the keyboard used. If the keyboard has both a Backspace
5650 key and a Delete key, and both are mapped to their usual meanings, the
5651 option's default value is set to t, so that Backspace can be used to
5652 delete backward, and Delete can be used to delete forward. On
5653 keyboards which either have only one key (usually labeled DEL), or two
5654 keys DEL and BS which produce the same effect, the option's value is
5655 set to nil, and these keys delete backward.
5656
5657 If not running under a window system, setting this option accomplishes
5658 a similar effect by mapping C-h, which is usually generated by the
5659 Backspace key, to DEL, and by mapping DEL to C-d via
5660 `keyboard-translate'. The former functionality of C-h is available on
5661 the F1 key. You should probably not use this setting on a text-only
5662 terminal if you don't have both Backspace, Delete and F1 keys.
5663
5664 Programmatically, you can call function normal-erase-is-backspace-mode
5665 to toggle the behavior of the Delete and Backspace keys.
5666
5667 ** The default for user-option `next-line-add-newlines' has been
5668 changed to nil, i.e. C-n will no longer add newlines at the end of a
5669 buffer by default.
5670
5671 ** The <home> and <end> keys now move to the beginning or end of the
5672 current line, respectively. C-<home> and C-<end> move to the
5673 beginning and end of the buffer.
5674
5675 ** Emacs now checks for recursive loads of Lisp files. If the
5676 recursion depth exceeds `recursive-load-depth-limit', an error is
5677 signaled.
5678
5679 ** When an error is signaled during the loading of the user's init
5680 file, Emacs now pops up the *Messages* buffer.
5681
5682 ** Emacs now refuses to load compiled Lisp files which weren't
5683 compiled with Emacs. Set `load-dangerous-libraries' to t to change
5684 this behavior.
5685
5686 The reason for this change is an incompatible change in XEmacs's byte
5687 compiler. Files compiled with XEmacs can contain byte codes that let
5688 Emacs dump core.
5689
5690 ** Toggle buttons and radio buttons in menus.
5691
5692 When compiled with LessTif (or Motif) support, Emacs uses toolkit
5693 widgets for radio and toggle buttons in menus. When configured for
5694 Lucid, Emacs draws radio buttons and toggle buttons similar to Motif.
5695
5696 ** The menu bar configuration has changed. The new configuration is
5697 more CUA-compliant. The most significant change is that Options is
5698 now a separate menu-bar item, with Mule and Customize as its submenus.
5699
5700 ** Item Save Options on the Options menu allows saving options set
5701 using that menu.
5702
5703 ** Highlighting of trailing whitespace.
5704
5705 When `show-trailing-whitespace' is non-nil, Emacs displays trailing
5706 whitespace in the face `trailing-whitespace'. Trailing whitespace is
5707 defined as spaces or tabs at the end of a line. To avoid busy
5708 highlighting when entering new text, trailing whitespace is not
5709 displayed if point is at the end of the line containing the
5710 whitespace.
5711
5712 ** C-x 5 1 runs the new command delete-other-frames which deletes
5713 all frames except the selected one.
5714
5715 ** The new user-option `confirm-kill-emacs' can be customized to
5716 let Emacs ask for confirmation before exiting.
5717
5718 ** The header line in an Info buffer is now displayed as an emacs
5719 header-line (which is like a mode-line, but at the top of the window),
5720 so that it remains visible even when the buffer has been scrolled.
5721 This behavior may be disabled by customizing the option
5722 `Info-use-header-line'.
5723
5724 ** Polish, Czech, German, and French translations of Emacs' reference card
5725 have been added. They are named `pl-refcard.tex', `cs-refcard.tex',
5726 `de-refcard.tex' and `fr-refcard.tex'. Postscript files are included.
5727
5728 ** An `Emacs Survival Guide', etc/survival.tex, is available.
5729
5730 ** A reference card for Dired has been added. Its name is
5731 `dired-ref.tex'. A French translation is available in
5732 `fr-drdref.tex'.
5733
5734 ** C-down-mouse-3 is bound differently. Now if the menu bar is not
5735 displayed it pops up a menu containing the items which would be on the
5736 menu bar. If the menu bar is displayed, it pops up the major mode
5737 menu or the Edit menu if there is no major mode menu.
5738
5739 ** Variable `load-path' is no longer customizable through Customize.
5740
5741 You can no longer use `M-x customize-variable' to customize `load-path'
5742 because it now contains a version-dependent component. You can still
5743 use `add-to-list' and `setq' to customize this variable in your
5744 `~/.emacs' init file or to modify it from any Lisp program in general.
5745
5746 ** C-u C-x = provides detailed information about the character at
5747 point in a pop-up window.
5748
5749 ** Emacs can now support 'wheeled' mice (such as the MS IntelliMouse)
5750 under XFree86. To enable this, use the `mouse-wheel-mode' command, or
5751 customize the variable `mouse-wheel-mode'.
5752
5753 The variables `mouse-wheel-follow-mouse' and `mouse-wheel-scroll-amount'
5754 determine where and by how much buffers are scrolled.
5755
5756 ** Emacs' auto-save list files are now by default stored in a
5757 sub-directory `.emacs.d/auto-save-list/' of the user's home directory.
5758 (On MS-DOS, this subdirectory's name is `_emacs.d/auto-save.list/'.)
5759 You can customize `auto-save-list-file-prefix' to change this location.
5760
5761 ** The function `getenv' is now callable interactively.
5762
5763 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
5764 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
5765
5766 ** The new command M-x delete-trailing-whitespace RET will delete the
5767 trailing whitespace within the current restriction. You can also add
5768 this function to `write-file-hooks' or `local-write-file-hooks'.
5769
5770 ** When visiting a file with M-x find-file-literally, no newlines will
5771 be added to the end of the buffer even if `require-final-newline' is
5772 non-nil.
5773
5774 ** The new user-option `find-file-suppress-same-file-warnings' can be
5775 set to suppress warnings ``X and Y are the same file'' when visiting a
5776 file that is already visited under a different name.
5777
5778 ** The new user-option `electric-help-shrink-window' can be set to
5779 nil to prevent adjusting the help window size to the buffer size.
5780
5781 ** New command M-x describe-character-set reads a character set name
5782 and displays information about that.
5783
5784 ** The new variable `auto-mode-interpreter-regexp' contains a regular
5785 expression matching interpreters, for file mode determination.
5786
5787 This regular expression is matched against the first line of a file to
5788 determine the file's mode in `set-auto-mode' when Emacs can't deduce a
5789 mode from the file's name. If it matches, the file is assumed to be
5790 interpreted by the interpreter matched by the second group of the
5791 regular expression. The mode is then determined as the mode
5792 associated with that interpreter in `interpreter-mode-alist'.
5793
5794 ** New function executable-make-buffer-file-executable-if-script-p is
5795 suitable as an after-save-hook as an alternative to `executable-chmod'.
5796
5797 ** The most preferred coding-system is now used to save a buffer if
5798 buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and it is safe for the buffer
5799 contents. (The most preferred is set by set-language-environment or
5800 by M-x prefer-coding-system.) Thus if you visit an ASCII file and
5801 insert a non-ASCII character from your current language environment,
5802 the file will be saved silently with the appropriate coding.
5803 Previously you would be prompted for a safe coding system.
5804
5805 ** The many obsolete language `setup-...-environment' commands have
5806 been removed -- use `set-language-environment'.
5807
5808 ** The new Custom option `keyboard-coding-system' specifies a coding
5809 system for keyboard input.
5810
5811 ** New variable `inhibit-iso-escape-detection' determines if Emacs'
5812 coding system detection algorithm should pay attention to ISO2022's
5813 escape sequences. If this variable is non-nil, the algorithm ignores
5814 such escape sequences. The default value is nil, and it is
5815 recommended not to change it except for the special case that you
5816 always want to read any escape code verbatim. If you just want to
5817 read a specific file without decoding escape codes, use C-x RET c
5818 (`universal-coding-system-argument'). For instance, C-x RET c latin-1
5819 RET C-x C-f filename RET.
5820
5821 ** Variable `default-korean-keyboard' is initialized properly from the
5822 environment variable `HANGUL_KEYBOARD_TYPE'.
5823
5824 ** New command M-x list-charset-chars reads a character set name and
5825 displays all characters in that character set.
5826
5827 ** M-x set-terminal-coding-system (C-x RET t) now allows CCL-based
5828 coding systems such as cpXXX and cyrillic-koi8.
5829
5830 ** Emacs now attempts to determine the initial language environment
5831 and preferred and locale coding systems systematically from the
5832 LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG environment variables during startup.
5833
5834 ** New language environments `Polish', `Latin-8' and `Latin-9'.
5835 Latin-8 and Latin-9 correspond respectively to the ISO character sets
5836 8859-14 (Celtic) and 8859-15 (updated Latin-1, with the Euro sign).
5837 GNU Intlfonts doesn't support these yet but recent X releases have
5838 8859-15. See etc/INSTALL for information on obtaining extra fonts.
5839 There are new Leim input methods for Latin-8 and Latin-9 prefix (only)
5840 and Polish `slash'.
5841
5842 ** New language environments `Dutch' and `Spanish'.
5843 These new environments mainly select appropriate translations
5844 of the tutorial.
5845
5846 ** In Ethiopic language environment, special key bindings for
5847 function keys are changed as follows. This is to conform to "Emacs
5848 Lisp Coding Convention".
5849
5850 new command old-binding
5851 --- ------- -----------
5852 f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-buffer f5
5853 S-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-region f5
5854 C-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-mail-or-marker f5
5855
5856 f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-buffer unchanged
5857 S-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-region unchanged
5858 C-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-mail-or-marker unchanged
5859
5860 S-f5 ethio-toggle-punctuation f3
5861 S-f6 ethio-modify-vowel f6
5862 S-f7 ethio-replace-space f7
5863 S-f8 ethio-input-special-character f8
5864 S-f9 ethio-replace-space unchanged
5865 C-f9 ethio-toggle-space f2
5866
5867 ** There are new Leim input methods.
5868 New input methods "turkish-postfix", "turkish-alt-postfix",
5869 "greek-mizuochi", "TeX", and "greek-babel" are now part of the Leim
5870 package.
5871
5872 ** The rule of input method "slovak" is slightly changed. Now the
5873 rules for translating "q" and "Q" to "`" (backquote) are deleted, thus
5874 typing them inserts "q" and "Q" respectively. Rules for translating
5875 "=q", "+q", "=Q", and "+Q" to "`" are also deleted. Now, to input
5876 "`", you must type "=q".
5877
5878 ** When your terminal can't display characters from some of the ISO
5879 8859 character sets but can display Latin-1, you can display
5880 more-or-less mnemonic sequences of ASCII/Latin-1 characters instead of
5881 empty boxes (under a window system) or question marks (not under a
5882 window system). Customize the option `latin1-display' to turn this
5883 on.
5884
5885 ** M-; now calls comment-dwim which tries to do something clever based
5886 on the context. M-x kill-comment is now an alias to comment-kill,
5887 defined in newcomment.el. You can choose different styles of region
5888 commenting with the variable `comment-style'.
5889
5890 ** New user options `display-time-mail-face' and
5891 `display-time-use-mail-icon' control the appearance of mode-line mail
5892 indicator used by the display-time package. On a suitable display the
5893 indicator can be an icon and is mouse-sensitive.
5894
5895 ** On window-systems, additional space can be put between text lines
5896 on the display using several methods
5897
5898 - By setting frame parameter `line-spacing' to PIXELS. PIXELS must be
5899 a positive integer, and specifies that PIXELS number of pixels should
5900 be put below text lines on the affected frame or frames.
5901
5902 - By setting X resource `lineSpacing', class `LineSpacing'. This is
5903 equivalent to specifying the frame parameter.
5904
5905 - By specifying `--line-spacing=N' or `-lsp N' on the command line.
5906
5907 - By setting buffer-local variable `line-spacing'. The meaning is
5908 the same, but applies to the a particular buffer only.
5909
5910 ** The new command `clone-indirect-buffer' can be used to create
5911 an indirect buffer that is a twin copy of the current buffer. The
5912 command `clone-indirect-buffer-other-window', bound to C-x 4 c,
5913 does the same but displays the indirect buffer in another window.
5914
5915 ** New user options `backup-directory-alist' and
5916 `make-backup-file-name-function' control the placement of backups,
5917 typically in a single directory or in an invisible sub-directory.
5918
5919 ** New commands iso-iso2sgml and iso-sgml2iso convert between Latin-1
5920 characters and the corresponding SGML (HTML) entities.
5921
5922 ** New X resources recognized
5923
5924 *** The X resource `synchronous', class `Synchronous', specifies
5925 whether Emacs should run in synchronous mode. Synchronous mode
5926 is useful for debugging X problems.
5927
5928 Example:
5929
5930 emacs.synchronous: true
5931
5932 *** The X resource `visualClass, class `VisualClass', specifies the
5933 visual Emacs should use. The resource's value should be a string of
5934 the form `CLASS-DEPTH', where CLASS is the name of the visual class,
5935 and DEPTH is the requested color depth as a decimal number. Valid
5936 visual class names are
5937
5938 TrueColor
5939 PseudoColor
5940 DirectColor
5941 StaticColor
5942 GrayScale
5943 StaticGray
5944
5945 Visual class names specified as X resource are case-insensitive, i.e.
5946 `pseudocolor', `Pseudocolor' and `PseudoColor' all have the same
5947 meaning.
5948
5949 The program `xdpyinfo' can be used to list the visual classes
5950 supported on your display, and which depths they have. If
5951 `visualClass' is not specified, Emacs uses the display's default
5952 visual.
5953
5954 Example:
5955
5956 emacs.visualClass: TrueColor-8
5957
5958 *** The X resource `privateColormap', class `PrivateColormap',
5959 specifies that Emacs should use a private colormap if it is using the
5960 default visual, and that visual is of class PseudoColor. Recognized
5961 resource values are `true' or `on'.
5962
5963 Example:
5964
5965 emacs.privateColormap: true
5966
5967 ** Faces and frame parameters.
5968
5969 There are four new faces `scroll-bar', `border', `cursor' and `mouse'.
5970 Setting the frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
5971 `scroll-bar-background' sets foreground and background color of face
5972 `scroll-bar' and vice versa. Setting frame parameter `border-color'
5973 sets the background color of face `border' and vice versa. Likewise
5974 for frame parameters `cursor-color' and face `cursor', and frame
5975 parameter `mouse-color' and face `mouse'.
5976
5977 Changing frame parameter `font' sets font-related attributes of the
5978 `default' face and vice versa. Setting frame parameters
5979 `foreground-color' or `background-color' sets the colors of the
5980 `default' face and vice versa.
5981
5982 ** New face `menu'.
5983
5984 The face `menu' can be used to change colors and font of Emacs' menus.
5985
5986 ** New frame parameter `screen-gamma' for gamma correction.
5987
5988 The new frame parameter `screen-gamma' specifies gamma-correction for
5989 colors. Its value may be nil, the default, in which case no gamma
5990 correction occurs, or a number > 0, usually a float, that specifies
5991 the screen gamma of a frame's display.
5992
5993 PC monitors usually have a screen gamma of 2.2. smaller values result
5994 in darker colors. You might want to try a screen gamma of 1.5 for LCD
5995 color displays. The viewing gamma Emacs uses is 0.4545. (1/2.2).
5996
5997 The X resource name of this parameter is `screenGamma', class
5998 `ScreenGamma'.
5999
6000 ** Tabs and variable-width text.
6001
6002 Tabs are now displayed with stretch properties; the width of a tab is
6003 defined as a multiple of the normal character width of a frame, and is
6004 independent of the fonts used in the text where the tab appears.
6005 Thus, tabs can be used to line up text in different fonts.
6006
6007 ** Enhancements of the Lucid menu bar
6008
6009 *** The Lucid menu bar now supports the resource "margin".
6010
6011 emacs.pane.menubar.margin: 5
6012
6013 The default margin is 4 which makes the menu bar appear like the
6014 LessTif/Motif one.
6015
6016 *** Arrows that indicate sub-menus are now drawn with shadows, as in
6017 LessTif and Motif.
6018
6019 ** A block cursor can be drawn as wide as the glyph under it under X.
6020
6021 As an example: if a block cursor is over a tab character, it will be
6022 drawn as wide as that tab on the display. To do this, set
6023 `x-stretch-cursor' to a non-nil value.
6024
6025 ** Empty display lines at the end of a buffer may be marked with a
6026 bitmap (this is similar to the tilde displayed by vi and Less).
6027
6028 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
6029 `indicate-empty-lines' to a non-nil value. The default value of this
6030 variable is found in `default-indicate-empty-lines'.
6031
6032 ** There is a new "aggressive" scrolling method.
6033
6034 When scrolling up because point is above the window start, if the
6035 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-up-aggressively' is a
6036 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
6037 fraction of the window's height from the top of the window.
6038
6039 When scrolling down because point is below the window end, if the
6040 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-down-aggressively' is a
6041 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
6042 fraction of the window's height from the bottom of the window.
6043
6044 ** You can now easily create new *Info* buffers using either
6045 M-x clone-buffer, C-u m <entry> RET or C-u g <entry> RET.
6046 M-x clone-buffer can also be used on *Help* and several other special
6047 buffers.
6048
6049 ** The command `Info-search' now uses a search history.
6050
6051 ** Listing buffers with M-x list-buffers (C-x C-b) now shows
6052 abbreviated file names. Abbreviations can be customized by changing
6053 `directory-abbrev-alist'.
6054
6055 ** A new variable, backup-by-copying-when-privileged-mismatch, gives
6056 the highest file uid for which backup-by-copying-when-mismatch will be
6057 forced on. The assumption is that uids less than or equal to this
6058 value are special uids (root, bin, daemon, etc.--not real system
6059 users) and that files owned by these users should not change ownership,
6060 even if your system policy allows users other than root to edit them.
6061
6062 The default is 200; set the variable to nil to disable the feature.
6063
6064 ** The rectangle commands now avoid inserting undesirable spaces,
6065 notably at the end of lines.
6066
6067 All these functions have been rewritten to avoid inserting unwanted
6068 spaces, and an optional prefix now allows them to behave the old way.
6069
6070 ** The function `replace-rectangle' is an alias for `string-rectangle'.
6071
6072 ** The new command M-x string-insert-rectangle is like `string-rectangle',
6073 but inserts text instead of replacing it.
6074
6075 ** The new command M-x query-replace-regexp-eval acts like
6076 query-replace-regexp, but takes a Lisp expression which is evaluated
6077 after each match to get the replacement text.
6078
6079 ** M-x query-replace recognizes a new command `e' (or `E') that lets
6080 you edit the replacement string.
6081
6082 ** The new command mail-abbrev-complete-alias, bound to `M-TAB'
6083 (if you load the library `mailabbrev'), lets you complete mail aliases
6084 in the text, analogous to lisp-complete-symbol.
6085
6086 ** The variable `echo-keystrokes' may now have a floating point value.
6087
6088 ** If your init file is compiled (.emacs.elc), `user-init-file' is set
6089 to the source name (.emacs.el), if that exists, after loading it.
6090
6091 ** The help string specified for a menu-item whose definition contains
6092 the property `:help HELP' is now displayed under X, on MS-Windows, and
6093 MS-DOS, either in the echo area or with tooltips. Many standard menus
6094 displayed by Emacs now have help strings.
6095
6096 --
6097 ** New user option `read-mail-command' specifies a command to use to
6098 read mail from the menu etc.
6099
6100 ** The environment variable `EMACSLOCKDIR' is no longer used on MS-Windows.
6101 This environment variable was used when creating lock files. Emacs on
6102 MS-Windows does not use this variable anymore. This change was made
6103 before Emacs 21.1, but wasn't documented until now.
6104
6105 ** Highlighting of mouse-sensitive regions is now supported in the
6106 MS-DOS version of Emacs.
6107
6108 ** The new command `msdos-set-mouse-buttons' forces the MS-DOS version
6109 of Emacs to behave as if the mouse had a specified number of buttons.
6110 This comes handy with mice that don't report their number of buttons
6111 correctly. One example is the wheeled mice, which report 3 buttons,
6112 but clicks on the middle button are not passed to the MS-DOS version
6113 of Emacs.
6114
6115 ** Customize changes
6116
6117 *** Customize now supports comments about customized items. Use the
6118 `State' menu to add comments, or give a prefix argument to
6119 M-x customize-set-variable or M-x customize-set-value. Note that
6120 customization comments will cause the customizations to fail in
6121 earlier versions of Emacs.
6122
6123 *** The new option `custom-buffer-done-function' says whether to kill
6124 Custom buffers when you've done with them or just bury them (the
6125 default).
6126
6127 *** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
6128 does not allow you to save customizations in your `~/.emacs' init
6129 file. This is because saving customizations from such a session would
6130 wipe out all the other customizationss you might have on your init
6131 file.
6132
6133 ** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
6134 does not save disabled and enabled commands for future sessions, to
6135 avoid overwriting existing customizations of this kind that are
6136 already in your init file.
6137
6138 ** New features in evaluation commands
6139
6140 *** The commands to evaluate Lisp expressions, such as C-M-x in Lisp
6141 modes, C-j in Lisp Interaction mode, and M-:, now bind the variables
6142 print-level, print-length, and debug-on-error based on the new
6143 customizable variables eval-expression-print-level,
6144 eval-expression-print-length, and eval-expression-debug-on-error.
6145
6146 The default values for the first two of these variables are 12 and 4
6147 respectively, which means that `eval-expression' now prints at most
6148 the first 12 members of a list and at most 4 nesting levels deep (if
6149 the list is longer or deeper than that, an ellipsis `...' is
6150 printed).
6151
6152 <RET> or <mouse-2> on the printed text toggles between an abbreviated
6153 printed representation and an unabbreviated one.
6154
6155 The default value of eval-expression-debug-on-error is t, so any error
6156 during evaluation produces a backtrace.
6157
6158 *** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) now loads Edebug and instruments
6159 code when called with a prefix argument.
6160
6161 ** CC mode changes.
6162
6163 Note: This release contains changes that might not be compatible with
6164 current user setups (although it's believed that these
6165 incompatibilities will only show in very uncommon circumstances).
6166 However, since the impact is uncertain, these changes may be rolled
6167 back depending on user feedback. Therefore there's no forward
6168 compatibility guarantee wrt the new features introduced in this
6169 release.
6170
6171 *** The hardcoded switch to "java" style in Java mode is gone.
6172 CC Mode used to automatically set the style to "java" when Java mode
6173 is entered. This has now been removed since it caused too much
6174 confusion.
6175
6176 However, to keep backward compatibility to a certain extent, the
6177 default value for c-default-style now specifies the "java" style for
6178 java-mode, but "gnu" for all other modes (as before). So you won't
6179 notice the change if you haven't touched that variable.
6180
6181 *** New cleanups, space-before-funcall and compact-empty-funcall.
6182 Two new cleanups have been added to c-cleanup-list:
6183
6184 space-before-funcall causes a space to be inserted before the opening
6185 parenthesis of a function call, which gives the style "foo (bar)".
6186
6187 compact-empty-funcall causes any space before a function call opening
6188 parenthesis to be removed if there are no arguments to the function.
6189 It's typically useful together with space-before-funcall to get the
6190 style "foo (bar)" and "foo()".
6191
6192 *** Some keywords now automatically trigger reindentation.
6193 Keywords like "else", "while", "catch" and "finally" have been made
6194 "electric" to make them reindent automatically when they continue an
6195 earlier statement. An example:
6196
6197 for (i = 0; i < 17; i++)
6198 if (a[i])
6199 res += a[i]->offset;
6200 else
6201
6202 Here, the "else" should be indented like the preceding "if", since it
6203 continues that statement. CC Mode will automatically reindent it after
6204 the "else" has been typed in full, since it's not until then it's
6205 possible to decide whether it's a new statement or a continuation of
6206 the preceding "if".
6207
6208 CC Mode uses Abbrev mode to achieve this, which is therefore turned on
6209 by default.
6210
6211 *** M-a and M-e now moves by sentence in multiline strings.
6212 Previously these two keys only moved by sentence in comments, which
6213 meant that sentence movement didn't work in strings containing
6214 documentation or other natural language text.
6215
6216 The reason it's only activated in multiline strings (i.e. strings that
6217 contain a newline, even when escaped by a '\') is to avoid stopping in
6218 the short strings that often reside inside statements. Multiline
6219 strings almost always contain text in a natural language, as opposed
6220 to other strings that typically contain format specifications,
6221 commands, etc. Also, it's not that bothersome that M-a and M-e misses
6222 sentences in single line strings, since they're short anyway.
6223
6224 *** Support for autodoc comments in Pike mode.
6225 Autodoc comments for Pike are used to extract documentation from the
6226 source, like Javadoc in Java. Pike mode now recognize this markup in
6227 comment prefixes and paragraph starts.
6228
6229 *** The comment prefix regexps on c-comment-prefix may be mode specific.
6230 When c-comment-prefix is an association list, it specifies the comment
6231 line prefix on a per-mode basis, like c-default-style does. This
6232 change came about to support the special autodoc comment prefix in
6233 Pike mode only.
6234
6235 *** Better handling of syntactic errors.
6236 The recovery after unbalanced parens earlier in the buffer has been
6237 improved; CC Mode now reports them by dinging and giving a message
6238 stating the offending line, but still recovers and indent the
6239 following lines in a sane way (most of the time). An "else" with no
6240 matching "if" is handled similarly. If an error is discovered while
6241 indenting a region, the whole region is still indented and the error
6242 is reported afterwards.
6243
6244 *** Lineup functions may now return absolute columns.
6245 A lineup function can give an absolute column to indent the line to by
6246 returning a vector with the desired column as the first element.
6247
6248 *** More robust and warning-free byte compilation.
6249 Although this is strictly not a user visible change (well, depending
6250 on the view of a user), it's still worth mentioning that CC Mode now
6251 can be compiled in the standard ways without causing trouble. Some
6252 code have also been moved between the subpackages to enhance the
6253 modularity somewhat. Thanks to Martin Buchholz for doing the
6254 groundwork.
6255
6256 *** c-style-variables-are-local-p now defaults to t.
6257 This is an incompatible change that has been made to make the behavior
6258 of the style system wrt global variable settings less confusing for
6259 non-advanced users. If you know what this variable does you might
6260 want to set it to nil in your .emacs, otherwise you probably don't
6261 have to bother.
6262
6263 Defaulting c-style-variables-are-local-p to t avoids the confusing
6264 situation that occurs when a user sets some style variables globally
6265 and edits both a Java and a non-Java file in the same Emacs session.
6266 If the style variables aren't buffer local in this case, loading of
6267 the second file will cause the default style (either "gnu" or "java"
6268 by default) to override the global settings made by the user.
6269
6270 *** New initialization procedure for the style system.
6271 When the initial style for a buffer is determined by CC Mode (from the
6272 variable c-default-style), the global values of style variables now
6273 take precedence over the values specified by the chosen style. This
6274 is different than the old behavior: previously, the style-specific
6275 settings would override the global settings. This change makes it
6276 possible to do simple configuration in the intuitive way with
6277 Customize or with setq lines in one's .emacs file.
6278
6279 By default, the global value of every style variable is the new
6280 special symbol set-from-style, which causes the value to be taken from
6281 the style system. This means that in effect, only an explicit setting
6282 of a style variable will cause the "overriding" behavior described
6283 above.
6284
6285 Also note that global settings override style-specific settings *only*
6286 when the initial style of a buffer is chosen by a CC Mode major mode
6287 function. When a style is chosen in other ways --- for example, by a
6288 call like (c-set-style "gnu") in a hook, or via M-x c-set-style ---
6289 then the style-specific values take precedence over any global style
6290 values. In Lisp terms, global values override style-specific values
6291 only when the new second argument to c-set-style is non-nil; see the
6292 function documentation for more info.
6293
6294 The purpose of these changes is to make it easier for users,
6295 especially novice users, to do simple customizations with Customize or
6296 with setq in their .emacs files. On the other hand, the new system is
6297 intended to be compatible with advanced users' customizations as well,
6298 such as those that choose styles in hooks or whatnot. This new system
6299 is believed to be almost entirely compatible with current
6300 configurations, in spite of the changed precedence between style and
6301 global variable settings when a buffer's default style is set.
6302
6303 (Thanks to Eric Eide for clarifying this explanation a bit.)
6304
6305 **** c-offsets-alist is now a customizable variable.
6306 This became possible as a result of the new initialization behavior.
6307
6308 This variable is treated slightly differently from the other style
6309 variables; instead of using the symbol set-from-style, it will be
6310 completed with the syntactic symbols it doesn't already contain when
6311 the style is first initialized. This means it now defaults to the
6312 empty list to make all syntactic elements get their values from the
6313 style system.
6314
6315 **** Compatibility variable to restore the old behavior.
6316 In case your configuration doesn't work with this change, you can set
6317 c-old-style-variable-behavior to non-nil to get the old behavior back
6318 as far as possible.
6319
6320 *** Improvements to line breaking and text filling.
6321 CC Mode now handles this more intelligently and seamlessly wrt the
6322 surrounding code, especially inside comments. For details see the new
6323 chapter about this in the manual.
6324
6325 **** New variable to recognize comment line prefix decorations.
6326 The variable c-comment-prefix-regexp has been added to properly
6327 recognize the line prefix in both block and line comments. It's
6328 primarily used to initialize the various paragraph recognition and
6329 adaptive filling variables that the text handling functions uses.
6330
6331 **** New variable c-block-comment-prefix.
6332 This is a generalization of the now obsolete variable
6333 c-comment-continuation-stars to handle arbitrary strings.
6334
6335 **** CC Mode now uses adaptive fill mode.
6336 This to make it adapt better to the paragraph style inside comments.
6337
6338 It's also possible to use other adaptive filling packages inside CC
6339 Mode, notably Kyle E. Jones' Filladapt mode (http://wonderworks.com/).
6340 A new convenience function c-setup-filladapt sets up Filladapt for use
6341 inside CC Mode.
6342
6343 Note though that the 2.12 version of Filladapt lacks a feature that
6344 causes it to work suboptimally when c-comment-prefix-regexp can match
6345 the empty string (which it commonly does). A patch for that is
6346 available from the CC Mode web site (http://www.python.org/emacs/
6347 cc-mode/).
6348
6349 **** The variables `c-hanging-comment-starter-p' and
6350 `c-hanging-comment-ender-p', which controlled how comment starters and
6351 enders were filled, are not used anymore. The new version of the
6352 function `c-fill-paragraph' keeps the comment starters and enders as
6353 they were before the filling.
6354
6355 **** It's now possible to selectively turn off auto filling.
6356 The variable c-ignore-auto-fill is used to ignore auto fill mode in
6357 specific contexts, e.g. in preprocessor directives and in string
6358 literals.
6359
6360 **** New context sensitive line break function c-context-line-break.
6361 It works like newline-and-indent in normal code, and adapts the line
6362 prefix according to the comment style when used inside comments. If
6363 you're normally using newline-and-indent, you might want to switch to
6364 this function.
6365
6366 *** Fixes to IDL mode.
6367 It now does a better job in recognizing only the constructs relevant
6368 to IDL. E.g. it no longer matches "class" as the beginning of a
6369 struct block, but it does match the CORBA 2.3 "valuetype" keyword.
6370 Thanks to Eric Eide.
6371
6372 *** Improvements to the Whitesmith style.
6373 It now keeps the style consistently on all levels and both when
6374 opening braces hangs and when they don't.
6375
6376 **** New lineup function c-lineup-whitesmith-in-block.
6377
6378 *** New lineup functions c-lineup-template-args and c-indent-multi-line-block.
6379 See their docstrings for details. c-lineup-template-args does a
6380 better job of tracking the brackets used as parens in C++ templates,
6381 and is used by default to line up continued template arguments.
6382
6383 *** c-lineup-comment now preserves alignment with a comment on the
6384 previous line. It used to instead preserve comments that started in
6385 the column specified by comment-column.
6386
6387 *** c-lineup-C-comments handles "free form" text comments.
6388 In comments with a long delimiter line at the start, the indentation
6389 is kept unchanged for lines that start with an empty comment line
6390 prefix. This is intended for the type of large block comments that
6391 contain documentation with its own formatting. In these you normally
6392 don't want CC Mode to change the indentation.
6393
6394 *** The `c' syntactic symbol is now relative to the comment start
6395 instead of the previous line, to make integers usable as lineup
6396 arguments.
6397
6398 *** All lineup functions have gotten docstrings.
6399
6400 *** More preprocessor directive movement functions.
6401 c-down-conditional does the reverse of c-up-conditional.
6402 c-up-conditional-with-else and c-down-conditional-with-else are
6403 variants of these that also stops at "#else" lines (suggested by Don
6404 Provan).
6405
6406 *** Minor improvements to many movement functions in tricky situations.
6407
6408 ** Dired changes
6409
6410 *** New variable `dired-recursive-deletes' determines if the delete
6411 command will delete non-empty directories recursively. The default
6412 is, delete only empty directories.
6413
6414 *** New variable `dired-recursive-copies' determines if the copy
6415 command will copy directories recursively. The default is, do not
6416 copy directories recursively.
6417
6418 *** In command `dired-do-shell-command' (usually bound to `!') a `?'
6419 in the shell command has a special meaning similar to `*', but with
6420 the difference that the command will be run on each file individually.
6421
6422 *** The new command `dired-find-alternate-file' (usually bound to `a')
6423 replaces the Dired buffer with the buffer for an alternate file or
6424 directory.
6425
6426 *** The new command `dired-show-file-type' (usually bound to `y') shows
6427 a message in the echo area describing what type of file the point is on.
6428 This command invokes the external program `file' do its work, and so
6429 will only work on systems with that program, and will be only as
6430 accurate or inaccurate as it is.
6431
6432 *** Dired now properly handles undo changes of adding/removing `-R'
6433 from ls switches.
6434
6435 *** Dired commands that prompt for a destination file now allow the use
6436 of the `M-n' command in the minibuffer to insert the source filename,
6437 which the user can then edit. This only works if there is a single
6438 source file, not when operating on multiple marked files.
6439
6440 ** Gnus changes.
6441
6442 The Gnus NEWS entries are short, but they reflect sweeping changes in
6443 four areas: Article display treatment, MIME treatment,
6444 internationalization and mail-fetching.
6445
6446 *** The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
6447 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
6448
6449 If you used procmail like in
6450
6451 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
6452 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
6453 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
6454 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
6455
6456 this now has changed to
6457
6458 (setq mail-sources
6459 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
6460 :suffix ".in")))
6461
6462 More information is available in the info doc at Select Methods ->
6463 Getting Mail -> Mail Sources
6464
6465 *** Gnus is now a MIME-capable reader. This affects many parts of
6466 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
6467 Separate MIME packages like RMIME, mime-compose etc., will probably no
6468 longer work; remove them and use the native facilities.
6469
6470 The FLIM/SEMI package still works with Emacs 21, but if you want to
6471 use the native facilities, you must remove any mailcap.el[c] that was
6472 installed by FLIM/SEMI version 1.13 or earlier.
6473
6474 *** Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too many
6475 parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables. There
6476 are built-in facilities equivalent to those of gnus-mule.el, which is
6477 now just a compatibility layer.
6478
6479 *** gnus-mule.el is now just a compatibility layer over the built-in
6480 Gnus facilities.
6481
6482 *** gnus-auto-select-first can now be a function to be
6483 called to position point.
6484
6485 *** The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
6486 summary buffers and NOV files.
6487
6488 *** `gnus-article-display-hook' has been removed. Instead, a number
6489 of variables starting with `gnus-treat-' have been added.
6490
6491 *** The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now work in a
6492 subtly different manner.
6493
6494 *** New web-based backends have been added: nnslashdot, nnwarchive
6495 and nnultimate. nnweb has been revamped, again, to keep up with
6496 ever-changing layouts.
6497
6498 *** Gnus can now read IMAP mail via nnimap.
6499
6500 *** There is image support of various kinds and some sound support.
6501
6502 ** Changes in Texinfo mode.
6503
6504 *** A couple of new key bindings have been added for inserting Texinfo
6505 macros
6506
6507 Key binding Macro
6508 -------------------------
6509 C-c C-c C-s @strong
6510 C-c C-c C-e @emph
6511 C-c C-c u @uref
6512 C-c C-c q @quotation
6513 C-c C-c m @email
6514 C-c C-o @<block> ... @end <block>
6515 M-RET @item
6516
6517 *** The " key now inserts either " or `` or '' depending on context.
6518
6519 ** Changes in Outline mode.
6520
6521 There is now support for Imenu to index headings. A new command
6522 `outline-headers-as-kill' copies the visible headings in the region to
6523 the kill ring, e.g. to produce a table of contents.
6524
6525 ** Changes to Emacs Server
6526
6527 *** The new option `server-kill-new-buffers' specifies what to do
6528 with buffers when done with them. If non-nil, the default, buffers
6529 are killed, unless they were already present before visiting them with
6530 Emacs Server. If nil, `server-temp-file-regexp' specifies which
6531 buffers to kill, as before.
6532
6533 Please note that only buffers are killed that still have a client,
6534 i.e. buffers visited with `emacsclient --no-wait' are never killed in
6535 this way.
6536
6537 ** Both emacsclient and Emacs itself now accept command line options
6538 of the form +LINE:COLUMN in addition to +LINE.
6539
6540 ** Changes to Show Paren mode.
6541
6542 *** Overlays used by Show Paren mode now use a priority property.
6543 The new user option show-paren-priority specifies the priority to
6544 use. Default is 1000.
6545
6546 ** New command M-x check-parens can be used to find unbalanced paren
6547 groups and strings in buffers in Lisp mode (or other modes).
6548
6549 ** Changes to hideshow.el
6550
6551 *** Generalized block selection and traversal
6552
6553 A block is now recognized by its start and end regexps (both strings),
6554 and an integer specifying which sub-expression in the start regexp
6555 serves as the place where a `forward-sexp'-like function can operate.
6556 See the documentation of variable `hs-special-modes-alist'.
6557
6558 *** During incremental search, if Hideshow minor mode is active,
6559 hidden blocks are temporarily shown. The variable `hs-headline' can
6560 be used in the mode line format to show the line at the beginning of
6561 the open block.
6562
6563 *** User option `hs-hide-all-non-comment-function' specifies a
6564 function to be called at each top-level block beginning, instead of
6565 the normal block-hiding function.
6566
6567 *** The command `hs-show-region' has been removed.
6568
6569 *** The key bindings have changed to fit the Emacs conventions,
6570 roughly imitating those of Outline minor mode. Notably, the prefix
6571 for all bindings is now `C-c @'. For details, see the documentation
6572 for `hs-minor-mode'.
6573
6574 *** The variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' has been removed, and
6575 hideshow.el now always behaves as if this variable were set to t.
6576
6577 ** Changes to Change Log mode and Add-Log functions
6578
6579 *** If you invoke `add-change-log-entry' from a backup file, it makes
6580 an entry appropriate for the file's parent. This is useful for making
6581 log entries by comparing a version with deleted functions.
6582
6583 **** New command M-x change-log-merge merges another log into the
6584 current buffer.
6585
6586 *** New command M-x change-log-redate fixes any old-style date entries
6587 in a log file.
6588
6589 *** Change Log mode now adds a file's version number to change log
6590 entries if user-option `change-log-version-info-enabled' is non-nil.
6591 Unless the file is under version control the search for a file's
6592 version number is performed based on regular expressions from
6593 `change-log-version-number-regexp-list' which can be customized.
6594 Version numbers are only found in the first 10 percent of a file.
6595
6596 *** Change Log mode now defines its own faces for font-lock highlighting.
6597
6598 ** Changes to cmuscheme
6599
6600 *** The user-option `scheme-program-name' has been renamed
6601 `cmuscheme-program-name' due to conflicts with xscheme.el.
6602
6603 ** Changes in Font Lock
6604
6605 *** The new function `font-lock-remove-keywords' can be used to remove
6606 font-lock keywords from the current buffer or from a specific major mode.
6607
6608 *** Multi-line patterns are now supported. Modes using this, should
6609 set font-lock-multiline to t in their font-lock-defaults.
6610
6611 *** `font-lock-syntactic-face-function' allows major-modes to choose
6612 the face used for each string/comment.
6613
6614 *** A new standard face `font-lock-doc-face'.
6615 Meant for Lisp docstrings, Javadoc comments and other "documentation in code".
6616
6617 ** Changes to Shell mode
6618
6619 *** The `shell' command now accepts an optional argument to specify the buffer
6620 to use, which defaults to "*shell*". When used interactively, a
6621 non-default buffer may be specified by giving the `shell' command a
6622 prefix argument (causing it to prompt for the buffer name).
6623
6624 ** Comint (subshell) changes
6625
6626 These changes generally affect all modes derived from comint mode, which
6627 include shell-mode, gdb-mode, scheme-interaction-mode, etc.
6628
6629 *** Comint now by default interprets some carriage-control characters.
6630 Comint now removes CRs from CR LF sequences, and treats single CRs and
6631 BSs in the output in a way similar to a terminal (by deleting to the
6632 beginning of the line, or deleting the previous character,
6633 respectively). This is achieved by adding `comint-carriage-motion' to
6634 the `comint-output-filter-functions' hook by default.
6635
6636 *** By default, comint no longer uses the variable `comint-prompt-regexp'
6637 to distinguish prompts from user-input. Instead, it notices which
6638 parts of the text were output by the process, and which entered by the
6639 user, and attaches `field' properties to allow emacs commands to use
6640 this information. Common movement commands, notably beginning-of-line,
6641 respect field boundaries in a fairly natural manner. To disable this
6642 feature, and use the old behavior, customize the user option
6643 `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields'.
6644
6645 *** Comint now includes new features to send commands to running processes
6646 and redirect the output to a designated buffer or buffers.
6647
6648 *** The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command reads a command and
6649 buffer name from the mini-buffer. The command is sent to the current
6650 buffer's process, and its output is inserted into the specified buffer.
6651
6652 The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command-to-process acts like
6653 M-x comint-redirect-send-command but additionally reads the name of
6654 the buffer whose process should be used from the mini-buffer.
6655
6656 *** Packages based on comint now highlight user input and program prompts,
6657 and support choosing previous input with mouse-2. To control these features,
6658 see the user-options `comint-highlight-input' and `comint-highlight-prompt'.
6659
6660 *** The new command `comint-write-output' (usually bound to `C-c C-s')
6661 saves the output from the most recent command to a file. With a prefix
6662 argument, it appends to the file.
6663
6664 *** The command `comint-kill-output' has been renamed `comint-delete-output'
6665 (usually bound to `C-c C-o'); the old name is aliased to it for
6666 compatibility.
6667
6668 *** The new function `comint-add-to-input-history' adds commands to the input
6669 ring (history).
6670
6671 *** The new variable `comint-input-history-ignore' is a regexp for
6672 identifying history lines that should be ignored, like tcsh time-stamp
6673 strings, starting with a `#'. The default value of this variable is "^#".
6674
6675 ** Changes to Rmail mode
6676
6677 *** The new user-option rmail-user-mail-address-regexp can be
6678 set to fine tune the identification of the correspondent when
6679 receiving new mail. If it matches the address of the sender, the
6680 recipient is taken as correspondent of a mail. If nil, the default,
6681 `user-login-name' and `user-mail-address' are used to exclude yourself
6682 as correspondent.
6683
6684 Usually you don't have to set this variable, except if you collect
6685 mails sent by you under different user names. Then it should be a
6686 regexp matching your mail addresses.
6687
6688 *** The new user-option rmail-confirm-expunge controls whether and how
6689 to ask for confirmation before expunging deleted messages from an
6690 Rmail file. You can choose between no confirmation, confirmation
6691 with y-or-n-p, or confirmation with yes-or-no-p. Default is to ask
6692 for confirmation with yes-or-no-p.
6693
6694 *** RET is now bound in the Rmail summary to rmail-summary-goto-msg,
6695 like `j'.
6696
6697 *** There is a new user option `rmail-digest-end-regexps' that
6698 specifies the regular expressions to detect the line that ends a
6699 digest message.
6700
6701 *** The new user option `rmail-automatic-folder-directives' specifies
6702 in which folder to put messages automatically.
6703
6704 *** The new function `rmail-redecode-body' allows to fix a message
6705 with non-ASCII characters if Emacs happens to decode it incorrectly
6706 due to missing or malformed "charset=" header.
6707
6708 ** The new user-option `mail-envelope-from' can be used to specify
6709 an envelope-from address different from user-mail-address.
6710
6711 ** The variable mail-specify-envelope-from controls whether to
6712 use the -f option when sending mail.
6713
6714 ** The Rmail command `o' (`rmail-output-to-rmail-file') now writes the
6715 current message in the internal `emacs-mule' encoding, rather than in
6716 the encoding taken from the variable `buffer-file-coding-system'.
6717 This allows to save messages whose characters cannot be safely encoded
6718 by the buffer's coding system, and makes sure the message will be
6719 displayed correctly when you later visit the target Rmail file.
6720
6721 If you want your Rmail files be encoded in a specific coding system
6722 other than `emacs-mule', you can customize the variable
6723 `rmail-file-coding-system' to set its value to that coding system.
6724
6725 ** Changes to TeX mode
6726
6727 *** The default mode has been changed from `plain-tex-mode' to
6728 `latex-mode'.
6729
6730 *** latex-mode now has a simple indentation algorithm.
6731
6732 *** M-f and M-p jump around \begin...\end pairs.
6733
6734 *** Added support for outline-minor-mode.
6735
6736 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
6737
6738 *** RefTeX has new support for index generation. Index entries can be
6739 created with `C-c <', with completion available on index keys.
6740 Pressing `C-c /' indexes the word at the cursor with a default
6741 macro. `C-c >' compiles all index entries into an alphabetically
6742 sorted *Index* buffer which looks like the final index. Entries
6743 can be edited from that buffer.
6744
6745 *** Label and citation key selection now allow to select several
6746 items and reference them together (use `m' to mark items, `a' or
6747 `A' to use all marked entries).
6748
6749 *** reftex.el has been split into a number of smaller files to reduce
6750 memory use when only a part of RefTeX is being used.
6751
6752 *** a new command `reftex-view-crossref-from-bibtex' (bound to `C-c &'
6753 in BibTeX-mode) can be called in a BibTeX database buffer in order
6754 to show locations in LaTeX documents where a particular entry has
6755 been cited.
6756
6757 ** Emacs Lisp mode now allows multiple levels of outline headings.
6758 The level of a heading is determined from the number of leading
6759 semicolons in a heading line. Toplevel forms starting with a `('
6760 in column 1 are always made leaves.
6761
6762 ** The M-x time-stamp command (most commonly used on write-file-hooks)
6763 has the following new features:
6764
6765 *** The patterns for finding the time stamp and for updating a pattern
6766 may match text spanning multiple lines. For example, some people like
6767 to have the filename and date on separate lines. The new variable
6768 time-stamp-inserts-lines controls the matching for multi-line patterns.
6769
6770 *** More than one time stamp can be updated in the same file. This
6771 feature is useful if you need separate time stamps in a program source
6772 file to both include in formatted documentation and insert in the
6773 compiled binary. The same time-stamp will be written at each matching
6774 pattern. The variable time-stamp-count enables this new feature; it
6775 defaults to 1.
6776
6777 ** Partial Completion mode now completes environment variables in
6778 file names.
6779
6780 ** Ispell changes
6781
6782 *** The command `ispell' now spell-checks a region if
6783 transient-mark-mode is on, and the mark is active. Otherwise it
6784 spell-checks the current buffer.
6785
6786 *** Support for synchronous subprocesses - DOS/Windoze - has been
6787 added.
6788
6789 *** An "alignment error" bug was fixed when a manual spelling
6790 correction is made and re-checked.
6791
6792 *** Italian, Portuguese, and Slovak dictionary definitions have been added.
6793
6794 *** Region skipping performance has been vastly improved in some
6795 cases.
6796
6797 *** Spell checking HTML buffers has been improved and isn't so strict
6798 on syntax errors.
6799
6800 *** The buffer-local words are now always placed on a new line at the
6801 end of the buffer.
6802
6803 *** Spell checking now works in the MS-DOS version of Emacs.
6804
6805 ** Makefile mode changes
6806
6807 *** The mode now uses the abbrev table `makefile-mode-abbrev-table'.
6808
6809 *** Conditionals and include statements are now highlighted when
6810 Fontlock mode is active.
6811
6812 ** Isearch changes
6813
6814 *** Isearch now puts a call to `isearch-resume' in the command history,
6815 so that searches can be resumed.
6816
6817 *** In Isearch mode, C-M-s and C-M-r are now bound like C-s and C-r,
6818 respectively, i.e. you can repeat a regexp isearch with the same keys
6819 that started the search.
6820
6821 *** In Isearch mode, mouse-2 in the echo area now yanks the current
6822 selection into the search string rather than giving an error.
6823
6824 *** There is a new lazy highlighting feature in incremental search.
6825
6826 Lazy highlighting is switched on/off by customizing variable
6827 `isearch-lazy-highlight'. When active, all matches for the current
6828 search string are highlighted. The current match is highlighted as
6829 before using face `isearch' or `region'. All other matches are
6830 highlighted using face `isearch-lazy-highlight-face' which defaults to
6831 `secondary-selection'.
6832
6833 The extra highlighting makes it easier to anticipate where the cursor
6834 will end up each time you press C-s or C-r to repeat a pending search.
6835 Highlighting of these additional matches happens in a deferred fashion
6836 using "idle timers," so the cycles needed do not rob isearch of its
6837 usual snappy response.
6838
6839 If `isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup' is set to t, highlights for
6840 matches are automatically cleared when you end the search. If it is
6841 set to nil, you can remove the highlights manually with `M-x
6842 isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup'.
6843
6844 ** VC Changes
6845
6846 VC has been overhauled internally. It is now modular, making it
6847 easier to plug-in arbitrary version control backends. (See Lisp
6848 Changes for details on the new structure.) As a result, the mechanism
6849 to enable and disable support for particular version systems has
6850 changed: everything is now controlled by the new variable
6851 `vc-handled-backends'. Its value is a list of symbols that identify
6852 version systems; the default is '(RCS CVS SCCS). When finding a file,
6853 each of the backends in that list is tried in order to see whether the
6854 file is registered in that backend.
6855
6856 When registering a new file, VC first tries each of the listed
6857 backends to see if any of them considers itself "responsible" for the
6858 directory of the file (e.g. because a corresponding subdirectory for
6859 master files exists). If none of the backends is responsible, then
6860 the first backend in the list that could register the file is chosen.
6861 As a consequence, the variable `vc-default-back-end' is now obsolete.
6862
6863 The old variable `vc-master-templates' is also obsolete, although VC
6864 still supports it for backward compatibility. To define templates for
6865 RCS or SCCS, you should rather use the new variables
6866 vc-{rcs,sccs}-master-templates. (There is no such feature under CVS
6867 where it doesn't make sense.)
6868
6869 The variables `vc-ignore-vc-files' and `vc-handle-cvs' are also
6870 obsolete now, you must set `vc-handled-backends' to nil or exclude
6871 `CVS' from the list, respectively, to achieve their effect now.
6872
6873 *** General Changes
6874
6875 The variable `vc-checkout-carefully' is obsolete: the corresponding
6876 checks are always done now.
6877
6878 VC Dired buffers are now kept up-to-date during all version control
6879 operations.
6880
6881 `vc-diff' output is now displayed in `diff-mode'.
6882 `vc-print-log' uses `log-view-mode'.
6883 `vc-log-mode' (used for *VC-Log*) has been replaced by `log-edit-mode'.
6884
6885 The command C-x v m (vc-merge) now accepts an empty argument as the
6886 first revision number. This means that any recent changes on the
6887 current branch should be picked up from the repository and merged into
6888 the working file (``merge news'').
6889
6890 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
6891 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) now ask for a directory name from which to work
6892 downwards.
6893
6894 *** Multiple Backends
6895
6896 VC now lets you register files in more than one backend. This is
6897 useful, for example, if you are working with a slow remote CVS
6898 repository. You can then use RCS for local editing, and occasionally
6899 commit your changes back to CVS, or pick up changes from CVS into your
6900 local RCS archives.
6901
6902 To make this work, the ``more local'' backend (RCS in our example)
6903 should come first in `vc-handled-backends', and the ``more remote''
6904 backend (CVS) should come later. (The default value of
6905 `vc-handled-backends' already has it that way.)
6906
6907 You can then commit changes to another backend (say, RCS), by typing
6908 C-u C-x v v RCS RET (i.e. vc-next-action now accepts a backend name as
6909 a revision number). VC registers the file in the more local backend
6910 if that hasn't already happened, and commits to a branch based on the
6911 current revision number from the more remote backend.
6912
6913 If a file is registered in multiple backends, you can switch to
6914 another one using C-x v b (vc-switch-backend). This does not change
6915 any files, it only changes VC's perspective on the file. Use this to
6916 pick up changes from CVS while working under RCS locally.
6917
6918 After you are done with your local RCS editing, you can commit your
6919 changes back to CVS using C-u C-x v v CVS RET. In this case, the
6920 local RCS archive is removed after the commit, and the log entry
6921 buffer is initialized to contain the entire RCS change log of the file.
6922
6923 *** Changes for CVS
6924
6925 There is a new user option, `vc-cvs-stay-local'. If it is `t' (the
6926 default), then VC avoids network queries for files registered in
6927 remote repositories. The state of such files is then only determined
6928 by heuristics and past information. `vc-cvs-stay-local' can also be a
6929 regexp to match against repository hostnames; only files from hosts
6930 that match it are treated locally. If the variable is nil, then VC
6931 queries the repository just as often as it does for local files.
6932
6933 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, then VC also makes local backups of
6934 repository versions. This means that ordinary diffs (C-x v =) and
6935 revert operations (C-x v u) can be done completely locally, without
6936 any repository interactions at all. The name of a local version
6937 backup of FILE is FILE.~REV.~, where REV is the repository version
6938 number. This format is similar to that used by C-x v ~
6939 (vc-version-other-window), except for the trailing dot. As a matter
6940 of fact, the two features can each use the files created by the other,
6941 the only difference being that files with a trailing `.' are deleted
6942 automatically after commit. (This feature doesn't work on MS-DOS,
6943 since DOS disallows more than a single dot in the trunk of a file
6944 name.)
6945
6946 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, and there have been changes in the
6947 repository, VC notifies you about it when you actually try to commit.
6948 If you want to check for updates from the repository without trying to
6949 commit, you can either use C-x v m RET to perform an update on the
6950 current file, or you can use C-x v r RET to get an update for an
6951 entire directory tree.
6952
6953 The new user option `vc-cvs-use-edit' indicates whether VC should call
6954 "cvs edit" to make files writeable; it defaults to `t'. (This option
6955 is only meaningful if the CVSREAD variable is set, or if files are
6956 "watched" by other developers.)
6957
6958 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
6959 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) are now also implemented for CVS. If you give
6960 an empty snapshot name to the latter, that performs a `cvs update',
6961 starting at the given directory.
6962
6963 *** Lisp Changes in VC
6964
6965 VC has been restructured internally to make it modular. You can now
6966 add support for arbitrary version control backends by writing a
6967 library that provides a certain set of backend-specific functions, and
6968 then telling VC to use that library. For example, to add support for
6969 a version system named SYS, you write a library named vc-sys.el, which
6970 provides a number of functions vc-sys-... (see commentary at the top
6971 of vc.el for a detailed list of them). To make VC use that library,
6972 you need to put it somewhere into Emacs' load path and add the symbol
6973 `SYS' to the list `vc-handled-backends'.
6974
6975 ** The customizable EDT emulation package now supports the EDT
6976 SUBS command and EDT scroll margins. It also works with more
6977 terminal/keyboard configurations and it now works under XEmacs.
6978 See etc/edt-user.doc for more information.
6979
6980 ** New modes and packages
6981
6982 *** The new global minor mode `minibuffer-electric-default-mode'
6983 automatically hides the `(default ...)' part of minibuffer prompts when
6984 the default is not applicable.
6985
6986 *** Artist is an Emacs lisp package that allows you to draw lines,
6987 rectangles and ellipses by using your mouse and/or keyboard. The
6988 shapes are made up with the ascii characters |, -, / and \.
6989
6990 Features are:
6991
6992 - Intersecting: When a `|' intersects with a `-', a `+' is
6993 drawn, like this: | \ /
6994 --+-- X
6995 | / \
6996
6997 - Rubber-banding: When drawing lines you can interactively see the
6998 result while holding the mouse button down and moving the mouse. If
6999 your machine is not fast enough (a 386 is a bit too slow, but a
7000 pentium is well enough), you can turn this feature off. You will
7001 then see 1's and 2's which mark the 1st and 2nd endpoint of the line
7002 you are drawing.
7003
7004 - Arrows: After having drawn a (straight) line or a (straight)
7005 poly-line, you can set arrows on the line-ends by typing < or >.
7006
7007 - Flood-filling: You can fill any area with a certain character by
7008 flood-filling.
7009
7010 - Cut copy and paste: You can cut, copy and paste rectangular
7011 regions. Artist also interfaces with the rect package (this can be
7012 turned off if it causes you any trouble) so anything you cut in
7013 artist can be yanked with C-x r y and vice versa.
7014
7015 - Drawing with keys: Everything you can do with the mouse, you can
7016 also do without the mouse.
7017
7018 - Aspect-ratio: You can set the variable artist-aspect-ratio to
7019 reflect the height-width ratio for the font you are using. Squares
7020 and circles are then drawn square/round. Note, that once your
7021 ascii-file is shown with font with a different height-width ratio,
7022 the squares won't be square and the circles won't be round.
7023
7024 - Drawing operations: The following drawing operations are implemented:
7025
7026 lines straight-lines
7027 rectangles squares
7028 poly-lines straight poly-lines
7029 ellipses circles
7030 text (see-thru) text (overwrite)
7031 spray-can setting size for spraying
7032 vaporize line vaporize lines
7033 erase characters erase rectangles
7034
7035 Straight lines are lines that go horizontally, vertically or
7036 diagonally. Plain lines go in any direction. The operations in
7037 the right column are accessed by holding down the shift key while
7038 drawing.
7039
7040 It is possible to vaporize (erase) entire lines and connected lines
7041 (rectangles for example) as long as the lines being vaporized are
7042 straight and connected at their endpoints. Vaporizing is inspired
7043 by the drawrect package by Jari Aalto <jari.aalto@poboxes.com>.
7044
7045 - Picture mode compatibility: Artist is picture mode compatible (this
7046 can be turned off).
7047
7048 *** The new package Eshell is an operating system command shell
7049 implemented entirely in Emacs Lisp. Use `M-x eshell' to invoke it.
7050 It functions similarly to bash and zsh, and allows running of Lisp
7051 functions and external commands using the same syntax. It supports
7052 history lists, aliases, extended globbing, smart scrolling, etc. It
7053 will work on any platform Emacs has been ported to. And since most of
7054 the basic commands -- ls, rm, mv, cp, ln, du, cat, etc. -- have been
7055 rewritten in Lisp, it offers an operating-system independent shell,
7056 all within the scope of your Emacs process.
7057
7058 *** The new package timeclock.el is a mode is for keeping track of time
7059 intervals. You can use it for whatever purpose you like, but the
7060 typical scenario is to keep track of how much time you spend working
7061 on certain projects.
7062
7063 *** The new package hi-lock.el provides commands to highlight matches
7064 of interactively entered regexps. For example,
7065
7066 M-x highlight-regexp RET clearly RET RET
7067
7068 will highlight all occurrences of `clearly' using a yellow background
7069 face. New occurrences of `clearly' will be highlighted as they are
7070 typed. `M-x unhighlight-regexp RET' will remove the highlighting.
7071 Any existing face can be used for highlighting and a set of
7072 appropriate faces is provided. The regexps can be written into the
7073 current buffer in a form that will be recognized the next time the
7074 corresponding file is read. There are commands to highlight matches
7075 to phrases and to highlight entire lines containing a match.
7076
7077 *** The new package zone.el plays games with Emacs' display when
7078 Emacs is idle.
7079
7080 *** The new package tildify.el allows to add hard spaces or other text
7081 fragments in accordance with the current major mode.
7082
7083 *** The new package xml.el provides a simple but generic XML
7084 parser. It doesn't parse the DTDs however.
7085
7086 *** The comment operations are now provided by the newcomment.el
7087 package which allows different styles of comment-region and should
7088 be more robust while offering the same functionality.
7089 `comment-region' now doesn't always comment a-line-at-a-time, but only
7090 comments the region, breaking the line at point if necessary.
7091
7092 *** The Ebrowse package implements a C++ class browser and tags
7093 facilities tailored for use with C++. It is documented in a
7094 separate Texinfo file.
7095
7096 *** The PCL-CVS package available by either running M-x cvs-examine or
7097 by visiting a CVS administrative directory (with a prefix argument)
7098 provides an alternative interface to VC-dired for CVS. It comes with
7099 `log-view-mode' to view RCS and SCCS logs and `log-edit-mode' used to
7100 enter check-in log messages.
7101
7102 *** The new package called `woman' allows to browse Unix man pages
7103 without invoking external programs.
7104
7105 The command `M-x woman' formats manual pages entirely in Emacs Lisp
7106 and then displays them, like `M-x manual-entry' does. Unlike
7107 `manual-entry', `woman' does not invoke any external programs, so it
7108 is useful on systems such as MS-DOS/MS-Windows where the `man' and
7109 Groff or `troff' commands are not readily available.
7110
7111 The command `M-x woman-find-file' asks for the file name of a man
7112 page, then formats and displays it like `M-x woman' does.
7113
7114 *** The new command M-x re-builder offers a convenient interface for
7115 authoring regular expressions with immediate visual feedback.
7116
7117 The buffer from which the command was called becomes the target for
7118 the regexp editor popping up in a separate window. Matching text in
7119 the target buffer is immediately color marked during the editing.
7120 Each sub-expression of the regexp will show up in a different face so
7121 even complex regexps can be edited and verified on target data in a
7122 single step.
7123
7124 On displays not supporting faces the matches instead blink like
7125 matching parens to make them stand out. On such a setup you will
7126 probably also want to use the sub-expression mode when the regexp
7127 contains such to get feedback about their respective limits.
7128
7129 *** glasses-mode is a minor mode that makes
7130 unreadableIdentifiersLikeThis readable. It works as glasses, without
7131 actually modifying content of a buffer.
7132
7133 *** The package ebnf2ps translates an EBNF to a syntactic chart in
7134 PostScript.
7135
7136 Currently accepts ad-hoc EBNF, ISO EBNF and Bison/Yacc.
7137
7138 The ad-hoc default EBNF syntax has the following elements:
7139
7140 ; comment (until end of line)
7141 A non-terminal
7142 "C" terminal
7143 ?C? special
7144 $A default non-terminal
7145 $"C" default terminal
7146 $?C? default special
7147 A = B. production (A is the header and B the body)
7148 C D sequence (C occurs before D)
7149 C | D alternative (C or D occurs)
7150 A - B exception (A excluding B, B without any non-terminal)
7151 n * A repetition (A repeats n (integer) times)
7152 (C) group (expression C is grouped together)
7153 [C] optional (C may or not occurs)
7154 C+ one or more occurrences of C
7155 {C}+ one or more occurrences of C
7156 {C}* zero or more occurrences of C
7157 {C} zero or more occurrences of C
7158 C / D equivalent to: C {D C}*
7159 {C || D}+ equivalent to: C {D C}*
7160 {C || D}* equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
7161 {C || D} equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
7162
7163 Please, see ebnf2ps documentation for EBNF syntax and how to use it.
7164
7165 *** The package align.el will align columns within a region, using M-x
7166 align. Its mode-specific rules, based on regular expressions,
7167 determine where the columns should be split. In C and C++, for
7168 example, it will align variable names in declaration lists, or the
7169 equal signs of assignments.
7170
7171 *** `paragraph-indent-minor-mode' is a new minor mode supporting
7172 paragraphs in the same style as `paragraph-indent-text-mode'.
7173
7174 *** bs.el is a new package for buffer selection similar to
7175 list-buffers or electric-buffer-list. Use M-x bs-show to display a
7176 buffer menu with this package. See the Custom group `bs'.
7177
7178 *** find-lisp.el is a package emulating the Unix find command in Lisp.
7179
7180 *** calculator.el is a small calculator package that is intended to
7181 replace desktop calculators such as xcalc and calc.exe. Actually, it
7182 is not too small - it has more features than most desktop calculators,
7183 and can be customized easily to get many more functions. It should
7184 not be confused with "calc" which is a much bigger mathematical tool
7185 which answers different needs.
7186
7187 *** The minor modes cwarn-mode and global-cwarn-mode highlights
7188 suspicious C and C++ constructions. Currently, assignments inside
7189 expressions, semicolon following `if', `for' and `while' (except, of
7190 course, after a `do .. while' statement), and C++ functions with
7191 reference parameters are recognized. The modes require font-lock mode
7192 to be enabled.
7193
7194 *** smerge-mode.el provides `smerge-mode', a simple minor-mode for files
7195 containing diff3-style conflict markers, such as generated by RCS.
7196
7197 *** 5x5.el is a simple puzzle game.
7198
7199 *** hl-line.el provides `hl-line-mode', a minor mode to highlight the
7200 current line in the current buffer. It also provides
7201 `global-hl-line-mode' to provide the same behavior in all buffers.
7202
7203 *** ansi-color.el translates ANSI terminal escapes into text-properties.
7204
7205 Please note: if `ansi-color-for-comint-mode' and
7206 `global-font-lock-mode' are non-nil, loading ansi-color.el will
7207 disable font-lock and add `ansi-color-apply' to
7208 `comint-preoutput-filter-functions' for all shell-mode buffers. This
7209 displays the output of "ls --color=yes" using the correct foreground
7210 and background colors.
7211
7212 *** delphi.el provides a major mode for editing the Delphi (Object
7213 Pascal) language.
7214
7215 *** quickurl.el provides a simple method of inserting a URL based on
7216 the text at point.
7217
7218 *** sql.el provides an interface to SQL data bases.
7219
7220 *** fortune.el uses the fortune program to create mail/news signatures.
7221
7222 *** whitespace.el is a package for warning about and cleaning bogus
7223 whitespace in a file.
7224
7225 *** PostScript mode (ps-mode) is a new major mode for editing PostScript
7226 files. It offers: interaction with a PostScript interpreter, including
7227 (very basic) error handling; fontification, easily customizable for
7228 interpreter messages; auto-indentation; insertion of EPSF templates and
7229 often used code snippets; viewing of BoundingBox; commenting out /
7230 uncommenting regions; conversion of 8bit characters to PostScript octal
7231 codes. All functionality is accessible through a menu.
7232
7233 *** delim-col helps to prettify columns in a text region or rectangle.
7234
7235 Here is an example of columns:
7236
7237 horse apple bus
7238 dog pineapple car EXTRA
7239 porcupine strawberry airplane
7240
7241 Doing the following settings:
7242
7243 (setq delimit-columns-str-before "[ ")
7244 (setq delimit-columns-str-after " ]")
7245 (setq delimit-columns-str-separator ", ")
7246 (setq delimit-columns-separator "\t")
7247
7248
7249 Selecting the lines above and typing:
7250
7251 M-x delimit-columns-region
7252
7253 It results:
7254
7255 [ horse , apple , bus , ]
7256 [ dog , pineapple , car , EXTRA ]
7257 [ porcupine, strawberry, airplane, ]
7258
7259 delim-col has the following options:
7260
7261 delimit-columns-str-before Specify a string to be inserted
7262 before all columns.
7263
7264 delimit-columns-str-separator Specify a string to be inserted
7265 between each column.
7266
7267 delimit-columns-str-after Specify a string to be inserted
7268 after all columns.
7269
7270 delimit-columns-separator Specify a regexp which separates
7271 each column.
7272
7273 delim-col has the following commands:
7274
7275 delimit-columns-region Prettify all columns in a text region.
7276 delimit-columns-rectangle Prettify all columns in a text rectangle.
7277
7278 *** Recentf mode maintains a menu for visiting files that were
7279 operated on recently. User option recentf-menu-filter specifies a
7280 menu filter function to change the menu appearance. For example, the
7281 recent file list can be displayed:
7282
7283 - organized by major modes, directories or user defined rules.
7284 - sorted by file paths, file names, ascending or descending.
7285 - showing paths relative to the current default-directory
7286
7287 The `recentf-filter-changer' menu filter function allows to
7288 dynamically change the menu appearance.
7289
7290 *** elide-head.el provides a mechanism for eliding boilerplate header
7291 text.
7292
7293 *** footnote.el provides `footnote-mode', a minor mode supporting use
7294 of footnotes. It is intended for use with Message mode, but isn't
7295 specific to Message mode.
7296
7297 *** diff-mode.el provides `diff-mode', a major mode for
7298 viewing/editing context diffs (patches). It is selected for files
7299 with extension `.diff', `.diffs', `.patch' and `.rej'.
7300
7301 *** EUDC, the Emacs Unified Directory Client, provides a common user
7302 interface to access directory servers using different directory
7303 protocols. It has a separate manual.
7304
7305 *** autoconf.el provides a major mode for editing configure.in files
7306 for Autoconf, selected automatically.
7307
7308 *** windmove.el provides moving between windows.
7309
7310 *** crm.el provides a facility to read multiple strings from the
7311 minibuffer with completion.
7312
7313 *** todo-mode.el provides management of TODO lists and integration
7314 with the diary features.
7315
7316 *** autoarg.el provides a feature reported from Twenex Emacs whereby
7317 numeric keys supply prefix args rather than self inserting.
7318
7319 *** The function `turn-off-auto-fill' unconditionally turns off Auto
7320 Fill mode.
7321
7322 *** pcomplete.el is a library that provides programmable completion
7323 facilities for Emacs, similar to what zsh and tcsh offer. The main
7324 difference is that completion functions are written in Lisp, meaning
7325 they can be profiled, debugged, etc.
7326
7327 *** antlr-mode is a new major mode for editing ANTLR grammar files.
7328 It is automatically turned on for files whose names have the extension
7329 `.g'.
7330
7331 ** Changes in sort.el
7332
7333 The function sort-numeric-fields interprets numbers starting with `0'
7334 as octal and numbers starting with `0x' or `0X' as hexadecimal. The
7335 new user-option sort-numeric-base can be used to specify a default
7336 numeric base.
7337
7338 ** Changes to Ange-ftp
7339
7340 *** Ange-ftp allows you to specify of a port number in remote file
7341 names cleanly. It is appended to the host name, separated by a hash
7342 sign, e.g. `/foo@bar.org#666:mumble'. (This syntax comes from EFS.)
7343
7344 *** If the new user-option `ange-ftp-try-passive-mode' is set, passive
7345 ftp mode will be used if the ftp client supports that.
7346
7347 *** Ange-ftp handles the output of the w32-style clients which
7348 output ^M at the end of lines.
7349
7350 ** The recommended way of using Iswitchb is via the new global minor
7351 mode `iswitchb-mode'.
7352
7353 ** Just loading the msb package doesn't switch on Msb mode anymore.
7354 If you have `(require 'msb)' in your .emacs, please replace it with
7355 `(msb-mode 1)'.
7356
7357 ** Flyspell mode has various new options. See the `flyspell' Custom
7358 group.
7359
7360 ** The user option `backward-delete-char-untabify-method' controls the
7361 behavior of `backward-delete-char-untabify'. The following values
7362 are recognized:
7363
7364 `untabify' -- turn a tab to many spaces, then delete one space;
7365 `hungry' -- delete all whitespace, both tabs and spaces;
7366 `all' -- delete all whitespace, including tabs, spaces and newlines;
7367 nil -- just delete one character.
7368
7369 Default value is `untabify'.
7370
7371 [This change was made in Emacs 20.3 but not mentioned then.]
7372
7373 ** In Cperl mode `cperl-invalid-face' should now be a normal face
7374 symbol, not double-quoted.
7375
7376 ** Some packages are declared obsolete, to be removed in a future
7377 version. They are: auto-show, c-mode, hilit19, hscroll, ooutline,
7378 profile, rnews, rnewspost, and sc. Their implementations have been
7379 moved to lisp/obsolete.
7380
7381 ** auto-compression mode is no longer enabled just by loading jka-compr.el.
7382 To control it, set `auto-compression-mode' via Custom or use the
7383 `auto-compression-mode' command.
7384
7385 ** `browse-url-gnome-moz' is a new option for
7386 `browse-url-browser-function', invoking Mozilla in GNOME, and
7387 `browse-url-kde' can be chosen for invoking the KDE browser.
7388
7389 ** The user-option `browse-url-new-window-p' has been renamed to
7390 `browse-url-new-window-flag'.
7391
7392 ** The functions `keep-lines', `flush-lines' and `how-many' now
7393 operate on the active region in Transient Mark mode.
7394
7395 ** `gnus-user-agent' is a new possibility for `mail-user-agent'. It
7396 is like `message-user-agent', but with all the Gnus paraphernalia.
7397
7398 ** The Strokes package has been updated. If your Emacs has XPM
7399 support, you can use it for pictographic editing. In Strokes mode,
7400 use C-mouse-2 to compose a complex stoke and insert it into the
7401 buffer. You can encode or decode a strokes buffer with new commands
7402 M-x strokes-encode-buffer and M-x strokes-decode-buffer. There is a
7403 new command M-x strokes-list-strokes.
7404
7405 ** Hexl contains a new command `hexl-insert-hex-string' which inserts
7406 a string of hexadecimal numbers read from the mini-buffer.
7407
7408 ** Hexl mode allows to insert non-ASCII characters.
7409
7410 The non-ASCII characters are encoded using the same encoding as the
7411 file you are visiting in Hexl mode.
7412
7413 ** Shell script mode changes.
7414
7415 Shell script mode (sh-script) can now indent scripts for shells
7416 derived from sh and rc. The indentation style is customizable, and
7417 sh-script can attempt to "learn" the current buffer's style.
7418
7419 ** Etags changes.
7420
7421 *** In DOS, etags looks for file.cgz if it cannot find file.c.
7422
7423 *** New option --ignore-case-regex is an alternative to --regex. It is now
7424 possible to bind a regexp to a language, by prepending the regexp with
7425 {lang}, where lang is one of the languages that `etags --help' prints out.
7426 This feature is useful especially for regex files, where each line contains
7427 a regular expression. The manual contains details.
7428
7429 *** In C and derived languages, etags creates tags for function
7430 declarations when given the --declarations option.
7431
7432 *** In C++, tags are created for "operator". The tags have the form
7433 "operator+", without spaces between the keyword and the operator.
7434
7435 *** You shouldn't generally need any more the -C or -c++ option: etags
7436 automatically switches to C++ parsing when it meets the `class' or
7437 `template' keywords.
7438
7439 *** Etags now is able to delve at arbitrary deeps into nested structures in
7440 C-like languages. Previously, it was limited to one or two brace levels.
7441
7442 *** New language Ada: tags are functions, procedures, packages, tasks, and
7443 types.
7444
7445 *** In Fortran, `procedure' is not tagged.
7446
7447 *** In Java, tags are created for "interface".
7448
7449 *** In Lisp, "(defstruct (foo", "(defun (operator" and similar constructs
7450 are now tagged.
7451
7452 *** In makefiles, tags the targets.
7453
7454 *** In Perl, the --globals option tags global variables. my and local
7455 variables are tagged.
7456
7457 *** New language Python: def and class at the beginning of a line are tags.
7458
7459 *** .ss files are Scheme files, .pdb is Postscript with C syntax, .psw is
7460 for PSWrap.
7461
7462 ** Changes in etags.el
7463
7464 *** The new user-option tags-case-fold-search can be used to make
7465 tags operations case-sensitive or case-insensitive. The default
7466 is to use the same setting as case-fold-search.
7467
7468 *** You can display additional output with M-x tags-apropos by setting
7469 the new variable tags-apropos-additional-actions.
7470
7471 If non-nil, the variable's value should be a list of triples (TITLE
7472 FUNCTION TO-SEARCH). For each triple, M-x tags-apropos processes
7473 TO-SEARCH and lists tags from it. TO-SEARCH should be an alist,
7474 obarray, or symbol. If it is a symbol, the symbol's value is used.
7475
7476 TITLE is a string to use to label the list of tags from TO-SEARCH.
7477
7478 FUNCTION is a function to call when an entry is selected in the Tags
7479 List buffer. It is called with one argument, the selected symbol.
7480
7481 A useful example value for this variable might be something like:
7482
7483 '(("Emacs Lisp" Info-goto-emacs-command-node obarray)
7484 ("Common Lisp" common-lisp-hyperspec common-lisp-hyperspec-obarray)
7485 ("SCWM" scwm-documentation scwm-obarray))
7486
7487 *** The face tags-tag-face can be used to customize the appearance
7488 of tags in the output of M-x tags-apropos.
7489
7490 *** Setting tags-apropos-verbose to a non-nil value displays the
7491 names of tags files in the *Tags List* buffer.
7492
7493 *** You can now search for tags that are part of the filename itself.
7494 If you have tagged the files topfile.c subdir/subfile.c
7495 /tmp/tempfile.c, you can now search for tags "topfile.c", "subfile.c",
7496 "dir/sub", "tempfile", "tempfile.c". If the tag matches the file name,
7497 point will go to the beginning of the file.
7498
7499 *** Compressed files are now transparently supported if
7500 auto-compression-mode is active. You can tag (with Etags) and search
7501 (with find-tag) both compressed and uncompressed files.
7502
7503 *** Tags commands like M-x tags-search no longer change point
7504 in buffers where no match is found. In buffers where a match is
7505 found, the original value of point is pushed on the marker ring.
7506
7507 ** Fortran mode has a new command `fortran-strip-sequence-nos' to
7508 remove text past column 72. The syntax class of `\' in Fortran is now
7509 appropriate for C-style escape sequences in strings.
7510
7511 ** SGML mode's default `sgml-validate-command' is now `nsgmls'.
7512
7513 ** A new command `view-emacs-problems' (C-h P) displays the PROBLEMS file.
7514
7515 ** The Dabbrev package has a new user-option `dabbrev-ignored-regexps'
7516 containing a list of regular expressions. Buffers matching a regular
7517 expression from that list, are not checked.
7518
7519 ** Emacs can now figure out modification times of remote files.
7520 When you do C-x C-f /user@host:/path/file RET and edit the file,
7521 and someone else modifies the file, you will be prompted to revert
7522 the buffer, just like for the local files.
7523
7524 ** The buffer menu (C-x C-b) no longer lists the *Buffer List* buffer.
7525
7526 ** When invoked with a prefix argument, the command `list-abbrevs' now
7527 displays local abbrevs, only.
7528
7529 ** Refill minor mode provides preliminary support for keeping
7530 paragraphs filled as you modify them.
7531
7532 ** The variable `double-click-fuzz' specifies how much the mouse
7533 may be moved between clicks that are recognized as a pair. Its value
7534 is measured in pixels.
7535
7536 ** The new global minor mode `auto-image-file-mode' allows image files
7537 to be visited as images.
7538
7539 ** Two new user-options `grep-command' and `grep-find-command'
7540 were added to compile.el.
7541
7542 ** Withdrawn packages
7543
7544 *** mldrag.el has been removed. mouse.el provides the same
7545 functionality with aliases for the mldrag functions.
7546
7547 *** eval-reg.el has been obsoleted by changes to edebug.el and removed.
7548
7549 *** ph.el has been obsoleted by EUDC and removed.
7550
7551 \f
7552 * Incompatible Lisp changes
7553
7554 There are a few Lisp changes which are not backwards-compatible and
7555 may require changes to existing code. Here is a list for reference.
7556 See the sections below for details.
7557
7558 ** Since `format' preserves text properties, the idiom
7559 `(format "%s" foo)' no longer works to copy and remove properties.
7560 Use `copy-sequence' to copy the string, then use `set-text-properties'
7561 to remove the properties of the copy.
7562
7563 ** Since the `keymap' text property now has significance, some code
7564 which uses both `local-map' and `keymap' properties (for portability)
7565 may, for instance, give rise to duplicate menus when the keymaps from
7566 these properties are active.
7567
7568 ** The change in the treatment of non-ASCII characters in search
7569 ranges may affect some code.
7570
7571 ** A non-nil value for the LOCAL arg of add-hook makes the hook
7572 buffer-local even if `make-local-hook' hasn't been called, which might
7573 make a difference to some code.
7574
7575 ** The new treatment of the minibuffer prompt might affect code which
7576 operates on the minibuffer.
7577
7578 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
7579 cause `no-conversion' and `emacs-mule-unix' coding systems to produce
7580 different results when reading files with non-ASCII characters
7581 (previously, both coding systems would produce the same results).
7582 Specifically, `no-conversion' interprets each 8-bit byte as a separate
7583 character. This makes `no-conversion' inappropriate for reading
7584 multibyte text, e.g. buffers written to disk in their internal MULE
7585 encoding (auto-saving does that, for example). If a Lisp program
7586 reads such files with `no-conversion', each byte of the multibyte
7587 sequence, including the MULE leading codes such as \201, is treated as
7588 a separate character, which prevents them from being interpreted in
7589 the buffer as multibyte characters.
7590
7591 Therefore, Lisp programs that read files which contain the internal
7592 MULE encoding should use `emacs-mule-unix'. `no-conversion' is only
7593 appropriate for reading truly binary files.
7594
7595 ** Code that relies on the obsolete `before-change-function' and
7596 `after-change-function' to detect buffer changes will now fail. Use
7597 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions' instead.
7598
7599 ** Code that uses `concat' with integer args now gets an error, as
7600 long promised. So does any code that uses derivatives of `concat',
7601 such as `mapconcat'.
7602
7603 ** The function base64-decode-string now always returns a unibyte
7604 string.
7605
7606 ** Not a Lisp incompatibility as such but, with the introduction of
7607 extra private charsets, there is now only one slot free for a new
7608 dimension-2 private charset. User code which tries to add more than
7609 one extra will fail unless you rebuild Emacs with some standard
7610 charset(s) removed; that is probably inadvisable because it changes
7611 the emacs-mule encoding. Also, files stored in the emacs-mule
7612 encoding using Emacs 20 with additional private charsets defined will
7613 probably not be read correctly by Emacs 21.
7614
7615 ** The variable `directory-sep-char' is slated for removal.
7616 Not really a change (yet), but a projected one that you should be
7617 aware of: The variable `directory-sep-char' is deprecated, and should
7618 not be used. It was always ignored on GNU/Linux and Unix systems and
7619 on MS-DOS, but the MS-Windows port tried to support it by adapting the
7620 behavior of certain primitives to the value of this variable. It
7621 turned out that such support cannot be reliable, so it was decided to
7622 remove this variable in the near future. Lisp programs are well
7623 advised not to set it to anything but '/', because any different value
7624 will not have any effect when support for this variable is removed.
7625
7626 \f
7627 * Lisp changes made after edition 2.6 of the Emacs Lisp Manual,
7628 (Display-related features are described in a page of their own below.)
7629
7630 ** Function assq-delete-all replaces function assoc-delete-all.
7631
7632 ** The new function animate-string, from lisp/play/animate.el
7633 allows the animated display of strings.
7634
7635 ** The new function `interactive-form' can be used to obtain the
7636 interactive form of a function.
7637
7638 ** The keyword :set-after in defcustom allows to specify dependencies
7639 between custom options. Example:
7640
7641 (defcustom default-input-method nil
7642 "*Default input method for multilingual text (a string).
7643 This is the input method activated automatically by the command
7644 `toggle-input-method' (\\[toggle-input-method])."
7645 :group 'mule
7646 :type '(choice (const nil) string)
7647 :set-after '(current-language-environment))
7648
7649 This specifies that default-input-method should be set after
7650 current-language-environment even if default-input-method appears
7651 first in a custom-set-variables statement.
7652
7653 ** The new hook `kbd-macro-termination-hook' is run at the end of
7654 function execute-kbd-macro. Functions on this hook are called with no
7655 args. The hook is run independent of how the macro was terminated
7656 (signal or normal termination).
7657
7658 ** Functions `butlast' and `nbutlast' for removing trailing elements
7659 from a list are now available without requiring the CL package.
7660
7661 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
7662 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
7663
7664 ** The user-option `face-font-registry-alternatives' specifies
7665 alternative font registry names to try when looking for a font.
7666
7667 ** Function `md5' calculates the MD5 "message digest"/"checksum".
7668
7669 ** Function `delete-frame' runs `delete-frame-hook' before actually
7670 deleting the frame. The hook is called with one arg, the frame
7671 being deleted.
7672
7673 ** `add-hook' now makes the hook local if called with a non-nil LOCAL arg.
7674
7675 ** The treatment of non-ASCII characters in search ranges has changed.
7676 If a range in a regular expression or the arg of
7677 skip-chars-forward/backward starts with a unibyte character C and ends
7678 with a multibyte character C2, the range is divided into two: one is
7679 C..?\377, the other is C1..C2, where C1 is the first character of C2's
7680 charset.
7681
7682 ** The new function `display-message-or-buffer' displays a message in
7683 the echo area or pops up a buffer, depending on the length of the
7684 message.
7685
7686 ** The new macro `with-auto-compression-mode' allows evaluating an
7687 expression with auto-compression-mode enabled.
7688
7689 ** In image specifications, `:heuristic-mask' has been replaced
7690 with the more general `:mask' property.
7691
7692 ** Image specifications accept more `:conversion's.
7693
7694 ** A `?' can be used in a symbol name without escaping it with a
7695 backslash.
7696
7697 ** Reading from the mini-buffer now reads from standard input if Emacs
7698 is running in batch mode. For example,
7699
7700 (message "%s" (read t))
7701
7702 will read a Lisp expression from standard input and print the result
7703 to standard output.
7704
7705 ** The argument of `down-list', `backward-up-list', `up-list',
7706 `kill-sexp', `backward-kill-sexp' and `mark-sexp' is now optional.
7707
7708 ** If `display-buffer-reuse-frames' is set, function `display-buffer'
7709 will raise frames displaying a buffer, instead of creating a new
7710 frame or window.
7711
7712 ** Two new functions for removing elements from lists/sequences
7713 were added
7714
7715 - Function: remove ELT SEQ
7716
7717 Return a copy of SEQ with all occurrences of ELT removed. SEQ must be
7718 a list, vector, or string. The comparison is done with `equal'.
7719
7720 - Function: remq ELT LIST
7721
7722 Return a copy of LIST with all occurrences of ELT removed. The
7723 comparison is done with `eq'.
7724
7725 ** The function `delete' now also works with vectors and strings.
7726
7727 ** The meaning of the `:weakness WEAK' argument of make-hash-table
7728 has been changed: WEAK can now have new values `key-or-value' and
7729 `key-and-value', in addition to `nil', `key', `value', and `t'.
7730
7731 ** Function `aset' stores any multibyte character in any string
7732 without signaling "Attempt to change char length of a string". It may
7733 convert a unibyte string to multibyte if necessary.
7734
7735 ** The value of the `help-echo' text property is called as a function
7736 or evaluated, if it is not a string already, to obtain a help string.
7737
7738 ** Function `make-obsolete' now has an optional arg to say when the
7739 function was declared obsolete.
7740
7741 ** Function `plist-member' is renamed from `widget-plist-member' (which is
7742 retained as an alias).
7743
7744 ** Easy-menu's :filter now takes the unconverted form of the menu and
7745 the result is automatically converted to Emacs' form.
7746
7747 ** The new function `window-list' has been defined
7748
7749 - Function: window-list &optional FRAME WINDOW MINIBUF
7750
7751 Return a list of windows on FRAME, starting with WINDOW. FRAME nil or
7752 omitted means use the selected frame. WINDOW nil or omitted means use
7753 the selected window. MINIBUF t means include the minibuffer window,
7754 even if it isn't active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means include the
7755 minibuffer window only if it's active. MINIBUF neither nil nor t
7756 means never include the minibuffer window.
7757
7758 ** There's a new function `get-window-with-predicate' defined as follows
7759
7760 - Function: get-window-with-predicate PREDICATE &optional MINIBUF ALL-FRAMES DEFAULT
7761
7762 Return a window satisfying PREDICATE.
7763
7764 This function cycles through all visible windows using `walk-windows',
7765 calling PREDICATE on each one. PREDICATE is called with a window as
7766 argument. The first window for which PREDICATE returns a non-nil
7767 value is returned. If no window satisfies PREDICATE, DEFAULT is
7768 returned.
7769
7770 Optional second arg MINIBUF t means count the minibuffer window even
7771 if not active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means count the minibuffer iff
7772 it is active. MINIBUF neither t nor nil means not to count the
7773 minibuffer even if it is active.
7774
7775 Several frames may share a single minibuffer; if the minibuffer
7776 counts, all windows on all frames that share that minibuffer count
7777 too. Therefore, if you are using a separate minibuffer frame
7778 and the minibuffer is active and MINIBUF says it counts,
7779 `walk-windows' includes the windows in the frame from which you
7780 entered the minibuffer, as well as the minibuffer window.
7781
7782 ALL-FRAMES is the optional third argument.
7783 ALL-FRAMES nil or omitted means cycle within the frames as specified above.
7784 ALL-FRAMES = `visible' means include windows on all visible frames.
7785 ALL-FRAMES = 0 means include windows on all visible and iconified frames.
7786 ALL-FRAMES = t means include windows on all frames including invisible frames.
7787 If ALL-FRAMES is a frame, it means include windows on that frame.
7788 Anything else means restrict to the selected frame.
7789
7790 ** The function `single-key-description' now encloses function key and
7791 event names in angle brackets. When called with a second optional
7792 argument non-nil, angle brackets won't be printed.
7793
7794 ** If the variable `message-truncate-lines' is bound to t around a
7795 call to `message', the echo area will not be resized to display that
7796 message; it will be truncated instead, as it was done in 20.x.
7797 Default value is nil.
7798
7799 ** The user option `line-number-display-limit' can now be set to nil,
7800 meaning no limit.
7801
7802 ** The new user option `line-number-display-limit-width' controls
7803 the maximum width of lines in a buffer for which Emacs displays line
7804 numbers in the mode line. The default is 200.
7805
7806 ** `select-safe-coding-system' now also checks the most preferred
7807 coding-system if buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and
7808 DEFAULT-CODING-SYSTEM is not specified,
7809
7810 ** The function `subr-arity' provides information about the argument
7811 list of a primitive.
7812
7813 ** `where-is-internal' now also accepts a list of keymaps.
7814
7815 ** The text property `keymap' specifies a key map which overrides the
7816 buffer's local map and the map specified by the `local-map' property.
7817 This is probably what most current uses of `local-map' want, rather
7818 than replacing the local map.
7819
7820 ** The obsolete variables `before-change-function' and
7821 `after-change-function' are no longer acted upon and have been
7822 removed. Use `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions'
7823 instead.
7824
7825 ** The function `apropos-mode' runs the hook `apropos-mode-hook'.
7826
7827 ** `concat' no longer accepts individual integer arguments,
7828 as promised long ago.
7829
7830 ** The new function `float-time' returns the current time as a float.
7831
7832 ** The new variable auto-coding-regexp-alist specifies coding systems
7833 for reading specific files, analogous to auto-coding-alist, but
7834 patterns are checked against file contents instead of file names.
7835
7836 \f
7837 * Lisp changes in Emacs 21.1 (see following page for display-related features)
7838
7839 ** The new package rx.el provides an alternative sexp notation for
7840 regular expressions.
7841
7842 - Function: rx-to-string SEXP
7843
7844 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
7845
7846 - Macro: rx SEXP
7847
7848 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
7849
7850 The following are valid subforms of regular expressions in sexp
7851 notation.
7852
7853 STRING
7854 matches string STRING literally.
7855
7856 CHAR
7857 matches character CHAR literally.
7858
7859 `not-newline'
7860 matches any character except a newline.
7861 .
7862 `anything'
7863 matches any character
7864
7865 `(any SET)'
7866 matches any character in SET. SET may be a character or string.
7867 Ranges of characters can be specified as `A-Z' in strings.
7868
7869 '(in SET)'
7870 like `any'.
7871
7872 `(not (any SET))'
7873 matches any character not in SET
7874
7875 `line-start'
7876 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of a line
7877 in the text being matched
7878
7879 `line-end'
7880 is similar to `line-start' but matches only at the end of a line
7881
7882 `string-start'
7883 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
7884 string being matched against.
7885
7886 `string-end'
7887 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
7888 string being matched against.
7889
7890 `buffer-start'
7891 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
7892 buffer being matched against.
7893
7894 `buffer-end'
7895 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
7896 buffer being matched against.
7897
7898 `point'
7899 matches the empty string, but only at point.
7900
7901 `word-start'
7902 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
7903 word.
7904
7905 `word-end'
7906 matches the empty string, but only at the end of a word.
7907
7908 `word-boundary'
7909 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
7910 word.
7911
7912 `(not word-boundary)'
7913 matches the empty string, but not at the beginning or end of a
7914 word.
7915
7916 `digit'
7917 matches 0 through 9.
7918
7919 `control'
7920 matches ASCII control characters.
7921
7922 `hex-digit'
7923 matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
7924
7925 `blank'
7926 matches space and tab only.
7927
7928 `graphic'
7929 matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
7930 space, and DEL.
7931
7932 `printing'
7933 matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
7934 and DEL.
7935
7936 `alphanumeric'
7937 matches letters and digits. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7938 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
7939
7940 `letter'
7941 matches letters. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7942 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
7943
7944 `ascii'
7945 matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
7946
7947 `nonascii'
7948 matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
7949
7950 `lower'
7951 matches anything lower-case.
7952
7953 `upper'
7954 matches anything upper-case.
7955
7956 `punctuation'
7957 matches punctuation. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7958 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
7959
7960 `space'
7961 matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
7962
7963 `word'
7964 matches anything that has word syntax.
7965
7966 `(syntax SYNTAX)'
7967 matches a character with syntax SYNTAX. SYNTAX must be one
7968 of the following symbols.
7969
7970 `whitespace' (\\s- in string notation)
7971 `punctuation' (\\s.)
7972 `word' (\\sw)
7973 `symbol' (\\s_)
7974 `open-parenthesis' (\\s()
7975 `close-parenthesis' (\\s))
7976 `expression-prefix' (\\s')
7977 `string-quote' (\\s\")
7978 `paired-delimiter' (\\s$)
7979 `escape' (\\s\\)
7980 `character-quote' (\\s/)
7981 `comment-start' (\\s<)
7982 `comment-end' (\\s>)
7983
7984 `(not (syntax SYNTAX))'
7985 matches a character that has not syntax SYNTAX.
7986
7987 `(category CATEGORY)'
7988 matches a character with category CATEGORY. CATEGORY must be
7989 either a character to use for C, or one of the following symbols.
7990
7991 `consonant' (\\c0 in string notation)
7992 `base-vowel' (\\c1)
7993 `upper-diacritical-mark' (\\c2)
7994 `lower-diacritical-mark' (\\c3)
7995 `tone-mark' (\\c4)
7996 `symbol' (\\c5)
7997 `digit' (\\c6)
7998 `vowel-modifying-diacritical-mark' (\\c7)
7999 `vowel-sign' (\\c8)
8000 `semivowel-lower' (\\c9)
8001 `not-at-end-of-line' (\\c<)
8002 `not-at-beginning-of-line' (\\c>)
8003 `alpha-numeric-two-byte' (\\cA)
8004 `chinse-two-byte' (\\cC)
8005 `greek-two-byte' (\\cG)
8006 `japanese-hiragana-two-byte' (\\cH)
8007 `indian-two-byte' (\\cI)
8008 `japanese-katakana-two-byte' (\\cK)
8009 `korean-hangul-two-byte' (\\cN)
8010 `cyrillic-two-byte' (\\cY)
8011 `ascii' (\\ca)
8012 `arabic' (\\cb)
8013 `chinese' (\\cc)
8014 `ethiopic' (\\ce)
8015 `greek' (\\cg)
8016 `korean' (\\ch)
8017 `indian' (\\ci)
8018 `japanese' (\\cj)
8019 `japanese-katakana' (\\ck)
8020 `latin' (\\cl)
8021 `lao' (\\co)
8022 `tibetan' (\\cq)
8023 `japanese-roman' (\\cr)
8024 `thai' (\\ct)
8025 `vietnamese' (\\cv)
8026 `hebrew' (\\cw)
8027 `cyrillic' (\\cy)
8028 `can-break' (\\c|)
8029
8030 `(not (category CATEGORY))'
8031 matches a character that has not category CATEGORY.
8032
8033 `(and SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
8034 matches what SEXP1 matches, followed by what SEXP2 matches, etc.
8035
8036 `(submatch SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
8037 like `and', but makes the match accessible with `match-end',
8038 `match-beginning', and `match-string'.
8039
8040 `(group SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
8041 another name for `submatch'.
8042
8043 `(or SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
8044 matches anything that matches SEXP1 or SEXP2, etc. If all
8045 args are strings, use `regexp-opt' to optimize the resulting
8046 regular expression.
8047
8048 `(minimal-match SEXP)'
8049 produce a non-greedy regexp for SEXP. Normally, regexps matching
8050 zero or more occurrences of something are \"greedy\" in that they
8051 match as much as they can, as long as the overall regexp can
8052 still match. A non-greedy regexp matches as little as possible.
8053
8054 `(maximal-match SEXP)'
8055 produce a greedy regexp for SEXP. This is the default.
8056
8057 `(zero-or-more SEXP)'
8058 matches zero or more occurrences of what SEXP matches.
8059
8060 `(0+ SEXP)'
8061 like `zero-or-more'.
8062
8063 `(* SEXP)'
8064 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
8065
8066 `(*? SEXP)'
8067 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
8068
8069 `(one-or-more SEXP)'
8070 matches one or more occurrences of A.
8071
8072 `(1+ SEXP)'
8073 like `one-or-more'.
8074
8075 `(+ SEXP)'
8076 like `one-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
8077
8078 `(+? SEXP)'
8079 like `one-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
8080
8081 `(zero-or-one SEXP)'
8082 matches zero or one occurrences of A.
8083
8084 `(optional SEXP)'
8085 like `zero-or-one'.
8086
8087 `(? SEXP)'
8088 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a greedy regexp.
8089
8090 `(?? SEXP)'
8091 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
8092
8093 `(repeat N SEXP)'
8094 matches N occurrences of what SEXP matches.
8095
8096 `(repeat N M SEXP)'
8097 matches N to M occurrences of what SEXP matches.
8098
8099 `(eval FORM)'
8100 evaluate FORM and insert result. If result is a string,
8101 `regexp-quote' it.
8102
8103 `(regexp REGEXP)'
8104 include REGEXP in string notation in the result.
8105
8106 *** The features `md5' and `overlay' are now provided by default.
8107
8108 *** The special form `save-restriction' now works correctly even if the
8109 buffer is widened inside the save-restriction and changes made outside
8110 the original restriction. Previously, doing this would cause the saved
8111 restriction to be restored incorrectly.
8112
8113 *** The functions `find-charset-region' and `find-charset-string' include
8114 `eight-bit-control' and/or `eight-bit-graphic' in the returned list
8115 when they find 8-bit characters. Previously, they included `ascii' in a
8116 multibyte buffer and `unknown' in a unibyte buffer.
8117
8118 *** The functions `set-buffer-multibyte', `string-as-multibyte' and
8119 `string-as-unibyte' change the byte sequence of a buffer or a string
8120 if it contains a character from the `eight-bit-control' character set.
8121
8122 *** The handling of multibyte sequences in a multibyte buffer is
8123 changed. Previously, a byte sequence matching the pattern
8124 [\200-\237][\240-\377]+ was interpreted as a single character
8125 regardless of the length of the trailing bytes [\240-\377]+. Thus, if
8126 the sequence was longer than what the leading byte indicated, the
8127 extra trailing bytes were ignored by Lisp functions. Now such extra
8128 bytes are independent 8-bit characters belonging to the charset
8129 eight-bit-graphic.
8130
8131 ** Fontsets are now implemented using char-tables.
8132
8133 A fontset can now be specified for each independent character, for
8134 a group of characters or for a character set rather than just for a
8135 character set as previously.
8136
8137 *** The arguments of the function `set-fontset-font' are changed.
8138 They are NAME, CHARACTER, FONTNAME, and optional FRAME. The function
8139 modifies fontset NAME to use FONTNAME for CHARACTER.
8140
8141 CHARACTER may be a cons (FROM . TO), where FROM and TO are non-generic
8142 characters. In that case FONTNAME is used for all characters in the
8143 range FROM and TO (inclusive). CHARACTER may be a charset. In that
8144 case FONTNAME is used for all character in the charset.
8145
8146 FONTNAME may be a cons (FAMILY . REGISTRY), where FAMILY is the family
8147 name of a font and REGISTRY is a registry name of a font.
8148
8149 *** Variable x-charset-registry has been deleted. The default charset
8150 registries of character sets are set in the default fontset
8151 "fontset-default".
8152
8153 *** The function `create-fontset-from-fontset-spec' ignores the second
8154 argument STYLE-VARIANT. It never creates style-variant fontsets.
8155
8156 ** The method of composing characters is changed. Now character
8157 composition is done by a special text property `composition' in
8158 buffers and strings.
8159
8160 *** Charset composition is deleted. Emacs never creates a `composite
8161 character' which is an independent character with a unique character
8162 code. Thus the following functions handling `composite characters'
8163 have been deleted: composite-char-component,
8164 composite-char-component-count, composite-char-composition-rule,
8165 composite-char-composition-rule and decompose-composite-char delete.
8166 The variables leading-code-composition and min-composite-char have
8167 also been deleted.
8168
8169 *** Three more glyph reference points are added. They can be used to
8170 specify a composition rule. See the documentation of the variable
8171 `reference-point-alist' for more detail.
8172
8173 *** The function `compose-region' takes new arguments COMPONENTS and
8174 MODIFICATION-FUNC. With COMPONENTS, you can specify not only a
8175 composition rule but also characters to be composed. Such characters
8176 may differ between buffer and string text.
8177
8178 *** The function `compose-string' takes new arguments START, END,
8179 COMPONENTS, and MODIFICATION-FUNC.
8180
8181 *** The function `compose-string' puts text property `composition'
8182 directly on the argument STRING instead of returning a new string.
8183 Likewise, the function `decompose-string' just removes text property
8184 `composition' from STRING.
8185
8186 *** The new function `find-composition' returns information about
8187 a composition at a specified position in a buffer or a string.
8188
8189 *** The function `decompose-composite-char' is now labeled as
8190 obsolete.
8191
8192 ** The new coding system `mac-roman' is primarily intended for use on
8193 the Macintosh but may be used generally for Macintosh-encoded text.
8194
8195 ** The new character sets `mule-unicode-0100-24ff',
8196 `mule-unicode-2500-33ff', and `mule-unicode-e000-ffff' have been
8197 introduced for Unicode characters in the range U+0100..U+24FF,
8198 U+2500..U+33FF, U+E000..U+FFFF respectively.
8199
8200 Note that the character sets are not yet unified in Emacs, so
8201 characters which belong to charsets such as Latin-2, Greek, Hebrew,
8202 etc. and the same characters in the `mule-unicode-*' charsets are
8203 different characters, as far as Emacs is concerned. For example, text
8204 which includes Unicode characters from the Latin-2 locale cannot be
8205 encoded by Emacs with ISO 8859-2 coding system.
8206
8207 ** The new coding system `mule-utf-8' has been added.
8208 It provides limited support for decoding/encoding UTF-8 text. For
8209 details, please see the documentation string of this coding system.
8210
8211 ** The new character sets `japanese-jisx0213-1' and
8212 `japanese-jisx0213-2' have been introduced for the new Japanese
8213 standard JIS X 0213 Plane 1 and Plane 2.
8214
8215 ** The new character sets `latin-iso8859-14' and `latin-iso8859-15'
8216 have been introduced.
8217
8218 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
8219 have been introduced for 8-bit characters in the ranges 0x80..0x9F and
8220 0xA0..0xFF respectively. Note that the multibyte representation of
8221 eight-bit-control is never exposed; this leads to an exception in the
8222 emacs-mule coding system, which encodes everything else to the
8223 buffer/string internal representation. Note that to search for
8224 eight-bit-graphic characters in a multibyte buffer, the search string
8225 must be multibyte, otherwise such characters will be converted to
8226 their multibyte equivalent.
8227
8228 ** If the APPEND argument of `write-region' is an integer, it seeks to
8229 that offset in the file before writing.
8230
8231 ** The function `add-minor-mode' has been added for convenience and
8232 compatibility with XEmacs (and is used internally by define-minor-mode).
8233
8234 ** The function `shell-command' now sets the default directory of the
8235 `*Shell Command Output*' buffer to the default directory of the buffer
8236 from which the command was issued.
8237
8238 ** The functions `query-replace', `query-replace-regexp',
8239 `query-replace-regexp-eval' `map-query-replace-regexp',
8240 `replace-string', `replace-regexp', and `perform-replace' take two
8241 additional optional arguments START and END that specify the region to
8242 operate on.
8243
8244 ** The new function `count-screen-lines' is a more flexible alternative
8245 to `window-buffer-height'.
8246
8247 - Function: count-screen-lines &optional BEG END COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE WINDOW
8248
8249 Return the number of screen lines in the region between BEG and END.
8250 The number of screen lines may be different from the number of actual
8251 lines, due to line breaking, display table, etc.
8252
8253 Optional arguments BEG and END default to `point-min' and `point-max'
8254 respectively.
8255
8256 If region ends with a newline, ignore it unless optional third argument
8257 COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE is non-nil.
8258
8259 The optional fourth argument WINDOW specifies the window used for
8260 obtaining parameters such as width, horizontal scrolling, and so
8261 on. The default is to use the selected window's parameters.
8262
8263 Like `vertical-motion', `count-screen-lines' always uses the current
8264 buffer, regardless of which buffer is displayed in WINDOW. This makes
8265 possible to use `count-screen-lines' in any buffer, whether or not it
8266 is currently displayed in some window.
8267
8268 ** The new function `mapc' is like `mapcar' but doesn't collect the
8269 argument function's results.
8270
8271 ** The functions base64-decode-region and base64-decode-string now
8272 signal an error instead of returning nil if decoding fails. Also,
8273 `base64-decode-string' now always returns a unibyte string (in Emacs
8274 20, it returned a multibyte string when the result was a valid multibyte
8275 sequence).
8276
8277 ** The function sendmail-user-agent-compose now recognizes a `body'
8278 header in the list of headers passed to it.
8279
8280 ** The new function member-ignore-case works like `member', but
8281 ignores differences in case and text representation.
8282
8283 ** The buffer-local variable cursor-type can be used to specify the
8284 cursor to use in windows displaying a buffer. Values are interpreted
8285 as follows:
8286
8287 t use the cursor specified for the frame (default)
8288 nil don't display a cursor
8289 `bar' display a bar cursor with default width
8290 (bar . WIDTH) display a bar cursor with width WIDTH
8291 others display a box cursor.
8292
8293 ** The variable open-paren-in-column-0-is-defun-start controls whether
8294 an open parenthesis in column 0 is considered to be the start of a
8295 defun. If set, the default, it is considered a defun start. If not
8296 set, an open parenthesis in column 0 has no special meaning.
8297
8298 ** The new function `string-to-syntax' can be used to translate syntax
8299 specifications in string form as accepted by `modify-syntax-entry' to
8300 the cons-cell form that is used for the values of the `syntax-table'
8301 text property, and in `font-lock-syntactic-keywords'.
8302
8303 Example:
8304
8305 (string-to-syntax "()")
8306 => (4 . 41)
8307
8308 ** Emacs' reader supports CL read syntax for integers in bases
8309 other than 10.
8310
8311 *** `#BINTEGER' or `#bINTEGER' reads INTEGER in binary (radix 2).
8312 INTEGER optionally contains a sign.
8313
8314 #b1111
8315 => 15
8316 #b-1111
8317 => -15
8318
8319 *** `#OINTEGER' or `#oINTEGER' reads INTEGER in octal (radix 8).
8320
8321 #o666
8322 => 438
8323
8324 *** `#XINTEGER' or `#xINTEGER' reads INTEGER in hexadecimal (radix 16).
8325
8326 #xbeef
8327 => 48815
8328
8329 *** `#RADIXrINTEGER' reads INTEGER in radix RADIX, 2 <= RADIX <= 36.
8330
8331 #2R-111
8332 => -7
8333 #25rah
8334 => 267
8335
8336 ** The function `documentation-property' now evaluates the value of
8337 the given property to obtain a string if it doesn't refer to etc/DOC
8338 and isn't a string.
8339
8340 ** If called for a symbol, the function `documentation' now looks for
8341 a `function-documentation' property of that symbol. If it has a non-nil
8342 value, the documentation is taken from that value. If the value is
8343 not a string, it is evaluated to obtain a string.
8344
8345 ** The last argument of `define-key-after' defaults to t for convenience.
8346
8347 ** The new function `replace-regexp-in-string' replaces all matches
8348 for a regexp in a string.
8349
8350 ** `mouse-position' now runs the abnormal hook
8351 `mouse-position-function'.
8352
8353 ** The function string-to-number now returns a float for numbers
8354 that don't fit into a Lisp integer.
8355
8356 ** The variable keyword-symbols-constants-flag has been removed.
8357 Keywords are now always considered constants.
8358
8359 ** The new function `delete-and-extract-region' deletes text and
8360 returns it.
8361
8362 ** The function `clear-this-command-keys' now also clears the vector
8363 returned by function `recent-keys'.
8364
8365 ** Variables `beginning-of-defun-function' and `end-of-defun-function'
8366 can be used to define handlers for the functions that find defuns.
8367 Major modes can define these locally instead of rebinding C-M-a
8368 etc. if the normal conventions for defuns are not appropriate for the
8369 mode.
8370
8371 ** easy-mmode-define-minor-mode now takes an additional BODY argument
8372 and is renamed `define-minor-mode'.
8373
8374 ** If an abbrev has a hook function which is a symbol, and that symbol
8375 has a non-nil `no-self-insert' property, the return value of the hook
8376 function specifies whether an expansion has been done or not. If it
8377 returns nil, abbrev-expand also returns nil, meaning "no expansion has
8378 been performed."
8379
8380 When abbrev expansion is done by typing a self-inserting character,
8381 and the abbrev has a hook with the `no-self-insert' property, and the
8382 hook function returns non-nil meaning expansion has been done,
8383 then the self-inserting character is not inserted.
8384
8385 ** The function `intern-soft' now accepts a symbol as first argument.
8386 In this case, that exact symbol is looked up in the specified obarray,
8387 and the function's value is nil if it is not found.
8388
8389 ** The new macro `with-syntax-table' can be used to evaluate forms
8390 with the syntax table of the current buffer temporarily set to a
8391 specified table.
8392
8393 (with-syntax-table TABLE &rest BODY)
8394
8395 Evaluate BODY with syntax table of current buffer set to a copy of
8396 TABLE. The current syntax table is saved, BODY is evaluated, and the
8397 saved table is restored, even in case of an abnormal exit. Value is
8398 what BODY returns.
8399
8400 ** Regular expressions now support intervals \{n,m\} as well as
8401 Perl's shy-groups \(?:...\) and non-greedy *? +? and ?? operators.
8402 Also back-references like \2 are now considered as an error if the
8403 corresponding subgroup does not exist (or is not closed yet).
8404 Previously it would have been silently turned into `2' (ignoring the `\').
8405
8406 ** The optional argument BUFFER of function file-local-copy has been
8407 removed since it wasn't used by anything.
8408
8409 ** The file name argument of function `file-locked-p' is now required
8410 instead of being optional.
8411
8412 ** The new built-in error `text-read-only' is signaled when trying to
8413 modify read-only text.
8414
8415 ** New functions and variables for locales.
8416
8417 The new variable `locale-coding-system' specifies how to encode and
8418 decode strings passed to low-level message functions like strerror and
8419 time functions like strftime. The new variables
8420 `system-messages-locale' and `system-time-locale' give the system
8421 locales to be used when invoking these two types of functions.
8422
8423 The new function `set-locale-environment' sets the language
8424 environment, preferred coding system, and locale coding system from
8425 the system locale as specified by the LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG
8426 environment variables. Normally, it is invoked during startup and need
8427 not be invoked thereafter. It uses the new variables
8428 `locale-language-names', `locale-charset-language-names', and
8429 `locale-preferred-coding-systems' to make its decisions.
8430
8431 ** syntax tables now understand nested comments.
8432 To declare a comment syntax as allowing nesting, just add an `n'
8433 modifier to either of the characters of the comment end and the comment
8434 start sequences.
8435
8436 ** The function `pixmap-spec-p' has been renamed `bitmap-spec-p'
8437 because `bitmap' is more in line with the usual X terminology.
8438
8439 ** New function `propertize'
8440
8441 The new function `propertize' can be used to conveniently construct
8442 strings with text properties.
8443
8444 - Function: propertize STRING &rest PROPERTIES
8445
8446 Value is a copy of STRING with text properties assigned as specified
8447 by PROPERTIES. PROPERTIES is a sequence of pairs PROPERTY VALUE, with
8448 PROPERTY being the name of a text property and VALUE being the
8449 specified value of that property. Example:
8450
8451 (propertize "foo" 'face 'bold 'read-only t)
8452
8453 ** push and pop macros.
8454
8455 Simple versions of the push and pop macros of Common Lisp
8456 are now defined in Emacs Lisp. These macros allow only symbols
8457 as the place that holds the list to be changed.
8458
8459 (push NEWELT LISTNAME) add NEWELT to the front of LISTNAME's value.
8460 (pop LISTNAME) return first elt of LISTNAME, and remove it
8461 (thus altering the value of LISTNAME).
8462
8463 ** New dolist and dotimes macros.
8464
8465 Simple versions of the dolist and dotimes macros of Common Lisp
8466 are now defined in Emacs Lisp.
8467
8468 (dolist (VAR LIST [RESULT]) BODY...)
8469 Execute body once for each element of LIST,
8470 using the variable VAR to hold the current element.
8471 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
8472
8473 (dotimes (VAR COUNT [RESULT]) BODY...)
8474 Execute BODY with VAR bound to successive integers running from 0,
8475 inclusive, to COUNT, exclusive.
8476 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
8477
8478 ** Regular expressions now support Posix character classes such as
8479 [:alpha:], [:space:] and so on. These must be used within a character
8480 class--for instance, [-[:digit:].+] matches digits or a period
8481 or a sign.
8482
8483 [:digit:] matches 0 through 9
8484 [:cntrl:] matches ASCII control characters
8485 [:xdigit:] matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
8486 [:blank:] matches space and tab only
8487 [:graph:] matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
8488 space, and DEL.
8489 [:print:] matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
8490 and DEL.
8491 [:alnum:] matches letters and digits.
8492 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8493 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8494 [:alpha:] matches letters.
8495 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8496 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8497 [:ascii:] matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
8498 [:nonascii:] matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
8499 [:lower:] matches anything lower-case.
8500 [:punct:] matches punctuation.
8501 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8502 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
8503 [:space:] matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
8504 [:upper:] matches anything upper-case.
8505 [:word:] matches anything that has word syntax.
8506
8507 ** Emacs now has built-in hash tables.
8508
8509 The following functions are defined for hash tables:
8510
8511 - Function: make-hash-table ARGS
8512
8513 The argument list ARGS consists of keyword/argument pairs. All arguments
8514 are optional. The following arguments are defined:
8515
8516 :test TEST
8517
8518 TEST must be a symbol specifying how to compare keys. Default is `eql'.
8519 Predefined are `eq', `eql' and `equal'. If TEST is not predefined,
8520 it must have been defined with `define-hash-table-test'.
8521
8522 :size SIZE
8523
8524 SIZE must be an integer > 0 giving a hint to the implementation how
8525 many elements will be put in the hash table. Default size is 65.
8526
8527 :rehash-size REHASH-SIZE
8528
8529 REHASH-SIZE specifies by how much to grow a hash table once it becomes
8530 full. If REHASH-SIZE is an integer, add that to the hash table's old
8531 size to get the new size. Otherwise, REHASH-SIZE must be a float >
8532 1.0, and the new size is computed by multiplying REHASH-SIZE with the
8533 old size. Default rehash size is 1.5.
8534
8535 :rehash-threshold THRESHOLD
8536
8537 THRESHOLD must be a float > 0 and <= 1.0 specifying when to resize the
8538 hash table. It is resized when the ratio of (number of entries) /
8539 (size of hash table) is >= THRESHOLD. Default threshold is 0.8.
8540
8541 :weakness WEAK
8542
8543 WEAK must be either nil, one of the symbols `key, `value',
8544 `key-or-value', `key-and-value', or t, meaning the same as
8545 `key-and-value'. Entries are removed from weak tables during garbage
8546 collection if their key and/or value are not referenced elsewhere
8547 outside of the hash table. Default are non-weak hash tables.
8548
8549 - Function: makehash &optional TEST
8550
8551 Similar to make-hash-table, but only TEST can be specified.
8552
8553 - Function: hash-table-p TABLE
8554
8555 Returns non-nil if TABLE is a hash table object.
8556
8557 - Function: copy-hash-table TABLE
8558
8559 Returns a copy of TABLE. Only the table itself is copied, keys and
8560 values are shared.
8561
8562 - Function: hash-table-count TABLE
8563
8564 Returns the number of entries in TABLE.
8565
8566 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
8567
8568 Returns the rehash size of TABLE.
8569
8570 - Function: hash-table-rehash-threshold TABLE
8571
8572 Returns the rehash threshold of TABLE.
8573
8574 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
8575
8576 Returns the size of TABLE.
8577
8578 - Function: hash-table-test TABLE
8579
8580 Returns the test TABLE uses to compare keys.
8581
8582 - Function: hash-table-weakness TABLE
8583
8584 Returns the weakness specified for TABLE.
8585
8586 - Function: clrhash TABLE
8587
8588 Clear TABLE.
8589
8590 - Function: gethash KEY TABLE &optional DEFAULT
8591
8592 Look up KEY in TABLE and return its associated VALUE or DEFAULT if
8593 not found.
8594
8595 - Function: puthash KEY VALUE TABLE
8596
8597 Associate KEY with VALUE in TABLE. If KEY is already associated with
8598 another value, replace the old value with VALUE.
8599
8600 - Function: remhash KEY TABLE
8601
8602 Remove KEY from TABLE if it is there.
8603
8604 - Function: maphash FUNCTION TABLE
8605
8606 Call FUNCTION for all elements in TABLE. FUNCTION must take two
8607 arguments KEY and VALUE.
8608
8609 - Function: sxhash OBJ
8610
8611 Return a hash code for Lisp object OBJ.
8612
8613 - Function: define-hash-table-test NAME TEST-FN HASH-FN
8614
8615 Define a new hash table test named NAME. If NAME is specified as
8616 a test in `make-hash-table', the table created will use TEST-FN for
8617 comparing keys, and HASH-FN to compute hash codes for keys. Test
8618 and hash function are stored as symbol property `hash-table-test'
8619 of NAME with a value of (TEST-FN HASH-FN).
8620
8621 TEST-FN must take two arguments and return non-nil if they are the same.
8622
8623 HASH-FN must take one argument and return an integer that is the hash
8624 code of the argument. The function should use the whole range of
8625 integer values for hash code computation, including negative integers.
8626
8627 Example: The following creates a hash table whose keys are supposed to
8628 be strings that are compared case-insensitively.
8629
8630 (defun case-fold-string= (a b)
8631 (compare-strings a nil nil b nil nil t))
8632
8633 (defun case-fold-string-hash (a)
8634 (sxhash (upcase a)))
8635
8636 (define-hash-table-test 'case-fold 'case-fold-string=
8637 'case-fold-string-hash))
8638
8639 (make-hash-table :test 'case-fold)
8640
8641 ** The Lisp reader handles circular structure.
8642
8643 It now works to use the #N= and #N# constructs to represent
8644 circular structures. For example, #1=(a . #1#) represents
8645 a cons cell which is its own cdr.
8646
8647 ** The Lisp printer handles circular structure.
8648
8649 If you bind print-circle to a non-nil value, the Lisp printer outputs
8650 #N= and #N# constructs to represent circular and shared structure.
8651
8652 ** If the second argument to `move-to-column' is anything but nil or
8653 t, that means replace a tab with spaces if necessary to reach the
8654 specified column, but do not add spaces at the end of the line if it
8655 is too short to reach that column.
8656
8657 ** perform-replace has a new feature: the REPLACEMENTS argument may
8658 now be a cons cell (FUNCTION . DATA). This means to call FUNCTION
8659 after each match to get the replacement text. FUNCTION is called with
8660 two arguments: DATA, and the number of replacements already made.
8661
8662 If the FROM-STRING contains any upper-case letters,
8663 perform-replace also turns off `case-fold-search' temporarily
8664 and inserts the replacement text without altering case in it.
8665
8666 ** The function buffer-size now accepts an optional argument
8667 to specify which buffer to return the size of.
8668
8669 ** The calendar motion commands now run the normal hook
8670 calendar-move-hook after moving point.
8671
8672 ** The new variable small-temporary-file-directory specifies a
8673 directory to use for creating temporary files that are likely to be
8674 small. (Certain Emacs features use this directory.) If
8675 small-temporary-file-directory is nil, they use
8676 temporary-file-directory instead.
8677
8678 ** The variable `inhibit-modification-hooks', if non-nil, inhibits all
8679 the hooks that track changes in the buffer. This affects
8680 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions', as well as
8681 hooks attached to text properties and overlay properties.
8682
8683 ** assq-delete-all is a new function that deletes all the
8684 elements of an alist which have a car `eq' to a particular value.
8685
8686 ** make-temp-file provides a more reliable way to create a temporary file.
8687
8688 make-temp-file is used like make-temp-name, except that it actually
8689 creates the file before it returns. This prevents a timing error,
8690 ensuring that no other job can use the same name for a temporary file.
8691
8692 ** New exclusive-open feature in `write-region'
8693
8694 The optional seventh arg is now called MUSTBENEW. If non-nil, it insists
8695 on a check for an existing file with the same name. If MUSTBENEW
8696 is `excl', that means to get an error if the file already exists;
8697 never overwrite. If MUSTBENEW is neither nil nor `excl', that means
8698 ask for confirmation before overwriting, but do go ahead and
8699 overwrite the file if the user gives confirmation.
8700
8701 If the MUSTBENEW argument in `write-region' is `excl',
8702 that means to use a special feature in the `open' system call
8703 to get an error if the file exists at that time.
8704 The error reported is `file-already-exists'.
8705
8706 ** Function `format' now handles text properties.
8707
8708 Text properties of the format string are applied to the result string.
8709 If the result string is longer than the format string, text properties
8710 ending at the end of the format string are extended to the end of the
8711 result string.
8712
8713 Text properties from string arguments are applied to the result
8714 string where arguments appear in the result string.
8715
8716 Example:
8717
8718 (let ((s1 "hello, %s")
8719 (s2 "world"))
8720 (put-text-property 0 (length s1) 'face 'bold s1)
8721 (put-text-property 0 (length s2) 'face 'italic s2)
8722 (format s1 s2))
8723
8724 results in a bold-face string with an italic `world' at the end.
8725
8726 ** Messages can now be displayed with text properties.
8727
8728 Text properties are handled as described above for function `format'.
8729 The following example displays a bold-face message with an italic
8730 argument in it.
8731
8732 (let ((msg "hello, %s!")
8733 (arg "world"))
8734 (put-text-property 0 (length msg) 'face 'bold msg)
8735 (put-text-property 0 (length arg) 'face 'italic arg)
8736 (message msg arg))
8737
8738 ** Sound support
8739
8740 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and the free BSDs
8741 (Voxware driver and native BSD driver, aka as Luigi's driver).
8742
8743 Currently supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio
8744 (*.au). You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes'
8745 to enable sound support.
8746
8747 Sound files can be played by calling (play-sound SOUND). SOUND is a
8748 list of the form `(sound PROPERTY...)'. The function is only defined
8749 when sound support is present for the system on which Emacs runs. The
8750 functions runs `play-sound-functions' with one argument which is the
8751 sound to play, before playing the sound.
8752
8753 The following sound properties are supported:
8754
8755 - `:file FILE'
8756
8757 FILE is a file name. If FILE isn't an absolute name, it will be
8758 searched relative to `data-directory'.
8759
8760 - `:data DATA'
8761
8762 DATA is a string containing sound data. Either :file or :data
8763 may be present, but not both.
8764
8765 - `:volume VOLUME'
8766
8767 VOLUME must be an integer in the range 0..100 or a float in the range
8768 0..1. This property is optional.
8769
8770 - `:device DEVICE'
8771
8772 DEVICE is a string specifying the system device on which to play the
8773 sound. The default device is system-dependent.
8774
8775 Other properties are ignored.
8776
8777 An alternative interface is called as
8778 (play-sound-file FILE &optional VOLUME DEVICE).
8779
8780 ** `multimedia' is a new Finder keyword and Custom group.
8781
8782 ** keywordp is a new predicate to test efficiently for an object being
8783 a keyword symbol.
8784
8785 ** Changes to garbage collection
8786
8787 *** The function garbage-collect now additionally returns the number
8788 of live and free strings.
8789
8790 *** There is a new variable `strings-consed' holding the number of
8791 strings that have been consed so far.
8792
8793 \f
8794 * Lisp-level Display features added after release 2.6 of the Emacs
8795 Lisp Manual
8796
8797 ** The user-option `resize-mini-windows' controls how Emacs resizes
8798 mini-windows.
8799
8800 ** The function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now has a third optional
8801 argument, PARTIALLY. If a character is only partially visible, nil is
8802 returned, unless PARTIALLY is non-nil.
8803
8804 ** On window systems, `glyph-table' is no longer used.
8805
8806 ** Help strings in menu items are now used to provide `help-echo' text.
8807
8808 ** The function `image-size' can be used to determine the size of an
8809 image.
8810
8811 - Function: image-size SPEC &optional PIXELS FRAME
8812
8813 Return the size of an image as a pair (WIDTH . HEIGHT).
8814
8815 SPEC is an image specification. PIXELS non-nil means return sizes
8816 measured in pixels, otherwise return sizes measured in canonical
8817 character units (fractions of the width/height of the frame's default
8818 font). FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed.
8819 FRAME nil or omitted means use the selected frame.
8820
8821 ** The function `image-mask-p' can be used to determine if an image
8822 has a mask bitmap.
8823
8824 - Function: image-mask-p SPEC &optional FRAME
8825
8826 Return t if image SPEC has a mask bitmap.
8827 FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed. FRAME nil
8828 or omitted means use the selected frame.
8829
8830 ** The function `find-image' can be used to find a usable image
8831 satisfying one of a list of specifications.
8832
8833 ** The STRING argument of `put-image' and `insert-image' is now
8834 optional.
8835
8836 ** Image specifications may contain the property `:ascent center' (see
8837 below).
8838
8839 \f
8840 * New Lisp-level Display features in Emacs 21.1
8841
8842 ** The function tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors can be used
8843 to make Emacs avoid displaying text with bold black foreground on TTYs.
8844
8845 Some terminals, notably PC consoles, emulate bold text by displaying
8846 text in brighter colors. On such a console, a bold black foreground
8847 is displayed in a gray color. If this turns out to be hard to read on
8848 your monitor---the problem occurred with the mode line on
8849 laptops---you can instruct Emacs to ignore the text's boldness, and to
8850 just display it black instead.
8851
8852 This situation can't be detected automatically. You will have to put
8853 a line like
8854
8855 (tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors t)
8856
8857 in your `.emacs'.
8858
8859 ** New face implementation.
8860
8861 Emacs faces have been reimplemented from scratch. They don't use XLFD
8862 font names anymore and face merging now works as expected.
8863
8864 *** New faces.
8865
8866 Each face can specify the following display attributes:
8867
8868 1. Font family or fontset alias name.
8869
8870 2. Relative proportionate width, aka character set width or set
8871 width (swidth), e.g. `semi-compressed'.
8872
8873 3. Font height in 1/10pt
8874
8875 4. Font weight, e.g. `bold'.
8876
8877 5. Font slant, e.g. `italic'.
8878
8879 6. Foreground color.
8880
8881 7. Background color.
8882
8883 8. Whether or not characters should be underlined, and in what color.
8884
8885 9. Whether or not characters should be displayed in inverse video.
8886
8887 10. A background stipple, a bitmap.
8888
8889 11. Whether or not characters should be overlined, and in what color.
8890
8891 12. Whether or not characters should be strike-through, and in what
8892 color.
8893
8894 13. Whether or not a box should be drawn around characters, its
8895 color, the width of the box lines, and 3D appearance.
8896
8897 Faces are frame-local by nature because Emacs allows to define the
8898 same named face (face names are symbols) differently for different
8899 frames. Each frame has an alist of face definitions for all named
8900 faces. The value of a named face in such an alist is a Lisp vector
8901 with the symbol `face' in slot 0, and a slot for each of the face
8902 attributes mentioned above.
8903
8904 There is also a global face alist `face-new-frame-defaults'. Face
8905 definitions from this list are used to initialize faces of newly
8906 created frames.
8907
8908 A face doesn't have to specify all attributes. Those not specified
8909 have a nil value. Faces specifying all attributes are called
8910 `fully-specified'.
8911
8912 *** Face merging.
8913
8914 The display style of a given character in the text is determined by
8915 combining several faces. This process is called `face merging'. Any
8916 aspect of the display style that isn't specified by overlays or text
8917 properties is taken from the `default' face. Since it is made sure
8918 that the default face is always fully-specified, face merging always
8919 results in a fully-specified face.
8920
8921 *** Face realization.
8922
8923 After all face attributes for a character have been determined by
8924 merging faces of that character, that face is `realized'. The
8925 realization process maps face attributes to what is physically
8926 available on the system where Emacs runs. The result is a `realized
8927 face' in form of an internal structure which is stored in the face
8928 cache of the frame on which it was realized.
8929
8930 Face realization is done in the context of the charset of the
8931 character to display because different fonts and encodings are used
8932 for different charsets. In other words, for characters of different
8933 charsets, different realized faces are needed to display them.
8934
8935 Except for composite characters, faces are always realized for a
8936 specific character set and contain a specific font, even if the face
8937 being realized specifies a fontset. The reason is that the result of
8938 the new font selection stage is better than what can be done with
8939 statically defined font name patterns in fontsets.
8940
8941 In unibyte text, Emacs' charsets aren't applicable; function
8942 `char-charset' reports ASCII for all characters, including those >
8943 0x7f. The X registry and encoding of fonts to use is determined from
8944 the variable `face-default-registry' in this case. The variable is
8945 initialized at Emacs startup time from the font the user specified for
8946 Emacs.
8947
8948 Currently all unibyte text, i.e. all buffers with
8949 `enable-multibyte-characters' nil are displayed with fonts of the same
8950 registry and encoding `face-default-registry'. This is consistent
8951 with the fact that languages can also be set globally, only.
8952
8953 **** Clearing face caches.
8954
8955 The Lisp function `clear-face-cache' can be called to clear face caches
8956 on all frames. If called with a non-nil argument, it will also unload
8957 unused fonts.
8958
8959 *** Font selection.
8960
8961 Font selection tries to find the best available matching font for a
8962 given (charset, face) combination. This is done slightly differently
8963 for faces specifying a fontset, or a font family name.
8964
8965 If the face specifies a fontset name, that fontset determines a
8966 pattern for fonts of the given charset. If the face specifies a font
8967 family, a font pattern is constructed. Charset symbols have a
8968 property `x-charset-registry' for that purpose that maps a charset to
8969 an XLFD registry and encoding in the font pattern constructed.
8970
8971 Available fonts on the system on which Emacs runs are then matched
8972 against the font pattern. The result of font selection is the best
8973 match for the given face attributes in this font list.
8974
8975 Font selection can be influenced by the user.
8976
8977 The user can specify the relative importance he gives the face
8978 attributes width, height, weight, and slant by setting
8979 face-font-selection-order (faces.el) to a list of face attribute
8980 names. The default is (:width :height :weight :slant), and means
8981 that font selection first tries to find a good match for the font
8982 width specified by a face, then---within fonts with that width---tries
8983 to find a best match for the specified font height, etc.
8984
8985 Setting `face-font-family-alternatives' allows the user to specify
8986 alternative font families to try if a family specified by a face
8987 doesn't exist.
8988
8989 Setting `face-font-registry-alternatives' allows the user to specify
8990 all alternative font registry names to try for a face specifying a
8991 registry.
8992
8993 Please note that the interpretations of the above two variables are
8994 slightly different.
8995
8996 Setting face-ignored-fonts allows the user to ignore specific fonts.
8997
8998
8999 **** Scalable fonts
9000
9001 Emacs can make use of scalable fonts but doesn't do so by default,
9002 since the use of too many or too big scalable fonts may crash XFree86
9003 servers.
9004
9005 To enable scalable font use, set the variable
9006 `scalable-fonts-allowed'. A value of nil, the default, means never use
9007 scalable fonts. A value of t means any scalable font may be used.
9008 Otherwise, the value must be a list of regular expressions. A
9009 scalable font may then be used if it matches a regular expression from
9010 that list. Example:
9011
9012 (setq scalable-fonts-allowed '("muleindian-2$"))
9013
9014 allows the use of scalable fonts with registry `muleindian-2'.
9015
9016 *** Functions and variables related to font selection.
9017
9018 - Function: x-family-fonts &optional FAMILY FRAME
9019
9020 Return a list of available fonts of family FAMILY on FRAME. If FAMILY
9021 is omitted or nil, list all families. Otherwise, FAMILY must be a
9022 string, possibly containing wildcards `?' and `*'.
9023
9024 If FRAME is omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Each element of
9025 the result is a vector [FAMILY WIDTH POINT-SIZE WEIGHT SLANT FIXED-P
9026 FULL REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING]. FAMILY is the font family name.
9027 POINT-SIZE is the size of the font in 1/10 pt. WIDTH, WEIGHT, and
9028 SLANT are symbols describing the width, weight and slant of the font.
9029 These symbols are the same as for face attributes. FIXED-P is non-nil
9030 if the font is fixed-pitch. FULL is the full name of the font, and
9031 REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING is a string giving the registry and encoding of
9032 the font. The result list is sorted according to the current setting
9033 of the face font sort order.
9034
9035 - Function: x-font-family-list
9036
9037 Return a list of available font families on FRAME. If FRAME is
9038 omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Value is a list of conses
9039 (FAMILY . FIXED-P) where FAMILY is a font family, and FIXED-P is
9040 non-nil if fonts of that family are fixed-pitch.
9041
9042 - Variable: font-list-limit
9043
9044 Limit for font matching. If an integer > 0, font matching functions
9045 won't load more than that number of fonts when searching for a
9046 matching font. The default is currently 100.
9047
9048 *** Setting face attributes.
9049
9050 For the most part, the new face implementation is interface-compatible
9051 with the old one. Old face attribute related functions are now
9052 implemented in terms of the new functions `set-face-attribute' and
9053 `face-attribute'.
9054
9055 Face attributes are identified by their names which are keyword
9056 symbols. All attributes can be set to `unspecified'.
9057
9058 The following attributes are recognized:
9059
9060 `:family'
9061
9062 VALUE must be a string specifying the font family, e.g. ``courier'',
9063 or a fontset alias name. If a font family is specified, wild-cards `*'
9064 and `?' are allowed.
9065
9066 `:width'
9067
9068 VALUE specifies the relative proportionate width of the font to use.
9069 It must be one of the symbols `ultra-condensed', `extra-condensed',
9070 `condensed', `semi-condensed', `normal', `semi-expanded', `expanded',
9071 `extra-expanded', or `ultra-expanded'.
9072
9073 `:height'
9074
9075 VALUE must be either an integer specifying the height of the font to use
9076 in 1/10 pt, a floating point number specifying the amount by which to
9077 scale any underlying face, or a function, which is called with the old
9078 height (from the underlying face), and should return the new height.
9079
9080 `:weight'
9081
9082 VALUE specifies the weight of the font to use. It must be one of the
9083 symbols `ultra-bold', `extra-bold', `bold', `semi-bold', `normal',
9084 `semi-light', `light', `extra-light', `ultra-light'.
9085
9086 `:slant'
9087
9088 VALUE specifies the slant of the font to use. It must be one of the
9089 symbols `italic', `oblique', `normal', `reverse-italic', or
9090 `reverse-oblique'.
9091
9092 `:foreground', `:background'
9093
9094 VALUE must be a color name, a string.
9095
9096 `:underline'
9097
9098 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be underlined. If
9099 VALUE is t, underline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is
9100 a string, underline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly
9101 don't underline.
9102
9103 `:overline'
9104
9105 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be overlined. If
9106 VALUE is t, overline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is a
9107 string, overline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't
9108 overline.
9109
9110 `:strike-through'
9111
9112 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be drawn with a line
9113 striking through them. If VALUE is t, use the foreground color of the
9114 face. If VALUE is a string, strike-through with that color. If VALUE
9115 is nil, explicitly don't strike through.
9116
9117 `:box'
9118
9119 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should have a box drawn
9120 around them. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't draw boxes. If
9121 VALUE is t, draw a box with lines of width 1 in the foreground color
9122 of the face. If VALUE is a string, the string must be a color name,
9123 and the box is drawn in that color with a line width of 1. Otherwise,
9124 VALUE must be a property list of the form `(:line-width WIDTH
9125 :color COLOR :style STYLE)'. If a keyword/value pair is missing from
9126 the property list, a default value will be used for the value, as
9127 specified below. WIDTH specifies the width of the lines to draw; it
9128 defaults to 1. COLOR is the name of the color to draw in, default is
9129 the foreground color of the face for simple boxes, and the background
9130 color of the face for 3D boxes. STYLE specifies whether a 3D box
9131 should be draw. If STYLE is `released-button', draw a box looking
9132 like a released 3D button. If STYLE is `pressed-button' draw a box
9133 that appears like a pressed button. If STYLE is nil, the default if
9134 the property list doesn't contain a style specification, draw a 2D
9135 box.
9136
9137 `:inverse-video'
9138
9139 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be displayed in
9140 inverse video. VALUE must be one of t or nil.
9141
9142 `:stipple'
9143
9144 If VALUE is a string, it must be the name of a file of pixmap data.
9145 The directories listed in the `x-bitmap-file-path' variable are
9146 searched. Alternatively, VALUE may be a list of the form (WIDTH
9147 HEIGHT DATA) where WIDTH and HEIGHT are the size in pixels, and DATA
9148 is a string containing the raw bits of the bitmap. VALUE nil means
9149 explicitly don't use a stipple pattern.
9150
9151 For convenience, attributes `:family', `:width', `:height', `:weight',
9152 and `:slant' may also be set in one step from an X font name:
9153
9154 `:font'
9155
9156 Set font-related face attributes from VALUE. VALUE must be a valid
9157 XLFD font name. If it is a font name pattern, the first matching font
9158 is used--this is for compatibility with the behavior of previous
9159 versions of Emacs.
9160
9161 For compatibility with Emacs 20, keywords `:bold' and `:italic' can
9162 be used to specify that a bold or italic font should be used. VALUE
9163 must be t or nil in that case. A value of `unspecified' is not allowed."
9164
9165 Please see also the documentation of `set-face-attribute' and
9166 `defface'.
9167
9168 `:inherit'
9169
9170 VALUE is the name of a face from which to inherit attributes, or a list
9171 of face names. Attributes from inherited faces are merged into the face
9172 like an underlying face would be, with higher priority than underlying faces.
9173
9174 *** Face attributes and X resources
9175
9176 The following X resource names can be used to set face attributes
9177 from X resources:
9178
9179 Face attribute X resource class
9180 -----------------------------------------------------------------------
9181 :family attributeFamily . Face.AttributeFamily
9182 :width attributeWidth Face.AttributeWidth
9183 :height attributeHeight Face.AttributeHeight
9184 :weight attributeWeight Face.AttributeWeight
9185 :slant attributeSlant Face.AttributeSlant
9186 foreground attributeForeground Face.AttributeForeground
9187 :background attributeBackground . Face.AttributeBackground
9188 :overline attributeOverline Face.AttributeOverline
9189 :strike-through attributeStrikeThrough Face.AttributeStrikeThrough
9190 :box attributeBox Face.AttributeBox
9191 :underline attributeUnderline Face.AttributeUnderline
9192 :inverse-video attributeInverse Face.AttributeInverse
9193 :stipple attributeStipple Face.AttributeStipple
9194 or attributeBackgroundPixmap
9195 Face.AttributeBackgroundPixmap
9196 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
9197 :bold attributeBold Face.AttributeBold
9198 :italic attributeItalic . Face.AttributeItalic
9199 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
9200
9201 *** Text property `face'.
9202
9203 The value of the `face' text property can now be a single face
9204 specification or a list of such specifications. Each face
9205 specification can be
9206
9207 1. A symbol or string naming a Lisp face.
9208
9209 2. A property list of the form (KEYWORD VALUE ...) where each
9210 KEYWORD is a face attribute name, and VALUE is an appropriate value
9211 for that attribute. Please see the doc string of `set-face-attribute'
9212 for face attribute names.
9213
9214 3. Conses of the form (FOREGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) or
9215 (BACKGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) where COLOR is a color name. This is
9216 for compatibility with previous Emacs versions.
9217
9218 ** Support functions for colors on text-only terminals.
9219
9220 The function `tty-color-define' can be used to define colors for use
9221 on TTY and MSDOS frames. It maps a color name to a color number on
9222 the terminal. Emacs defines a couple of common color mappings by
9223 default. You can get defined colors with a call to
9224 `defined-colors'. The function `tty-color-clear' can be
9225 used to clear the mapping table.
9226
9227 ** Unified support for colors independent of frame type.
9228
9229 The new functions `defined-colors', `color-defined-p', `color-values',
9230 and `display-color-p' work for any type of frame. On frames whose
9231 type is neither x nor w32, these functions transparently map X-style
9232 color specifications to the closest colors supported by the frame
9233 display. Lisp programs should use these new functions instead of the
9234 old `x-defined-colors', `x-color-defined-p', `x-color-values', and
9235 `x-display-color-p'. (The old function names are still available for
9236 compatibility; they are now aliases of the new names.) Lisp programs
9237 should no more look at the value of the variable window-system to
9238 modify their color-related behavior.
9239
9240 The primitives `color-gray-p' and `color-supported-p' also work for
9241 any frame type.
9242
9243 ** Platform-independent functions to describe display capabilities.
9244
9245 The new functions `display-mouse-p', `display-popup-menus-p',
9246 `display-graphic-p', `display-selections-p', `display-screens',
9247 `display-pixel-width', `display-pixel-height', `display-mm-width',
9248 `display-mm-height', `display-backing-store', `display-save-under',
9249 `display-planes', `display-color-cells', `display-visual-class', and
9250 `display-grayscale-p' describe the basic capabilities of a particular
9251 display. Lisp programs should call these functions instead of testing
9252 the value of the variables `window-system' or `system-type', or calling
9253 platform-specific functions such as `x-display-pixel-width'.
9254
9255 The new function `display-images-p' returns non-nil if a particular
9256 display can display image files.
9257
9258 ** The minibuffer prompt is now actually inserted in the minibuffer.
9259
9260 This makes it possible to scroll through the prompt, if you want to.
9261 To disallow this completely (like previous versions of emacs), customize
9262 the variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', and turn on the
9263 `Inviolable' option.
9264
9265 The function `minibuffer-prompt-end' returns the current position of the
9266 end of the minibuffer prompt, if the minibuffer is current.
9267 Otherwise, it returns `(point-min)'.
9268
9269 ** New `field' abstraction in buffers.
9270
9271 There is now code to support an abstraction called `fields' in emacs
9272 buffers. A field is a contiguous region of text with the same `field'
9273 property (which can be a text property or an overlay).
9274
9275 Many emacs functions, such as forward-word, forward-sentence,
9276 forward-paragraph, beginning-of-line, etc., stop moving when they come
9277 to the boundary between fields; beginning-of-line and end-of-line will
9278 not let the point move past the field boundary, but other movement
9279 commands continue into the next field if repeated. Stopping at field
9280 boundaries can be suppressed programmatically by binding
9281 `inhibit-field-text-motion' to a non-nil value around calls to these
9282 functions.
9283
9284 Now that the minibuffer prompt is inserted into the minibuffer, it is in
9285 a separate field from the user-input part of the buffer, so that common
9286 editing commands treat the user's text separately from the prompt.
9287
9288 The following functions are defined for operating on fields:
9289
9290 - Function: constrain-to-field NEW-POS OLD-POS &optional ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE ONLY-IN-LINE INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY
9291
9292 Return the position closest to NEW-POS that is in the same field as OLD-POS.
9293
9294 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9295 If NEW-POS is nil, then the current point is used instead, and set to the
9296 constrained position if that is different.
9297
9298 If OLD-POS is at the boundary of two fields, then the allowable
9299 positions for NEW-POS depends on the value of the optional argument
9300 ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE: If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is nil, then NEW-POS is
9301 constrained to the field that has the same `field' char-property
9302 as any new characters inserted at OLD-POS, whereas if ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
9303 is non-nil, NEW-POS is constrained to the union of the two adjacent
9304 fields. Additionally, if two fields are separated by another field with
9305 the special value `boundary', then any point within this special field is
9306 also considered to be `on the boundary'.
9307
9308 If the optional argument ONLY-IN-LINE is non-nil and constraining
9309 NEW-POS would move it to a different line, NEW-POS is returned
9310 unconstrained. This useful for commands that move by line, like
9311 C-n or C-a, which should generally respect field boundaries
9312 only in the case where they can still move to the right line.
9313
9314 If the optional argument INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY is non-nil, and OLD-POS has
9315 a non-nil property of that name, then any field boundaries are ignored.
9316
9317 Field boundaries are not noticed if `inhibit-field-text-motion' is non-nil.
9318
9319 - Function: delete-field &optional POS
9320
9321 Delete the field surrounding POS.
9322 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9323 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9324
9325 - Function: field-beginning &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
9326
9327 Return the beginning of the field surrounding POS.
9328 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9329 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9330 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the beginning of its
9331 field, then the beginning of the *previous* field is returned.
9332
9333 - Function: field-end &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
9334
9335 Return the end of the field surrounding POS.
9336 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9337 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9338 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the end of its field,
9339 then the end of the *following* field is returned.
9340
9341 - Function: field-string &optional POS
9342
9343 Return the contents of the field surrounding POS as a string.
9344 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9345 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9346
9347 - Function: field-string-no-properties &optional POS
9348
9349 Return the contents of the field around POS, without text-properties.
9350 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9351 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9352
9353 ** Image support.
9354
9355 Emacs can now display images. Images are inserted into text by giving
9356 strings or buffer text a `display' text property containing one of
9357 (AREA IMAGE) or IMAGE. The display of the `display' property value
9358 replaces the display of the characters having that property.
9359
9360 If the property value has the form (AREA IMAGE), AREA must be one of
9361 `(margin left-margin)', `(margin right-margin)' or `(margin nil)'. If
9362 AREA is `(margin nil)', IMAGE will be displayed in the text area of a
9363 window, otherwise it will be displayed in the left or right marginal
9364 area.
9365
9366 IMAGE is an image specification.
9367
9368 *** Image specifications
9369
9370 Image specifications are lists of the form `(image PROPS)' where PROPS
9371 is a property list whose keys are keyword symbols. Each
9372 specifications must contain a property `:type TYPE' with TYPE being a
9373 symbol specifying the image type, e.g. `xbm'. Properties not
9374 described below are ignored.
9375
9376 The following is a list of properties all image types share.
9377
9378 `:ascent ASCENT'
9379
9380 ASCENT must be a number in the range 0..100, or the symbol `center'.
9381 If it is a number, it specifies the percentage of the image's height
9382 to use for its ascent.
9383
9384 If not specified, ASCENT defaults to the value 50 which means that the
9385 image will be centered with the base line of the row it appears in.
9386
9387 If ASCENT is `center' the image is vertically centered around a
9388 centerline which is the vertical center of text drawn at the position
9389 of the image, in the manner specified by the text properties and
9390 overlays that apply to the image.
9391
9392 `:margin MARGIN'
9393
9394 MARGIN must be either a number >= 0 specifying how many pixels to put
9395 as margin around the image, or a pair (X . Y) with X specifying the
9396 horizontal margin and Y specifying the vertical margin. Default is 0.
9397
9398 `:relief RELIEF'
9399
9400 RELIEF is analogous to the `:relief' attribute of faces. Puts a relief
9401 around an image.
9402
9403 `:conversion ALGO'
9404
9405 Apply an image algorithm to the image before displaying it.
9406
9407 ALGO `laplace' or `emboss' means apply a Laplace or ``emboss''
9408 edge-detection algorithm to the image.
9409
9410 ALGO `(edge-detection :matrix MATRIX :color-adjust ADJUST)' means
9411 apply a general edge-detection algorithm. MATRIX must be either a
9412 nine-element list or a nine-element vector of numbers. A pixel at
9413 position x/y in the transformed image is computed from original pixels
9414 around that position. MATRIX specifies, for each pixel in the
9415 neighborhood of x/y, a factor with which that pixel will influence the
9416 transformed pixel; element 0 specifies the factor for the pixel at
9417 x-1/y-1, element 1 the factor for the pixel at x/y-1 etc. as shown
9418 below.
9419
9420 (x-1/y-1 x/y-1 x+1/y-1
9421 x-1/y x/y x+1/y
9422 x-1/y+1 x/y+1 x+1/y+1)
9423
9424 The resulting pixel is computed from the color intensity of the color
9425 resulting from summing up the RGB values of surrounding pixels,
9426 multiplied by the specified factors, and dividing that sum by the sum
9427 of the factors' absolute values.
9428
9429 Laplace edge-detection currently uses a matrix of
9430
9431 (1 0 0
9432 0 0 0
9433 9 9 -1)
9434
9435 Emboss edge-detection uses a matrix of
9436
9437 ( 2 -1 0
9438 -1 0 1
9439 0 1 -2)
9440
9441 ALGO `disabled' means transform the image so that it looks
9442 ``disabled''.
9443
9444 `:mask MASK'
9445
9446 If MASK is `heuristic' or `(heuristic BG)', build a clipping mask for
9447 the image, so that the background of a frame is visible behind the
9448 image. If BG is not specified, or if BG is t, determine the
9449 background color of the image by looking at the 4 corners of the
9450 image, assuming the most frequently occurring color from the corners is
9451 the background color of the image. Otherwise, BG must be a list `(RED
9452 GREEN BLUE)' specifying the color to assume for the background of the
9453 image.
9454
9455 If MASK is nil, remove a mask from the image, if it has one. Images
9456 in some formats include a mask which can be removed by specifying
9457 `:mask nil'.
9458
9459 `:file FILE'
9460
9461 Load image from FILE. If FILE is not absolute after expanding it,
9462 search for the image in `data-directory'. Some image types support
9463 building images from data. When this is done, no `:file' property
9464 may be present in the image specification.
9465
9466 `:data DATA'
9467
9468 Get image data from DATA. (As of this writing, this is not yet
9469 supported for image type `postscript'). Either :file or :data may be
9470 present in an image specification, but not both. All image types
9471 support strings as DATA, some types allow additional types of DATA.
9472
9473 *** Supported image types
9474
9475 **** XBM, image type `xbm'.
9476
9477 XBM images don't require an external library. Additional image
9478 properties supported are:
9479
9480 `:foreground FG'
9481
9482 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
9483 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
9484
9485 `:background BG'
9486
9487 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
9488 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
9489
9490 XBM images can be constructed from data instead of file. In this
9491 case, the image specification must contain the following properties
9492 instead of a `:file' property.
9493
9494 `:width WIDTH'
9495
9496 WIDTH specifies the width of the image in pixels.
9497
9498 `:height HEIGHT'
9499
9500 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pixels.
9501
9502 `:data DATA'
9503
9504 DATA must be either
9505
9506 1. a string large enough to hold the bitmap data, i.e. it must
9507 have a size >= (WIDTH + 7) / 8 * HEIGHT
9508
9509 2. a bool-vector of size >= WIDTH * HEIGHT
9510
9511 3. a vector of strings or bool-vectors, one for each line of the
9512 bitmap.
9513
9514 4. a string that's an in-memory XBM file. Neither width nor
9515 height may be specified in this case because these are defined
9516 in the file.
9517
9518 **** XPM, image type `xpm'
9519
9520 XPM images require the external library `libXpm', package
9521 `xpm-3.4k.tar.gz', version 3.4k or later. Make sure the library is
9522 found when Emacs is configured by supplying appropriate paths via
9523 `--x-includes' and `--x-libraries'.
9524
9525 Additional image properties supported are:
9526
9527 `:color-symbols SYMBOLS'
9528
9529 SYMBOLS must be a list of pairs (NAME . COLOR), with NAME being the
9530 name of color as it appears in an XPM file, and COLOR being an X color
9531 name.
9532
9533 XPM images can be built from memory instead of files. In that case,
9534 add a `:data' property instead of a `:file' property.
9535
9536 The XPM library uses libz in its implementation so that it is able
9537 to display compressed images.
9538
9539 **** PBM, image type `pbm'
9540
9541 PBM images don't require an external library. Color, gray-scale and
9542 mono images are supported. Additional image properties supported for
9543 mono images are:
9544
9545 `:foreground FG'
9546
9547 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
9548 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
9549
9550 `:background FG'
9551
9552 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
9553 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
9554
9555 **** JPEG, image type `jpeg'
9556
9557 Support for JPEG images requires the external library `libjpeg',
9558 package `jpegsrc.v6a.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9559 properties defined.
9560
9561 **** TIFF, image type `tiff'
9562
9563 Support for TIFF images requires the external library `libtiff',
9564 package `tiff-v3.4-tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9565 properties defined.
9566
9567 **** GIF, image type `gif'
9568
9569 Support for GIF images requires the external library `libungif', package
9570 `libungif-4.1.0', or later.
9571
9572 Additional image properties supported are:
9573
9574 `:index INDEX'
9575
9576 INDEX must be an integer >= 0. Load image number INDEX from a
9577 multi-image GIF file. If INDEX is too large, the image displays
9578 as a hollow box.
9579
9580 This could be used to implement limited support for animated GIFs.
9581 For example, the following function displays a multi-image GIF file
9582 at point-min in the current buffer, switching between sub-images
9583 every 0.1 seconds.
9584
9585 (defun show-anim (file max)
9586 "Display multi-image GIF file FILE which contains MAX subimages."
9587 (display-anim (current-buffer) file 0 max t))
9588
9589 (defun display-anim (buffer file idx max first-time)
9590 (when (= idx max)
9591 (setq idx 0))
9592 (let ((img (create-image file nil nil :index idx)))
9593 (save-excursion
9594 (set-buffer buffer)
9595 (goto-char (point-min))
9596 (unless first-time (delete-char 1))
9597 (insert-image img "x"))
9598 (run-with-timer 0.1 nil 'display-anim buffer file (1+ idx) max nil)))
9599
9600 **** PNG, image type `png'
9601
9602 Support for PNG images requires the external library `libpng',
9603 package `libpng-1.0.2.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9604 properties defined.
9605
9606 **** Ghostscript, image type `postscript'.
9607
9608 Additional image properties supported are:
9609
9610 `:pt-width WIDTH'
9611
9612 WIDTH is width of the image in pt (1/72 inch). WIDTH must be an
9613 integer. This is a required property.
9614
9615 `:pt-height HEIGHT'
9616
9617 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pt (1/72 inch). HEIGHT
9618 must be a integer. This is an required property.
9619
9620 `:bounding-box BOX'
9621
9622 BOX must be a list or vector of 4 integers giving the bounding box of
9623 the PS image, analogous to the `BoundingBox' comment found in PS
9624 files. This is an required property.
9625
9626 Part of the Ghostscript interface is implemented in Lisp. See
9627 lisp/gs.el.
9628
9629 *** Lisp interface.
9630
9631 The variable `image-types' contains a list of those image types
9632 which are supported in the current configuration.
9633
9634 Images are stored in an image cache and removed from the cache when
9635 they haven't been displayed for `image-cache-eviction-delay seconds.
9636 The function `clear-image-cache' can be used to clear the image cache
9637 manually. Images in the cache are compared with `equal', i.e. all
9638 images with `equal' specifications share the same image.
9639
9640 *** Simplified image API, image.el
9641
9642 The new Lisp package image.el contains functions that simplify image
9643 creation and putting images into text. The function `create-image'
9644 can be used to create images. The macro `defimage' can be used to
9645 define an image based on available image types. The functions
9646 `put-image' and `insert-image' can be used to insert an image into a
9647 buffer.
9648
9649 ** Display margins.
9650
9651 Windows can now have margins which are used for special text
9652 and images.
9653
9654 To give a window margins, either set the buffer-local variables
9655 `left-margin-width' and `right-margin-width', or call
9656 `set-window-margins'. The function `window-margins' can be used to
9657 obtain the current settings. To make `left-margin-width' and
9658 `right-margin-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
9659 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
9660 of the display margins.
9661
9662 You can put text in margins by giving it a `display' text property
9663 containing a pair of the form `(LOCATION . VALUE)', where LOCATION is
9664 one of `left-margin' or `right-margin' or nil. VALUE can be either a
9665 string, an image specification or a stretch specification (see later
9666 in this file).
9667
9668 ** Help display
9669
9670 Emacs displays short help messages in the echo area, when the mouse
9671 moves over a tool-bar item or a piece of text that has a text property
9672 `help-echo'. This feature also applies to strings in the mode line
9673 that have a `help-echo' property.
9674
9675 If the value of the `help-echo' property is a function, that function
9676 is called with three arguments WINDOW, OBJECT and POSITION. WINDOW is
9677 the window in which the help was found.
9678
9679 If OBJECT is a buffer, POS is the position in the buffer where the
9680 `help-echo' text property was found.
9681
9682 If OBJECT is an overlay, that overlay has a `help-echo' property, and
9683 POS is the position in the overlay's buffer under the mouse.
9684
9685 If OBJECT is a string (an overlay string or a string displayed with
9686 the `display' property), POS is the position in that string under the
9687 mouse.
9688
9689 If the value of the `help-echo' property is neither a function nor a
9690 string, it is evaluated to obtain a help string.
9691
9692 For tool-bar and menu-bar items, their key definition is used to
9693 determine the help to display. If their definition contains a
9694 property `:help FORM', FORM is evaluated to determine the help string.
9695 For tool-bar items without a help form, the caption of the item is
9696 used as help string.
9697
9698 The hook `show-help-function' can be set to a function that displays
9699 the help string differently. For example, enabling a tooltip window
9700 causes the help display to appear there instead of in the echo area.
9701
9702 ** Vertical fractional scrolling.
9703
9704 The display of text in windows can be scrolled smoothly in pixels.
9705 This is useful, for example, for making parts of large images visible.
9706
9707 The function `window-vscroll' returns the current value of vertical
9708 scrolling, a non-negative fraction of the canonical character height.
9709 The function `set-window-vscroll' can be used to set the vertical
9710 scrolling value. Here is an example of how these function might be
9711 used.
9712
9713 (global-set-key [A-down]
9714 #'(lambda ()
9715 (interactive)
9716 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
9717 (+ 0.5 (window-vscroll)))))
9718 (global-set-key [A-up]
9719 #'(lambda ()
9720 (interactive)
9721 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
9722 (- (window-vscroll) 0.5)))))
9723
9724 ** New hook `fontification-functions'.
9725
9726 Functions from `fontification-functions' are called from redisplay
9727 when it encounters a region of text that is not yet fontified. This
9728 variable automatically becomes buffer-local when set. Each function
9729 is called with one argument, POS.
9730
9731 At least one of the hook functions should fontify one or more
9732 characters starting at POS in the current buffer. It should mark them
9733 as fontified by giving them a non-nil value of the `fontified' text
9734 property. It may be reasonable for these functions to check for the
9735 `fontified' property and not put it back on, but they do not have to.
9736
9737 ** Tool bar support.
9738
9739 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. The frame
9740 parameter `tool-bar-lines' (X resource "toolBar", class "ToolBar")
9741 controls how may lines to reserve for the tool bar. A zero value
9742 suppresses the tool bar. If the value is non-zero and
9743 `auto-resize-tool-bars' is non-nil the tool bar's size will be changed
9744 automatically so that all tool bar items are visible.
9745
9746 *** Tool bar item definitions
9747
9748 Tool bar items are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
9749 `tool-bar'. For example `(define-key global-map [tool-bar item1] ITEM)'
9750 where ITEM is a list `(menu-item CAPTION BINDING PROPS...)'.
9751
9752 CAPTION is the caption of the item, If it's not a string, it is
9753 evaluated to get a string. The caption is currently not displayed in
9754 the tool bar, but it is displayed if the item doesn't have a `:help'
9755 property (see below).
9756
9757 BINDING is the tool bar item's binding. Tool bar items with keymaps as
9758 binding are currently ignored.
9759
9760 The following properties are recognized:
9761
9762 `:enable FORM'.
9763
9764 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is enabled
9765 or disabled.
9766
9767 `:visible FORM'
9768
9769 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is displayed.
9770
9771 `:filter FUNCTION'
9772
9773 FUNCTION is called with one parameter, the same list BINDING in which
9774 FUNCTION is specified as the filter. The value FUNCTION returns is
9775 used instead of BINDING to display this item.
9776
9777 `:button (TYPE SELECTED)'
9778
9779 TYPE must be one of `:radio' or `:toggle'. SELECTED is evaluated
9780 and specifies whether the button is selected (pressed) or not.
9781
9782 `:image IMAGES'
9783
9784 IMAGES is either a single image specification or a vector of four
9785 image specifications. If it is a vector, this table lists the
9786 meaning of each of the four elements:
9787
9788 Index Use when item is
9789 ----------------------------------------
9790 0 enabled and selected
9791 1 enabled and deselected
9792 2 disabled and selected
9793 3 disabled and deselected
9794
9795 If IMAGE is a single image specification, a Laplace edge-detection
9796 algorithm is used on that image to draw the image in disabled state.
9797
9798 `:help HELP-STRING'.
9799
9800 Gives a help string to display for the tool bar item. This help
9801 is displayed when the mouse is moved over the item.
9802
9803 The function `toolbar-add-item' is a convenience function for adding
9804 toolbar items generally, and `tool-bar-add-item-from-menu' can be used
9805 to define a toolbar item with a binding copied from an item on the
9806 menu bar.
9807
9808 The default bindings use a menu-item :filter to derive the tool-bar
9809 dynamically from variable `tool-bar-map' which may be set
9810 buffer-locally to override the global map.
9811
9812 *** Tool-bar-related variables.
9813
9814 If `auto-resize-tool-bar' is non-nil, the tool bar will automatically
9815 resize to show all defined tool bar items. It will never grow larger
9816 than 1/4 of the frame's size.
9817
9818 If `auto-raise-tool-bar-buttons' is non-nil, tool bar buttons will be
9819 raised when the mouse moves over them.
9820
9821 You can add extra space between tool bar items by setting
9822 `tool-bar-button-margin' to a positive integer specifying a number of
9823 pixels, or a pair of integers (X . Y) specifying horizontal and
9824 vertical margins . Default is 1.
9825
9826 You can change the shadow thickness of tool bar buttons by setting
9827 `tool-bar-button-relief' to an integer. Default is 3.
9828
9829 *** Tool-bar clicks with modifiers.
9830
9831 You can bind commands to clicks with control, shift, meta etc. on
9832 a tool bar item. If
9833
9834 (define-key global-map [tool-bar shell]
9835 '(menu-item "Shell" shell
9836 :image (image :type xpm :file "shell.xpm")))
9837
9838 is the original tool bar item definition, then
9839
9840 (define-key global-map [tool-bar S-shell] 'some-command)
9841
9842 makes a binding to run `some-command' for a shifted click on the same
9843 item.
9844
9845 ** Mode line changes.
9846
9847 *** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
9848
9849 The mode line can be made mouse-sensitive by displaying strings there
9850 that have a `local-map' text property. There are three ways to display
9851 a string with a `local-map' property in the mode line.
9852
9853 1. The mode line spec contains a variable whose string value has
9854 a `local-map' text property.
9855
9856 2. The mode line spec contains a format specifier (e.g. `%12b'), and
9857 that format specifier has a `local-map' property.
9858
9859 3. The mode line spec contains a list containing `:eval FORM'. FORM
9860 is evaluated. If the result is a string, and that string has a
9861 `local-map' property.
9862
9863 The same mechanism is used to determine the `face' and `help-echo'
9864 properties of strings in the mode line. See `bindings.el' for an
9865 example.
9866
9867 *** If a mode line element has the form `(:eval FORM)', FORM is
9868 evaluated and the result is used as mode line element.
9869
9870 *** You can suppress mode-line display by setting the buffer-local
9871 variable mode-line-format to nil.
9872
9873 *** A headerline can now be displayed at the top of a window.
9874
9875 This mode line's contents are controlled by the new variable
9876 `header-line-format' and `default-header-line-format' which are
9877 completely analogous to `mode-line-format' and
9878 `default-mode-line-format'. A value of nil means don't display a top
9879 line.
9880
9881 The appearance of top mode lines is controlled by the face
9882 `header-line'.
9883
9884 The function `coordinates-in-window-p' returns `header-line' for a
9885 position in the header-line.
9886
9887 ** Text property `display'
9888
9889 The `display' text property is used to insert images into text,
9890 replace text with other text, display text in marginal area, and it is
9891 also used to control other aspects of how text displays. The value of
9892 the `display' property should be a display specification, as described
9893 below, or a list or vector containing display specifications.
9894
9895 *** Replacing text, displaying text in marginal areas
9896
9897 To replace the text having the `display' property with some other
9898 text, use a display specification of the form `(LOCATION STRING)'.
9899
9900 If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)', STRING is displayed in the left
9901 marginal area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in
9902 the right marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' STRING
9903 is displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
9904 simpler form STRING as property value.
9905
9906 *** Variable width and height spaces
9907
9908 To display a space of fractional width or height, use a display
9909 specification of the form `(LOCATION STRECH)'. If LOCATION is
9910 `(margin left-margin)', the space is displayed in the left marginal
9911 area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in the right
9912 marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the space is
9913 displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
9914 simpler form STRETCH as property value.
9915
9916 The stretch specification STRETCH itself is a list of the form `(space
9917 PROPS)', where PROPS is a property list which can contain the
9918 properties described below.
9919
9920 The display of the fractional space replaces the display of the
9921 characters having the `display' property.
9922
9923 - :width WIDTH
9924
9925 Specifies that the space width should be WIDTH times the normal
9926 character width. WIDTH can be an integer or floating point number.
9927
9928 - :relative-width FACTOR
9929
9930 Specifies that the width of the stretch should be computed from the
9931 first character in a group of consecutive characters that have the
9932 same `display' property. The computation is done by multiplying the
9933 width of that character by FACTOR.
9934
9935 - :align-to HPOS
9936
9937 Specifies that the space should be wide enough to reach HPOS. The
9938 value HPOS is measured in units of the normal character width.
9939
9940 Exactly one of the above properties should be used.
9941
9942 - :height HEIGHT
9943
9944 Specifies the height of the space, as HEIGHT, measured in terms of the
9945 normal line height.
9946
9947 - :relative-height FACTOR
9948
9949 The height of the space is computed as the product of the height
9950 of the text having the `display' property and FACTOR.
9951
9952 - :ascent ASCENT
9953
9954 Specifies that ASCENT percent of the height of the stretch should be
9955 used for the ascent of the stretch, i.e. for the part above the
9956 baseline. The value of ASCENT must be a non-negative number less or
9957 equal to 100.
9958
9959 You should not use both `:height' and `:relative-height' together.
9960
9961 *** Images
9962
9963 A display specification for an image has the form `(LOCATION
9964 . IMAGE)', where IMAGE is an image specification. The image replaces,
9965 in the display, the characters having this display specification in
9966 their `display' text property. If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)',
9967 the image will be displayed in the left marginal area, if it is
9968 `(margin right-margin)' it will be displayed in the right marginal
9969 area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the image will be displayed in
9970 the text. In the latter case you can also use the simpler form IMAGE
9971 as display specification.
9972
9973 *** Other display properties
9974
9975 - (space-width FACTOR)
9976
9977 Specifies that space characters in the text having that property
9978 should be displayed FACTOR times as wide as normal; FACTOR must be an
9979 integer or float.
9980
9981 - (height HEIGHT)
9982
9983 Display text having this property in a font that is smaller or larger.
9984
9985 If HEIGHT is a list of the form `(+ N)', where N is an integer, that
9986 means to use a font that is N steps larger. If HEIGHT is a list of
9987 the form `(- N)', that means to use a font that is N steps smaller. A
9988 ``step'' is defined by the set of available fonts; each size for which
9989 a font is available counts as a step.
9990
9991 If HEIGHT is a number, that means to use a font that is HEIGHT times
9992 as tall as the frame's default font.
9993
9994 If HEIGHT is a symbol, it is called as a function with the current
9995 height as argument. The function should return the new height to use.
9996
9997 Otherwise, HEIGHT is evaluated to get the new height, with the symbol
9998 `height' bound to the current specified font height.
9999
10000 - (raise FACTOR)
10001
10002 FACTOR must be a number, specifying a multiple of the current
10003 font's height. If it is positive, that means to display the characters
10004 raised. If it is negative, that means to display them lower down. The
10005 amount of raising or lowering is computed without taking account of the
10006 `height' subproperty.
10007
10008 *** Conditional display properties
10009
10010 All display specifications can be conditionalized. If a specification
10011 has the form `(when CONDITION . SPEC)', the specification SPEC applies
10012 only when CONDITION yields a non-nil value when evaluated. During the
10013 evaluation, `object' is bound to the string or buffer having the
10014 conditional display property; `position' and `buffer-position' are
10015 bound to the position within `object' and the buffer position where
10016 the display property was found, respectively. Both positions can be
10017 different when object is a string.
10018
10019 The normal specification consisting of SPEC only is equivalent to
10020 `(when t . SPEC)'.
10021
10022 ** New menu separator types.
10023
10024 Emacs now supports more than one menu separator type. Menu items with
10025 item names consisting of dashes only (including zero dashes) are
10026 treated like before. In addition, the following item names are used
10027 to specify other menu separator types.
10028
10029 - `--no-line' or `--space', or `--:space', or `--:noLine'
10030
10031 No separator lines are drawn, but a small space is inserted where the
10032 separator occurs.
10033
10034 - `--single-line' or `--:singleLine'
10035
10036 A single line in the menu's foreground color.
10037
10038 - `--double-line' or `--:doubleLine'
10039
10040 A double line in the menu's foreground color.
10041
10042 - `--single-dashed-line' or `--:singleDashedLine'
10043
10044 A single dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
10045
10046 - `--double-dashed-line' or `--:doubleDashedLine'
10047
10048 A double dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
10049
10050 - `--shadow-etched-in' or `--:shadowEtchedIn'
10051
10052 A single line with 3D sunken appearance. This is the form
10053 displayed for item names consisting of dashes only.
10054
10055 - `--shadow-etched-out' or `--:shadowEtchedOut'
10056
10057 A single line with 3D raised appearance.
10058
10059 - `--shadow-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedInDash'
10060
10061 A single dashed line with 3D sunken appearance.
10062
10063 - `--shadow-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedOutDash'
10064
10065 A single dashed line with 3D raise appearance.
10066
10067 - `--shadow-double-etched-in' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedIn'
10068
10069 Two lines with 3D sunken appearance.
10070
10071 - `--shadow-double-etched-out' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOut'
10072
10073 Two lines with 3D raised appearance.
10074
10075 - `--shadow-double-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedInDash'
10076
10077 Two dashed lines with 3D sunken appearance.
10078
10079 - `--shadow-double-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOutDash'
10080
10081 Two dashed lines with 3D raised appearance.
10082
10083 Under LessTif/Motif, the last four separator types are displayed like
10084 the corresponding single-line separators.
10085
10086 ** New frame parameters for scroll bar colors.
10087
10088 The new frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
10089 `scroll-bar-background' can be used to change scroll bar colors.
10090 Their value must be either a color name, a string, or nil to specify
10091 that scroll bars should use a default color. For toolkit scroll bars,
10092 default colors are toolkit specific. For non-toolkit scroll bars, the
10093 default background is the background color of the frame, and the
10094 default foreground is black.
10095
10096 The X resource name of these parameters are `scrollBarForeground'
10097 (class ScrollBarForeground) and `scrollBarBackground' (class
10098 `ScrollBarBackground').
10099
10100 Setting these parameters overrides toolkit specific X resource
10101 settings for scroll bar colors.
10102
10103 ** You can set `redisplay-dont-pause' to a non-nil value to prevent
10104 display updates from being interrupted when input is pending.
10105
10106 ** Changing a window's width may now change its window start if it
10107 starts on a continuation line. The new window start is computed based
10108 on the window's new width, starting from the start of the continued
10109 line as the start of the screen line with the minimum distance from
10110 the original window start.
10111
10112 ** The variable `hscroll-step' and the functions
10113 `hscroll-point-visible' and `hscroll-window-column' have been removed
10114 now that proper horizontal scrolling is implemented.
10115
10116 ** Windows can now be made fixed-width and/or fixed-height.
10117
10118 A window is fixed-size if its buffer has a buffer-local variable
10119 `window-size-fixed' whose value is not nil. A value of `height' makes
10120 windows fixed-height, a value of `width' makes them fixed-width, any
10121 other non-nil value makes them both fixed-width and fixed-height.
10122
10123 The following code makes all windows displaying the current buffer
10124 fixed-width and fixed-height.
10125
10126 (set (make-local-variable 'window-size-fixed) t)
10127
10128 A call to enlarge-window on a window gives an error if that window is
10129 fixed-width and it is tried to change the window's width, or if the
10130 window is fixed-height, and it is tried to change its height. To
10131 change the size of a fixed-size window, bind `window-size-fixed'
10132 temporarily to nil, for example
10133
10134 (let ((window-size-fixed nil))
10135 (enlarge-window 10))
10136
10137 Likewise, an attempt to split a fixed-height window vertically,
10138 or a fixed-width window horizontally results in a error.
10139
10140 ** The cursor-type frame parameter is now supported on MS-DOS
10141 terminals. When Emacs starts, it by default changes the cursor shape
10142 to a solid box, as it does on Unix. The `cursor-type' frame parameter
10143 overrides this as it does on Unix, except that the bar cursor is
10144 horizontal rather than vertical (since the MS-DOS display doesn't
10145 support a vertical-bar cursor).
10146
10147
10148 \f
10149 * Emacs 20.7 is a bug-fix release with few user-visible changes
10150
10151 ** It is now possible to use CCL-based coding systems for keyboard
10152 input.
10153
10154 ** ange-ftp now handles FTP security extensions, like Kerberos.
10155
10156 ** Rmail has been extended to recognize more forms of digest messages.
10157
10158 ** Now, most coding systems set in keyboard coding system work not
10159 only for character input, but also in incremental search. The
10160 exceptions are such coding systems that handle 2-byte character sets
10161 (e.g euc-kr, euc-jp) and that use ISO's escape sequence
10162 (e.g. iso-2022-jp). They are ignored in incremental search.
10163
10164 ** Support for Macintosh PowerPC-based machines running GNU/Linux has
10165 been added.
10166
10167 \f
10168 * Emacs 20.6 is a bug-fix release with one user-visible change
10169
10170 ** Support for ARM-based non-RISCiX machines has been added.
10171
10172
10173 \f
10174 * Emacs 20.5 is a bug-fix release with no user-visible changes.
10175
10176 ** Not new, but not mentioned before:
10177 M-w when Transient Mark mode is enabled disables the mark.
10178 \f
10179 * Changes in Emacs 20.4
10180
10181 ** Init file may be called .emacs.el.
10182
10183 You can now call the Emacs init file `.emacs.el'.
10184 Formerly the name had to be `.emacs'. If you use the name
10185 `.emacs.el', you can byte-compile the file in the usual way.
10186
10187 If both `.emacs' and `.emacs.el' exist, the latter file
10188 is the one that is used.
10189
10190 ** shell-command, and shell-command-on-region, now return
10191 the exit code of the command (unless it is asynchronous).
10192 Also, you can specify a place to put the error output,
10193 separate from the command's regular output.
10194 Interactively, the variable shell-command-default-error-buffer
10195 says where to put error output; set it to a buffer name.
10196 In calls from Lisp, an optional argument ERROR-BUFFER specifies
10197 the buffer name.
10198
10199 When you specify a non-nil error buffer (or buffer name), any error
10200 output is inserted before point in that buffer, with \f\n to separate
10201 it from the previous batch of error output. The error buffer is not
10202 cleared, so error output from successive commands accumulates there.
10203
10204 ** Setting the default value of enable-multibyte-characters to nil in
10205 the .emacs file, either explicitly using setq-default, or via Custom,
10206 is now essentially equivalent to using --unibyte: all buffers
10207 created during startup will be made unibyte after loading .emacs.
10208
10209 ** C-x C-f now handles the wildcards * and ? in file names. For
10210 example, typing C-x C-f c*.c RET visits all the files whose names
10211 match c*.c. To visit a file whose name contains * or ?, add the
10212 quoting sequence /: to the beginning of the file name.
10213
10214 ** The M-x commands keep-lines, flush-lines and count-matches
10215 now have the same feature as occur and query-replace:
10216 if the pattern contains any upper case letters, then
10217 they never ignore case.
10218
10219 ** The end-of-line format conversion feature previously mentioned
10220 under `* Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows' actually
10221 applies to all operating systems. Emacs recognizes from the contents
10222 of a file what convention it uses to separate lines--newline, CRLF, or
10223 just CR--and automatically converts the contents to the normal Emacs
10224 convention (using newline to separate lines) for editing. This is a
10225 part of the general feature of coding system conversion.
10226
10227 If you subsequently save the buffer, Emacs converts the text back to
10228 the same format that was used in the file before.
10229
10230 You can turn off end-of-line conversion by setting the variable
10231 `inhibit-eol-conversion' to non-nil, e.g. with Custom in the MULE group.
10232
10233 ** The character set property `prefered-coding-system' has been
10234 renamed to `preferred-coding-system', for the sake of correct spelling.
10235 This is a fairly internal feature, so few programs should be affected.
10236
10237 ** Mode-line display of end-of-line format is changed.
10238 The indication of the end-of-line format of the file visited by a
10239 buffer is now more explicit when that format is not the usual one for
10240 your operating system. For example, the DOS-style end-of-line format
10241 is displayed as "(DOS)" on Unix and GNU/Linux systems. The usual
10242 end-of-line format is still displayed as a single character (colon for
10243 Unix, backslash for DOS and Windows, and forward slash for the Mac).
10244
10245 The values of the variables eol-mnemonic-unix, eol-mnemonic-dos,
10246 eol-mnemonic-mac, and eol-mnemonic-undecided, which are strings,
10247 control what is displayed in the mode line for each end-of-line
10248 format. You can now customize these variables.
10249
10250 ** In the previous version of Emacs, tar-mode didn't work well if a
10251 filename contained non-ASCII characters. Now this is fixed. Such a
10252 filename is decoded by file-name-coding-system if the default value of
10253 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil.
10254
10255 ** The command temp-buffer-resize-mode toggles a minor mode
10256 in which temporary buffers (such as help buffers) are given
10257 windows just big enough to hold the whole contents.
10258
10259 ** If you use completion.el, you must now run the function
10260 dynamic-completion-mode to enable it. Just loading the file
10261 doesn't have any effect.
10262
10263 ** In Flyspell mode, the default is now to make just one Ispell process,
10264 not one per buffer.
10265
10266 ** If you use iswitchb but do not call (iswitchb-default-keybindings) to
10267 use the default keybindings, you will need to add the following line:
10268 (add-hook 'minibuffer-setup-hook 'iswitchb-minibuffer-setup)
10269
10270 ** Auto-show mode is no longer enabled just by loading auto-show.el.
10271 To control it, set `auto-show-mode' via Custom or use the
10272 `auto-show-mode' command.
10273
10274 ** Handling of X fonts' ascent/descent parameters has been changed to
10275 avoid redisplay problems. As a consequence, compared with previous
10276 versions the line spacing and frame size now differ with some font
10277 choices, typically increasing by a pixel per line. This change
10278 occurred in version 20.3 but was not documented then.
10279
10280 ** If you select the bar cursor style, it uses the frame's
10281 cursor-color, rather than the cursor foreground pixel.
10282
10283 ** In multibyte mode, Rmail decodes incoming MIME messages using the
10284 character set specified in the message. If you want to disable this
10285 feature, set the variable rmail-decode-mime-charset to nil.
10286
10287 ** Not new, but not mentioned previously in NEWS: when you use #! at
10288 the beginning of a file to make it executable and specify an
10289 interpreter program, Emacs looks on the second line for the -*- mode
10290 and variable specification, as well as on the first line.
10291
10292 ** Support for IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters.
10293
10294 The new command M-x codepage-setup creates a special coding system
10295 that can be used to convert text between a specific IBM codepage and
10296 one of the character sets built into Emacs which matches that
10297 codepage. For example, codepage 850 corresponds to Latin-1 character
10298 set, codepage 855 corresponds to Cyrillic-ISO character set, etc.
10299
10300 Windows codepages 1250, 1251 and some others, where Windows deviates
10301 from the corresponding ISO character set, are also supported.
10302
10303 IBM box-drawing characters and other glyphs which don't have
10304 equivalents in the corresponding ISO character set, are converted to
10305 a character defined by dos-unsupported-char-glyph on MS-DOS, and to
10306 `?' on other systems.
10307
10308 IBM codepages are widely used on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, so this
10309 feature is most useful on those platforms, but it can also be used on
10310 Unix.
10311
10312 Emacs compiled for MS-DOS automatically loads the support for the
10313 current codepage when it starts.
10314
10315 ** Mail changes
10316
10317 *** When mail is sent using compose-mail (C-x m), and if
10318 `mail-send-nonascii' is set to the new default value `mime',
10319 appropriate MIME headers are added. The headers are added only if
10320 non-ASCII characters are present in the body of the mail, and no other
10321 MIME headers are already present. For example, the following three
10322 headers are added if the coding system used in the *mail* buffer is
10323 latin-1:
10324
10325 MIME-version: 1.0
10326 Content-type: text/plain; charset=iso-8859-1
10327 Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit
10328
10329 *** The new variable default-sendmail-coding-system specifies the
10330 default way to encode outgoing mail. This has higher priority than
10331 default-buffer-file-coding-system but has lower priority than
10332 sendmail-coding-system and the local value of
10333 buffer-file-coding-system.
10334
10335 You should not set this variable manually. Instead, set
10336 sendmail-coding-system to specify a fixed encoding for all outgoing
10337 mail.
10338
10339 *** When you try to send a message that contains non-ASCII characters,
10340 if the coding system specified by those variables doesn't handle them,
10341 Emacs will ask you to select a suitable coding system while showing a
10342 list of possible coding systems.
10343
10344 ** CC Mode changes
10345
10346 *** c-default-style can now take an association list that maps major
10347 modes to style names. When this variable is an alist, Java mode no
10348 longer hardcodes a setting to "java" style. See the variable's
10349 docstring for details.
10350
10351 *** It's now possible to put a list as the offset on a syntactic
10352 symbol. The list is evaluated recursively until a non-nil offset is
10353 found. This is useful to combine several lineup functions to act in a
10354 prioritized order on a single line. However, none of the supplied
10355 lineup functions use this feature currently.
10356
10357 *** New syntactic symbol catch-clause, which is used on the "catch" and
10358 "finally" lines in try-catch constructs in C++ and Java.
10359
10360 *** New cleanup brace-catch-brace on c-cleanup-list, which does for
10361 "catch" lines what brace-elseif-brace does for "else if" lines.
10362
10363 *** The braces of Java anonymous inner classes are treated separately
10364 from the braces of other classes in auto-newline mode. Two new
10365 symbols inexpr-class-open and inexpr-class-close may be used on
10366 c-hanging-braces-alist to control the automatic newlines used for
10367 anonymous classes.
10368
10369 *** Support for the Pike language added, along with new Pike specific
10370 syntactic symbols: inlambda, lambda-intro-cont
10371
10372 *** Support for Java anonymous classes via new syntactic symbol
10373 inexpr-class. New syntactic symbol inexpr-statement for Pike
10374 support and gcc-style statements inside expressions. New lineup
10375 function c-lineup-inexpr-block.
10376
10377 *** New syntactic symbol brace-entry-open which is used in brace lists
10378 (i.e. static initializers) when a list entry starts with an open
10379 brace. These used to be recognized as brace-list-entry's.
10380 c-electric-brace also recognizes brace-entry-open braces
10381 (brace-list-entry's can no longer be electrified).
10382
10383 *** New command c-indent-line-or-region, not bound by default.
10384
10385 *** `#' is only electric when typed in the indentation of a line.
10386
10387 *** Parentheses are now electric (via the new command c-electric-paren)
10388 for auto-reindenting lines when parens are typed.
10389
10390 *** In "gnu" style, inline-open offset is now set to zero.
10391
10392 *** Uniform handling of the inclass syntactic symbol. The indentation
10393 associated with it is now always relative to the class opening brace.
10394 This means that the indentation behavior has changed in some
10395 circumstances, but only if you've put anything besides 0 on the
10396 class-open syntactic symbol (none of the default styles do that).
10397
10398 ** Gnus changes.
10399
10400 *** New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
10401 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added. See the
10402 Gnus manual for the full story.
10403
10404 *** The nndraft backend has returned, but works differently than
10405 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the nndraft
10406 group, which is created automatically.
10407
10408 *** `gnus-alter-header-function' can now be used to alter header
10409 values.
10410
10411 *** `gnus-summary-goto-article' now accept Message-ID's.
10412
10413 *** A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
10414 outside the region: `C-c C-v'.
10415
10416 *** You can now post to component group in nnvirtual groups with
10417 `C-u C-c C-c'.
10418
10419 *** `nntp-rlogin-program' -- new variable to ease customization.
10420
10421 *** `C-u C-c C-c' in `gnus-article-edit-mode' will now inhibit
10422 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
10423
10424 *** New element in `gnus-boring-article-headers' -- `long-to'.
10425
10426 *** `M-i' symbolic prefix command. See the section "Symbolic
10427 Prefixes" in the Gnus manual for details.
10428
10429 *** `L' and `I' in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
10430 `a' to add the score rule to the "all.SCORE" file.
10431
10432 *** `gnus-simplify-subject-functions' variable to allow greater
10433 control over simplification.
10434
10435 *** `A T' -- new command for fetching the current thread.
10436
10437 *** `/ T' -- new command for including the current thread in the
10438 limit.
10439
10440 *** `M-RET' is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
10441
10442 *** \\1-expressions are now valid in `nnmail-split-methods'.
10443
10444 *** The `custom-face-lookup' function has been removed.
10445 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
10446 rewrite them to use `face-spec-set' instead.
10447
10448 *** Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
10449 `a' forces normal posting method.
10450
10451 *** New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper text
10452 -- `W d'.
10453
10454 *** For easier debugging of nntp, you can set `nntp-record-commands'
10455 to a non-nil value.
10456
10457 *** nntp now uses ~/.authinfo, a .netrc-like file, for controlling
10458 where and how to send AUTHINFO to NNTP servers.
10459
10460 *** A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
10461 has been added.
10462
10463 *** A history of where mails have been split is available.
10464
10465 *** A new article date command has been added -- `article-date-iso8601'.
10466
10467 *** Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
10468 `gnus-score-thread-simplify'.
10469
10470 *** A new function for citing in Message has been added --
10471 `message-cite-original-without-signature'.
10472
10473 *** `article-strip-all-blank-lines' -- new article command.
10474
10475 *** A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
10476 been added.
10477
10478 *** A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
10479 `gnus-adaptive-word-minimum' variable.
10480
10481 *** The "lapsed date" article header can be kept continually
10482 updated by the `gnus-start-date-timer' command.
10483
10484 *** Web listserv archives can be read with the nnlistserv backend.
10485
10486 *** Old dejanews archives can now be read by nnweb.
10487
10488 *** `gnus-posting-styles' has been re-activated.
10489
10490 ** Changes to TeX and LaTeX mode
10491
10492 *** The new variable `tex-start-options-string' can be used to give
10493 options for the TeX run. The default value causes TeX to run in
10494 nonstopmode. For an interactive TeX run set it to nil or "".
10495
10496 *** The command `tex-feed-input' sends input to the Tex Shell. In a
10497 TeX buffer it is bound to the keys C-RET, C-c RET, and C-c C-m (some
10498 of these keys may not work on all systems). For instance, if you run
10499 TeX interactively and if the TeX run stops because of an error, you
10500 can continue it without leaving the TeX buffer by typing C-RET.
10501
10502 *** The Tex Shell Buffer is now in `compilation-shell-minor-mode'.
10503 All error-parsing commands of the Compilation major mode are available
10504 but bound to keys that don't collide with the shell. Thus you can use
10505 the Tex Shell for command line executions like a usual shell.
10506
10507 *** The commands `tex-validate-region' and `tex-validate-buffer' check
10508 the matching of braces and $'s. The errors are listed in a *Occur*
10509 buffer and you can use C-c C-c or mouse-2 to go to a particular
10510 mismatch.
10511
10512 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
10513
10514 *** The table of contents buffer can now also display labels and
10515 file boundaries in addition to sections. Use `l', `i', and `c' keys.
10516
10517 *** Labels derived from context (the section heading) are now
10518 lowercase by default. To make the label legal in LaTeX, latin-1
10519 characters will lose their accent. All Mule characters will be
10520 removed from the label.
10521
10522 *** The automatic display of cross reference information can also use
10523 a window instead of the echo area. See variable `reftex-auto-view-crossref'.
10524
10525 *** kpsewhich can be used by RefTeX to find TeX and BibTeX files. See the
10526 customization group `reftex-finding-files'.
10527
10528 *** The option `reftex-bibfile-ignore-list' has been renamed to
10529 `reftex-bibfile-ignore-regexps' and indeed can be fed with regular
10530 expressions.
10531
10532 *** Multiple Selection buffers are now hidden buffers.
10533
10534 ** New/deleted modes and packages
10535
10536 *** The package snmp-mode.el provides major modes for editing SNMP and
10537 SNMPv2 MIBs. It has entries on `auto-mode-alist'.
10538
10539 *** The package sql.el provides a major mode, M-x sql-mode, for
10540 editing SQL files, and M-x sql-interactive-mode for interacting with
10541 SQL interpreters. It has an entry on `auto-mode-alist'.
10542
10543 *** M-x highlight-changes-mode provides a minor mode displaying buffer
10544 changes with a special face.
10545
10546 *** ispell4.el has been deleted. It got in the way of ispell.el and
10547 this was hard to fix reliably. It has long been obsolete -- use
10548 Ispell 3.1 and ispell.el.
10549 \f
10550 * MS-DOS changes in Emacs 20.4
10551
10552 ** Emacs compiled for MS-DOS now supports MULE features better.
10553 This includes support for display of all ISO 8859-N character sets,
10554 conversion to and from IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters,
10555 and automatic setup of the MULE environment at startup. For details,
10556 check out the section `MS-DOS and MULE' in the manual.
10557
10558 The MS-DOS installation procedure automatically configures and builds
10559 Emacs with input method support if it finds an unpacked Leim
10560 distribution when the config.bat script is run.
10561
10562 ** Formerly, the value of lpr-command did not affect printing on
10563 MS-DOS unless print-region-function was set to nil, but now it
10564 controls whether an external program is invoked or output is written
10565 directly to a printer port. Similarly, in the previous version of
10566 Emacs, the value of ps-lpr-command did not affect PostScript printing
10567 on MS-DOS unless ps-printer-name was set to something other than a
10568 string (eg. t or `pipe'), but now it controls whether an external
10569 program is used. (These changes were made so that configuration of
10570 printing variables would be almost identical across all platforms.)
10571
10572 ** In the previous version of Emacs, PostScript and non-PostScript
10573 output was piped to external programs, but because most print programs
10574 available for MS-DOS and MS-Windows cannot read data from their standard
10575 input, on those systems the data to be output is now written to a
10576 temporary file whose name is passed as the last argument to the external
10577 program.
10578
10579 An exception is made for `print', a standard program on Windows NT,
10580 and `nprint', a standard program on Novell Netware. For both of these
10581 programs, the command line is constructed in the appropriate syntax
10582 automatically, using only the value of printer-name or ps-printer-name
10583 as appropriate--the value of the relevant `-switches' variable is
10584 ignored, as both programs have no useful switches.
10585
10586 ** The value of the variable dos-printer (cf. dos-ps-printer), if it has
10587 a value, overrides the value of printer-name (cf. ps-printer-name), on
10588 MS-DOS and MS-Windows only. This has been true since version 20.3, but
10589 was not documented clearly before.
10590
10591 ** All the Emacs games now work on MS-DOS terminals.
10592 This includes Tetris and Snake.
10593 \f
10594 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.4
10595
10596 ** New functions line-beginning-position and line-end-position
10597 return the position of the beginning or end of the current line.
10598 They both accept an optional argument, which has the same
10599 meaning as the argument to beginning-of-line or end-of-line.
10600
10601 ** find-file and allied functions now have an optional argument
10602 WILDCARD. If this is non-nil, they do wildcard processing,
10603 and visit all files that match the wildcard pattern.
10604
10605 ** Changes in the file-attributes function.
10606
10607 *** The file size returned by file-attributes may be an integer or a float.
10608 It is an integer if the size fits in a Lisp integer, float otherwise.
10609
10610 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
10611 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a cons cell containing two
10612 integers.
10613
10614 ** The new function directory-files-and-attributes returns a list of
10615 files in a directory and their attributes. It accepts the same
10616 arguments as directory-files and has similar semantics, except that
10617 file names and attributes are returned.
10618
10619 ** The new function file-attributes-lessp is a helper function for
10620 sorting the list generated by directory-files-and-attributes. It
10621 accepts two arguments, each a list of a file name and its attributes.
10622 It compares the file names of each according to string-lessp and
10623 returns the result.
10624
10625 ** The new function file-expand-wildcards expands a wildcard-pattern
10626 to produce a list of existing files that match the pattern.
10627
10628 ** New functions for base64 conversion:
10629
10630 The function base64-encode-region converts a part of the buffer
10631 into the base64 code used in MIME. base64-decode-region
10632 performs the opposite conversion. Line-breaking is supported
10633 optionally.
10634
10635 Functions base64-encode-string and base64-decode-string do a similar
10636 job on the text in a string. They return the value as a new string.
10637
10638 **
10639 The new function process-running-child-p
10640 will tell you if a subprocess has given control of its
10641 terminal to its own child process.
10642
10643 ** interrupt-process and such functions have a new feature:
10644 when the second argument is `lambda', they send a signal
10645 to the running child of the subshell, if any, but if the shell
10646 itself owns its terminal, no signal is sent.
10647
10648 ** There are new widget types `plist' and `alist' which can
10649 be used for customizing variables whose values are plists or alists.
10650
10651 ** easymenu.el now understands `:key-sequence' and `:style button'.
10652 :included is an alias for :visible.
10653
10654 easy-menu-add-item now understands the values returned by
10655 easy-menu-remove-item and easy-menu-item-present-p. This can be used
10656 to move or copy menu entries.
10657
10658 ** Multibyte editing changes
10659
10660 *** The definitions of sref and char-bytes are changed. Now, sref is
10661 an alias of aref and char-bytes always returns 1. This change is to
10662 make some Emacs Lisp code which works on 20.2 and earlier also
10663 work on the latest Emacs. Such code uses a combination of sref and
10664 char-bytes in a loop typically as below:
10665 (setq char (sref str idx)
10666 idx (+ idx (char-bytes idx)))
10667 The byte-compiler now warns that this is obsolete.
10668
10669 If you want to know how many bytes a specific multibyte character
10670 (say, CH) occupies in a multibyte buffer, use this code:
10671 (charset-bytes (char-charset ch))
10672
10673 *** In multibyte mode, when you narrow a buffer to some region, and the
10674 region is preceded or followed by non-ASCII codes, inserting or
10675 deleting at the head or the end of the region may signal this error:
10676
10677 Byte combining across boundary of accessible buffer text inhibited
10678
10679 This is to avoid some bytes being combined together into a character
10680 across the boundary.
10681
10682 *** The functions find-charset-region and find-charset-string include
10683 `unknown' in the returned list in the following cases:
10684 o The current buffer or the target string is unibyte and
10685 contains 8-bit characters.
10686 o The current buffer or the target string is multibyte and
10687 contains invalid characters.
10688
10689 *** The functions decode-coding-region and encode-coding-region remove
10690 text properties of the target region. Ideally, they should correctly
10691 preserve text properties, but for the moment, it's hard. Removing
10692 text properties is better than preserving them in a less-than-correct
10693 way.
10694
10695 *** prefer-coding-system sets EOL conversion of default coding systems.
10696 If the argument to prefer-coding-system specifies a certain type of
10697 end of line conversion, the default coding systems set by
10698 prefer-coding-system will specify that conversion type for end of line.
10699
10700 *** The new function thai-compose-string can be used to properly
10701 compose Thai characters in a string.
10702
10703 ** The primitive `define-prefix-command' now takes an optional third
10704 argument NAME, which should be a string. It supplies the menu name
10705 for the created keymap. Keymaps created in order to be displayed as
10706 menus should always use the third argument.
10707
10708 ** The meanings of optional second arguments for read-char,
10709 read-event, and read-char-exclusive are flipped. Now the second
10710 arguments are INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. These functions use the current
10711 input method (if any) if and only if INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD is non-nil.
10712
10713 ** The new function clear-this-command-keys empties out the contents
10714 of the vector that (this-command-keys) returns. This is useful in
10715 programs that read passwords, to prevent the passwords from echoing
10716 inadvertently as part of the next command in certain cases.
10717
10718 ** The new macro `with-temp-message' displays a temporary message in
10719 the echo area, while executing some Lisp code. Like `progn', it
10720 returns the value of the last form, but it also restores the previous
10721 echo area contents.
10722
10723 (with-temp-message MESSAGE &rest BODY)
10724
10725 ** The function `require' now takes an optional third argument
10726 NOERROR. If it is non-nil, then there is no error if the
10727 requested feature cannot be loaded.
10728
10729 ** In the function modify-face, an argument of (nil) for the
10730 foreground color, background color or stipple pattern
10731 means to clear out that attribute.
10732
10733 ** The `outer-window-id' frame property of an X frame
10734 gives the window number of the outermost X window for the frame.
10735
10736 ** Temporary buffers made with with-output-to-temp-buffer are now
10737 read-only by default, and normally use the major mode Help mode
10738 unless you put them in some other non-Fundamental mode before the
10739 end of with-output-to-temp-buffer.
10740
10741 ** The new functions gap-position and gap-size return information on
10742 the gap of the current buffer.
10743
10744 ** The new functions position-bytes and byte-to-position provide a way
10745 to convert between character positions and byte positions in the
10746 current buffer.
10747
10748 ** vc.el defines two new macros, `edit-vc-file' and `with-vc-file', to
10749 facilitate working with version-controlled files from Lisp programs.
10750 These macros check out a given file automatically if needed, and check
10751 it back in after any modifications have been made.
10752 \f
10753 * Installation Changes in Emacs 20.3
10754
10755 ** The default value of load-path now includes most subdirectories of
10756 the site-specific directories /usr/local/share/emacs/site-lisp and
10757 /usr/local/share/emacs/VERSION/site-lisp, in addition to those
10758 directories themselves. Both immediate subdirectories and
10759 subdirectories multiple levels down are added to load-path.
10760
10761 Not all subdirectories are included, though. Subdirectories whose
10762 names do not start with a letter or digit are excluded.
10763 Subdirectories named RCS or CVS are excluded. Also, a subdirectory
10764 which contains a file named `.nosearch' is excluded. You can use
10765 these methods to prevent certain subdirectories from being searched.
10766
10767 Emacs finds these subdirectories and adds them to load-path when it
10768 starts up. While it would be cleaner to find the subdirectories each
10769 time Emacs loads a file, that would be much slower.
10770
10771 This feature is an incompatible change. If you have stored some Emacs
10772 Lisp files in a subdirectory of the site-lisp directory specifically
10773 to prevent them from being used, you will need to rename the
10774 subdirectory to start with a non-alphanumeric character, or create a
10775 `.nosearch' file in it, in order to continue to achieve the desired
10776 results.
10777
10778 ** Emacs no longer includes an old version of the C preprocessor from
10779 GCC. This was formerly used to help compile Emacs with C compilers
10780 that had limits on the significant length of an identifier, but in
10781 fact we stopped supporting such compilers some time ago.
10782 \f
10783 * Changes in Emacs 20.3
10784
10785 ** The new command C-x z (repeat) repeats the previous command
10786 including its argument. If you repeat the z afterward,
10787 it repeats the command additional times; thus, you can
10788 perform many repetitions with one keystroke per repetition.
10789
10790 ** Emacs now supports "selective undo" which undoes only within a
10791 specified region. To do this, set point and mark around the desired
10792 region and type C-u C-x u (or C-u C-_). You can then continue undoing
10793 further, within the same region, by repeating the ordinary undo
10794 command C-x u or C-_. This will keep undoing changes that were made
10795 within the region you originally specified, until either all of them
10796 are undone, or it encounters a change which crosses the edge of that
10797 region.
10798
10799 In Transient Mark mode, undoing when a region is active requests
10800 selective undo.
10801
10802 ** If you specify --unibyte when starting Emacs, then all buffers are
10803 unibyte, except when a Lisp program specifically creates a multibyte
10804 buffer. Setting the environment variable EMACS_UNIBYTE has the same
10805 effect. The --no-unibyte option overrides EMACS_UNIBYTE and directs
10806 Emacs to run normally in multibyte mode.
10807
10808 The option --unibyte does not affect the reading of Emacs Lisp files,
10809 though. If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode, use
10810 -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line. That will force Emacs to
10811 load that file in unibyte mode, regardless of how Emacs was started.
10812
10813 ** toggle-enable-multibyte-characters no longer has a key binding and
10814 no longer appears in the menu bar. We've realized that changing the
10815 enable-multibyte-characters variable in an existing buffer is
10816 something that most users not do.
10817
10818 ** You can specify a coding system to use for the next cut or paste
10819 operations through the window system with the command C-x RET X.
10820 The coding system can make a difference for communication with other
10821 applications.
10822
10823 C-x RET x specifies a coding system for all subsequent cutting and
10824 pasting operations.
10825
10826 ** You can specify the printer to use for commands that do printing by
10827 setting the variable `printer-name'. Just what a printer name looks
10828 like depends on your operating system. You can specify a different
10829 printer for the Postscript printing commands by setting
10830 `ps-printer-name'.
10831
10832 ** Emacs now supports on-the-fly spell checking by the means of a
10833 minor mode. It is called M-x flyspell-mode. You don't have to remember
10834 any other special commands to use it, and you will hardly notice it
10835 except when you make a spelling error. Flyspell works by highlighting
10836 incorrect words as soon as they are completed or as soon as the cursor
10837 hits a new word.
10838
10839 Flyspell mode works with whichever dictionary you have selected for
10840 Ispell in Emacs. In TeX mode, it understands TeX syntax so as not
10841 to be confused by TeX commands.
10842
10843 You can correct a misspelled word by editing it into something
10844 correct. You can also correct it, or accept it as correct, by
10845 clicking on the word with Mouse-2; that gives you a pop-up menu
10846 of various alternative replacements and actions.
10847
10848 Flyspell mode also proposes "automatic" corrections. M-TAB replaces
10849 the current misspelled word with a possible correction. If several
10850 corrections are made possible, M-TAB cycles through them in
10851 alphabetical order, or in order of decreasing likelihood if
10852 flyspell-sort-corrections is nil.
10853
10854 Flyspell mode also flags an error when a word is repeated, if
10855 flyspell-mark-duplications-flag is non-nil.
10856
10857 ** Changes in input method usage.
10858
10859 Now you can use arrow keys (right, left, down, up) for selecting among
10860 the alternatives just the same way as you do by C-f, C-b, C-n, and C-p
10861 respectively.
10862
10863 You can use the ENTER key to accept the current conversion.
10864
10865 If you type TAB to display a list of alternatives, you can select one
10866 of the alternatives with Mouse-2.
10867
10868 The meaning of the variable `input-method-verbose-flag' is changed so
10869 that you can set it to t, nil, `default', or `complex-only'.
10870
10871 If the value is nil, extra guidance is never given.
10872
10873 If the value is t, extra guidance is always given.
10874
10875 If the value is `complex-only', extra guidance is always given only
10876 when you are using complex input methods such as chinese-py.
10877
10878 If the value is `default' (this is the default), extra guidance is
10879 given in the following case:
10880 o When you are using a complex input method.
10881 o When you are using a simple input method but not in the minibuffer.
10882
10883 If you are using Emacs through a very slow line, setting
10884 input-method-verbose-flag to nil or to complex-only is a good choice,
10885 and if you are using an input method you are not familiar with,
10886 setting it to t is helpful.
10887
10888 The old command select-input-method is now called set-input-method.
10889
10890 In the language environment "Korean", you can use the following
10891 keys:
10892 Shift-SPC toggle-korean-input-method
10893 C-F9 quail-hangul-switch-symbol-ksc
10894 F9 quail-hangul-switch-hanja
10895 These key bindings are canceled when you switch to another language
10896 environment.
10897
10898 ** The minibuffer history of file names now records the specified file
10899 names, not the entire minibuffer input. For example, if the
10900 minibuffer starts out with /usr/foo/, you might type in /etc/passwd to
10901 get
10902
10903 /usr/foo//etc/passwd
10904
10905 which stands for the file /etc/passwd.
10906
10907 Formerly, this used to put /usr/foo//etc/passwd in the history list.
10908 Now this puts just /etc/passwd in the history list.
10909
10910 ** If you are root, Emacs sets backup-by-copying-when-mismatch to t
10911 at startup, so that saving a file will be sure to preserve
10912 its owner and group.
10913
10914 ** find-func.el can now also find the place of definition of Emacs
10915 Lisp variables in user-loaded libraries.
10916
10917 ** C-x r t (string-rectangle) now deletes the existing rectangle
10918 contents before inserting the specified string on each line.
10919
10920 ** There is a new command delete-whitespace-rectangle
10921 which deletes whitespace starting from a particular column
10922 in all the lines on a rectangle. The column is specified
10923 by the left edge of the rectangle.
10924
10925 ** You can now store a number into a register with C-u NUMBER C-x r n REG,
10926 increment it by INC with C-u INC C-x r + REG (to increment by one, omit
10927 C-u INC), and insert it in the buffer with C-x r g REG. This is useful
10928 for writing keyboard macros.
10929
10930 ** The new command M-x speedbar displays a frame in which directories,
10931 files, and tags can be displayed, manipulated, and jumped to. The
10932 frame defaults to 20 characters in width, and is the same height as
10933 the frame that it was started from. Some major modes define
10934 additional commands for the speedbar, including Rmail, GUD/GDB, and
10935 info.
10936
10937 ** query-replace-regexp is now bound to C-M-%.
10938
10939 ** In Transient Mark mode, when the region is active, M-x
10940 query-replace and the other replace commands now operate on the region
10941 contents only.
10942
10943 ** M-x write-region, when used interactively, now asks for
10944 confirmation before overwriting an existing file. When you call
10945 the function from a Lisp program, a new optional argument CONFIRM
10946 says whether to ask for confirmation in this case.
10947
10948 ** If you use find-file-literally and the file is already visited
10949 non-literally, the command asks you whether to revisit the file
10950 literally. If you say no, it signals an error.
10951
10952 ** Major modes defined with the "derived mode" feature
10953 now use the proper name for the mode hook: WHATEVER-mode-hook.
10954 Formerly they used the name WHATEVER-mode-hooks, but that is
10955 inconsistent with Emacs conventions.
10956
10957 ** shell-command-on-region (and shell-command) reports success or
10958 failure if the command produces no output.
10959
10960 ** Set focus-follows-mouse to nil if your window system or window
10961 manager does not transfer focus to another window when you just move
10962 the mouse.
10963
10964 ** mouse-menu-buffer-maxlen has been renamed to
10965 mouse-buffer-menu-maxlen to be consistent with the other related
10966 function and variable names.
10967
10968 ** The new variable auto-coding-alist specifies coding systems for
10969 reading specific files. This has higher priority than
10970 file-coding-system-alist.
10971
10972 ** If you set the variable unibyte-display-via-language-environment to
10973 t, then Emacs displays non-ASCII characters are displayed by
10974 converting them to the equivalent multibyte characters according to
10975 the current language environment. As a result, they are displayed
10976 according to the current fontset.
10977
10978 ** C-q's handling of codes in the range 0200 through 0377 is changed.
10979
10980 The codes in the range 0200 through 0237 are inserted as one byte of
10981 that code regardless of the values of nonascii-translation-table and
10982 nonascii-insert-offset.
10983
10984 For the codes in the range 0240 through 0377, if
10985 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil and nonascii-translation-table
10986 nor nonascii-insert-offset can't convert them to valid multibyte
10987 characters, they are converted to Latin-1 characters.
10988
10989 ** If you try to find a file that is not read-accessible, you now get
10990 an error, rather than an empty buffer and a warning.
10991
10992 ** In the minibuffer history commands M-r and M-s, an upper case
10993 letter in the regular expression forces case-sensitive search.
10994
10995 ** In the *Help* buffer, cross-references to commands and variables
10996 are inferred and hyperlinked. Use C-h m in Help mode for the relevant
10997 command keys.
10998
10999 ** M-x apropos-command, with a prefix argument, no longer looks for
11000 user option variables--instead it looks for noninteractive functions.
11001
11002 Meanwhile, the command apropos-variable normally searches for
11003 user option variables; with a prefix argument, it looks at
11004 all variables that have documentation.
11005
11006 ** When you type a long line in the minibuffer, and the minibuffer
11007 shows just one line, automatically scrolling works in a special way
11008 that shows you overlap with the previous line of text. The variable
11009 minibuffer-scroll-overlap controls how many characters of overlap
11010 it should show; the default is 20.
11011
11012 Meanwhile, Resize Minibuffer mode is still available; in that mode,
11013 the minibuffer grows taller (up to a point) as needed to show the whole
11014 of your input.
11015
11016 ** The new command M-x customize-changed-options lets you customize
11017 all the options whose meanings or default values have changed in
11018 recent Emacs versions. You specify a previous Emacs version number as
11019 argument, and the command creates a customization buffer showing all
11020 the customizable options which were changed since that version.
11021 Newly added options are included as well.
11022
11023 If you don't specify a particular version number argument,
11024 then the customization buffer shows all the customizable options
11025 for which Emacs versions of changes are recorded.
11026
11027 This function is also bound to the Changed Options entry in the
11028 Customize menu.
11029
11030 ** When you run M-x grep with a prefix argument, it figures out
11031 the tag around point and puts that into the default grep command.
11032
11033 ** The new command M-* (pop-tag-mark) pops back through a history of
11034 buffer positions from which M-. or other tag-finding commands were
11035 invoked.
11036
11037 ** The new variable comment-padding specifies the number of spaces
11038 that `comment-region' will insert before the actual text of the comment.
11039 The default is 1.
11040
11041 ** In Fortran mode the characters `.', `_' and `$' now have symbol
11042 syntax, not word syntax. Fortran mode now supports `imenu' and has
11043 new commands fortran-join-line (M-^) and fortran-narrow-to-subprogram
11044 (C-x n d). M-q can be used to fill a statement or comment block
11045 sensibly.
11046
11047 ** GUD now supports jdb, the Java debugger, and pdb, the Python debugger.
11048
11049 ** If you set the variable add-log-keep-changes-together to a non-nil
11050 value, the command `C-x 4 a' will automatically notice when you make
11051 two entries in one day for one file, and combine them.
11052
11053 ** You can use the command M-x diary-mail-entries to mail yourself a
11054 reminder about upcoming diary entries. See the documentation string
11055 for a sample shell script for calling this function automatically
11056 every night.
11057
11058 ** Desktop changes
11059
11060 *** All you need to do to enable use of the Desktop package, is to set
11061 the variable desktop-enable to t with Custom.
11062
11063 *** Minor modes are now restored. Which minor modes are restored
11064 and how modes are restored is controlled by `desktop-minor-mode-table'.
11065
11066 ** There is no need to do anything special, now, to enable Gnus to
11067 read and post multi-lingual articles.
11068
11069 ** Outline mode has now support for showing hidden outlines when
11070 doing an isearch. In order for this to happen search-invisible should
11071 be set to open (the default). If an isearch match is inside a hidden
11072 outline the outline is made visible. If you continue pressing C-s and
11073 the match moves outside the formerly invisible outline, the outline is
11074 made invisible again.
11075
11076 ** Mail reading and sending changes
11077
11078 *** The Rmail e command now switches to displaying the whole header of
11079 the message before it lets you edit the message. This is so that any
11080 changes you make in the header will not be lost if you subsequently
11081 toggle.
11082
11083 *** The w command in Rmail, which writes the message body into a file,
11084 now works in the summary buffer as well. (The command to delete the
11085 summary buffer is now Q.) The default file name for the w command, if
11086 the message has no subject, is stored in the variable
11087 rmail-default-body-file.
11088
11089 *** Most of the commands and modes that operate on mail and netnews no
11090 longer depend on the value of mail-header-separator. Instead, they
11091 handle whatever separator the buffer happens to use.
11092
11093 *** If you set mail-signature to a value which is not t, nil, or a string,
11094 it should be an expression. When you send a message, this expression
11095 is evaluated to insert the signature.
11096
11097 *** The new Lisp library feedmail.el (version 8) enhances processing of
11098 outbound email messages. It works in coordination with other email
11099 handling packages (e.g., rmail, VM, gnus) and is responsible for
11100 putting final touches on messages and actually submitting them for
11101 transmission. Users of the emacs program "fakemail" might be
11102 especially interested in trying feedmail.
11103
11104 feedmail is not enabled by default. See comments at the top of
11105 feedmail.el for set-up instructions. Among the bigger features
11106 provided by feedmail are:
11107
11108 **** you can park outgoing messages into a disk-based queue and
11109 stimulate sending some or all of them later (handy for laptop users);
11110 there is also a queue for draft messages
11111
11112 **** you can get one last look at the prepped outbound message and
11113 be prompted for confirmation
11114
11115 **** does smart filling of address headers
11116
11117 **** can generate a MESSAGE-ID: line and a DATE: line; the date can be
11118 the time the message was written or the time it is being sent; this
11119 can make FCC copies more closely resemble copies that recipients get
11120
11121 **** you can specify an arbitrary function for actually transmitting
11122 the message; included in feedmail are interfaces for /bin/[r]mail,
11123 /usr/lib/sendmail, and Emacs Lisp smtpmail; it's easy to write a new
11124 function for something else (10-20 lines of Lisp code).
11125
11126 ** Dired changes
11127
11128 *** The Dired function dired-do-toggle, which toggles marked and unmarked
11129 files, is now bound to "t" instead of "T".
11130
11131 *** dired-at-point has been added to ffap.el. It allows one to easily
11132 run Dired on the directory name at point.
11133
11134 *** Dired has a new command: %g. It searches the contents of
11135 files in the directory and marks each file that contains a match
11136 for a specified regexp.
11137
11138 ** VC Changes
11139
11140 *** New option vc-ignore-vc-files lets you turn off version control
11141 conveniently.
11142
11143 *** VC Dired has been completely rewritten. It is now much
11144 faster, especially for CVS, and works very similar to ordinary
11145 Dired.
11146
11147 VC Dired is invoked by typing C-x v d and entering the name of the
11148 directory to display. By default, VC Dired gives you a recursive
11149 listing of all files at or below the given directory which are
11150 currently locked (for CVS, all files not up-to-date are shown).
11151
11152 You can change the listing format by setting vc-dired-recurse to nil,
11153 then it shows only the given directory, and you may also set
11154 vc-dired-terse-display to nil, then it shows all files under version
11155 control plus the names of any subdirectories, so that you can type `i'
11156 on such lines to insert them manually, as in ordinary Dired.
11157
11158 All Dired commands operate normally in VC Dired, except for `v', which
11159 is redefined as the version control prefix. That means you may type
11160 `v l', `v =' etc. to invoke `vc-print-log', `vc-diff' and the like on
11161 the file named in the current Dired buffer line. `v v' invokes
11162 `vc-next-action' on this file, or on all files currently marked.
11163
11164 The new command `v t' (vc-dired-toggle-terse-mode) allows you to
11165 toggle between terse display (only locked files) and full display (all
11166 VC files plus subdirectories). There is also a special command,
11167 `* l', to mark all files currently locked.
11168
11169 Giving a prefix argument to C-x v d now does the same thing as in
11170 ordinary Dired: it allows you to supply additional options for the ls
11171 command in the minibuffer, to fine-tune VC Dired's output.
11172
11173 *** Under CVS, if you merge changes from the repository into a working
11174 file, and CVS detects conflicts, VC now offers to start an ediff
11175 session to resolve them.
11176
11177 Alternatively, you can use the new command `vc-resolve-conflicts' to
11178 resolve conflicts in a file at any time. It works in any buffer that
11179 contains conflict markers as generated by rcsmerge (which is what CVS
11180 uses as well).
11181
11182 *** You can now transfer changes between branches, using the new
11183 command vc-merge (C-x v m). It is implemented for RCS and CVS. When
11184 you invoke it in a buffer under version-control, you can specify
11185 either an entire branch or a pair of versions, and the changes on that
11186 branch or between the two versions are merged into the working file.
11187 If this results in any conflicts, they may be resolved interactively,
11188 using ediff.
11189
11190 ** Changes in Font Lock
11191
11192 *** The face and variable previously known as font-lock-reference-face
11193 are now called font-lock-constant-face to better reflect their typical
11194 use for highlighting constants and labels. (Its face properties are
11195 unchanged.) The variable font-lock-reference-face remains for now for
11196 compatibility reasons, but its value is font-lock-constant-face.
11197
11198 ** Frame name display changes
11199
11200 *** The command set-frame-name lets you set the name of the current
11201 frame. You can use the new command select-frame-by-name to select and
11202 raise a frame; this is mostly useful on character-only terminals, or
11203 when many frames are invisible or iconified.
11204
11205 *** On character-only terminal (not a window system), changing the
11206 frame name is now reflected on the mode line and in the Buffers/Frames
11207 menu.
11208
11209 ** Comint (subshell) changes
11210
11211 *** In Comint modes, the commands to kill, stop or interrupt a
11212 subjob now also kill pending input. This is for compatibility
11213 with ordinary shells, where the signal characters do this.
11214
11215 *** There are new commands in Comint mode.
11216
11217 C-c C-x fetches the "next" line from the input history;
11218 that is, the line after the last line you got.
11219 You can use this command to fetch successive lines, one by one.
11220
11221 C-c SPC accumulates lines of input. More precisely, it arranges to
11222 send the current line together with the following line, when you send
11223 the following line.
11224
11225 C-c C-a if repeated twice consecutively now moves to the process mark,
11226 which separates the pending input from the subprocess output and the
11227 previously sent input.
11228
11229 C-c M-r now runs comint-previous-matching-input-from-input;
11230 it searches for a previous command, using the current pending input
11231 as the search string.
11232
11233 *** New option compilation-scroll-output can be set to scroll
11234 automatically in compilation-mode windows.
11235
11236 ** C mode changes
11237
11238 *** Multiline macros are now handled, both as they affect indentation,
11239 and as recognized syntax. New syntactic symbol cpp-macro-cont is
11240 assigned to second and subsequent lines of a multiline macro
11241 definition.
11242
11243 *** A new style "user" which captures all non-hook-ified
11244 (i.e. top-level) .emacs file variable settings and customizations.
11245 Style "cc-mode" is an alias for "user" and is deprecated. "gnu"
11246 style is still the default however.
11247
11248 *** "java" style now conforms to Sun's JDK coding style.
11249
11250 *** There are new commands c-beginning-of-defun, c-end-of-defun which
11251 are alternatives which you could bind to C-M-a and C-M-e if you prefer
11252 them. They do not have key bindings by default.
11253
11254 *** New and improved implementations of M-a (c-beginning-of-statement)
11255 and M-e (c-end-of-statement).
11256
11257 *** C++ namespace blocks are supported, with new syntactic symbols
11258 namespace-open, namespace-close, and innamespace.
11259
11260 *** File local variable settings of c-file-style and c-file-offsets
11261 makes the style variables local to that buffer only.
11262
11263 *** New indentation functions c-lineup-close-paren,
11264 c-indent-one-line-block, c-lineup-dont-change.
11265
11266 *** Improvements (hopefully!) to the way CC Mode is loaded. You
11267 should now be able to do a (require 'cc-mode) to get the entire
11268 package loaded properly for customization in your .emacs file. A new
11269 variable c-initialize-on-load controls this and is t by default.
11270
11271 ** Changes to hippie-expand.
11272
11273 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-skip-space'. If
11274 non-nil, trailing spaces may be included in the abbreviation to search for,
11275 which then gives the same behavior as the original `dabbrev-expand'.
11276
11277 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-as-symbol'. If
11278 non-nil, characters of syntax '_' is considered part of the word when
11279 expanding dynamically.
11280
11281 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-no-restriction'. If
11282 non-nil, narrowed buffers are widened before they are searched.
11283
11284 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-only-buffers'. If
11285 non-empty, buffers searched are restricted to the types specified in
11286 this list. Useful for example when constructing new special-purpose
11287 expansion functions with `make-hippie-expand-function'.
11288
11289 *** Text properties of the expansion are no longer copied.
11290
11291 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
11292
11293 *** Any titleword matching a regexp in the new variable
11294 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore (case sensitive) is ignored during
11295 automatic key generation. This replaces variable
11296 bibtex-autokey-titleword-first-ignore, which only checked for matches
11297 against the first word in the title.
11298
11299 *** Autokey generation now uses all words from the title, not just
11300 capitalized words. To avoid conflicts with existing customizations,
11301 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore is set up such that words starting with
11302 lowerkey characters will still be ignored. Thus, if you want to use
11303 lowercase words from the title, you will have to overwrite the
11304 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore standard setting.
11305
11306 *** Case conversion of names and title words for automatic key
11307 generation is more flexible. Variable bibtex-autokey-preserve-case is
11308 replaced by bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert and
11309 bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert.
11310
11311 ** Changes in vcursor.el.
11312
11313 *** Support for character terminals is available: there is a new keymap
11314 and the vcursor will appear as an arrow between buffer text. A
11315 variable `vcursor-interpret-input' allows input from the vcursor to be
11316 entered exactly as if typed. Numerous functions, including
11317 `vcursor-compare-windows', have been rewritten to improve consistency
11318 in the selection of windows and corresponding keymaps.
11319
11320 *** vcursor options can now be altered with M-x customize under the
11321 Editing group once the package is loaded.
11322
11323 *** Loading vcursor now does not define keys by default, as this is
11324 generally a bad side effect. Use M-x customize to set
11325 vcursor-key-bindings to t to restore the old behavior.
11326
11327 *** vcursor-auto-disable can be `copy', which turns off copying from the
11328 vcursor, but doesn't disable it, after any non-vcursor command.
11329
11330 ** Ispell changes.
11331
11332 *** You can now spell check comments and strings in the current
11333 buffer with M-x ispell-comments-and-strings. Comments and strings
11334 are identified by syntax tables in effect.
11335
11336 *** Generic region skipping implemented.
11337 A single buffer can be broken into a number of regions where text will
11338 and will not be checked. The definitions of the regions can be user
11339 defined. New applications and improvements made available by this
11340 include:
11341
11342 o URLs are automatically skipped
11343 o EMail message checking is vastly improved.
11344
11345 *** Ispell can highlight the erroneous word even on non-window terminals.
11346
11347 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
11348
11349 RefTeX has been updated in order to make it more usable with very
11350 large projects (like a several volume math book). The parser has been
11351 re-written from scratch. To get maximum speed from RefTeX, check the
11352 section `Optimizations' in the manual.
11353
11354 *** New recursive parser.
11355
11356 The old version of RefTeX created a single large buffer containing the
11357 entire multifile document in order to parse the document. The new
11358 recursive parser scans the individual files.
11359
11360 *** Parsing only part of a document.
11361
11362 Reparsing of changed document parts can now be made faster by enabling
11363 partial scans. To use this feature, read the documentation string of
11364 the variable `reftex-enable-partial-scans' and set the variable to t.
11365
11366 (setq reftex-enable-partial-scans t)
11367
11368 *** Storing parsing information in a file.
11369
11370 This can improve startup times considerably. To turn it on, use
11371
11372 (setq reftex-save-parse-info t)
11373
11374 *** Using multiple selection buffers
11375
11376 If the creation of label selection buffers is too slow (this happens
11377 for large documents), you can reuse these buffers by setting
11378
11379 (setq reftex-use-multiple-selection-buffers t)
11380
11381 *** References to external documents.
11382
11383 The LaTeX package `xr' allows to cross-reference labels in external
11384 documents. RefTeX can provide information about the external
11385 documents as well. To use this feature, set up the \externaldocument
11386 macros required by the `xr' package and rescan the document with
11387 RefTeX. The external labels can then be accessed with the `x' key in
11388 the selection buffer provided by `reftex-reference' (bound to `C-c )').
11389 The `x' key also works in the table of contents buffer.
11390
11391 *** Many more labeled LaTeX environments are recognized by default.
11392
11393 The built-in command list now covers all the standard LaTeX commands,
11394 and all of the major packages included in the LaTeX distribution.
11395
11396 Also, RefTeX now understands the \appendix macro and changes
11397 the enumeration of sections in the *toc* buffer accordingly.
11398
11399 *** Mouse support for selection and *toc* buffers
11400
11401 The mouse can now be used to select items in the selection and *toc*
11402 buffers. See also the new option `reftex-highlight-selection'.
11403
11404 *** New keymaps for selection and table of contents modes.
11405
11406 The selection processes for labels and citation keys, and the table of
11407 contents buffer now have their own keymaps: `reftex-select-label-map',
11408 `reftex-select-bib-map', `reftex-toc-map'. The selection processes
11409 have a number of new keys predefined. In particular, TAB lets you
11410 enter a label with completion. Check the on-the-fly help (press `?'
11411 at the selection prompt) or read the Info documentation to find out
11412 more.
11413
11414 *** Support for the varioref package
11415
11416 The `v' key in the label selection buffer toggles \ref versus \vref.
11417
11418 *** New hooks
11419
11420 Three new hooks can be used to redefine the way labels, references,
11421 and citations are created. These hooks are
11422 `reftex-format-label-function', `reftex-format-ref-function',
11423 `reftex-format-cite-function'.
11424
11425 *** Citations outside LaTeX
11426
11427 The command `reftex-citation' may also be used outside LaTeX (e.g. in
11428 a mail buffer). See the Info documentation for details.
11429
11430 *** Short context is no longer fontified.
11431
11432 The short context in the label menu no longer copies the
11433 fontification from the text in the buffer. If you prefer it to be
11434 fontified, use
11435
11436 (setq reftex-refontify-context t)
11437
11438 ** file-cache-minibuffer-complete now accepts a prefix argument.
11439 With a prefix argument, it does not try to do completion of
11440 the file name within its directory; it only checks for other
11441 directories that contain the same file name.
11442
11443 Thus, given the file name Makefile, and assuming that a file
11444 Makefile.in exists in the same directory, ordinary
11445 file-cache-minibuffer-complete will try to complete Makefile to
11446 Makefile.in and will therefore never look for other directories that
11447 have Makefile. A prefix argument tells it not to look for longer
11448 names such as Makefile.in, so that instead it will look for other
11449 directories--just as if the name were already complete in its present
11450 directory.
11451
11452 ** New modes and packages
11453
11454 *** There is a new alternative major mode for Perl, Cperl mode.
11455 It has many more features than Perl mode, and some people prefer
11456 it, but some do not.
11457
11458 *** There is a new major mode, M-x vhdl-mode, for editing files of VHDL
11459 code.
11460
11461 *** M-x which-function-mode enables a minor mode that displays the
11462 current function name continuously in the mode line, as you move
11463 around in a buffer.
11464
11465 Which Function mode is effective in major modes which support Imenu.
11466
11467 *** Gametree is a major mode for editing game analysis trees. The author
11468 uses it for keeping notes about his postal Chess games, but it should
11469 be helpful for other two-player games as well, as long as they have an
11470 established system of notation similar to Chess.
11471
11472 *** The new minor mode checkdoc-minor-mode provides Emacs Lisp
11473 documentation string checking for style and spelling. The style
11474 guidelines are found in the Emacs Lisp programming manual.
11475
11476 *** The net-utils package makes some common networking features
11477 available in Emacs. Some of these functions are wrappers around
11478 system utilities (ping, nslookup, etc); others are implementations of
11479 simple protocols (finger, whois) in Emacs Lisp. There are also
11480 functions to make simple connections to TCP/IP ports for debugging and
11481 the like.
11482
11483 *** highlight-changes-mode is a minor mode that uses colors to
11484 identify recently changed parts of the buffer text.
11485
11486 *** The new package `midnight' lets you specify things to be done
11487 within Emacs at midnight--by default, kill buffers that you have not
11488 used in a considerable time. To use this feature, customize
11489 the user option `midnight-mode' to t.
11490
11491 *** The file generic-x.el defines a number of simple major modes.
11492
11493 apache-generic-mode: For Apache and NCSA httpd configuration files
11494 samba-generic-mode: Samba configuration files
11495 fvwm-generic-mode: For fvwm initialization files
11496 x-resource-generic-mode: For X resource files
11497 hosts-generic-mode: For hosts files (.rhosts, /etc/hosts, etc)
11498 mailagent-rules-generic-mode: For mailagent .rules files
11499 javascript-generic-mode: For JavaScript files
11500 vrml-generic-mode: For VRML files
11501 java-manifest-generic-mode: For Java MANIFEST files
11502 java-properties-generic-mode: For Java property files
11503 mailrc-generic-mode: For .mailrc files
11504
11505 Platform-specific modes:
11506
11507 prototype-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V prototype files
11508 pkginfo-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V pkginfo files
11509 alias-generic-mode: For C shell alias files
11510 inf-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INF files
11511 ini-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INI files
11512 reg-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Registry files
11513 bat-generic-mode: For MS-Windows BAT scripts
11514 rc-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Resource files
11515 rul-generic-mode: For InstallShield scripts
11516 \f
11517 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 since the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
11518
11519 ** If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode,
11520 use -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line.
11521 That will force Emacs to read that file in unibyte mode.
11522 Otherwise, the file will be loaded and byte-compiled in multibyte mode.
11523
11524 Thus, each lisp file is read in a consistent way regardless of whether
11525 you started Emacs with --unibyte, so that a Lisp program gives
11526 consistent results regardless of how Emacs was started.
11527
11528 ** The new function assoc-default is useful for searching an alist,
11529 and using a default value if the key is not found there. You can
11530 specify a comparison predicate, so this function is useful for
11531 searching comparing a string against an alist of regular expressions.
11532
11533 ** The functions unibyte-char-to-multibyte and
11534 multibyte-char-to-unibyte convert between unibyte and multibyte
11535 character codes, in a way that is appropriate for the current language
11536 environment.
11537
11538 ** The functions read-event, read-char and read-char-exclusive now
11539 take two optional arguments. PROMPT, if non-nil, specifies a prompt
11540 string. SUPPRESS-INPUT-METHOD, if non-nil, says to disable the
11541 current input method for reading this one event.
11542
11543 ** Two new variables print-escape-nonascii and print-escape-multibyte
11544 now control whether to output certain characters as
11545 backslash-sequences. print-escape-nonascii applies to single-byte
11546 non-ASCII characters; print-escape-multibyte applies to multibyte
11547 characters. Both of these variables are used only when printing
11548 in readable fashion (prin1 uses them, princ does not).
11549 \f
11550 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 before the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
11551
11552 ** Compiled Emacs Lisp files made with the modified "MBSK" version
11553 of Emacs 20.2 do not work in Emacs 20.3.
11554
11555 ** Buffer positions are now measured in characters, as they were
11556 in Emacs 19 and before. This means that (forward-char 1)
11557 always increases point by 1.
11558
11559 The function chars-in-region now just subtracts its arguments. It is
11560 considered obsolete. The function char-boundary-p has been deleted.
11561
11562 See below for additional changes relating to multibyte characters.
11563
11564 ** defcustom, defface and defgroup now accept the keyword `:version'.
11565 Use this to specify in which version of Emacs a certain variable's
11566 default value changed. For example,
11567
11568 (defcustom foo-max 34 "*Maximum number of foo's allowed."
11569 :type 'integer
11570 :group 'foo
11571 :version "20.3")
11572
11573 (defgroup foo-group nil "The foo group."
11574 :version "20.3")
11575
11576 If an entire new group is added or the variables in it have the
11577 default values changed, then just add a `:version' to that group. It
11578 is recommended that new packages added to the distribution contain a
11579 `:version' in the top level group.
11580
11581 This information is used to control the customize-changed-options command.
11582
11583 ** It is now an error to change the value of a symbol whose name
11584 starts with a colon--if it is interned in the standard obarray.
11585
11586 However, setting such a symbol to its proper value, which is that
11587 symbol itself, is not an error. This is for the sake of programs that
11588 support previous Emacs versions by explicitly setting these variables
11589 to themselves.
11590
11591 If you set the variable keyword-symbols-constant-flag to nil,
11592 this error is suppressed, and you can set these symbols to any
11593 values whatever.
11594
11595 ** There is a new debugger command, R.
11596 It evaluates an expression like e, but saves the result
11597 in the buffer *Debugger-record*.
11598
11599 ** Frame-local variables.
11600
11601 You can now make a variable local to various frames. To do this, call
11602 the function make-variable-frame-local; this enables frames to have
11603 local bindings for that variable.
11604
11605 These frame-local bindings are actually frame parameters: you create a
11606 frame-local binding in a specific frame by calling
11607 modify-frame-parameters and specifying the variable name as the
11608 parameter name.
11609
11610 Buffer-local bindings take precedence over frame-local bindings.
11611 Thus, if the current buffer has a buffer-local binding, that binding is
11612 active; otherwise, if the selected frame has a frame-local binding,
11613 that binding is active; otherwise, the default binding is active.
11614
11615 It would not be hard to implement window-local bindings, but it is not
11616 clear that this would be very useful; windows tend to come and go in a
11617 very transitory fashion, so that trying to produce any specific effect
11618 through a window-local binding would not be very robust.
11619
11620 ** `sregexq' and `sregex' are two new functions for constructing
11621 "symbolic regular expressions." These are Lisp expressions that, when
11622 evaluated, yield conventional string-based regexps. The symbolic form
11623 makes it easier to construct, read, and maintain complex patterns.
11624 See the documentation in sregex.el.
11625
11626 ** parse-partial-sexp's return value has an additional element which
11627 is used to pass information along if you pass it to another call to
11628 parse-partial-sexp, starting its scan where the first call ended.
11629 The contents of this field are not yet finalized.
11630
11631 ** eval-region now accepts a fourth optional argument READ-FUNCTION.
11632 If it is non-nil, that function is used instead of `read'.
11633
11634 ** unload-feature by default removes the feature's functions from
11635 known hooks to avoid trouble, but a package providing FEATURE can
11636 define a hook FEATURE-unload-hook to be run by unload-feature instead.
11637
11638 ** read-from-minibuffer no longer returns the argument DEFAULT-VALUE
11639 when the user enters empty input. It now returns the null string, as
11640 it did in Emacs 19. The default value is made available in the
11641 history via M-n, but it is not applied here as a default.
11642
11643 The other, more specialized minibuffer-reading functions continue to
11644 return the default value (not the null string) when the user enters
11645 empty input.
11646
11647 ** The new variable read-buffer-function controls which routine to use
11648 for selecting buffers. For example, if you set this variable to
11649 `iswitchb-read-buffer', iswitchb will be used to read buffer names.
11650 Other functions can also be used if they accept the same arguments as
11651 `read-buffer' and return the selected buffer name as a string.
11652
11653 ** The new function read-passwd reads a password from the terminal,
11654 echoing a period for each character typed. It takes three arguments:
11655 a prompt string, a flag which says "read it twice to make sure", and a
11656 default password to use if the user enters nothing.
11657
11658 ** The variable fill-nobreak-predicate gives major modes a way to
11659 specify not to break a line at certain places. Its value is a
11660 function which is called with no arguments, with point located at the
11661 place where a break is being considered. If the function returns
11662 non-nil, then the line won't be broken there.
11663
11664 ** window-end now takes an optional second argument, UPDATE.
11665 If this is non-nil, then the function always returns an accurate
11666 up-to-date value for the buffer position corresponding to the
11667 end of the window, even if this requires computation.
11668
11669 ** other-buffer now takes an optional argument FRAME
11670 which specifies which frame's buffer list to use.
11671 If it is nil, that means use the selected frame's buffer list.
11672
11673 ** The new variable buffer-display-time, always local in every buffer,
11674 holds the value of (current-time) as of the last time that a window
11675 was directed to display this buffer.
11676
11677 ** It is now meaningful to compare two window-configuration objects
11678 with `equal'. Two window-configuration objects are equal if they
11679 describe equivalent arrangements of windows, in the same frame--in
11680 other words, if they would give the same results if passed to
11681 set-window-configuration.
11682
11683 ** compare-window-configurations is a new function that compares two
11684 window configurations loosely. It ignores differences in saved buffer
11685 positions and scrolling, and considers only the structure and sizes of
11686 windows and the choice of buffers to display.
11687
11688 ** The variable minor-mode-overriding-map-alist allows major modes to
11689 override the key bindings of a minor mode. The elements of this alist
11690 look like the elements of minor-mode-map-alist: (VARIABLE . KEYMAP).
11691
11692 If the VARIABLE in an element of minor-mode-overriding-map-alist has a
11693 non-nil value, the paired KEYMAP is active, and totally overrides the
11694 map (if any) specified for the same variable in minor-mode-map-alist.
11695
11696 minor-mode-overriding-map-alist is automatically local in all buffers,
11697 and it is meant to be set by major modes.
11698
11699 ** The function match-string-no-properties is like match-string
11700 except that it discards all text properties from the result.
11701
11702 ** The function load-average now accepts an optional argument
11703 USE-FLOATS. If it is non-nil, the load average values are returned as
11704 floating point numbers, rather than as integers to be divided by 100.
11705
11706 ** The new variable temporary-file-directory specifies the directory
11707 to use for creating temporary files. The default value is determined
11708 in a reasonable way for your operating system; on GNU and Unix systems
11709 it is based on the TMP and TMPDIR environment variables.
11710
11711 ** Menu changes
11712
11713 *** easymenu.el now uses the new menu item format and supports the
11714 keywords :visible and :filter. The existing keyword :keys is now
11715 better supported.
11716
11717 The variable `easy-menu-precalculate-equivalent-keybindings' controls
11718 a new feature which calculates keyboard equivalents for the menu when
11719 you define the menu. The default is t. If you rarely use menus, you
11720 can set the variable to nil to disable this precalculation feature;
11721 then the calculation is done only if you use the menu bar.
11722
11723 *** A new format for menu items is supported.
11724
11725 In a keymap, a key binding that has the format
11726 (STRING . REAL-BINDING) or (STRING HELP-STRING . REAL-BINDING)
11727 defines a menu item. Now a menu item definition may also be a list that
11728 starts with the symbol `menu-item'.
11729
11730 The format is:
11731 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) or
11732 (menu-item ITEM-NAME REAL-BINDING . ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST)
11733 where ITEM-NAME is an expression which evaluates to the menu item
11734 string, and ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST has the form of a property list.
11735 The supported properties include
11736
11737 :enable FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
11738 item is enabled.
11739 :visible FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
11740 item should appear in the menu.
11741 :filter FILTER-FN
11742 FILTER-FN is a function of one argument,
11743 which will be REAL-BINDING.
11744 It should return a binding to use instead.
11745 :keys DESCRIPTION
11746 DESCRIPTION is a string that describes an equivalent keyboard
11747 binding for REAL-BINDING. DESCRIPTION is expanded with
11748 `substitute-command-keys' before it is used.
11749 :key-sequence KEY-SEQUENCE
11750 KEY-SEQUENCE is a key-sequence for an equivalent
11751 keyboard binding.
11752 :key-sequence nil
11753 This means that the command normally has no
11754 keyboard equivalent.
11755 :help HELP HELP is the extra help string (not currently used).
11756 :button (TYPE . SELECTED)
11757 TYPE is :toggle or :radio.
11758 SELECTED is a form, to be evaluated, and its
11759 value says whether this button is currently selected.
11760
11761 Buttons are at the moment only simulated by prefixes in the menu.
11762 Eventually ordinary X-buttons may be supported.
11763
11764 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) defines unselectable item.
11765
11766 ** New event types
11767
11768 *** The new event type `mouse-wheel' is generated by a wheel on a
11769 mouse (such as the MS Intellimouse). The event contains a delta that
11770 corresponds to the amount and direction that the wheel is rotated,
11771 which is typically used to implement a scroll or zoom. The format is:
11772
11773 (mouse-wheel POSITION DELTA)
11774
11775 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
11776 same format as a mouse-click event, and DELTA is a signed number
11777 indicating the number of increments by which the wheel was rotated. A
11778 negative DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated backwards, towards
11779 the user, and a positive DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated
11780 forward, away from the user.
11781
11782 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
11783
11784 *** The new event type `drag-n-drop' is generated when a group of
11785 files is selected in an application outside of Emacs, and then dragged
11786 and dropped onto an Emacs frame. The event contains a list of
11787 filenames that were dragged and dropped, which are then typically
11788 loaded into Emacs. The format is:
11789
11790 (drag-n-drop POSITION FILES)
11791
11792 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
11793 same format as a mouse-click event, and FILES is the list of filenames
11794 that were dragged and dropped.
11795
11796 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
11797
11798 ** Changes relating to multibyte characters.
11799
11800 *** The variable enable-multibyte-characters is now read-only;
11801 any attempt to set it directly signals an error. The only way
11802 to change this value in an existing buffer is with set-buffer-multibyte.
11803
11804 *** In a string constant, `\ ' now stands for "nothing at all". You
11805 can use it to terminate a hex escape which is followed by a character
11806 that could otherwise be read as part of the hex escape.
11807
11808 *** String indices are now measured in characters, as they were
11809 in Emacs 19 and before.
11810
11811 The function chars-in-string has been deleted.
11812 The function concat-chars has been renamed to `string'.
11813
11814 *** The function set-buffer-multibyte sets the flag in the current
11815 buffer that says whether the buffer uses multibyte representation or
11816 unibyte representation. If the argument is nil, it selects unibyte
11817 representation. Otherwise it selects multibyte representation.
11818
11819 This function does not change the contents of the buffer, viewed
11820 as a sequence of bytes. However, it does change the contents
11821 viewed as characters; a sequence of two bytes which is treated as
11822 one character when the buffer uses multibyte representation
11823 will count as two characters using unibyte representation.
11824
11825 This function sets enable-multibyte-characters to record which
11826 representation is in use. It also adjusts various data in the buffer
11827 (including its markers, overlays and text properties) so that they are
11828 consistent with the new representation.
11829
11830 *** string-make-multibyte takes a string and converts it to multibyte
11831 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care
11832 about the representation, because Emacs converts when necessary;
11833 however, it makes a difference when you compare strings.
11834
11835 The conversion of non-ASCII characters works by adding the value of
11836 nonascii-insert-offset to each character, or by translating them
11837 using the table nonascii-translation-table.
11838
11839 *** string-make-unibyte takes a string and converts it to unibyte
11840 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care about the
11841 representation, but it makes a difference when you compare strings.
11842
11843 The conversion from multibyte to unibyte representation
11844 loses information; the only time Emacs performs it automatically
11845 is when inserting a multibyte string into a unibyte buffer.
11846
11847 *** string-as-multibyte takes a string, and returns another string
11848 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as multibyte.
11849
11850 *** string-as-unibyte takes a string, and returns another string
11851 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as unibyte.
11852
11853 *** The new function compare-strings lets you compare
11854 portions of two strings. Unibyte strings are converted to multibyte,
11855 so that a unibyte string can match a multibyte string.
11856 You can specify whether to ignore case or not.
11857
11858 *** assoc-ignore-case now uses compare-strings so that
11859 it can treat unibyte and multibyte strings as equal.
11860
11861 *** Regular expression operations and buffer string searches now
11862 convert the search pattern to multibyte or unibyte to accord with the
11863 buffer or string being searched.
11864
11865 One consequence is that you cannot always use \200-\377 inside of
11866 [...] to match all non-ASCII characters. This does still work when
11867 searching or matching a unibyte buffer or string, but not when
11868 searching or matching a multibyte string. Unfortunately, there is no
11869 obvious choice of syntax to use within [...] for that job. But, what
11870 you want is just to match all non-ASCII characters, the regular
11871 expression [^\0-\177] works for it.
11872
11873 *** Structure of coding system changed.
11874
11875 All coding systems (including aliases and subsidiaries) are named
11876 by symbols; the symbol's `coding-system' property is a vector
11877 which defines the coding system. Aliases share the same vector
11878 as the principal name, so that altering the contents of this
11879 vector affects the principal name and its aliases. You can define
11880 your own alias name of a coding system by the function
11881 define-coding-system-alias.
11882
11883 The coding system definition includes a property list of its own. Use
11884 the new functions `coding-system-get' and `coding-system-put' to
11885 access such coding system properties as post-read-conversion,
11886 pre-write-conversion, character-translation-table-for-decode,
11887 character-translation-table-for-encode, mime-charset, and
11888 safe-charsets. For instance, (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1
11889 'mime-charset) gives the corresponding MIME-charset parameter
11890 `iso-8859-1'.
11891
11892 Among the coding system properties listed above, safe-charsets is new.
11893 The value of this property is a list of character sets which this
11894 coding system can correctly encode and decode. For instance:
11895 (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1 'safe-charsets) => (ascii latin-iso8859-1)
11896
11897 Here, "correctly encode" means that the encoded character sets can
11898 also be handled safely by systems other than Emacs as far as they
11899 are capable of that coding system. Though, Emacs itself can encode
11900 the other character sets and read it back correctly.
11901
11902 *** The new function select-safe-coding-system can be used to find a
11903 proper coding system for encoding the specified region or string.
11904 This function requires a user interaction.
11905
11906 *** The new functions find-coding-systems-region and
11907 find-coding-systems-string are helper functions used by
11908 select-safe-coding-system. They return a list of all proper coding
11909 systems to encode a text in some region or string. If you don't want
11910 a user interaction, use one of these functions instead of
11911 select-safe-coding-system.
11912
11913 *** The explicit encoding and decoding functions, such as
11914 decode-coding-region and encode-coding-string, now set
11915 last-coding-system-used to reflect the actual way encoding or decoding
11916 was done.
11917
11918 *** The new function detect-coding-with-language-environment can be
11919 used to detect a coding system of text according to priorities of
11920 coding systems used by some specific language environment.
11921
11922 *** The functions detect-coding-region and detect-coding-string always
11923 return a list if the arg HIGHEST is nil. Thus, if only ASCII
11924 characters are found, they now return a list of single element
11925 `undecided' or its subsidiaries.
11926
11927 *** The new functions coding-system-change-eol-conversion and
11928 coding-system-change-text-conversion can be used to get a different
11929 coding system than what specified only in how end-of-line or text is
11930 converted.
11931
11932 *** The new function set-selection-coding-system can be used to set a
11933 coding system for communicating with other X clients.
11934
11935 *** The function `map-char-table' now passes as argument only valid
11936 character codes, plus generic characters that stand for entire
11937 character sets or entire subrows of a character set. In other words,
11938 each time `map-char-table' calls its FUNCTION argument, the key value
11939 either will be a valid individual character code, or will stand for a
11940 range of characters.
11941
11942 *** The new function `char-valid-p' can be used for checking whether a
11943 Lisp object is a valid character code or not.
11944
11945 *** The new function `charset-after' returns a charset of a character
11946 in the current buffer at position POS.
11947
11948 *** Input methods are now implemented using the variable
11949 input-method-function. If this is non-nil, its value should be a
11950 function; then, whenever Emacs reads an input event that is a printing
11951 character with no modifier bits, it calls that function, passing the
11952 event as an argument. Often this function will read more input, first
11953 binding input-method-function to nil.
11954
11955 The return value should be a list of the events resulting from input
11956 method processing. These events will be processed sequentially as
11957 input, before resorting to unread-command-events. Events returned by
11958 the input method function are not passed to the input method function,
11959 not even if they are printing characters with no modifier bits.
11960
11961 The input method function is not called when reading the second and
11962 subsequent events of a key sequence.
11963
11964 *** You can customize any language environment by using
11965 set-language-environment-hook and exit-language-environment-hook.
11966
11967 The hook `exit-language-environment-hook' should be used to undo
11968 customizations that you made with set-language-environment-hook. For
11969 instance, if you set up a special key binding for a specific language
11970 environment by set-language-environment-hook, you should set up
11971 exit-language-environment-hook to restore the normal key binding.
11972 \f
11973 * Changes in Emacs 20.1
11974
11975 ** Emacs has a new facility for customization of its many user
11976 options. It is called M-x customize. With this facility you can look
11977 at the many user options in an organized way; they are grouped into a
11978 tree structure.
11979
11980 M-x customize also knows what sorts of values are legitimate for each
11981 user option and ensures that you don't use invalid values.
11982
11983 With M-x customize, you can set options either for the present Emacs
11984 session or permanently. (Permanent settings are stored automatically
11985 in your .emacs file.)
11986
11987 ** Scroll bars are now on the left side of the window.
11988 You can change this with M-x customize-option scroll-bar-mode.
11989
11990 ** The mode line no longer includes the string `Emacs'.
11991 This makes more space in the mode line for other information.
11992
11993 ** When you select a region with the mouse, it is highlighted
11994 immediately afterward. At that time, if you type the DELETE key, it
11995 kills the region.
11996
11997 The BACKSPACE key, and the ASCII character DEL, do not do this; they
11998 delete the character before point, as usual.
11999
12000 ** In an incremental search the whole current match is highlighted
12001 on terminals which support this. (You can disable this feature
12002 by setting search-highlight to nil.)
12003
12004 ** In the minibuffer, in some cases, you can now use M-n to
12005 insert the default value into the minibuffer as text. In effect,
12006 the default value (if the minibuffer routines know it) is tacked
12007 onto the history "in the future". (The more normal use of the
12008 history list is to use M-p to insert minibuffer input used in the
12009 past.)
12010
12011 ** In Text mode, now only blank lines separate paragraphs.
12012 This makes it possible to get the full benefit of Adaptive Fill mode
12013 in Text mode, and other modes derived from it (such as Mail mode).
12014 TAB in Text mode now runs the command indent-relative; this
12015 makes a practical difference only when you use indented paragraphs.
12016
12017 As a result, the old Indented Text mode is now identical to Text mode,
12018 and is an alias for it.
12019
12020 If you want spaces at the beginning of a line to start a paragraph,
12021 use the new mode, Paragraph Indent Text mode.
12022
12023 ** Scrolling changes
12024
12025 *** Scroll commands to scroll a whole screen now preserve the screen
12026 position of the cursor, if scroll-preserve-screen-position is non-nil.
12027
12028 In this mode, if you scroll several screens back and forth, finishing
12029 on the same screen where you started, the cursor goes back to the line
12030 where it started.
12031
12032 *** If you set scroll-conservatively to a small number, then when you
12033 move point a short distance off the screen, Emacs will scroll the
12034 screen just far enough to bring point back on screen, provided that
12035 does not exceed `scroll-conservatively' lines.
12036
12037 *** The new variable scroll-margin says how close point can come to the
12038 top or bottom of a window. It is a number of screen lines; if point
12039 comes within that many lines of the top or bottom of the window, Emacs
12040 recenters the window.
12041
12042 ** International character set support (MULE)
12043
12044 Emacs now supports a wide variety of international character sets,
12045 including European variants of the Latin alphabet, as well as Chinese,
12046 Devanagari (Hindi and Marathi), Ethiopian, Greek, IPA, Japanese,
12047 Korean, Lao, Russian, Thai, Tibetan, and Vietnamese scripts. These
12048 features have been merged from the modified version of Emacs known as
12049 MULE (for "MULti-lingual Enhancement to GNU Emacs")
12050
12051 Users of these scripts have established many more-or-less standard
12052 coding systems for storing files. Emacs uses a single multibyte
12053 character encoding within Emacs buffers; it can translate from a wide
12054 variety of coding systems when reading a file and can translate back
12055 into any of these coding systems when saving a file.
12056
12057 Keyboards, even in the countries where these character sets are used,
12058 generally don't have keys for all the characters in them. So Emacs
12059 supports various "input methods", typically one for each script or
12060 language, to make it possible to type them.
12061
12062 The Emacs internal multibyte encoding represents a non-ASCII
12063 character as a sequence of bytes in the range 0200 through 0377.
12064
12065 The new prefix key C-x RET is used for commands that pertain
12066 to multibyte characters, coding systems, and input methods.
12067
12068 You can disable multibyte character support as follows:
12069
12070 (setq-default enable-multibyte-characters nil)
12071
12072 Calling the function standard-display-european turns off multibyte
12073 characters, unless you specify a non-nil value for the second
12074 argument, AUTO. This provides compatibility for people who are
12075 already using standard-display-european to continue using unibyte
12076 characters for their work until they want to change.
12077
12078 *** Input methods
12079
12080 An input method is a kind of character conversion which is designed
12081 specifically for interactive input. In Emacs, typically each language
12082 has its own input method (though sometimes several languages which use
12083 the same characters can share one input method). Some languages
12084 support several input methods.
12085
12086 The simplest kind of input method works by mapping ASCII letters into
12087 another alphabet. This is how the Greek and Russian input methods
12088 work.
12089
12090 A more powerful technique is composition: converting sequences of
12091 characters into one letter. Many European input methods use
12092 composition to produce a single non-ASCII letter from a sequence which
12093 consists of a letter followed by diacritics. For example, a' is one
12094 sequence of two characters that might be converted into a single
12095 letter.
12096
12097 The input methods for syllabic scripts typically use mapping followed
12098 by conversion. The input methods for Thai and Korean work this way.
12099 First, letters are mapped into symbols for particular sounds or tone
12100 marks; then, sequences of these which make up a whole syllable are
12101 mapped into one syllable sign--most often a "composite character".
12102
12103 None of these methods works very well for Chinese and Japanese, so
12104 they are handled specially. First you input a whole word using
12105 phonetic spelling; then, after the word is in the buffer, Emacs
12106 converts it into one or more characters using a large dictionary.
12107
12108 Since there is more than one way to represent a phonetically spelled
12109 word using Chinese characters, Emacs can only guess which one to use;
12110 typically these input methods give you a way to say "guess again" if
12111 the first guess is wrong.
12112
12113 *** The command C-x RET m (toggle-enable-multibyte-characters)
12114 turns multibyte character support on or off for the current buffer.
12115
12116 If multibyte character support is turned off in a buffer, then each
12117 byte is a single character, even codes 0200 through 0377--exactly as
12118 they did in Emacs 19.34. This includes the features for support for
12119 the European characters, ISO Latin-1 and ISO Latin-2.
12120
12121 However, there is no need to turn off multibyte character support to
12122 use ISO Latin-1 or ISO Latin-2; the Emacs multibyte character set
12123 includes all the characters in these character sets, and Emacs can
12124 translate automatically to and from either one.
12125
12126 *** Visiting a file in unibyte mode.
12127
12128 Turning off multibyte character support in the buffer after visiting a
12129 file with multibyte code conversion will display the multibyte
12130 sequences already in the buffer, byte by byte. This is probably not
12131 what you want.
12132
12133 If you want to edit a file of unibyte characters (Latin-1, for
12134 example), you can do it by specifying `no-conversion' as the coding
12135 system when reading the file. This coding system also turns off
12136 multibyte characters in that buffer.
12137
12138 If you turn off multibyte character support entirely, this turns off
12139 character conversion as well.
12140
12141 *** Displaying international characters on X Windows.
12142
12143 A font for X typically displays just one alphabet or script.
12144 Therefore, displaying the entire range of characters Emacs supports
12145 requires using many fonts.
12146
12147 Therefore, Emacs now supports "fontsets". Each fontset is a
12148 collection of fonts, each assigned to a range of character codes.
12149
12150 A fontset has a name, like a font. Individual fonts are defined by
12151 the X server; fontsets are defined within Emacs itself. But once you
12152 have defined a fontset, you can use it in a face or a frame just as
12153 you would use a font.
12154
12155 If a fontset specifies no font for a certain character, or if it
12156 specifies a font that does not exist on your system, then it cannot
12157 display that character. It will display an empty box instead.
12158
12159 The fontset height and width are determined by the ASCII characters
12160 (that is, by the font in the fontset which is used for ASCII
12161 characters).
12162
12163 *** Defining fontsets.
12164
12165 Emacs does not use any fontset by default. Its default font is still
12166 chosen as in previous versions. You can tell Emacs to use a fontset
12167 with the `-fn' option or the `Font' X resource.
12168
12169 Emacs creates a standard fontset automatically according to the value
12170 of standard-fontset-spec. This fontset's short name is
12171 `fontset-standard'. Bold, italic, and bold-italic variants of the
12172 standard fontset are created automatically.
12173
12174 If you specify a default ASCII font with the `Font' resource or `-fn'
12175 argument, a fontset is generated from it. This works by replacing the
12176 FOUNDARY, FAMILY, ADD_STYLE, and AVERAGE_WIDTH fields of the font name
12177 with `*' then using this to specify a fontset. This fontset's short
12178 name is `fontset-startup'.
12179
12180 Emacs checks resources of the form Fontset-N where N is 0, 1, 2...
12181 The resource value should have this form:
12182 FONTSET-NAME, [CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME]...
12183 FONTSET-NAME should have the form of a standard X font name, except:
12184 * most fields should be just the wild card "*".
12185 * the CHARSET_REGISTRY field should be "fontset"
12186 * the CHARSET_ENCODING field can be any nickname of the fontset.
12187 The construct CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME can be repeated any number
12188 of times; each time specifies the font for one character set.
12189 CHARSET-NAME should be the name of a character set, and FONT-NAME
12190 should specify an actual font to use for that character set.
12191
12192 Each of these fontsets has an alias which is made from the
12193 last two font name fields, CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING.
12194 You can refer to the fontset by that alias or by its full name.
12195
12196 For any character sets that you don't mention, Emacs tries to choose a
12197 font by substituting into FONTSET-NAME. For instance, with the
12198 following resource,
12199 Emacs*Fontset-0: -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-*-*-*-*-fontset-24
12200 the font for ASCII is generated as below:
12201 -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-ISO8859-1
12202 Here is the substitution rule:
12203 Change CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING to that of the charset
12204 defined in the variable x-charset-registries. For instance, ASCII has
12205 the entry (ascii . "ISO8859-1") in this variable. Then, reduce
12206 sequences of wild cards -*-...-*- with a single wildcard -*-.
12207 (This is to prevent use of auto-scaled fonts.)
12208
12209 The function which processes the fontset resource value to create the
12210 fontset is called create-fontset-from-fontset-spec. You can also call
12211 that function explicitly to create a fontset.
12212
12213 With the X resource Emacs.Font, you can specify a fontset name just
12214 like an actual font name. But be careful not to specify a fontset
12215 name in a wildcard resource like Emacs*Font--that tries to specify the
12216 fontset for other purposes including menus, and they cannot handle
12217 fontsets.
12218
12219 *** The command M-x set-language-environment sets certain global Emacs
12220 defaults for a particular choice of language.
12221
12222 Selecting a language environment typically specifies a default input
12223 method and which coding systems to recognize automatically when
12224 visiting files. However, it does not try to reread files you have
12225 already visited; the text in those buffers is not affected. The
12226 language environment may also specify a default choice of coding
12227 system for new files that you create.
12228
12229 It makes no difference which buffer is current when you use
12230 set-language-environment, because these defaults apply globally to the
12231 whole Emacs session.
12232
12233 For example, M-x set-language-environment RET Latin-1 RET
12234 chooses the Latin-1 character set. In the .emacs file, you can do this
12235 with (set-language-environment "Latin-1").
12236
12237 *** The command C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system)
12238 specifies the file coding system for the current buffer. This
12239 specifies what sort of character code translation to do when saving
12240 the file. As an argument, you must specify the name of one of the
12241 coding systems that Emacs supports.
12242
12243 *** The command C-x RET c (universal-coding-system-argument)
12244 lets you specify a coding system when you read or write a file.
12245 This command uses the minibuffer to read a coding system name.
12246 After you exit the minibuffer, the specified coding system
12247 is used for *the immediately following command*.
12248
12249 So if the immediately following command is a command to read or
12250 write a file, it uses the specified coding system for that file.
12251
12252 If the immediately following command does not use the coding system,
12253 then C-x RET c ultimately has no effect.
12254
12255 For example, C-x RET c iso-8859-1 RET C-x C-f temp RET
12256 visits the file `temp' treating it as ISO Latin-1.
12257
12258 *** You can specify the coding system for a file using the -*-
12259 construct. Include `coding: CODINGSYSTEM;' inside the -*-...-*-
12260 to specify use of coding system CODINGSYSTEM. You can also
12261 specify the coding system in a local variable list at the end
12262 of the file.
12263
12264 *** The command C-x RET t (set-terminal-coding-system) specifies
12265 the coding system for terminal output. If you specify a character
12266 code for terminal output, all characters output to the terminal are
12267 translated into that character code.
12268
12269 This feature is useful for certain character-only terminals built in
12270 various countries to support the languages of those countries.
12271
12272 By default, output to the terminal is not translated at all.
12273
12274 *** The command C-x RET k (set-keyboard-coding-system) specifies
12275 the coding system for keyboard input.
12276
12277 Character code translation of keyboard input is useful for terminals
12278 with keys that send non-ASCII graphic characters--for example,
12279 some terminals designed for ISO Latin-1 or subsets of it.
12280
12281 By default, keyboard input is not translated at all.
12282
12283 Character code translation of keyboard input is similar to using an
12284 input method, in that both define sequences of keyboard input that
12285 translate into single characters. However, input methods are designed
12286 to be convenient for interactive use, while the code translations are
12287 designed to work with terminals.
12288
12289 *** The command C-x RET p (set-buffer-process-coding-system)
12290 specifies the coding system for input and output to a subprocess.
12291 This command applies to the current buffer; normally, each subprocess
12292 has its own buffer, and thus you can use this command to specify
12293 translation to and from a particular subprocess by giving the command
12294 in the corresponding buffer.
12295
12296 By default, process input and output are not translated at all.
12297
12298 *** The variable file-name-coding-system specifies the coding system
12299 to use for encoding file names before operating on them.
12300 It is also used for decoding file names obtained from the system.
12301
12302 *** The command C-\ (toggle-input-method) activates or deactivates
12303 an input method. If no input method has been selected before, the
12304 command prompts for you to specify the language and input method you
12305 want to use.
12306
12307 C-u C-\ (select-input-method) lets you switch to a different input
12308 method. C-h C-\ (or C-h I) describes the current input method.
12309
12310 *** Some input methods remap the keyboard to emulate various keyboard
12311 layouts commonly used for particular scripts. How to do this
12312 remapping properly depends on your actual keyboard layout. To specify
12313 which layout your keyboard has, use M-x quail-set-keyboard-layout.
12314
12315 *** The command C-h C (describe-coding-system) displays
12316 the coding systems currently selected for various purposes, plus
12317 related information.
12318
12319 *** The command C-h h (view-hello-file) displays a file called
12320 HELLO, which has examples of text in many languages, using various
12321 scripts.
12322
12323 *** The command C-h L (describe-language-support) displays
12324 information about the support for a particular language.
12325 You specify the language as an argument.
12326
12327 *** The mode line now contains a letter or character that identifies
12328 the coding system used in the visited file. It normally follows the
12329 first dash.
12330
12331 A dash indicates the default state of affairs: no code conversion
12332 (except CRLF => newline if appropriate). `=' means no conversion
12333 whatsoever. The ISO 8859 coding systems are represented by digits
12334 1 through 9. Other coding systems are represented by letters:
12335
12336 A alternativnyj (Russian)
12337 B big5 (Chinese)
12338 C cn-gb-2312 (Chinese)
12339 C iso-2022-cn (Chinese)
12340 D in-is13194-devanagari (Indian languages)
12341 E euc-japan (Japanese)
12342 I iso-2022-cjk or iso-2022-ss2 (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
12343 J junet (iso-2022-7) or old-jis (iso-2022-jp-1978-irv) (Japanese)
12344 K euc-korea (Korean)
12345 R koi8 (Russian)
12346 Q tibetan
12347 S shift_jis (Japanese)
12348 T lao
12349 T tis620 (Thai)
12350 V viscii or vscii (Vietnamese)
12351 i iso-2022-lock (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
12352 k iso-2022-kr (Korean)
12353 v viqr (Vietnamese)
12354 z hz (Chinese)
12355
12356 When you are using a character-only terminal (not a window system),
12357 two additional characters appear in between the dash and the file
12358 coding system. These two characters describe the coding system for
12359 keyboard input, and the coding system for terminal output.
12360
12361 *** The new variable rmail-file-coding-system specifies the code
12362 conversion to use for RMAIL files. The default value is nil.
12363
12364 When you read mail with Rmail, each message is decoded automatically
12365 into Emacs' internal format. This has nothing to do with
12366 rmail-file-coding-system. That variable controls reading and writing
12367 Rmail files themselves.
12368
12369 *** The new variable sendmail-coding-system specifies the code
12370 conversion for outgoing mail. The default value is nil.
12371
12372 Actually, there are three different ways of specifying the coding system
12373 for sending mail:
12374
12375 - If you use C-x RET f in the mail buffer, that takes priority.
12376 - Otherwise, if you set sendmail-coding-system non-nil, that specifies it.
12377 - Otherwise, the default coding system for new files is used,
12378 if that is non-nil. That comes from your language environment.
12379 - Otherwise, Latin-1 is used.
12380
12381 *** The command C-h t (help-with-tutorial) accepts a prefix argument
12382 to specify the language for the tutorial file. Currently, English,
12383 Japanese, Korean and Thai are supported. We welcome additional
12384 translations.
12385
12386 ** An easy new way to visit a file with no code or format conversion
12387 of any kind: Use M-x find-file-literally. There is also a command
12388 insert-file-literally which inserts a file into the current buffer
12389 without any conversion.
12390
12391 ** C-q's handling of octal character codes is changed.
12392 You can now specify any number of octal digits.
12393 RET terminates the digits and is discarded;
12394 any other non-digit terminates the digits and is then used as input.
12395
12396 ** There are new commands for looking up Info documentation for
12397 functions, variables and file names used in your programs.
12398
12399 Type M-x info-lookup-symbol to look up a symbol in the buffer at point.
12400 Type M-x info-lookup-file to look up a file in the buffer at point.
12401
12402 Precisely which Info files are used to look it up depends on the major
12403 mode. For example, in C mode, the GNU libc manual is used.
12404
12405 ** M-TAB in most programming language modes now runs the command
12406 complete-symbol. This command performs completion on the symbol name
12407 in the buffer before point.
12408
12409 With a numeric argument, it performs completion based on the set of
12410 symbols documented in the Info files for the programming language that
12411 you are using.
12412
12413 With no argument, it does completion based on the current tags tables,
12414 just like the old binding of M-TAB (complete-tag).
12415
12416 ** File locking works with NFS now.
12417
12418 The lock file for FILENAME is now a symbolic link named .#FILENAME,
12419 in the same directory as FILENAME.
12420
12421 This means that collision detection between two different machines now
12422 works reasonably well; it also means that no file server or directory
12423 can become a bottleneck.
12424
12425 The new method does have drawbacks. It means that collision detection
12426 does not operate when you edit a file in a directory where you cannot
12427 create new files. Collision detection also doesn't operate when the
12428 file server does not support symbolic links. But these conditions are
12429 rare, and the ability to have collision detection while using NFS is
12430 so useful that the change is worth while.
12431
12432 When Emacs or a system crashes, this may leave behind lock files which
12433 are stale. So you may occasionally get warnings about spurious
12434 collisions. When you determine that the collision is spurious, just
12435 tell Emacs to go ahead anyway.
12436
12437 ** If you wish to use Show Paren mode to display matching parentheses,
12438 it is no longer sufficient to load paren.el. Instead you must call
12439 show-paren-mode.
12440
12441 ** If you wish to use Delete Selection mode to replace a highlighted
12442 selection when you insert new text, it is no longer sufficient to load
12443 delsel.el. Instead you must call the function delete-selection-mode.
12444
12445 ** If you wish to use Partial Completion mode to complete partial words
12446 within symbols or filenames, it is no longer sufficient to load
12447 complete.el. Instead you must call the function partial-completion-mode.
12448
12449 ** If you wish to use uniquify to rename buffers for you,
12450 it is no longer sufficient to load uniquify.el. You must also
12451 set uniquify-buffer-name-style to one of the non-nil legitimate values.
12452
12453 ** Changes in View mode.
12454
12455 *** Several new commands are available in View mode.
12456 Do H in view mode for a list of commands.
12457
12458 *** There are two new commands for entering View mode:
12459 view-file-other-frame and view-buffer-other-frame.
12460
12461 *** Exiting View mode does a better job of restoring windows to their
12462 previous state.
12463
12464 *** New customization variable view-scroll-auto-exit. If non-nil,
12465 scrolling past end of buffer makes view mode exit.
12466
12467 *** New customization variable view-exits-all-viewing-windows. If
12468 non-nil, view-mode will at exit restore all windows viewing buffer,
12469 not just the selected window.
12470
12471 *** New customization variable view-read-only. If non-nil, visiting a
12472 read-only file automatically enters View mode, and toggle-read-only
12473 turns View mode on or off.
12474
12475 *** New customization variable view-remove-frame-by-deleting controls
12476 how to remove a not needed frame at view mode exit. If non-nil,
12477 delete the frame, if nil make an icon of it.
12478
12479 ** C-x v l, the command to print a file's version control log,
12480 now positions point at the entry for the file's current branch version.
12481
12482 ** C-x v =, the command to compare a file with the last checked-in version,
12483 has a new feature. If the file is currently not locked, so that it is
12484 presumably identical to the last checked-in version, the command now asks
12485 which version to compare with.
12486
12487 ** When using hideshow.el, incremental search can temporarily show hidden
12488 blocks if a match is inside the block.
12489
12490 The block is hidden again if the search is continued and the next match
12491 is outside the block. By customizing the variable
12492 isearch-hide-immediately you can choose to hide all the temporarily
12493 shown blocks only when exiting from incremental search.
12494
12495 By customizing the variable hs-isearch-open you can choose what kind
12496 of blocks to temporarily show during isearch: comment blocks, code
12497 blocks, all of them or none.
12498
12499 ** The new command C-x 4 0 (kill-buffer-and-window) kills the
12500 current buffer and deletes the selected window. It asks for
12501 confirmation first.
12502
12503 ** C-x C-w, which saves the buffer into a specified file name,
12504 now changes the major mode according to that file name.
12505 However, the mode will not be changed if
12506 (1) a local variables list or the `-*-' line specifies a major mode, or
12507 (2) the current major mode is a "special" mode,
12508 not suitable for ordinary files, or
12509 (3) the new file name does not particularly specify any mode.
12510
12511 This applies to M-x set-visited-file-name as well.
12512
12513 However, if you set change-major-mode-with-file-name to nil, then
12514 these commands do not change the major mode.
12515
12516 ** M-x occur changes.
12517
12518 *** If the argument to M-x occur contains upper case letters,
12519 it performs a case-sensitive search.
12520
12521 *** In the *Occur* buffer made by M-x occur,
12522 if you type g or M-x revert-buffer, this repeats the search
12523 using the same regular expression and the same buffer as before.
12524
12525 ** In Transient Mark mode, the region in any one buffer is highlighted
12526 in just one window at a time. At first, it is highlighted in the
12527 window where you set the mark. The buffer's highlighting remains in
12528 that window unless you select to another window which shows the same
12529 buffer--then the highlighting moves to that window.
12530
12531 ** The feature to suggest key bindings when you use M-x now operates
12532 after the command finishes. The message suggesting key bindings
12533 appears temporarily in the echo area. The previous echo area contents
12534 come back after a few seconds, in case they contain useful information.
12535
12536 ** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
12537 selected buffers, so that the default for C-x b is now based on the
12538 buffers recently selected in the selected frame.
12539
12540 ** Outline mode changes.
12541
12542 *** Outline mode now uses overlays (this is the former noutline.el).
12543
12544 *** Incremental searches skip over invisible text in Outline mode.
12545
12546 ** When a minibuffer window is active but not the selected window, if
12547 you try to use the minibuffer, you used to get a nested minibuffer.
12548 Now, this not only gives an error, it also cancels the minibuffer that
12549 was already active.
12550
12551 The motive for this change is so that beginning users do not
12552 unknowingly move away from minibuffers, leaving them active, and then
12553 get confused by it.
12554
12555 If you want to be able to have recursive minibuffers, you must
12556 set enable-recursive-minibuffers to non-nil.
12557
12558 ** Changes in dynamic abbrevs.
12559
12560 *** Expanding dynamic abbrevs with M-/ is now smarter about case
12561 conversion. If the expansion has mixed case not counting the first
12562 character, and the abbreviation matches the beginning of the expansion
12563 including case, then the expansion is copied verbatim.
12564
12565 The expansion is also copied verbatim if the abbreviation itself has
12566 mixed case. And using SPC M-/ to copy an additional word always
12567 copies it verbatim except when the previous copied word is all caps.
12568
12569 *** The values of `dabbrev-case-replace' and `dabbrev-case-fold-search'
12570 are no longer Lisp expressions. They have simply three possible
12571 values.
12572
12573 `dabbrev-case-replace' has these three values: nil (don't preserve
12574 case), t (do), or `case-replace' (do like M-x query-replace).
12575 `dabbrev-case-fold-search' has these three values: nil (don't ignore
12576 case), t (do), or `case-fold-search' (do like search).
12577
12578 ** Minibuffer history lists are truncated automatically now to a
12579 certain length. The variable history-length specifies how long they
12580 can be. The default value is 30.
12581
12582 ** Changes in Mail mode.
12583
12584 *** The key C-x m no longer runs the `mail' command directly.
12585 Instead, it runs the command `compose-mail', which invokes the mail
12586 composition mechanism you have selected with the variable
12587 `mail-user-agent'. The default choice of user agent is
12588 `sendmail-user-agent', which gives behavior compatible with the old
12589 behavior.
12590
12591 C-x 4 m now runs compose-mail-other-window, and C-x 5 m runs
12592 compose-mail-other-frame.
12593
12594 *** While composing a reply to a mail message, from Rmail, you can use
12595 the command C-c C-r to cite just the region from the message you are
12596 replying to. This copies the text which is the selected region in the
12597 buffer that shows the original message.
12598
12599 *** The command C-c C-i inserts a file at the end of the message,
12600 with separator lines around the contents.
12601
12602 *** The command M-x expand-mail-aliases expands all mail aliases
12603 in suitable mail headers. Emacs automatically extracts mail alias
12604 definitions from your mail alias file (e.g., ~/.mailrc). You do not
12605 need to expand mail aliases yourself before sending mail.
12606
12607 *** New features in the mail-complete command.
12608
12609 **** The mail-complete command now inserts the user's full name,
12610 for local users or if that is known. The variable mail-complete-style
12611 controls the style to use, and whether to do this at all.
12612 Its values are like those of mail-from-style.
12613
12614 **** The variable mail-passwd-command lets you specify a shell command
12615 to run to fetch a set of password-entries that add to the ones in
12616 /etc/passwd.
12617
12618 **** The variable mail-passwd-file now specifies a list of files to read
12619 to get the list of user ids. By default, one file is used:
12620 /etc/passwd.
12621
12622 ** You can "quote" a file name to inhibit special significance of
12623 special syntax, by adding `/:' to the beginning. Thus, if you have a
12624 directory named `/foo:', you can prevent it from being treated as a
12625 reference to a remote host named `foo' by writing it as `/:/foo:'.
12626
12627 Emacs uses this new construct automatically when necessary, such as
12628 when you start it with a working directory whose name might otherwise
12629 be taken to be magic.
12630
12631 ** There is a new command M-x grep-find which uses find to select
12632 files to search through, and grep to scan them. The output is
12633 available in a Compile mode buffer, as with M-x grep.
12634
12635 M-x grep now uses the -e option if the grep program supports that.
12636 (-e prevents problems if the search pattern starts with a dash.)
12637
12638 ** In Dired, the & command now flags for deletion the files whose names
12639 suggest they are probably not needed in the long run.
12640
12641 In Dired, * is now a prefix key for mark-related commands.
12642
12643 new key dired.el binding old key
12644 ------- ---------------- -------
12645 * c dired-change-marks c
12646 * m dired-mark m
12647 * * dired-mark-executables * (binding deleted)
12648 * / dired-mark-directories / (binding deleted)
12649 * @ dired-mark-symlinks @ (binding deleted)
12650 * u dired-unmark u
12651 * DEL dired-unmark-backward DEL
12652 * ? dired-unmark-all-files C-M-?
12653 * ! dired-unmark-all-marks
12654 * % dired-mark-files-regexp % m
12655 * C-n dired-next-marked-file M-}
12656 * C-p dired-prev-marked-file M-{
12657
12658 ** Rmail changes.
12659
12660 *** When Rmail cannot convert your incoming mail into Babyl format, it
12661 saves the new mail in the file RMAILOSE.n, where n is an integer
12662 chosen to make a unique name. This way, Rmail will not keep crashing
12663 each time you run it.
12664
12665 *** In Rmail, the variable rmail-summary-line-count-flag now controls
12666 whether to include the line count in the summary. Non-nil means yes.
12667
12668 *** In Rmail summary buffers, d and C-d (the commands to delete
12669 messages) now take repeat counts as arguments. A negative argument
12670 means to move in the opposite direction.
12671
12672 *** In Rmail, the t command now takes an optional argument which lets
12673 you specify whether to show the message headers in full or pruned.
12674
12675 *** In Rmail, the new command w (rmail-output-body-to-file) writes
12676 just the body of the current message into a file, without the headers.
12677 It takes the file name from the message subject, by default, but you
12678 can edit that file name in the minibuffer before it is actually used
12679 for output.
12680
12681 ** Gnus changes.
12682
12683 *** nntp.el has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
12684
12685 *** Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
12686 Gnus.
12687
12688 *** Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like
12689 `and', `or', `not', and parent redirection.
12690
12691 *** Article washing status can be displayed in the
12692 article mode line.
12693
12694 *** gnus.el has been split into many smaller files.
12695
12696 *** Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID.
12697
12698 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
12699
12700 *** New variables for specifying what score and adapt files
12701 are to be considered home score and adapt files. See
12702 `gnus-home-score-file' and `gnus-home-adapt-files'.
12703
12704 *** Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics.
12705
12706 *** Article editing has been revamped and is now usable.
12707
12708 *** Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions.
12709 See `gnus-signature-separator' and `gnus-signature-limit'.
12710
12711 *** Summary pick mode has been made to look more nn-like.
12712 Line numbers are displayed and the `.' command can be
12713 used to pick articles.
12714
12715 *** Commands for moving the .newsrc.eld from one server to
12716 another have been added.
12717
12718 `M-x gnus-change-server'
12719
12720 *** A way to specify that "uninteresting" fields be suppressed when
12721 generating lines in buffers.
12722
12723 *** Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with
12724 `C-M-_'.
12725
12726 *** Scoring can be done on words using the new score type `w'.
12727
12728 *** Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis:
12729
12730 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
12731
12732 *** Scores can be decayed.
12733
12734 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
12735
12736 *** Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The
12737 Date is normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first.
12738
12739 *** A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
12740 the native server.
12741
12742 `M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups'
12743
12744 *** A new command for reading collections of documents
12745 (nndoc with nnvirtual on top) has been added -- `C-M-d'.
12746
12747 *** Process mark sets can be pushed and popped.
12748
12749 *** A new mail-to-news backend makes it possible to post
12750 even when the NNTP server doesn't allow posting.
12751
12752 *** A new backend for reading searches from Web search engines
12753 (DejaNews, Alta Vista, InReference) has been added.
12754
12755 Use the `G w' command in the group buffer to create such
12756 a group.
12757
12758 *** Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard
12759 sorting functions, and each topic can be sorted independently.
12760
12761 See the commands under the `T S' submap.
12762
12763 *** Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently.
12764
12765 See the commands under the `G P' submap.
12766
12767 *** Cached articles can be pulled into the groups.
12768
12769 Use the `Y c' command.
12770
12771 *** Score files are now applied in a more reliable order.
12772
12773 *** Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated.
12774
12775 `M-x nnmail-split-history'
12776
12777 *** More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk
12778 from incoming mail before saving the mail.
12779
12780 See `nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook'.
12781
12782 *** The nnml mail backend now understands compressed article files.
12783
12784 *** To enable Gnus to read/post multi-lingual articles, you must execute
12785 the following code, for instance, in your .emacs.
12786
12787 (add-hook 'gnus-startup-hook 'gnus-mule-initialize)
12788
12789 Then, when you start Gnus, it will decode non-ASCII text automatically
12790 and show appropriate characters. (Note: if you are using gnus-mime
12791 from the SEMI package, formerly known as TM, you should NOT add this
12792 hook to gnus-startup-hook; gnus-mime has its own method of handling
12793 this issue.)
12794
12795 Since it is impossible to distinguish all coding systems
12796 automatically, you may need to specify a choice of coding system for a
12797 particular news group. This can be done by:
12798
12799 (gnus-mule-add-group NEWSGROUP 'CODING-SYSTEM)
12800
12801 Here NEWSGROUP should be a string which names a newsgroup or a tree
12802 of newsgroups. If NEWSGROUP is "XXX.YYY", all news groups under
12803 "XXX.YYY" (including "XXX.YYY.ZZZ") will use the specified coding
12804 system. CODING-SYSTEM specifies which coding system to use (for both
12805 for reading and posting).
12806
12807 CODING-SYSTEM can also be a cons cell of the form
12808 (READ-CODING-SYSTEM . POST-CODING-SYSTEM)
12809 Then READ-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you read messages from the
12810 newsgroups, while POST-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you post messages
12811 there.
12812
12813 Emacs knows the right coding systems for certain newsgroups by
12814 default. Here are some of these default settings:
12815
12816 (gnus-mule-add-group "fj" 'iso-2022-7)
12817 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text" 'hz-gb-2312)
12818 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.hk" 'hz-gb-2312)
12819 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text.big5" 'cn-big5)
12820 (gnus-mule-add-group "soc.culture.vietnamese" '(nil . viqr))
12821
12822 When you reply by mail to an article, these settings are ignored;
12823 the mail is encoded according to sendmail-coding-system, as usual.
12824
12825 ** CC mode changes.
12826
12827 *** If you edit primarily one style of C (or C++, Objective-C, Java)
12828 code, you may want to make the CC Mode style variables have global
12829 values so that you can set them directly in your .emacs file. To do
12830 this, set c-style-variables-are-local-p to nil in your .emacs file.
12831 Note that this only takes effect if you do it *before* cc-mode.el is
12832 loaded.
12833
12834 If you typically edit more than one style of C (or C++, Objective-C,
12835 Java) code in a single Emacs session, you may want to make the CC Mode
12836 style variables have buffer local values. By default, all buffers
12837 share the same style variable settings; to make them buffer local, set
12838 c-style-variables-are-local-p to t in your .emacs file. Note that you
12839 must do this *before* CC Mode is loaded.
12840
12841 *** The new variable c-indentation-style holds the C style name
12842 of the current buffer.
12843
12844 *** The variable c-block-comments-indent-p has been deleted, because
12845 it is no longer necessary. C mode now handles all the supported styles
12846 of block comments, with no need to say which one you will use.
12847
12848 *** There is a new indentation style "python", which specifies the C
12849 style that the Python developers like.
12850
12851 *** There is a new c-cleanup-list option: brace-elseif-brace.
12852 This says to put ...} else if (...) {... on one line,
12853 just as brace-else-brace says to put ...} else {... on one line.
12854
12855 ** VC Changes [new]
12856
12857 *** In vc-retrieve-snapshot (C-x v r), if you don't specify a snapshot
12858 name, it retrieves the *latest* versions of all files in the current
12859 directory and its subdirectories (aside from files already locked).
12860
12861 This feature is useful if your RCS directory is a link to a common
12862 master directory, and you want to pick up changes made by other
12863 developers.
12864
12865 You can do the same thing for an individual file by typing C-u C-x C-q
12866 RET in a buffer visiting that file.
12867
12868 *** VC can now handle files under CVS that are being "watched" by
12869 other developers. Such files are made read-only by CVS. To get a
12870 writable copy, type C-x C-q in a buffer visiting such a file. VC then
12871 calls "cvs edit", which notifies the other developers of it.
12872
12873 *** vc-version-diff (C-u C-x v =) now suggests reasonable defaults for
12874 version numbers, based on the current state of the file.
12875
12876 ** Calendar changes.
12877
12878 *** A new function, list-holidays, allows you list holidays or
12879 subclasses of holidays for ranges of years. Related menu items allow
12880 you do this for the year of the selected date, or the
12881 following/previous years.
12882
12883 *** There is now support for the Baha'i calendar system. Use `pb' in
12884 the *Calendar* buffer to display the current Baha'i date. The Baha'i
12885 calendar, or "Badi calendar" is a system of 19 months with 19 days
12886 each, and 4 intercalary days (5 during a Gregorian leap year). The
12887 calendar begins May 23, 1844, with each of the months named after a
12888 supposed attribute of God.
12889
12890 ** ps-print changes
12891
12892 There are some new user variables and subgroups for customizing the page
12893 layout.
12894
12895 *** Headers & Footers (subgroup)
12896
12897 Some printer systems print a header page and force the first page to
12898 be printed on the back of the header page when using duplex. If your
12899 printer system has this behavior, set variable
12900 `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' to t.
12901
12902 If variable `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' is non-nil, it prints a
12903 blank page as the very first printed page. So, it behaves as if the
12904 very first character of buffer (or region) were a form feed ^L (\014).
12905
12906 The variable `ps-spool-config' specifies who is responsible for
12907 setting duplex mode and page size. Valid values are:
12908
12909 lpr-switches duplex and page size are configured by `ps-lpr-switches'.
12910 Don't forget to set `ps-lpr-switches' to select duplex
12911 printing for your printer.
12912
12913 setpagedevice duplex and page size are configured by ps-print using the
12914 setpagedevice PostScript operator.
12915
12916 nil duplex and page size are configured by ps-print *not* using
12917 the setpagedevice PostScript operator.
12918
12919 The variable `ps-spool-tumble' specifies how the page images on
12920 opposite sides of a sheet are oriented with respect to each other. If
12921 `ps-spool-tumble' is nil, ps-print produces output suitable for
12922 bindings on the left or right. If `ps-spool-tumble' is non-nil,
12923 ps-print produces output suitable for bindings at the top or bottom.
12924 This variable takes effect only if `ps-spool-duplex' is non-nil.
12925 The default value is nil.
12926
12927 The variable `ps-header-frame-alist' specifies a header frame
12928 properties alist. Valid frame properties are:
12929
12930 fore-color Specify the foreground frame color.
12931 Value should be a float number between 0.0 (black
12932 color) and 1.0 (white color), or a string which is a
12933 color name, or a list of 3 float numbers which
12934 correspond to the Red Green Blue color scale, each
12935 float number between 0.0 (dark color) and 1.0 (bright
12936 color). The default is 0 ("black").
12937
12938 back-color Specify the background frame color (similar to fore-color).
12939 The default is 0.9 ("gray90").
12940
12941 shadow-color Specify the shadow color (similar to fore-color).
12942 The default is 0 ("black").
12943
12944 border-color Specify the border color (similar to fore-color).
12945 The default is 0 ("black").
12946
12947 border-width Specify the border width.
12948 The default is 0.4.
12949
12950 Any other property is ignored.
12951
12952 Don't change this alist directly; instead use Custom, or the
12953 `ps-value', `ps-get', `ps-put' and `ps-del' functions (see there for
12954 documentation).
12955
12956 Ps-print can also print footers. The footer variables are:
12957 `ps-print-footer', `ps-footer-offset', `ps-print-footer-frame',
12958 `ps-footer-font-family', `ps-footer-font-size', `ps-footer-line-pad',
12959 `ps-footer-lines', `ps-left-footer', `ps-right-footer' and
12960 `ps-footer-frame-alist'. These variables are similar to those
12961 controlling headers.
12962
12963 *** Color management (subgroup)
12964
12965 If `ps-print-color-p' is non-nil, the buffer's text will be printed in
12966 color.
12967
12968 *** Face Management (subgroup)
12969
12970 If you need to print without worrying about face background colors,
12971 set the variable `ps-use-face-background' which specifies if face
12972 background should be used. Valid values are:
12973
12974 t always use face background color.
12975 nil never use face background color.
12976 (face...) list of faces whose background color will be used.
12977
12978 *** N-up printing (subgroup)
12979
12980 The variable `ps-n-up-printing' specifies the number of pages per
12981 sheet of paper.
12982
12983 The variable `ps-n-up-margin' specifies the margin in points (pt)
12984 between the sheet border and the n-up printing.
12985
12986 If variable `ps-n-up-border-p' is non-nil, a border is drawn around
12987 each page.
12988
12989 The variable `ps-n-up-filling' specifies how the page matrix is filled
12990 on each sheet of paper. Following are the valid values for
12991 `ps-n-up-filling' with a filling example using a 3x4 page matrix:
12992
12993 `left-top' 1 2 3 4 `left-bottom' 9 10 11 12
12994 5 6 7 8 5 6 7 8
12995 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
12996
12997 `right-top' 4 3 2 1 `right-bottom' 12 11 10 9
12998 8 7 6 5 8 7 6 5
12999 12 11 10 9 4 3 2 1
13000
13001 `top-left' 1 4 7 10 `bottom-left' 3 6 9 12
13002 2 5 8 11 2 5 8 11
13003 3 6 9 12 1 4 7 10
13004
13005 `top-right' 10 7 4 1 `bottom-right' 12 9 6 3
13006 11 8 5 2 11 8 5 2
13007 12 9 6 3 10 7 4 1
13008
13009 Any other value is treated as `left-top'.
13010
13011 *** Zebra stripes (subgroup)
13012
13013 The variable `ps-zebra-color' controls the zebra stripes grayscale or
13014 RGB color.
13015
13016 The variable `ps-zebra-stripe-follow' specifies how zebra stripes
13017 continue on next page. Visually, valid values are (the character `+'
13018 to the right of each column indicates that a line is printed):
13019
13020 `nil' `follow' `full' `full-follow'
13021 Current Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
13022 1 XXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXX + 1 XXXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13023 2 XXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXX + 2 XXXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13024 3 XXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXX + 3 XXXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13025 4 + 4 + 4 + 4 +
13026 5 + 5 + 5 + 5 +
13027 6 + 6 + 6 + 6 +
13028 7 XXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXX + 7 XXXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13029 8 XXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXX + 8 XXXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13030 9 XXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXX + 9 XXXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13031 10 + 10 +
13032 11 + 11 +
13033 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
13034 Next Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
13035 12 XXXXX + 12 + 10 XXXXXX + 10 +
13036 13 XXXXX + 13 XXXXXXXX + 11 XXXXXX + 11 +
13037 14 XXXXX + 14 XXXXXXXX + 12 XXXXXX + 12 +
13038 15 + 15 XXXXXXXX + 13 + 13 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13039 16 + 16 + 14 + 14 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13040 17 + 17 + 15 + 15 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13041 18 XXXXX + 18 + 16 XXXXXX + 16 +
13042 19 XXXXX + 19 XXXXXXXX + 17 XXXXXX + 17 +
13043 20 XXXXX + 20 XXXXXXXX + 18 XXXXXX + 18 +
13044 21 + 21 XXXXXXXX +
13045 22 + 22 +
13046 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
13047
13048 Any other value is treated as `nil'.
13049
13050
13051 *** Printer management (subgroup)
13052
13053 The variable `ps-printer-name-option' determines the option used by
13054 some utilities to indicate the printer name; it's used only when
13055 `ps-printer-name' is a non-empty string. If you're using the lpr
13056 utility to print, for example, `ps-printer-name-option' should be set
13057 to "-P".
13058
13059 The variable `ps-manual-feed' indicates if the printer requires manual
13060 paper feeding. If it's nil, automatic feeding takes place. If it's
13061 non-nil, manual feeding takes place.
13062
13063 The variable `ps-end-with-control-d' specifies whether C-d (\x04)
13064 should be inserted at end of the generated PostScript. Non-nil means
13065 do so.
13066
13067 *** Page settings (subgroup)
13068
13069 If variable `ps-warn-paper-type' is nil, it's *not* treated as an
13070 error if the PostScript printer doesn't have a paper with the size
13071 indicated by `ps-paper-type'; the default paper size will be used
13072 instead. If `ps-warn-paper-type' is non-nil, an error is signaled if
13073 the PostScript printer doesn't support a paper with the size indicated
13074 by `ps-paper-type'. This is used when `ps-spool-config' is set to
13075 `setpagedevice'.
13076
13077 The variable `ps-print-upside-down' determines the orientation for
13078 printing pages: nil means `normal' printing, non-nil means
13079 `upside-down' printing (that is, the page is rotated by 180 degrees).
13080
13081 The variable `ps-selected-pages' specifies which pages to print. If
13082 it's nil, all pages are printed. If it's a list, list elements may be
13083 integers specifying a single page to print, or cons cells (FROM . TO)
13084 specifying to print from page FROM to TO. Invalid list elements, that
13085 is integers smaller than one, or elements whose FROM is greater than
13086 its TO, are ignored.
13087
13088 The variable `ps-even-or-odd-pages' specifies how to print even/odd
13089 pages. Valid values are:
13090
13091 nil print all pages.
13092
13093 `even-page' print only even pages.
13094
13095 `odd-page' print only odd pages.
13096
13097 `even-sheet' print only even sheets.
13098 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
13099 `even-page', but for values greater than 1, it'll
13100 print only the even sheet of paper.
13101
13102 `odd-sheet' print only odd sheets.
13103 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
13104 `odd-page'; but for values greater than 1, it'll print
13105 only the odd sheet of paper.
13106
13107 Any other value is treated as nil.
13108
13109 If you set `ps-selected-pages' (see there for documentation), pages
13110 are filtered by `ps-selected-pages', and then by
13111 `ps-even-or-odd-pages'. For example, if we have:
13112
13113 (setq ps-selected-pages '(1 4 (6 . 10) (12 . 16) 20))
13114
13115 and we combine this with `ps-even-or-odd-pages' and
13116 `ps-n-up-printing', we get:
13117
13118 `ps-n-up-printing' = 1:
13119 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
13120 nil 1, 4, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 20
13121 even-page 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
13122 odd-page 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
13123 even-sheet 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
13124 odd-sheet 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
13125
13126 `ps-n-up-printing' = 2:
13127 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
13128 nil 1/4, 6/7, 8/9, 10/12, 13/14, 15/16, 20
13129 even-page 4/6, 8/10, 12/14, 16/20
13130 odd-page 1/7, 9/13, 15
13131 even-sheet 6/7, 10/12, 15/16
13132 odd-sheet 1/4, 8/9, 13/14, 20
13133
13134 *** Miscellany (subgroup)
13135
13136 The variable `ps-error-handler-message' specifies where error handler
13137 messages should be sent.
13138
13139 It is also possible to add a user-defined PostScript prologue code in
13140 front of all generated prologue code by setting the variable
13141 `ps-user-defined-prologue'.
13142
13143 The variable `ps-line-number-font' specifies the font for line numbers.
13144
13145 The variable `ps-line-number-font-size' specifies the font size in
13146 points for line numbers.
13147
13148 The variable `ps-line-number-color' specifies the color for line
13149 numbers. See `ps-zebra-color' for documentation.
13150
13151 The variable `ps-line-number-step' specifies the interval in which
13152 line numbers are printed. For example, if `ps-line-number-step' is set
13153 to 2, the printing will look like:
13154
13155 1 one line
13156 one line
13157 3 one line
13158 one line
13159 5 one line
13160 one line
13161 ...
13162
13163 Valid values are:
13164
13165 integer an integer specifying the interval in which line numbers are
13166 printed. If it's smaller than or equal to zero, 1
13167 is used.
13168
13169 `zebra' specifies that only the line number of the first line in a
13170 zebra stripe is to be printed.
13171
13172 Any other value is treated as `zebra'.
13173
13174 The variable `ps-line-number-start' specifies the starting point in
13175 the interval given by `ps-line-number-step'. For example, if
13176 `ps-line-number-step' is set to 3, and `ps-line-number-start' is set to
13177 3, the output will look like:
13178
13179 one line
13180 one line
13181 3 one line
13182 one line
13183 one line
13184 6 one line
13185 one line
13186 one line
13187 9 one line
13188 one line
13189 ...
13190
13191 The variable `ps-postscript-code-directory' specifies the directory
13192 where the PostScript prologue file used by ps-print is found.
13193
13194 The variable `ps-line-spacing' determines the line spacing in points,
13195 for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
13196 `ps-font-size').
13197
13198 The variable `ps-paragraph-spacing' determines the paragraph spacing,
13199 in points, for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
13200 `ps-font-size').
13201
13202 The variable `ps-paragraph-regexp' specifies the paragraph delimiter.
13203
13204 The variable `ps-begin-cut-regexp' and `ps-end-cut-regexp' specify the
13205 start and end of a region to cut out when printing.
13206
13207 ** hideshow changes.
13208
13209 *** now supports hiding of blocks of single line comments (like // for
13210 C++, ; for lisp).
13211
13212 *** Support for java-mode added.
13213
13214 *** When doing `hs-hide-all' it is now possible to also hide the comments
13215 in the file if `hs-hide-comments-when-hiding-all' is set.
13216
13217 *** The new function `hs-hide-initial-comment' hides the comments at
13218 the beginning of the files. Finally those huge RCS logs don't stay in your
13219 way! This is run by default when entering the `hs-minor-mode'.
13220
13221 *** Now uses overlays instead of `selective-display', so is more
13222 robust and a lot faster.
13223
13224 *** A block beginning can span multiple lines.
13225
13226 *** The new variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' if t, directs hideshow
13227 to show only the beginning of a block when it is hidden. See the
13228 documentation for more details.
13229
13230 ** Changes in Enriched mode.
13231
13232 *** When you visit a file in enriched-mode, Emacs will make sure it is
13233 filled to the current fill-column. This behavior is now independent
13234 of the size of the window. When you save the file, the fill-column in
13235 use is stored as well, so that the whole buffer need not be refilled
13236 the next time unless the fill-column is different.
13237
13238 *** use-hard-newlines is now a minor mode. When it is enabled, Emacs
13239 distinguishes between hard and soft newlines, and treats hard newlines
13240 as paragraph boundaries. Otherwise all newlines inserted are marked
13241 as soft, and paragraph boundaries are determined solely from the text.
13242
13243 ** Font Lock mode
13244
13245 *** Custom support
13246
13247 The variables font-lock-face-attributes, font-lock-display-type and
13248 font-lock-background-mode are now obsolete; the recommended way to specify the
13249 faces to use for Font Lock mode is with M-x customize-group on the new custom
13250 group font-lock-highlighting-faces. If you set font-lock-face-attributes in
13251 your ~/.emacs file, Font Lock mode will respect its value. However, you should
13252 consider converting from setting that variable to using M-x customize.
13253
13254 You can still use X resources to specify Font Lock face appearances.
13255
13256 *** Maximum decoration
13257
13258 Fontification now uses the maximum level of decoration supported by
13259 default. Previously, fontification used a mode-specific default level
13260 of decoration, which is typically the minimum level of decoration
13261 supported. You can set font-lock-maximum-decoration to nil
13262 to get the old behavior.
13263
13264 *** New support
13265
13266 Support is now provided for Java, Objective-C, AWK and SIMULA modes.
13267
13268 Note that Font Lock mode can be turned on without knowing exactly what modes
13269 support Font Lock mode, via the command global-font-lock-mode.
13270
13271 *** Configurable support
13272
13273 Support for C, C++, Objective-C and Java can be more easily configured for
13274 additional types and classes via the new variables c-font-lock-extra-types,
13275 c++-font-lock-extra-types, objc-font-lock-extra-types and, you guessed it,
13276 java-font-lock-extra-types. These value of each of these variables should be a
13277 list of regexps matching the extra type names. For example, the default value
13278 of c-font-lock-extra-types is ("\\sw+_t") which means fontification follows the
13279 convention that C type names end in _t. This results in slower fontification.
13280
13281 Of course, you can change the variables that specify fontification in whatever
13282 way you wish, typically by adding regexps. However, these new variables make
13283 it easier to make specific and common changes for the fontification of types.
13284
13285 *** Adding highlighting patterns to existing support
13286
13287 You can use the new function font-lock-add-keywords to add your own
13288 highlighting patterns, such as for project-local or user-specific constructs,
13289 for any mode.
13290
13291 For example, to highlight `FIXME:' words in C comments, put:
13292
13293 (font-lock-add-keywords 'c-mode '(("\\<FIXME:" 0 font-lock-warning-face t)))
13294
13295 in your ~/.emacs.
13296
13297 *** New faces
13298
13299 Font Lock now defines two new faces, font-lock-builtin-face and
13300 font-lock-warning-face. These are intended to highlight builtin keywords,
13301 distinct from a language's normal keywords, and objects that should be brought
13302 to user attention, respectively. Various modes now use these new faces.
13303
13304 *** Changes to fast-lock support mode
13305
13306 The fast-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now process
13307 cache files silently. You can use the new variable fast-lock-verbose, in the
13308 same way as font-lock-verbose, to control this feature.
13309
13310 *** Changes to lazy-lock support mode
13311
13312 The lazy-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now fontify
13313 according to the true syntactic context relative to other lines. You can use
13314 the new variable lazy-lock-defer-contextually to control this feature. If
13315 non-nil, changes to the buffer will cause subsequent lines in the buffer to be
13316 refontified after lazy-lock-defer-time seconds of idle time. If nil, then only
13317 the modified lines will be refontified; this is the same as the previous Lazy
13318 Lock mode behavior and the behavior of Font Lock mode.
13319
13320 This feature is useful in modes where strings or comments can span lines.
13321 For example, if a string or comment terminating character is deleted, then if
13322 this feature is enabled subsequent lines in the buffer will be correctly
13323 refontified to reflect their new syntactic context. Previously, only the line
13324 containing the deleted character would be refontified and you would have to use
13325 the command M-o M-o (font-lock-fontify-block) to refontify some lines.
13326
13327 As a consequence of this new feature, two other variables have changed:
13328
13329 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-driven' is renamed `lazy-lock-defer-on-scrolling'.
13330 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-time' can now only be a time, i.e., a number.
13331 Buffer modes for which on-the-fly deferral applies can be specified via the
13332 new variable `lazy-lock-defer-on-the-fly'.
13333
13334 If you set these variables in your ~/.emacs, then you may have to change those
13335 settings.
13336
13337 ** Ada mode changes.
13338
13339 *** There is now better support for using find-file.el with Ada mode.
13340 If you switch between spec and body, the cursor stays in the same
13341 procedure (modulo overloading). If a spec has no body file yet, but
13342 you try to switch to its body file, Ada mode now generates procedure
13343 stubs.
13344
13345 *** There are two new commands:
13346 - `ada-make-local' : invokes gnatmake on the current buffer
13347 - `ada-check-syntax' : check syntax of current buffer.
13348
13349 The user options `ada-compiler-make', `ada-make-options',
13350 `ada-language-version', `ada-compiler-syntax-check', and
13351 `ada-compile-options' are used within these commands.
13352
13353 *** Ada mode can now work with Outline minor mode. The outline level
13354 is calculated from the indenting, not from syntactic constructs.
13355 Outlining does not work if your code is not correctly indented.
13356
13357 *** The new function `ada-gnat-style' converts the buffer to the style of
13358 formatting used in GNAT. It places two blanks after a comment start,
13359 places one blank between a word end and an opening '(', and puts one
13360 space between a comma and the beginning of a word.
13361
13362 ** Scheme mode changes.
13363
13364 *** Scheme mode indentation now uses many of the facilities of Lisp
13365 mode; therefore, the variables to customize it are the variables used
13366 for Lisp mode which have names starting with `lisp-'. The variables
13367 with names starting with `scheme-' which used to do this no longer
13368 have any effect.
13369
13370 If you want to use different indentation for Scheme and Lisp, this is
13371 still possible, but now you must do it by adding a hook to
13372 scheme-mode-hook, which could work by setting the `lisp-' indentation
13373 variables as buffer-local variables.
13374
13375 *** DSSSL mode is a variant of Scheme mode, for editing DSSSL scripts.
13376 Use M-x dsssl-mode.
13377
13378 ** Changes to the emacsclient program
13379
13380 *** If a socket can't be found, and environment variables LOGNAME or
13381 USER are set, emacsclient now looks for a socket based on the UID
13382 associated with the name. That is an emacsclient running as root
13383 can connect to an Emacs server started by a non-root user.
13384
13385 *** The emacsclient program now accepts an option --no-wait which tells
13386 it to return immediately without waiting for you to "finish" the
13387 buffer in Emacs.
13388
13389 *** The new option --alternate-editor allows to specify an editor to
13390 use if Emacs is not running. The environment variable
13391 ALTERNATE_EDITOR can be used for the same effect; the command line
13392 option takes precedence.
13393
13394 ** M-x eldoc-mode enables a minor mode in which the echo area
13395 constantly shows the parameter list for function being called at point
13396 (in Emacs Lisp and Lisp Interaction modes only).
13397
13398 ** C-x n d now runs the new command narrow-to-defun,
13399 which narrows the accessible parts of the buffer to just
13400 the current defun.
13401
13402 ** Emacs now handles the `--' argument in the standard way; all
13403 following arguments are treated as ordinary file names.
13404
13405 ** On MSDOS and Windows, the bookmark file is now called _emacs.bmk,
13406 and the saved desktop file is now called _emacs.desktop (truncated if
13407 necessary).
13408
13409 ** When you kill a buffer that visits a file,
13410 if there are any registers that save positions in the file,
13411 these register values no longer become completely useless.
13412 If you try to go to such a register with C-x j, then you are
13413 asked whether to visit the file again. If you say yes,
13414 it visits the file and then goes to the same position.
13415
13416 ** When you visit a file that changes frequently outside Emacs--for
13417 example, a log of output from a process that continues to run--it may
13418 be useful for Emacs to revert the file without querying you whenever
13419 you visit the file afresh with C-x C-f.
13420
13421 You can request this behavior for certain files by setting the
13422 variable revert-without-query to a list of regular expressions. If a
13423 file's name matches any of these regular expressions, find-file and
13424 revert-buffer revert the buffer without asking for permission--but
13425 only if you have not edited the buffer text yourself.
13426
13427 ** set-default-font has been renamed to set-frame-font
13428 since it applies only to the current frame.
13429
13430 ** In TeX mode, you can use the variable tex-main-file to specify the
13431 file for tex-file to run TeX on. (By default, tex-main-file is nil,
13432 and tex-file runs TeX on the current visited file.)
13433
13434 This is useful when you are editing a document that consists of
13435 multiple files. In each of the included files, you can set up a local
13436 variable list which specifies the top-level file of your document for
13437 tex-main-file. Then tex-file will run TeX on the whole document
13438 instead of just the file you are editing.
13439
13440 ** RefTeX mode
13441
13442 RefTeX mode is a new minor mode with special support for \label, \ref
13443 and \cite macros in LaTeX documents. RefTeX distinguishes labels of
13444 different environments (equation, figure, ...) and has full support for
13445 multifile documents. To use it, select a buffer with a LaTeX document and
13446 turn the mode on with M-x reftex-mode. Here are the main user commands:
13447
13448 C-c ( reftex-label
13449 Creates a label semi-automatically. RefTeX is context sensitive and
13450 knows which kind of label is needed.
13451
13452 C-c ) reftex-reference
13453 Offers in a menu all labels in the document, along with context of the
13454 label definition. The selected label is referenced as \ref{LABEL}.
13455
13456 C-c [ reftex-citation
13457 Prompts for a regular expression and displays a list of matching BibTeX
13458 database entries. The selected entry is cited with a \cite{KEY} macro.
13459
13460 C-c & reftex-view-crossref
13461 Views the cross reference of a \ref or \cite command near point.
13462
13463 C-c = reftex-toc
13464 Shows a table of contents of the (multifile) document. From there you
13465 can quickly jump to every section.
13466
13467 Under X, RefTeX installs a "Ref" menu in the menu bar, with additional
13468 commands. Press `?' to get help when a prompt mentions this feature.
13469 Full documentation and customization examples are in the file
13470 reftex.el. You can use the finder to view the file documentation:
13471 C-h p --> tex --> reftex.el
13472
13473 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
13474
13475 *** Info documentation is now available.
13476
13477 *** Don't allow parentheses in string constants anymore. This confused
13478 both the BibTeX program and Emacs BibTeX mode.
13479
13480 *** Renamed variable bibtex-mode-user-optional-fields to
13481 bibtex-user-optional-fields.
13482
13483 *** Removed variable bibtex-include-OPTannote
13484 (use bibtex-user-optional-fields instead).
13485
13486 *** New interactive functions to copy and kill fields and complete
13487 entries to the BibTeX kill ring, from where they can be yanked back by
13488 appropriate functions.
13489
13490 *** New interactive functions for repositioning and marking of
13491 entries. They are bound by default to C-M-l and C-M-h.
13492
13493 *** New hook bibtex-clean-entry-hook. It is called after entry has
13494 been cleaned.
13495
13496 *** New variable bibtex-field-delimiters, which replaces variables
13497 bibtex-field-{left|right}-delimiter.
13498
13499 *** New variable bibtex-entry-delimiters to determine how entries
13500 shall be delimited.
13501
13502 *** Allow preinitialization of fields. See documentation of
13503 bibtex-user-optional-fields, bibtex-entry-field-alist, and
13504 bibtex-include-OPTkey for details.
13505
13506 *** Book and InBook entries require either an author or an editor
13507 field. This is now supported by bibtex.el. Alternative fields are
13508 prefixed with `ALT'.
13509
13510 *** New variable bibtex-entry-format, which replaces variable
13511 bibtex-clean-entry-zap-empty-opts and allows specification of many
13512 formatting options performed on cleaning an entry (see variable
13513 documentation).
13514
13515 *** Even more control on how automatic keys are generated. See
13516 documentation of bibtex-generate-autokey for details. Transcriptions
13517 for foreign languages other than German are now handled, too.
13518
13519 *** New boolean user option bibtex-comma-after-last-field to decide if
13520 comma should be inserted at end of last field.
13521
13522 *** New boolean user option bibtex-align-at-equal-sign to determine if
13523 alignment should be made at left side of field contents or at equal
13524 signs. New user options to control entry layout (e.g. indentation).
13525
13526 *** New function bibtex-fill-entry to realign entries.
13527
13528 *** New function bibtex-reformat to reformat region or buffer.
13529
13530 *** New function bibtex-convert-alien to convert a BibTeX database
13531 from alien sources.
13532
13533 *** New function bibtex-complete-key (similar to bibtex-complete-string)
13534 to complete prefix to a key defined in buffer. Mainly useful in
13535 crossref entries.
13536
13537 *** New function bibtex-count-entries to count entries in buffer or
13538 region.
13539
13540 *** Added support for imenu.
13541
13542 *** The function `bibtex-validate' now checks current region instead
13543 of buffer if mark is active. Now it shows all errors of buffer in a
13544 `compilation mode' buffer. You can use the normal commands (e.g.
13545 `next-error') for compilation modes to jump to errors.
13546
13547 *** New variable `bibtex-string-file-path' to determine where the files
13548 from `bibtex-string-files' are searched.
13549
13550 ** Iso Accents mode now supports Latin-3 as an alternative.
13551
13552 ** The command next-error now opens blocks hidden by hideshow.
13553
13554 ** The function using-unix-filesystems has been replaced by the
13555 functions add-untranslated-filesystem and remove-untranslated-filesystem.
13556 Each of these functions takes the name of a drive letter or directory
13557 as an argument.
13558
13559 When a filesystem is added as untranslated, all files on it are read
13560 and written in binary mode (no cr/lf translation is performed).
13561
13562 ** browse-url changes
13563
13564 *** New methods for: Grail (browse-url-generic), MMM (browse-url-mmm),
13565 Lynx in a separate xterm (browse-url-lynx-xterm) or in an Emacs window
13566 (browse-url-lynx-emacs), remote W3 (browse-url-w3-gnudoit), generic
13567 non-remote-controlled browsers (browse-url-generic) and associated
13568 customization variables.
13569
13570 *** New commands `browse-url-of-region' and `browse-url'.
13571
13572 *** URLs marked up with <URL:...> (RFC1738) work if broken across
13573 lines. Browsing methods can be associated with URL regexps
13574 (e.g. mailto: URLs) via `browse-url-browser-function'.
13575
13576 ** Changes in Ediff
13577
13578 *** Clicking Mouse-2 on a brief command description in Ediff control panel
13579 pops up the Info file for this command.
13580
13581 *** There is now a variable, ediff-autostore-merges, which controls whether
13582 the result of a merge is saved in a file. By default, this is done only when
13583 merge is done from a session group (eg, when merging files in two different
13584 directories).
13585
13586 *** Since Emacs 19.31 (this hasn't been announced before), Ediff can compare
13587 and merge groups of files residing in different directories, or revisions of
13588 files in the same directory.
13589
13590 *** Since Emacs 19.31, Ediff can apply multi-file patches interactively.
13591 The patches must be in the context format or GNU unified format. (The bug
13592 related to the GNU format has now been fixed.)
13593
13594 ** Changes in Viper
13595
13596 *** The startup file is now .viper instead of .vip
13597 *** All variable/function names have been changed to start with viper-
13598 instead of vip-.
13599 *** C-\ now simulates the meta-key in all Viper states.
13600 *** C-z in Insert state now escapes to Vi for the duration of the next
13601 Viper command. In Vi and Insert states, C-z behaves as before.
13602 *** C-c \ escapes to Vi for one command if Viper is in Insert or Emacs states.
13603 *** _ is no longer the meta-key in Vi state.
13604 *** The variable viper-insert-state-cursor-color can be used to change cursor
13605 color when Viper is in insert state.
13606 *** If search lands the cursor near the top or the bottom of the window,
13607 Viper pulls the window up or down to expose more context. The variable
13608 viper-adjust-window-after-search controls this behavior.
13609
13610 ** Etags changes.
13611
13612 *** In C, C++, Objective C and Java, Etags tags global variables by
13613 default. The resulting tags files are inflated by 30% on average.
13614 Use --no-globals to turn this feature off. Etags can also tag
13615 variables which are members of structure-like constructs, but it does
13616 not by default. Use --members to turn this feature on.
13617
13618 *** C++ member functions are now recognized as tags.
13619
13620 *** Java is tagged like C++. In addition, "extends" and "implements"
13621 constructs are tagged. Files are recognized by the extension .java.
13622
13623 *** Etags can now handle programs written in Postscript. Files are
13624 recognized by the extensions .ps and .pdb (Postscript with C syntax).
13625 In Postscript, tags are lines that start with a slash.
13626
13627 *** Etags now handles Objective C and Objective C++ code. The usual C and
13628 C++ tags are recognized in these languages; in addition, etags
13629 recognizes special Objective C syntax for classes, class categories,
13630 methods and protocols.
13631
13632 *** Etags also handles Cobol. Files are recognized by the extension
13633 .cobol. The tagged lines are those containing a word that begins in
13634 column 8 and ends in a full stop, i.e. anything that could be a
13635 paragraph name.
13636
13637 *** Regexps in Etags now support intervals, as in ed or grep. The syntax of
13638 an interval is \{M,N\}, and it means to match the preceding expression
13639 at least M times and as many as N times.
13640
13641 ** The format for specifying a custom format for time-stamp to insert
13642 in files has changed slightly.
13643
13644 With the new enhancements to the functionality of format-time-string,
13645 time-stamp-format will change to be eventually compatible with it.
13646 This conversion is being done in two steps to maintain compatibility
13647 with old time-stamp-format values.
13648
13649 In the new scheme, alternate case is signified by the number-sign
13650 (`#') modifier, rather than changing the case of the format character.
13651 This feature is as yet incompletely implemented for compatibility
13652 reasons.
13653
13654 In the old time-stamp-format, all numeric fields defaulted to their
13655 natural width. (With format-time-string, each format has a
13656 fixed-width default.) In this version, you can specify the colon
13657 (`:') modifier to a numeric conversion to mean "give me the historical
13658 time-stamp-format width default." Do not use colon if you are
13659 specifying an explicit width, as in "%02d".
13660
13661 Numbers are no longer truncated to the requested width, except in the
13662 case of "%02y", which continues to give a two-digit year. Digit
13663 truncation probably wasn't being used for anything else anyway.
13664
13665 The new formats will work with old versions of Emacs. New formats are
13666 being recommended now to allow time-stamp-format to change in the
13667 future to be compatible with format-time-string. The new forms being
13668 recommended now will continue to work then.
13669
13670 See the documentation string for the variable time-stamp-format for
13671 details.
13672
13673 ** There are some additional major modes:
13674
13675 dcl-mode, for editing VMS DCL files.
13676 m4-mode, for editing files of m4 input.
13677 meta-mode, for editing MetaFont and MetaPost source files.
13678
13679 ** In Shell mode, the command shell-copy-environment-variable lets you
13680 copy the value of a specified environment variable from the subshell
13681 into Emacs.
13682
13683 ** New Lisp packages include:
13684
13685 *** battery.el displays battery status for laptops.
13686
13687 *** M-x bruce (named after Lenny Bruce) is a program that might
13688 be used for adding some indecent words to your email.
13689
13690 *** M-x crisp-mode enables an emulation for the CRiSP editor.
13691
13692 *** M-x dirtrack arranges for better tracking of directory changes
13693 in shell buffers.
13694
13695 *** The new library elint.el provides for linting of Emacs Lisp code.
13696 See the documentation for `elint-initialize', `elint-current-buffer'
13697 and `elint-defun'.
13698
13699 *** M-x expand-add-abbrevs defines a special kind of abbrev which is
13700 meant for programming constructs. These abbrevs expand like ordinary
13701 ones, when you type SPC, but only at the end of a line and not within
13702 strings or comments.
13703
13704 These abbrevs can act as templates: you can define places within an
13705 abbrev for insertion of additional text. Once you expand the abbrev,
13706 you can then use C-x a p and C-x a n to move back and forth to these
13707 insertion points. Thus you can conveniently insert additional text
13708 at these points.
13709
13710 *** filecache.el remembers the location of files so that you
13711 can visit them by short forms of their names.
13712
13713 *** find-func.el lets you find the definition of the user-loaded
13714 Emacs Lisp function at point.
13715
13716 *** M-x handwrite converts text to a "handwritten" picture.
13717
13718 *** M-x iswitchb-buffer is a command for switching to a buffer, much like
13719 switch-buffer, but it reads the argument in a more helpful way.
13720
13721 *** M-x landmark implements a neural network for landmark learning.
13722
13723 *** M-x locate provides a convenient interface to the `locate' program.
13724
13725 *** M4 mode is a new mode for editing files of m4 input.
13726
13727 *** mantemp.el creates C++ manual template instantiations
13728 from the GCC error messages which indicate which instantiations are needed.
13729
13730 *** mouse-copy.el provides a one-click copy and move feature.
13731 You can drag a region with M-mouse-1, and it is automatically
13732 inserted at point. M-Shift-mouse-1 deletes the text from its
13733 original place after inserting the copy.
13734
13735 *** mouse-drag.el lets you do scrolling by dragging Mouse-2
13736 on the buffer.
13737
13738 You click the mouse and move; that distance either translates into the
13739 velocity to scroll (with mouse-drag-throw) or the distance to scroll
13740 (with mouse-drag-drag). Horizontal scrolling is enabled when needed.
13741
13742 Enable mouse-drag with:
13743 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-throw)
13744 -or-
13745 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-drag)
13746
13747 *** mspools.el is useful for determining which mail folders have
13748 mail waiting to be read in them. It works with procmail.
13749
13750 *** Octave mode is a major mode for editing files of input for Octave.
13751 It comes with a facility for communicating with an Octave subprocess.
13752
13753 *** ogonek
13754
13755 The ogonek package provides functions for changing the coding of
13756 Polish diacritic characters in buffers. Codings known from various
13757 platforms are supported such as ISO8859-2, Mazovia, IBM Latin2, and
13758 TeX. For example, you can change the coding from Mazovia to
13759 ISO8859-2. Another example is a change of coding from ISO8859-2 to
13760 prefix notation (in which `/a' stands for the aogonek character, for
13761 instance) and vice versa.
13762
13763 To use this package load it using
13764 M-x load-library [enter] ogonek
13765 Then, you may get an explanation by calling one of
13766 M-x ogonek-jak -- in Polish
13767 M-x ogonek-how -- in English
13768 The info specifies the commands and variables provided as well as the
13769 ways of customization in `.emacs'.
13770
13771 *** Interface to ph.
13772
13773 Emacs provides a client interface to CCSO Nameservers (ph/qi)
13774
13775 The CCSO nameserver is used in many universities to provide directory
13776 services about people. ph.el provides a convenient Emacs interface to
13777 these servers.
13778
13779 *** uce.el is useful for replying to unsolicited commercial email.
13780
13781 *** vcursor.el implements a "virtual cursor" feature.
13782 You can move the virtual cursor with special commands
13783 while the real cursor does not move.
13784
13785 *** webjump.el is a "hot list" package which you can set up
13786 for visiting your favorite web sites.
13787
13788 *** M-x winner-mode is a minor mode which saves window configurations,
13789 so you can move back to other configurations that you have recently used.
13790
13791 ** movemail change
13792
13793 Movemail no longer needs to be installed setuid root in order for POP
13794 mail retrieval to function properly. This is because it no longer
13795 supports the RPOP (reserved-port POP) protocol; instead, it uses the
13796 user's POP password to authenticate to the mail server.
13797
13798 This change was made earlier, but not reported in NEWS before.
13799 \f
13800 * Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows.
13801
13802 ** Changes in handling MS-DOS/MS-Windows text files.
13803
13804 Emacs handles three different conventions for representing
13805 end-of-line: CRLF for MSDOS, LF for Unix and GNU, and CR (used on the
13806 Macintosh). Emacs determines which convention is used in a specific
13807 file based on the contents of that file (except for certain special
13808 file names), and when it saves the file, it uses the same convention.
13809
13810 To save the file and change the end-of-line convention, you can use
13811 C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system) to specify a different
13812 coding system for the buffer. Then, when you save the file, the newly
13813 specified coding system will take effect. For example, to save with
13814 LF, specify undecided-unix (or some other ...-unix coding system); to
13815 save with CRLF, specify undecided-dos.
13816 \f
13817 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 20.1
13818
13819 ** Byte-compiled files made with Emacs 20 will, in general, work in
13820 Emacs 19 as well, as long as the source code runs in Emacs 19. And
13821 vice versa: byte-compiled files made with Emacs 19 should also run in
13822 Emacs 20, as long as the program itself works in Emacs 20.
13823
13824 ** Windows-specific functions and variables have been renamed
13825 to start with w32- instead of win32-.
13826
13827 In hacker language, calling something a "win" is a form of praise. We
13828 don't want to praise a non-free Microsoft system, so we don't call it
13829 "win".
13830
13831 ** Basic Lisp changes
13832
13833 *** A symbol whose name starts with a colon now automatically
13834 evaluates to itself. Therefore such a symbol can be used as a constant.
13835
13836 *** The defined purpose of `defconst' has been changed. It should now
13837 be used only for values that should not be changed whether by a program
13838 or by the user.
13839
13840 The actual behavior of defconst has not been changed.
13841
13842 *** There are new macros `when' and `unless'
13843
13844 (when CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION (progn BODY...))
13845 (unless CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION nil BODY...)
13846
13847 *** Emacs now defines functions caar, cadr, cdar and cddr with their
13848 usual Lisp meanings. For example, caar returns the car of the car of
13849 its argument.
13850
13851 *** equal, when comparing strings, now ignores their text properties.
13852
13853 *** The new function `functionp' tests whether an object is a function.
13854
13855 *** arrayp now returns t for char-tables and bool-vectors.
13856
13857 *** Certain primitives which use characters (as integers) now get an
13858 error if the integer is not a valid character code. These primitives
13859 include insert-char, char-to-string, and the %c construct in the
13860 `format' function.
13861
13862 *** The `require' function now insists on adding a suffix, either .el
13863 or .elc, to the file name. Thus, (require 'foo) will not use a file
13864 whose name is just foo. It insists on foo.el or foo.elc.
13865
13866 *** The `autoload' function, when the file name does not contain
13867 either a directory name or the suffix .el or .elc, insists on
13868 adding one of these suffixes.
13869
13870 *** string-to-number now takes an optional second argument BASE
13871 which specifies the base to use when converting an integer.
13872 If BASE is omitted, base 10 is used.
13873
13874 We have not implemented other radices for floating point numbers,
13875 because that would be much more work and does not seem useful.
13876
13877 *** substring now handles vectors as well as strings.
13878
13879 *** The Common Lisp function eql is no longer defined normally.
13880 You must load the `cl' library to define it.
13881
13882 *** The new macro `with-current-buffer' lets you evaluate an expression
13883 conveniently with a different current buffer. It looks like this:
13884
13885 (with-current-buffer BUFFER BODY-FORMS...)
13886
13887 BUFFER is the expression that says which buffer to use.
13888 BODY-FORMS say what to do in that buffer.
13889
13890 *** The new primitive `save-current-buffer' saves and restores the
13891 choice of current buffer, like `save-excursion', but without saving or
13892 restoring the value of point or the mark. `with-current-buffer'
13893 works using `save-current-buffer'.
13894
13895 *** The new macro `with-temp-file' lets you do some work in a new buffer and
13896 write the output to a specified file. Like `progn', it returns the value
13897 of the last form.
13898
13899 *** The new macro `with-temp-buffer' lets you do some work in a new buffer,
13900 which is discarded after use. Like `progn', it returns the value of the
13901 last form. If you wish to return the buffer contents, use (buffer-string)
13902 as the last form.
13903
13904 *** The new function split-string takes a string, splits it at certain
13905 characters, and returns a list of the substrings in between the
13906 matches.
13907
13908 For example, (split-string "foo bar lose" " +") returns ("foo" "bar" "lose").
13909
13910 *** The new macro with-output-to-string executes some Lisp expressions
13911 with standard-output set up so that all output feeds into a string.
13912 Then it returns that string.
13913
13914 For example, if the current buffer name is `foo',
13915
13916 (with-output-to-string
13917 (princ "The buffer is ")
13918 (princ (buffer-name)))
13919
13920 returns "The buffer is foo".
13921
13922 ** Non-ASCII characters are now supported, if enable-multibyte-characters
13923 is non-nil.
13924
13925 These characters have character codes above 256. When inserted in the
13926 buffer or stored in a string, they are represented as multibyte
13927 characters that occupy several buffer positions each.
13928
13929 *** When enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, a single character in
13930 a buffer or string can be two or more bytes (as many as four).
13931
13932 Buffers and strings are still made up of unibyte elements;
13933 character positions and string indices are always measured in bytes.
13934 Therefore, moving forward one character can increase the buffer
13935 position by 2, 3 or 4. The function forward-char moves by whole
13936 characters, and therefore is no longer equivalent to
13937 (lambda (n) (goto-char (+ (point) n))).
13938
13939 ASCII characters (codes 0 through 127) are still single bytes, always.
13940 Sequences of byte values 128 through 255 are used to represent
13941 non-ASCII characters. These sequences are called "multibyte
13942 characters".
13943
13944 The first byte of a multibyte character is always in the range 128
13945 through 159 (octal 0200 through 0237). These values are called
13946 "leading codes". The second and subsequent bytes are always in the
13947 range 160 through 255 (octal 0240 through 0377). The first byte, the
13948 leading code, determines how many bytes long the sequence is.
13949
13950 *** The function forward-char moves over characters, and therefore
13951 (forward-char 1) may increase point by more than 1 if it moves over a
13952 multibyte character. Likewise, delete-char always deletes a
13953 character, which may be more than one buffer position.
13954
13955 This means that some Lisp programs, which assume that a character is
13956 always one buffer position, need to be changed.
13957
13958 However, all ASCII characters are always one buffer position.
13959
13960 *** The regexp [\200-\377] no longer matches all non-ASCII characters,
13961 because when enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, these characters
13962 have codes that are not in the range octal 200 to octal 377. However,
13963 the regexp [^\000-\177] does match all non-ASCII characters,
13964 guaranteed.
13965
13966 *** The function char-boundary-p returns non-nil if position POS is
13967 between two characters in the buffer (not in the middle of a
13968 character).
13969
13970 When the value is non-nil, it says what kind of character follows POS:
13971
13972 0 if POS is at an ASCII character or at the end of range,
13973 1 if POS is before a 2-byte length multi-byte form,
13974 2 if POS is at a head of 3-byte length multi-byte form,
13975 3 if POS is at a head of 4-byte length multi-byte form,
13976 4 if POS is at a head of multi-byte form of a composite character.
13977
13978 *** The function char-bytes returns how many bytes the character CHAR uses.
13979
13980 *** Strings can contain multibyte characters. The function
13981 `length' returns the string length counting bytes, which may be
13982 more than the number of characters.
13983
13984 You can include a multibyte character in a string constant by writing
13985 it literally. You can also represent it with a hex escape,
13986 \xNNNNNNN..., using as many digits as necessary. Any character which
13987 is not a valid hex digit terminates this construct. If you want to
13988 follow it with a character that is a hex digit, write backslash and
13989 newline in between; that will terminate the hex escape.
13990
13991 *** The function concat-chars takes arguments which are characters
13992 and returns a string containing those characters.
13993
13994 *** The function sref access a multibyte character in a string.
13995 (sref STRING INDX) returns the character in STRING at INDEX. INDEX
13996 counts from zero. If INDEX is at a position in the middle of a
13997 character, sref signals an error.
13998
13999 *** The function chars-in-string returns the number of characters
14000 in a string. This is less than the length of the string, if the
14001 string contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
14002
14003 *** The function chars-in-region returns the number of characters
14004 in a region from BEG to END. This is less than (- END BEG) if the
14005 region contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
14006
14007 *** The function string-to-list converts a string to a list of
14008 the characters in it. string-to-vector converts a string
14009 to a vector of the characters in it.
14010
14011 *** The function store-substring alters part of the contents
14012 of a string. You call it as follows:
14013
14014 (store-substring STRING IDX OBJ)
14015
14016 This says to alter STRING, by storing OBJ starting at index IDX in
14017 STRING. OBJ may be either a character or a (smaller) string.
14018 This function really does alter the contents of STRING.
14019 Since it is impossible to change the length of an existing string,
14020 it is an error if OBJ doesn't fit within STRING's actual length.
14021
14022 *** char-width returns the width (in columns) of the character CHAR,
14023 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
14024
14025 *** string-width returns the width (in columns) of the text in STRING,
14026 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
14027
14028 *** truncate-string-to-width shortens a string, if necessary,
14029 to fit within a certain number of columns. (Of course, it does
14030 not alter the string that you give it; it returns a new string
14031 which contains all or just part of the existing string.)
14032
14033 (truncate-string-to-width STR END-COLUMN &optional START-COLUMN PADDING)
14034
14035 This returns the part of STR up to column END-COLUMN.
14036
14037 The optional argument START-COLUMN specifies the starting column.
14038 If this is non-nil, then the first START-COLUMN columns of the string
14039 are not included in the resulting value.
14040
14041 The optional argument PADDING, if non-nil, is a padding character to be added
14042 at the beginning and end the resulting string, to extend it to exactly
14043 WIDTH columns. If PADDING is nil, that means do not pad; then, if STRING
14044 is narrower than WIDTH, the value is equal to STRING.
14045
14046 If PADDING and START-COLUMN are both non-nil, and if there is no clean
14047 place in STRING that corresponds to START-COLUMN (because one
14048 character extends across that column), then the padding character
14049 PADDING is added one or more times at the beginning of the result
14050 string, so that its columns line up as if it really did start at
14051 column START-COLUMN.
14052
14053 *** When the functions in the list after-change-functions are called,
14054 the third argument is the number of bytes in the pre-change text, not
14055 necessarily the number of characters. It is, in effect, the
14056 difference in buffer position between the beginning and the end of the
14057 changed text, before the change.
14058
14059 *** The characters Emacs uses are classified in various character
14060 sets, each of which has a name which is a symbol. In general there is
14061 one character set for each script, not for each language.
14062
14063 **** The function charsetp tests whether an object is a character set name.
14064
14065 **** The variable charset-list holds a list of character set names.
14066
14067 **** char-charset, given a character code, returns the name of the character
14068 set that the character belongs to. (The value is a symbol.)
14069
14070 **** split-char, given a character code, returns a list containing the
14071 name of the character set, followed by one or two byte-values
14072 which identify the character within that character set.
14073
14074 **** make-char, given a character set name and one or two subsequent
14075 byte-values, constructs a character code. This is roughly the
14076 opposite of split-char.
14077
14078 **** find-charset-region returns a list of the character sets
14079 of all the characters between BEG and END.
14080
14081 **** find-charset-string returns a list of the character sets
14082 of all the characters in a string.
14083
14084 *** Here are the Lisp facilities for working with coding systems
14085 and specifying coding systems.
14086
14087 **** The function coding-system-list returns a list of all coding
14088 system names (symbols). With optional argument t, it returns a list
14089 of all distinct base coding systems, not including variants.
14090 (Variant coding systems are those like latin-1-dos, latin-1-unix
14091 and latin-1-mac which specify the end-of-line conversion as well
14092 as what to do about code conversion.)
14093
14094 **** coding-system-p tests a symbol to see if it is a coding system
14095 name. It returns t if so, nil if not.
14096
14097 **** file-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
14098 for certain file names. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
14099 except that the PATTERN is matched against the file name.
14100
14101 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
14102 which file names the element applies to. PATTERN should be a regexp
14103 to match against a file name.
14104
14105 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
14106 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
14107 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
14108 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
14109 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
14110 specifies the coding system for encoding.
14111
14112 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
14113 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
14114
14115 **** The variable network-coding-system-alist specifies
14116 the coding system to use for network sockets.
14117
14118 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
14119 which network sockets the element applies to. PATTERN should be
14120 either a port number or a regular expression matching some network
14121 service names.
14122
14123 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
14124 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
14125 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
14126 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
14127 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
14128 specifies the coding system for encoding.
14129
14130 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
14131 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
14132
14133 **** process-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
14134 for certain subprocess. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
14135 except that the PATTERN is matched against the program name used to
14136 start the subprocess.
14137
14138 **** The variable default-process-coding-system specifies the coding
14139 systems to use for subprocess (and net connection) input and output,
14140 when nothing else specifies what to do. The value is a cons cell
14141 (OUTPUT-CODING . INPUT-CODING). OUTPUT-CODING applies to output
14142 to the subprocess, and INPUT-CODING applies to input from it.
14143
14144 **** The variable coding-system-for-write, if non-nil, specifies the
14145 coding system to use for writing a file, or for output to a synchronous
14146 subprocess.
14147
14148 It also applies to any asynchronous subprocess or network connection,
14149 but in a different way: the value of coding-system-for-write when you
14150 start the subprocess or connection affects that subprocess or
14151 connection permanently or until overridden.
14152
14153 The variable coding-system-for-write takes precedence over
14154 file-coding-system-alist, process-coding-system-alist and
14155 network-coding-system-alist, and all other methods of specifying a
14156 coding system for output. But most of the time this variable is nil.
14157 It exists so that Lisp programs can bind it to a specific coding
14158 system for one operation at a time.
14159
14160 **** coding-system-for-read applies similarly to input from
14161 files, subprocesses or network connections.
14162
14163 **** The function process-coding-system tells you what
14164 coding systems(s) an existing subprocess is using.
14165 The value is a cons cell,
14166 (DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM . ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM)
14167 where DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for decoding output from
14168 the subprocess, and ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for encoding
14169 input to the subprocess.
14170
14171 **** The function set-process-coding-system can be used to
14172 change the coding systems in use for an existing subprocess.
14173
14174 ** Emacs has a new facility to help users manage the many
14175 customization options. To make a Lisp program work with this facility,
14176 you need to use the new macros defgroup and defcustom.
14177
14178 You use defcustom instead of defvar, for defining a user option
14179 variable. The difference is that you specify two additional pieces of
14180 information (usually): the "type" which says what values are
14181 legitimate, and the "group" which specifies the hierarchy for
14182 customization.
14183
14184 Thus, instead of writing
14185
14186 (defvar foo-blurgoze nil
14187 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely.")
14188
14189 you would now write this:
14190
14191 (defcustom foo-blurgoze nil
14192 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely."
14193 :type 'boolean
14194 :group foo)
14195
14196 The type `boolean' means that this variable has only
14197 two meaningful states: nil and non-nil. Other type values
14198 describe other possibilities; see the manual for Custom
14199 for a description of them.
14200
14201 The "group" argument is used to specify a group which the option
14202 should belong to. You define a new group like this:
14203
14204 (defgroup ispell nil
14205 "Spell checking using Ispell."
14206 :group 'processes)
14207
14208 The "group" argument in defgroup specifies the parent group. The root
14209 group is called `emacs'; it should not contain any variables itself,
14210 but only other groups. The immediate subgroups of `emacs' correspond
14211 to the keywords used by C-h p. Under these subgroups come
14212 second-level subgroups that belong to individual packages.
14213
14214 Each Emacs package should have its own set of groups. A simple
14215 package should have just one group; a more complex package should
14216 have a hierarchy of its own groups. The sole or root group of a
14217 package should be a subgroup of one or more of the "keyword"
14218 first-level subgroups.
14219
14220 ** New `widget' library for inserting UI components in buffers.
14221
14222 This library, used by the new custom library, is documented in a
14223 separate manual that accompanies Emacs.
14224
14225 ** easy-mmode
14226
14227 The easy-mmode package provides macros and functions that make
14228 developing minor modes easier. Roughly, the programmer has to code
14229 only the functionality of the minor mode. All the rest--toggles,
14230 predicate, and documentation--can be done in one call to the macro
14231 `easy-mmode-define-minor-mode' (see the documentation). See also
14232 `easy-mmode-define-keymap'.
14233
14234 ** Text property changes
14235
14236 *** The `intangible' property now works on overlays as well as on a
14237 text property.
14238
14239 *** The new functions next-char-property-change and
14240 previous-char-property-change scan through the buffer looking for a
14241 place where either a text property or an overlay might change. The
14242 functions take two arguments, POSITION and LIMIT. POSITION is the
14243 starting position for the scan. LIMIT says where to stop the scan.
14244
14245 If no property change is found before LIMIT, the value is LIMIT. If
14246 LIMIT is nil, scan goes to the beginning or end of the accessible part
14247 of the buffer. If no property change is found, the value is the
14248 position of the beginning or end of the buffer.
14249
14250 *** In the `local-map' text property or overlay property, the property
14251 value can now be a symbol whose function definition is a keymap. This
14252 is an alternative to using the keymap itself.
14253
14254 ** Changes in invisibility features
14255
14256 *** Isearch can now temporarily show parts of the buffer which are
14257 hidden by an overlay with a invisible property, when the search match
14258 is inside that portion of the buffer. To enable this the overlay
14259 should have a isearch-open-invisible property which is a function that
14260 would be called having the overlay as an argument, the function should
14261 make the overlay visible.
14262
14263 During incremental search the overlays are shown by modifying the
14264 invisible and intangible properties, if beside this more actions are
14265 needed the overlay should have a isearch-open-invisible-temporary
14266 which is a function. The function is called with 2 arguments: one is
14267 the overlay and the second is nil when it should show the overlay and
14268 t when it should hide it.
14269
14270 *** add-to-invisibility-spec, remove-from-invisibility-spec
14271
14272 Modes that use overlays to hide portions of a buffer should set the
14273 invisible property of the overlay to the mode's name (or another symbol)
14274 and modify the `buffer-invisibility-spec' to include that symbol.
14275 Use `add-to-invisibility-spec' and `remove-from-invisibility-spec' to
14276 manipulate the `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
14277 Here is an example of how to do this:
14278
14279 ;; If we want to display an ellipsis:
14280 (add-to-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
14281 ;; If you don't want ellipsis:
14282 (add-to-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
14283
14284 ...
14285 (overlay-put (make-overlay beginning end) 'invisible 'my-symbol)
14286
14287 ...
14288 ;; When done with the overlays:
14289 (remove-from-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
14290 ;; Or respectively:
14291 (remove-from-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
14292
14293 ** Changes in syntax parsing.
14294
14295 *** The syntax-directed buffer-scan functions (such as
14296 `parse-partial-sexp', `forward-word' and similar functions) can now
14297 obey syntax information specified by text properties, if the variable
14298 `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil.
14299
14300 If the value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is nil, the behavior
14301 is as before: the syntax-table of the current buffer is always
14302 used to determine the syntax of the character at the position.
14303
14304 When `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil, the syntax of a
14305 character in the buffer is calculated thus:
14306
14307 a) if the `syntax-table' text-property of that character
14308 is a cons, this cons becomes the syntax-type;
14309
14310 Valid values of `syntax-table' text-property are: nil, a valid
14311 syntax-table, and a valid syntax-table element, i.e.,
14312 a cons cell of the form (SYNTAX-CODE . MATCHING-CHAR).
14313
14314 b) if the character's `syntax-table' text-property
14315 is a syntax table, this syntax table is used
14316 (instead of the syntax-table of the current buffer) to
14317 determine the syntax type of the character.
14318
14319 c) otherwise the syntax-type is determined by the syntax-table
14320 of the current buffer.
14321
14322 *** The meaning of \s in regular expressions is also affected by the
14323 value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties'. The details are the same as
14324 for the syntax-directed buffer-scan functions.
14325
14326 *** There are two new syntax-codes, `!' and `|' (numeric values 14
14327 and 15). A character with a code `!' starts a comment which is ended
14328 only by another character with the same code (unless quoted). A
14329 character with a code `|' starts a string which is ended only by
14330 another character with the same code (unless quoted).
14331
14332 These codes are mainly meant for use as values of the `syntax-table'
14333 text property.
14334
14335 *** The function `parse-partial-sexp' has new semantics for the sixth
14336 arg COMMENTSTOP. If it is `syntax-table', parse stops after the start
14337 of a comment or a string, or after end of a comment or a string.
14338
14339 *** The state-list which the return value from `parse-partial-sexp'
14340 (and can also be used as an argument) now has an optional ninth
14341 element: the character address of the start of last comment or string;
14342 nil if none. The fourth and eighth elements have special values if the
14343 string/comment is started by a "!" or "|" syntax-code.
14344
14345 *** Since new features of `parse-partial-sexp' allow a complete
14346 syntactic parsing, `font-lock' no longer supports
14347 `font-lock-comment-start-regexp'.
14348
14349 ** Changes in face features
14350
14351 *** The face functions are now unconditionally defined in Emacs, even
14352 if it does not support displaying on a device that supports faces.
14353
14354 *** The function face-documentation returns the documentation string
14355 of a face (or nil if it doesn't have one).
14356
14357 *** The function face-bold-p returns t if a face should be bold.
14358 set-face-bold-p sets that flag.
14359
14360 *** The function face-italic-p returns t if a face should be italic.
14361 set-face-italic-p sets that flag.
14362
14363 *** You can now specify foreground and background colors for text
14364 by adding elements of the form (foreground-color . COLOR-NAME)
14365 and (background-color . COLOR-NAME) to the list of faces in
14366 the `face' property (either the character's text property or an
14367 overlay property).
14368
14369 This means that you no longer need to create named faces to use
14370 arbitrary colors in a Lisp package.
14371
14372 ** Changes in file-handling functions
14373
14374 *** File-access primitive functions no longer discard an extra redundant
14375 directory name from the beginning of the file name. In other words,
14376 they no longer do anything special with // or /~. That conversion
14377 is now done only in substitute-in-file-name.
14378
14379 This makes it possible for a Lisp program to open a file whose name
14380 begins with ~.
14381
14382 *** If copy-file is unable to set the date of the output file,
14383 it now signals an error with the condition file-date-error.
14384
14385 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
14386 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a list of integers.
14387
14388 *** insert-file-contents can now read from a special file,
14389 as long as the arguments VISIT and REPLACE are nil.
14390
14391 *** The RAWFILE arg to find-file-noselect, if non-nil, now suppresses
14392 character code conversion as well as other things.
14393
14394 Meanwhile, this feature does work with remote file names
14395 (formerly it did not).
14396
14397 *** Lisp packages which create temporary files should use the TMPDIR
14398 environment variable to decide which directory to put them in.
14399
14400 *** interpreter-mode-alist elements now specify regexps
14401 instead of constant strings.
14402
14403 *** expand-file-name no longer treats `//' or `/~' specially. It used
14404 to delete all the text of a file name up through the first slash of
14405 any `//' or `/~' sequence. Now it passes them straight through.
14406
14407 substitute-in-file-name continues to treat those sequences specially,
14408 in the same way as before.
14409
14410 *** The variable `format-alist' is more general now.
14411 The FROM-FN and TO-FN in a format definition can now be strings
14412 which specify shell commands to use as filters to perform conversion.
14413
14414 *** The new function access-file tries to open a file, and signals an
14415 error if that fails. If the open succeeds, access-file does nothing
14416 else, and returns nil.
14417
14418 *** The function insert-directory now signals an error if the specified
14419 directory cannot be listed.
14420
14421 ** Changes in minibuffer input
14422
14423 *** The functions read-buffer, read-variable, read-command, read-string
14424 read-file-name, read-from-minibuffer and completing-read now take an
14425 additional argument which specifies the default value. If this
14426 argument is non-nil, it should be a string; that string is used in two
14427 ways:
14428
14429 It is returned if the user enters empty input.
14430 It is available through the history command M-n.
14431
14432 *** The functions read-string, read-from-minibuffer,
14433 read-no-blanks-input and completing-read now take an additional
14434 argument INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. If this is non-nil, then the
14435 minibuffer inherits the current input method and the setting of
14436 enable-multibyte-characters from the previously current buffer.
14437
14438 In an interactive spec, you can use M instead of s to read an
14439 argument in this way.
14440
14441 *** All minibuffer input functions discard text properties
14442 from the text you enter in the minibuffer, unless the variable
14443 minibuffer-allow-text-properties is non-nil.
14444
14445 ** Echo area features
14446
14447 *** Clearing the echo area now runs the normal hook
14448 echo-area-clear-hook. Note that the echo area can be used while the
14449 minibuffer is active; in that case, the minibuffer is still active
14450 after the echo area is cleared.
14451
14452 *** The function current-message returns the message currently displayed
14453 in the echo area, or nil if there is none.
14454
14455 ** Keyboard input features
14456
14457 *** tty-erase-char is a new variable that reports which character was
14458 set up as the terminal's erase character when time Emacs was started.
14459
14460 *** num-nonmacro-input-events is the total number of input events
14461 received so far from the terminal. It does not count those generated
14462 by keyboard macros.
14463
14464 ** Frame-related changes
14465
14466 *** make-frame runs the normal hook before-make-frame-hook just before
14467 creating a frame, and just after creating a frame it runs the abnormal
14468 hook after-make-frame-functions with the new frame as arg.
14469
14470 *** The new hook window-configuration-change-hook is now run every time
14471 the window configuration has changed. The frame whose configuration
14472 has changed is the selected frame when the hook is run.
14473
14474 *** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
14475 selected buffers, in its buffer-list frame parameter, so that the
14476 value of other-buffer is now based on the buffers recently displayed
14477 in the selected frame.
14478
14479 *** The value of the frame parameter vertical-scroll-bars
14480 is now `left', `right' or nil. A non-nil value specifies
14481 which side of the window to put the scroll bars on.
14482
14483 ** X Windows features
14484
14485 *** You can examine X resources for other applications by binding
14486 x-resource-class around a call to x-get-resource. The usual value of
14487 x-resource-class is "Emacs", which is the correct value for Emacs.
14488
14489 *** In menus, checkboxes and radio buttons now actually work.
14490 The menu displays the current status of the box or button.
14491
14492 *** The function x-list-fonts now takes an optional fourth argument
14493 MAXIMUM which sets a limit on how many matching fonts to return.
14494 A smaller value of MAXIMUM makes the function faster.
14495
14496 If the only question is whether *any* font matches the pattern,
14497 it is good to supply 1 for this argument.
14498
14499 ** Subprocess features
14500
14501 *** A reminder: it is no longer necessary for subprocess filter
14502 functions and sentinels to do save-match-data, because Emacs does this
14503 automatically.
14504
14505 *** The new function shell-command-to-string executes a shell command
14506 and returns the output from the command as a string.
14507
14508 *** The new function process-contact returns t for a child process,
14509 and (HOSTNAME SERVICE) for a net connection.
14510
14511 ** An error in running pre-command-hook or post-command-hook
14512 does clear the variable to nil. The documentation was wrong before.
14513
14514 ** In define-key-after, if AFTER is t, the new binding now always goes
14515 at the end of the keymap. If the keymap is a menu, this means it
14516 goes after the other menu items.
14517
14518 ** If you have a program that makes several changes in the same area
14519 of the buffer, you can use the macro combine-after-change-calls
14520 around that Lisp code to make it faster when after-change hooks
14521 are in use.
14522
14523 The macro arranges to call the after-change functions just once for a
14524 series of several changes--if that seems safe.
14525
14526 Don't alter the variables after-change-functions and
14527 after-change-function within the body of a combine-after-change-calls
14528 form.
14529
14530 ** If you define an abbrev (with define-abbrev) whose EXPANSION
14531 is not a string, then the abbrev does not expand in the usual sense,
14532 but its hook is still run.
14533
14534 ** Normally, the Lisp debugger is not used (even if you have enabled it)
14535 for errors that are handled by condition-case.
14536
14537 If you set debug-on-signal to a non-nil value, then the debugger is called
14538 regardless of whether there is a handler for the condition. This is
14539 useful for debugging problems that happen inside of a condition-case.
14540
14541 This mode of operation seems to be unreliable in other ways. Errors that
14542 are normal and ought to be handled, perhaps in timers or process
14543 filters, will instead invoke the debugger. So don't say you weren't
14544 warned.
14545
14546 ** The new variable ring-bell-function lets you specify your own
14547 way for Emacs to "ring the bell".
14548
14549 ** If run-at-time's TIME argument is t, the action is repeated at
14550 integral multiples of REPEAT from the epoch; this is useful for
14551 functions like display-time.
14552
14553 ** You can use the function locate-library to find the precise file
14554 name of a Lisp library. This isn't new, but wasn't documented before.
14555
14556 ** Commands for entering view mode have new optional arguments that
14557 can be used from Lisp. Low-level entrance to and exit from view mode
14558 is done by functions view-mode-enter and view-mode-exit.
14559
14560 ** batch-byte-compile-file now makes Emacs return a nonzero status code
14561 if there is an error in compilation.
14562
14563 ** pop-to-buffer, switch-to-buffer-other-window and
14564 switch-to-buffer-other-frame now accept an additional optional
14565 argument NORECORD, much like switch-to-buffer. If it is non-nil,
14566 they don't put the buffer at the front of the buffer list.
14567
14568 ** If your .emacs file leaves the *scratch* buffer non-empty,
14569 Emacs does not display the startup message, so as to avoid changing
14570 the *scratch* buffer.
14571
14572 ** The new function regexp-opt returns an efficient regexp to match a string.
14573 The arguments are STRINGS and (optionally) PAREN. This function can be used
14574 where regexp matching or searching is intensively used and speed is important,
14575 e.g., in Font Lock mode.
14576
14577 ** The variable buffer-display-count is local to each buffer,
14578 and is incremented each time the buffer is displayed in a window.
14579 It starts at 0 when the buffer is created.
14580
14581 ** The new function compose-mail starts composing a mail message
14582 using the user's chosen mail composition agent (specified with the
14583 variable mail-user-agent). It has variants compose-mail-other-window
14584 and compose-mail-other-frame.
14585
14586 ** The `user-full-name' function now takes an optional parameter which
14587 can either be a number (the UID) or a string (the login name). The
14588 full name of the specified user will be returned.
14589
14590 ** Lisp packages that load files of customizations, or any other sort
14591 of user profile, should obey the variable init-file-user in deciding
14592 where to find it. They should load the profile of the user name found
14593 in that variable. If init-file-user is nil, meaning that the -q
14594 option was used, then Lisp packages should not load the customization
14595 files at all.
14596
14597 ** format-time-string now allows you to specify the field width
14598 and type of padding. This works as in printf: you write the field
14599 width as digits in the middle of a %-construct. If you start
14600 the field width with 0, it means to pad with zeros.
14601
14602 For example, %S normally specifies the number of seconds since the
14603 minute; %03S means to pad this with zeros to 3 positions, %_3S to pad
14604 with spaces to 3 positions. Plain %3S pads with zeros, because that
14605 is how %S normally pads to two positions.
14606
14607 ** thing-at-point now supports a new kind of "thing": url.
14608
14609 ** imenu.el changes.
14610
14611 You can now specify a function to be run when selecting an
14612 item from menu created by imenu.
14613
14614 An example of using this feature: if we define imenu items for the
14615 #include directives in a C file, we can open the included file when we
14616 select one of those items.
14617 \f
14618 * For older news, see the file ONEWS
14619
14620 ----------------------------------------------------------------------
14621 Copyright information:
14622
14623 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004,
14624 2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
14625
14626 Permission is granted to anyone to make or distribute verbatim copies
14627 of this document as received, in any medium, provided that the
14628 copyright notice and this permission notice are preserved,
14629 thus giving the recipient permission to redistribute in turn.
14630
14631 Permission is granted to distribute modified versions
14632 of this document, or of portions of it,
14633 under the above conditions, provided also that they
14634 carry prominent notices stating who last changed them.
14635 \f
14636 Local variables:
14637 mode: outline
14638 paragraph-separate: "[ \f]*$"
14639 end:
14640
14641 arch-tag: 1aca9dfa-2ac4-4d14-bebf-0007cee12793